US20080254512A1 - Hybrid immunoglobulins with moving parts - Google Patents

Hybrid immunoglobulins with moving parts Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20080254512A1
US20080254512A1 US11/982,085 US98208507A US2008254512A1 US 20080254512 A1 US20080254512 A1 US 20080254512A1 US 98208507 A US98208507 A US 98208507A US 2008254512 A1 US2008254512 A1 US 2008254512A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
amino acids
stretch
terminal
sequence
consecutive amino
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US11/982,085
Inventor
Daniel J. Capon
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Biomolecular Holdings LLC
Original Assignee
Capon Daniel J
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Capon Daniel J filed Critical Capon Daniel J
Priority to US11/982,085 priority Critical patent/US20080254512A1/en
Publication of US20080254512A1 publication Critical patent/US20080254512A1/en
Priority to US15/198,475 priority patent/US10428332B2/en
Priority to US16/590,143 priority patent/US20200032272A1/en
Assigned to BIOMOLECULAR HOLDINGS LLC reassignment BIOMOLECULAR HOLDINGS LLC ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: CAPON, DANIEL J.
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K19/00Hybrid peptides, i.e. peptides covalently bound to nucleic acids, or non-covalently bound protein-protein complexes
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N15/00Mutation or genetic engineering; DNA or RNA concerning genetic engineering, vectors, e.g. plasmids, or their isolation, preparation or purification; Use of hosts therefor
    • C12N15/09Recombinant DNA-technology
    • C12N15/11DNA or RNA fragments; Modified forms thereof; Non-coding nucleic acids having a biological activity
    • C12N15/62DNA sequences coding for fusion proteins
    • C12N15/625DNA sequences coding for fusion proteins containing a sequence coding for a signal sequence
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K47/00Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient
    • A61K47/50Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates
    • A61K47/51Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent
    • A61K47/68Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent the modifying agent being an antibody, an immunoglobulin or a fragment thereof, e.g. an Fc-fragment
    • A61K47/6835Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent the modifying agent being an antibody, an immunoglobulin or a fragment thereof, e.g. an Fc-fragment the modifying agent being an antibody or an immunoglobulin bearing at least one antigen-binding site
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K47/00Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient
    • A61K47/50Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates
    • A61K47/51Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent
    • A61K47/68Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent the modifying agent being an antibody, an immunoglobulin or a fragment thereof, e.g. an Fc-fragment
    • A61K47/6835Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent the modifying agent being an antibody, an immunoglobulin or a fragment thereof, e.g. an Fc-fragment the modifying agent being an antibody or an immunoglobulin bearing at least one antigen-binding site
    • A61K47/6875Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent the modifying agent being an antibody, an immunoglobulin or a fragment thereof, e.g. an Fc-fragment the modifying agent being an antibody or an immunoglobulin bearing at least one antigen-binding site the antibody being a hybrid immunoglobulin
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K51/00Preparations containing radioactive substances for use in therapy or testing in vivo
    • A61K51/02Preparations containing radioactive substances for use in therapy or testing in vivo characterised by the carrier, i.e. characterised by the agent or material covalently linked or complexing the radioactive nucleus
    • A61K51/04Organic compounds
    • A61K51/08Peptides, e.g. proteins, carriers being peptides, polyamino acids, proteins
    • A61K51/10Antibodies or immunoglobulins; Fragments thereof, the carrier being an antibody, an immunoglobulin or a fragment thereof, e.g. a camelised human single domain antibody or the Fc fragment of an antibody
    • A61K51/1084Antibodies or immunoglobulins; Fragments thereof, the carrier being an antibody, an immunoglobulin or a fragment thereof, e.g. a camelised human single domain antibody or the Fc fragment of an antibody the antibody being a hybrid immunoglobulin
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P11/00Drugs for disorders of the respiratory system
    • A61P11/06Antiasthmatics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P17/00Drugs for dermatological disorders
    • A61P17/06Antipsoriatics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P19/00Drugs for skeletal disorders
    • A61P19/02Drugs for skeletal disorders for joint disorders, e.g. arthritis, arthrosis
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P29/00Non-central analgesic, antipyretic or antiinflammatory agents, e.g. antirheumatic agents; Non-steroidal antiinflammatory drugs [NSAID]
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • A61P35/02Antineoplastic agents specific for leukemia
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • A61P35/04Antineoplastic agents specific for metastasis
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K16/00Immunoglobulins [IGs], e.g. monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies
    • C07K16/18Immunoglobulins [IGs], e.g. monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies against material from animals or humans
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N15/00Mutation or genetic engineering; DNA or RNA concerning genetic engineering, vectors, e.g. plasmids, or their isolation, preparation or purification; Use of hosts therefor
    • C12N15/09Recombinant DNA-technology
    • C12N15/11DNA or RNA fragments; Modified forms thereof; Non-coding nucleic acids having a biological activity
    • C12N15/62DNA sequences coding for fusion proteins
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12PFERMENTATION OR ENZYME-USING PROCESSES TO SYNTHESISE A DESIRED CHEMICAL COMPOUND OR COMPOSITION OR TO SEPARATE OPTICAL ISOMERS FROM A RACEMIC MIXTURE
    • C12P21/00Preparation of peptides or proteins
    • C12P21/02Preparation of peptides or proteins having a known sequence of two or more amino acids, e.g. glutathione
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K2317/00Immunoglobulins specific features
    • C07K2317/50Immunoglobulins specific features characterized by immunoglobulin fragments
    • C07K2317/52Constant or Fc region; Isotype
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K2319/00Fusion polypeptide
    • C07K2319/30Non-immunoglobulin-derived peptide or protein having an immunoglobulin constant or Fc region, or a fragment thereof, attached thereto

Definitions

  • Moving parts All machines and devices have moving parts.
  • the function of the moving parts is to perform work, by transforming a source of energy, in order to carry out a useful task.
  • Moving parts cover a spectrum of sizes and shapes. At one end of the spectrum is a visible world evident in machines that perform mechanical tasks. At the other end of the spectrum is an invisible world of charge carriers utilized by devices that carry out electrical work.
  • Nano-machines have the potential to exploit the unique properties of molecules, such as intermolecular binding or catalysis.
  • any two given atoms interconnected by a single bond i.e., a single electron pair
  • a single bond can rotate fully 360 degrees with respect to each other and with respect to the other atoms that each is bonded to.
  • a series of consecutive single bonds is like a series of interconnected ball joints.
  • a series of consecutive single bonds like a series of consecutive ball joints, can recapitulate the movement of other types of interconnected moving parts (e.g., a series of consecutive hinges).
  • Globular proteins are, for nearly all practical purposes, machines with few if any moving parts, like a crowbar that must exert its leverage in combination with other objects, such as the human that wields it and the objects against which it is wedged. Notwithstanding, there are many instances in which there would be great value to protein-like molecules having distinct regions (e.g., binding domains) that are joined together in some manner permitting relative, yet coordinated movement.
  • protein-like molecules capable of cooperatively binding a disease target having two or more identical binding sites. This would take full advantage of the unique properties of globular protein binding domains, namely their great specificity for targets, particularly other proteins associated with disease.
  • the potential commercial value of protein-like molecules that are able to cooperatively bind a disease target may be estimated quantitatively.
  • a starting assumption is that most therapeutics in current use, whether small molecules or biopharmaceuticals, typically bind their targets non-cooperatively with affinity constants on the order of nano-molar (10 ⁇ 9 M).
  • a cooperative therapeutic could conceivably bind the same target, with an affinity of nano-molar ⁇ nano-molar (10 ⁇ 9 M ⁇ 10 ⁇ 9 M) [i.e., atto-molar (10 ⁇ 18 M)].
  • a “one size fits all” strategy is based upon the proposition that a protein-like molecule with binding domains that move symmetrically will also be capable of binding symmetrically (i.e., cooperativity)
  • the binding domains are driven thermodynamically into a conformation most compatible with simultaneous binding of both target sites because it represents the energetically favored conformational minima.
  • each X is the same and represents a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and each C represents a beta-carbon of one of such cysteine or selenocysteine residues.
  • each X may be the same or different and represents a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and each C represents a beta-carbon of one of such cysteine or selenocysteine residues.
  • Genetic devices disclosed herein comprise two or more stretches of consecutive amino acids that are connected at a predefined terminus by a non-peptide bond. Such genetic devices are both symmetric and symmetrically binding with respect to one or more important targets (i.e., cooperative).
  • the genetic devices herein are protein-like molecules may be described by a number of related terms that include symmetroadhesins, immuno-symmetroadhesins, hemi-symmetroadhesins, and bi-symmetroadhesins [meaning “stick to proportionately,” from the Gk. symmetros “having a common measure, even, proportionate,” and the L. adhaerentem , prp. of adhaerere “stick to”].
  • Disclosed herein is a compound comprising two or more independently-folding protein domains linked to one another through one or more non-peptide bonds, around which bond(s) dihedral rotation may occur.
  • FIG. 1 Stretches of consecutive amino acids, with one X-terminus, depicting positions of N-, C-, S-, and Se-termini.
  • FIG. 2 Stretches of consecutive amino acids, with two X-termini, depicting positions of N-, C-, S-, and Se-termini. N-terminal and C-terminal amino acid residues, drawn as a Newman-style projection, are shown above and below the projection plane, respectively.
  • FIG. 3 General structure of a chimeric polypeptide consisting of a first stretch of consecutive amino acids joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a second stretch of consecutive amino acids.
  • Chimeric polypeptides like proteins found in nature, are continuous stretches of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond. Like other proteins, chimeric polypeptides have limited conformational flexibility because the peptide bond by itself provides no more than two consecutive single bonds capable of dihedral rotation along the polypeptide chain.
  • the major and minor tautomeric forms and the resonance structure are shown on the left, center and right, respectively.
  • FIG. 4A General structure of a “symmetroadhesin” with a head-to-tail configuration consisting of a first stretch of consecutive amino acids joined at its C-terminal-X-terminus by an -X-X- bond to the N-terminal-X-terminus of a second stretch of consecutive amino acids.
  • the -X-X- bond is not a peptide bond.
  • Non-limiting examples of the bonds envisaged here include any combination wherein each X is a S or a Se atom.
  • the overall polarity of head-to-tail symmetroadhesins is N- to C-terminal.
  • Symmetroadhesins like proteins, are stretches of consecutive amino acids each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid, but differ from proteins by substituting one or more -X-X- bonds for peptide bonds. Symmetroadhesins have greater conformational flexibility than polypeptides because each -X-X- bond provides seven adjacent single bonds capable of dihedral rotation.
  • the major and minor tautomeric forms and the resonance structure are shown on the left, center and right, respectively.
  • FIG. 4B The symmetroadhesin of FIG. 4A (left) compared with a symmetroadhesin (right) consisting of a first stretch of consecutive amino acids joined at the X-terminus of its penultimate C-terminal residue by an -X-X- bond to the X-terminus of the penultimate N-terminal residue of a second stretch of consecutive amino acids. Resonance structures are shown for each.
  • FIG. 4C The symmetroadhesin of FIG. 4A (left) compared with a symmetroadhesin (right) consisting of a first stretch of consecutive amino acids joined at the X-terminus of its antepenultimate C-terminal residue by an -X-X- bond to the X-terminus of the antepenultimate N-terminal residue of a second stretch of consecutive amino acids. Resonance structures are shown for each.
  • FIG. 4D The symmetroadhesin of FIG. 4A (left) compared with a symmetroadhesin (right) consisting of a first stretch of consecutive amino acids joined at the X-terminus of its preantepenultimate C-terminal residue by an -X-X- bond to the X-terminus of the preantepenultimate N-terminal residue of a second stretch of consecutive amino acids. Resonance structures are shown for each.
  • FIG. 5 General structure of a symmetroadhesin with a head-to-head configuration consisting of a first stretch of consecutive amino acids, joined at its N-terminal-X-terminus by an -X-X- bond to the N-terminal-X-terminus of a second stretch of consecutive amino acids.
  • the overall polarity of head-to-head symmetroadhesins changes at the position of the -X-X- bond, going from C- to N-terminal to N- to C-terminal.
  • the major and minor tautomeric forms and the resonance structure are shown on the left, center and right, respectively.
  • FIG. 6 General structure of a symmetroadhesin with a tail-to-tail configuration consisting of a first stretch of consecutive amino acids joined at its C-terminal-X-terminus by an -X-X- bond to the C-terminal-X-terminus of a second stretch of consecutive amino acids.
  • the overall polarity of tail-to-tail symmetroadhesins changes at the position of the -X-X- bond, going from N- to C-terminal to C- to N-terminal.
  • the major and minor tautomeric forms and the resonance structure are shown on the left, center and right, respectively.
  • FIG. 7 A schematic representation of a head-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesin showing the all-trans conformation. All of the seven consecutive single bonds joining the C-terminal-X-terminus with the N-terminal-X-terminus are trans (N—C—C—X—X—C—C—C). The two binding domains are pointed away from one another in this conformation; a rotation of 180 degrees around any one of the seven consecutive single bonds will point the two binding domains towards one another. Hemi-symmetroadhesins with the head-to-tail configuration are asymmetric molecules regardless of conformation (compare FIGS. 7 and 8 ); however, two or more head-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesins can together form a symmetric molecule.
  • FIG. 8 A schematic representation of a head-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesin showing the X-cis-X conformation. All but one of seven consecutive single bonds joining the C-terminal-X-terminus with the N-terminal-X-terminus are trans (N—C—C—X-cis-X—C—C—C). The two binding domains are pointed towards one another in this conformation; further rotations of 180 degrees around any one of the seven consecutive single bonds will point the two binding domains away from one another. Hemi-symmetroadhesins with the head-to-tail configuration are asymmetric molecules regardless of conformation (compare FIGS. 7 and 8 ); however, two or more head-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesins can together form a symmetric molecule.
  • FIG. 9 A schematic representation of a head-to-head hemi-symmetroadhesin showing the all-trans conformation. All of the seven consecutive single bonds joining the 1 st N-terminal-X-terminus and 2 nd N-terminal-X-terminus are trans (C—C—C—X—X—C—C—C). The two binding domains are pointed away from one another in this conformation; a rotation of 180 degrees around any one of the seven consecutive single bonds will point the two binding domains towards one another.
  • Hemi-symmetroadhesins with the head-to-head configuration are symmetric molecules in only two of their possible conformations: the all-trans and the X-cis-X (compare FIGS. 9 and 10 ); however, two or more head-to-head hemi-symmetroadhesins subunits can form a molecule that has an unlimited number of symmetric conformations.
  • FIG. 10 A schematic representation of a head-to-head hemi-symmetroadhesin showing the X-cis-X conformation. All but one of the seven consecutive single bonds joining the 1 st N-terminal-X-terminus and 2 nd N-terminal-X-terminus are trans (C—C—C—X-cis-X—C—C—C). The two binding domains are pointed towards one another in this conformation; further rotations of 180 degrees around any one of the seven consecutive single bonds will point the two binding domains away from one another.
  • Hemi-symmetroadhesins with the head-to-head configuration are symmetric molecules in only two of their possible conformations: the all-trans and the X-cis-X (compare FIGS. 9 and 10 ); however, two or more head-to-head hemi-symmetroadhesins subunits can form a molecule that has an unlimited number of symmetric conformations.
  • FIG. 11 A schematic representation of a tail-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesin showing the all-trans conformation. All of the seven consecutive single bonds joining the 1 st C-terminal-X-terminus and 2 nd C-terminal-X-terminus are trans (N—C—C—X—X—C—C—N). The two binding domains are pointed away from one another in this conformation; a rotation of 180 degrees around any one of the seven consecutive single bonds will point the two binding domains towards one another.
  • Hemi-symmetroadhesins with the tail-to-tail configuration are symmetric molecules in only two of their possible conformations: the all-trans and the X-cis-X (compare FIGS. 11 and 12 ); however, two or more tail-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesins subunits can form a molecule that has an unlimited number of symmetric conformations.
  • FIG. 12 A schematic representation of a tail-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesin showing the X-cis-X conformation. All but one of the seven consecutive single bonds joining the 1 st C-terminal-X-terminus and 2 nd C-terminal-X-terminus are trans (N—C—C—X-cis-X—C—C—N). The two binding domains are pointed towards one another in this conformation; further rotations of 180 degrees around any one of the seven consecutive single bonds will point the two binding domains away from one another.
  • Hemi-symmetroadhesins with the tail-to-tail configuration are symmetric molecules in only two of their possible conformations: the all-trans and the X-cis-X (compare FIGS. 9 and 10 ); however, two or more tail-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesins subunits can form a molecule that has an unlimited number of symmetric conformations.
  • FIG. 13 A schematic representation of a tail-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesin consisting of two immunoglobulin Fab binding domains. The all-trans conformation is shown here. All of the seven consecutive single bonds joining the 1 st C-terminal-X-terminus and 2 nd C-terminal-X-terminus are trans (N—C—C—X—X—C—C—N). The two Fab binding domains are pointed away from one another in this conformation; a rotation of 180 degrees around any one of the seven consecutive single bonds will point the Fab binding domains towards one another (compare FIGS. 13 and 14 ).
  • VL light chain variable region
  • CL light chain constant region
  • VH heavy chain variable region
  • CH heavy chain constant region 1.
  • FIG. 14 A schematic representation of a tail-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesin consisting of two immunoglobulin Fab binding domains.
  • the X-cis-X conformation is shown here. All but one of seven consecutive single bonds joining the 1 st C-terminal-X-terminus and 2 nd C-terminal-X-terminus are trans (N—C—C—X-cis-X—C—C—N).
  • the two Fab binding domains are pointed towards one another in this conformation; further rotation of 180 degrees around any one of the seven consecutive single bonds will point the Fab binding domains away from one another (compare FIGS. 13 and 14 ).
  • VL light chain variable region
  • CL light chain constant region
  • VH heavy chain variable region
  • CH heavy chain constant region 1.
  • FIG. 15 Schematic representation of the immunoadhesin molecule (Capon et al. (1989) Nature 337, 525-530).
  • Immunoadhesins are chimeric polypeptides that form disulfide-linked dimers. Each chimeric polypeptide consists of a binding domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of an immunoglobulin Fc domain. Although immunoadhesins are structurally symmetric, they do not generally bind cooperatively to dimeric or multimeric target molecules.
  • FIG. 16 Schematic representation of the immunoglobulin (antibody) molecule.
  • Immunoglobulins are heterotetramers consisting of two heavy chains and two light chains. Although immunoglobulins are structurally symmetric, they do not generally bind cooperatively to dimeric or multimeric target molecules.
  • VL light chain variable region
  • CL light chain constant region
  • VH heavy chain variable region
  • CH1 heavy chain constant region 1
  • CH2 heavy chain constant region 2
  • FIG. 17 A schematic representation of a head-to-tail immunosymmetroadhesin showing the all-trans conformation.
  • Head-to-tail immunosymmetroadhesins are head-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesins that form disulfide-linked dimers.
  • Each hemi-symmetroadhesin consists of an immunoglobulin Fab binding domain having a C-terminal-X-terminus joined by an -X-X- bond to a immunoglobulin Fc subunit having an N-terminal-X-terminus.
  • the dimer contains two functional Fab binding domains and one functional Fc binding domain.
  • the seven consecutive single bonds which join each Fab domain to an Fc subunit are all trans (N—C—C—X—X—C—C—C). Symmetric rotations of 180 degrees around the first (N—C), third (C—X), fifth (X—C), or seventh (C—C) pairs of consecutive single bonds will move the two Fab domains in a first general direction (compare FIGS. 17 and 18 ). Symmetric rotations of 180 degrees around the second (C—C), fourth (X—X), or sixth (C—C) single bond pairs will move the two Fab domains in a second general direction (compare FIGS. 17 and 19 ).
  • FIG. 18 A schematic representation of a head-to-tail immunosymmetroadhesin showing the X-cis-C conformation.
  • the X-cis-C conformation is obtained from the all-trans conformation by the symmetric rotation of the fifth pair of seven consecutive single bonds (N—C—C—X—X-cis-C—C—C) (compare FIGS. 17 and 18 ).
  • FIG. 19 A schematic representation of a head-to-tail immunosymmetroadhesin showing the X-cis-X conformation.
  • the X-cis-X conformation is obtained from the all-trans conformation by the symmetric rotation of the fourth pair of seven consecutive single bonds (N—C—C—X-cis-X—C—C—C) (compare FIGS. 17 and 19 ).
  • Other conformations that are similar to the X-cis-X conformation shown here are obtained from the all-trans conformation following the symmetric rotation of the second (N—C-cis-C—X—X—C-C—C), or the sixth pairs (N—C-C—X—X—C-cis-C—C) of consecutive single bonds.
  • FIG. 20 A schematic representation of a tail-to-tail immunosymmetroadhesin showing the all-trans conformation.
  • Tail-to-tail immunosymmetroadhesins are tail-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesins that form disulfide-linked dimers.
  • Each hemi-symmetroadhesin consists of an immunoglobulin Fab binding domain having a C-terminal-X-terminus joined by an X-X bond to an immunoglobulin Fc subunit having a C-terminal-X-terminus.
  • the dimer contains two functional Fab binding domains and one functional Fc binding domain.
  • the seven consecutive single bonds which join each Fab domain to an Fc subunit are all trans (N—C—C—X—X—C—C—N). Symmetric rotations of 180 degrees around the first (N—C), third (C—X), fifth (X—C), or seventh (C—N) pairs of consecutive single bonds will move the two Fab domains in a first general direction (compare FIGS. 20 and 21 ). Symmetric rotations of 180 degrees around the second (C—C), fourth (X—X), or sixth (C—C) single bond pairs will move the two Fab domains in a second general direction (compare FIGS. 20 and 22 ).
  • FIG. 21 A schematic representation of a tail-to-tail immunosymmetroadhesin showing the X-cis-C conformation.
  • the X-cis-C conformation is obtained from the all-trans conformation by the symmetric rotation of the fifth pair of seven consecutive single bonds (N—C—C—X—X-cis-C—C—N) (compare FIGS. 20 and 21 ).
  • FIG. 22 A schematic representation of a tail-to-tail immunosymmetroadhesin showing the X-cis-X conformation.
  • the X-cis-X conformation is obtained from the all-trans conformation by the symmetric rotation of the fourth pair of seven consecutive single bonds (N—C—C—X-cis-X—C—C—N) (compare FIGS. 20 and 22 ).
  • Other conformations that are similar to the X-cis-X conformation shown here are obtained from the all-trans conformation following the symmetric rotation of the second (N—C-cis-C—X—X—C—C—N), or the sixth pairs (N—C—C—X—X—C-cis-C—N) of consecutive single bonds.
  • FIG. 23 Schematic representation of bi-symmetroadhesin with four Fab binding domains, showing the all-trans conformation.
  • the molecule is a dimer of two hemi-symmetroadhesins each consisting of three stretches of consecutive amino acids.
  • the bi-symmetroadhesin shown here is a head-to-tail, tail-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesin that forms disulfide-linked dimers.
  • Each hemi-symmetroadhesin consists of two immunoglobulin Fab domains having a C-terminal-X-terminus that is joined by an -X-X- bond to a immunoglobulin Fc subunit; the first Fab domain is joined to the Fc N-terminal-X-terminus, and the second Fab is joined to the Fc C-terminal-X-terminus.
  • the dimer has four functional Fab binding domains, and one functional Fc binding domain. The seven consecutive single bonds which join all four Fab domains to an Fc subunit are all trans (N—C—C—X—X—C—C—C/N).
  • Symmetric rotations of 180 degrees around the first (N—C), third (C—X), fifth (X—C), or seventh (C—C/N) pairs of consecutive single bonds will move the four Fab domains in a first general direction (compare FIGS. 23 and 24 ).
  • Symmetric rotations of 180 degrees around the second (C—C), fourth (X—X), or sixth (C—C) single bond pairs will move the four Fab domains in a second general direction (compare FIGS. 23 and 25 ).
  • FIG. 24 Schematic representation of the X-cis-C conformation of a bi-immunosymmetroadhesin consisting of four Fab binding domains and one Fc domain.
  • the molecule is a dimer of two hemi-symmetroadhesins each consisting of three stretches of consecutive amino acids.
  • FIG. 25 Schematic representation of the X-cis-X conformation of a bi-immunosymmetroadhesin consisting of four Fab binding domains and one Fc domain.
  • the molecule is a dimer of two hemi-symmetroadhesins each consisting of three stretches of consecutive amino acids.
  • FIG. 26 Schematic representation of the all-trans conformation of a bi-immunosymmetroadhesin consisting of two Fab binding domains, one Fc domain, and two non-Fab binding domains.
  • the molecule is a dimer of two hemi-symmetroadhesins each consisting of three stretches of consecutive amino acids.
  • the bi-symmetroadhesin shown here is a head-to-tail, tail-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesin that forms disulfide-linked dimers.
  • Each hemi-symmetroadhesin consists of one immunoglobulin Fab domain having a C-terminal-X-terminus that is joined by an -X-X- bond to the N-terminal-X-terminus of an immunoglobulin Fc subunit, and one non-immunoglobulin binding domain having a C-terminal-X-terminus that is joined by an -X-X- bond to the C-terminal-X-terminus of an immunoglobulin Fc subunit.
  • the dimer has two functional Fab binding domains, two functional non-immunoglobulin binding domains, and one functional Fc binding domain.
  • the seven consecutive single bonds which join all four binding domain to an Fc subunit are all trans (N—C—C—X—X—C—C—C/N). Symmetric rotations of 180 degrees around the first (N—C), third (C—X), fifth (X—C), or seventh (C—C/N) pairs of consecutive single bonds will move the four binding domains in a first general direction (compare FIGS. 26 and 27 ). Symmetric rotations of 180 degrees around the second (C—C), fourth (X—X), or sixth (C—C) single bond pairs will move the four binding domains in a second general direction (compare FIGS. 26 and 28 ).
  • FIG. 27 Schematic representation of the X-cis-C conformation of a bi-immunosymmetroadhesin consisting of two Fab binding domains, one Fc domain, and two non-Fab binding domains.
  • the molecule is a dimer of two hemi-symmetroadhesins each consisting of three stretches of consecutive amino acids.
  • FIG. 28 Schematic representation of the X-cis-X conformation of a bi-immunosymmetroadhesin consisting of two Fab binding domains, one Fc domain, and two non-Fab binding domains.
  • the molecule is a dimer of two hemi-symmetroadhesins each consisting of three stretches of consecutive amino acids.
  • FIG. 29 Schematic representation of an immunoglobulin binding to a first symmetric target. The interaction is symmetric and cooperative. Both targets are bound by both immunoglobulins.
  • FIG. 30 Schematic representation of a symmetroadhesin binding to a first symmetric target. The interaction is symmetric and cooperative. Both targets are bound by both symmetroadhesins in a first conformation (all-trans).
  • FIG. 31 Schematic representation of an immunoglobulin binding to a second symmetric target. The interaction is neither symmetric and nor cooperative. Only one target is bound by each immunoglobulin.
  • FIG. 32 Schematic representation of a symmetroadhesin binding to a second symmetric target. The interaction is symmetric and cooperative. Both targets are bound by both symmetroadhesins in a second conformation (X-cis-C).
  • FIG. 33 Schematic representation of an immunoglobulin binding to a third symmetric target. The interaction is neither symmetric and nor cooperative. Only one target is bound by each immunoglobulin.
  • FIG. 34 Schematic representation of a symmetroadhesin binding to a third symmetric target. The interaction is symmetric and cooperative. Both targets are bound by both symmetroadhesins in a third conformation (X-cis-X).
  • FIG. 35A Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide synthetic intermediates of a human IgG1 Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with an N-terminal-S-terminus.
  • Part (i) shows three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human sonic hedgehog (SHH), human interferon alpha-2 (IFN), or human cholesterol ester transferase (CETP) signal sequences (residues ⁇ 23 to ⁇ 1, ⁇ 23 to ⁇ 1, or ⁇ 17 to ⁇ 1, respectively), and the human IGHG1 Fc domain (residues 1 to 228) beginning at the fifth amino acid encoded by the hinge exon, CDKTHTCPPCP (Ellison et al.
  • SHH human sonic hedgehog
  • IFN human interferon alpha-2
  • CETP human cholesterol ester transferase
  • the three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides have lengths of 251, 251 and 245 residues, respectively.
  • FIG. 35B Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide synthetic intermediates of a human IgG2 Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with an N-terminal-S-terminus.
  • Part (i) shows three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human sonic hedgehog (SHH), human interferon alpha-2 (IFN), or human cholesterol ester transferase (CETP) signal sequences (residues ⁇ 23 to ⁇ 1, ⁇ 23 to ⁇ 1, or ⁇ 17 to ⁇ 1, respectively), and the human IGHG2 Fc domain (residues 1 to 225) beginning at the fourth amino acid encoded by the hinge exon, CCVECPPCP (Ellison et al.
  • SHH human sonic hedgehog
  • IFN human interferon alpha-2
  • CETP human cholesterol ester transferase
  • the three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides have lengths of 248, 248 and 242 residues, respectively.
  • FIG. 35C Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide synthetic intermediates of a human IgG3 Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with an N-terminal-S-terminus.
  • Part (i) shows three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human sonic hedgehog (SHH), human interferon alpha-2 (IFN), or human cholesterol ester transferase (CETP) signal sequences (residues ⁇ 23 to ⁇ 1, ⁇ 23 to ⁇ 1, or ⁇ 17 to ⁇ 1, respectively), and the human IGHG3 Fc domain (residues 1 to 267) beginning at the thirteenth amino acid encoded by the first hinge exon, CPRCP (Strausberg et al.
  • SHH human sonic hedgehog
  • IFN human interferon alpha-2
  • CETP human cholesterol ester transferase
  • the three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides have lengths of 290, 290 and 284 residues, respectively.
  • the N-terminal cysteine residue is underlined. (IGHG3, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry Q8N4Y9, Ig gamma-3 chain C region, Homo sapiens ).
  • FIG. 35D Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide synthetic intermediates of a human IgG4 Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with an N-terminal-S-terminus.
  • Part (i) shows three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human sonic hedgehog (SHH), human interferon alpha-2 (IFN), or human cholesterol ester transferase (CETP) signal sequences (residues ⁇ 23 to ⁇ 1, ⁇ 23 to ⁇ 1, or ⁇ 17 to ⁇ 1, respectively), and the human IGHG4 Fc domain (residues 1 to 222) beginning at the eighth amino acid encoded by the hinge exon, CPSCP (Strausberg et al.
  • SHH human sonic hedgehog
  • IFN human interferon alpha-2
  • CETP human cholesterol ester transferase
  • the three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides have lengths of 245, 245 and 239 residues, respectively.
  • FIG. 36A Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide synthetic intermediates of a human Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with an N-terminal-X-terminus.
  • Part (i) shows three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human sonic hedgehog (SHH), human interferon alpha-2 (IFN), or human cholesterol ester transferase (CETP) signal sequences (residues ⁇ 23 to ⁇ 1, ⁇ 23 to ⁇ 1, or ⁇ 17 to ⁇ 1, respectively), and the human IGHG1 Fc domain (residues 1 to 222) beginning at the eleventh amino acid encoded by the hinge exon, CPPCP (Ellison et al.
  • SHH human sonic hedgehog
  • IFN human interferon alpha-2
  • CETP human cholesterol ester transferase
  • the three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides have lengths of 245, 245 and 239 residues, respectively.
  • the N-terminal X amino acid e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine
  • FIG. 36B Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide synthetic intermediates of a human Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with an N-terminal-X-terminus.
  • Part (i) shows three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human sonic hedgehog (SHH), human interferon alpha-2 (IFN), or human cholesterol ester transferase (CETP) signal sequences (residues ⁇ 23 to ⁇ 1, ⁇ 23 to ⁇ 1, or ⁇ 17 to ⁇ 1, respectively), and the human IGHG1 Fc domain (residues 1 to 219) beginning at the fourteenth amino acid encoded by the hinge exon, CP (Ellison et al.
  • SHH human sonic hedgehog
  • IFN human interferon alpha-2
  • CETP human cholesterol ester transferase
  • the three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides have lengths of 242, 242 and 236 residues, respectively.
  • the N-terminal cysteine residue is underlined.
  • the N-terminal X amino acid e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine
  • IGHG1 UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P01857, Ig gamma-1 chain C region, Homo sapiens ).
  • FIG. 37A Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus.
  • Part (i) shows two distinct pre-Fc-intein polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human CD2 or CD4 signal sequences (residues ⁇ 24 to ⁇ 1, or ⁇ 25 to ⁇ 1, respectively), the human IGHG1 Fc domain (residues 1 to 224) beginning at the seventh amino acid encoded by the hinge exon (KTHTCPPCP), the human IGHG3 M1 domain (residues 225 to 241), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 242 to 441).
  • the two distinct pre-Fc-intein chimeric polypeptides have lengths of 465 and 466 residues, respectively.
  • the C-terminal thio-glycine residue (Z) is underlined.
  • the C-terminal X amino acid residue (e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine) is underlined.
  • IGHG1 UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P01857, Ig gamma-1 chain C region, Homo sapiens ; IGHG3, NCBI/GenBank accession BAA11363, membrane-bound-type Ig gamma-chain, Homo sapiens ).
  • FIG. 37B Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide synthetic intermediates of a human Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with an C-terminal-S-terminus.
  • Part (i) shows two distinct pre-Fc polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human CD2 or CD4 signal sequences (residues ⁇ 24 to ⁇ 1, or ⁇ 25 to ⁇ 1, respectively), the human IGHG1 Fc domain (residues 1 to 224) beginning at the seventh amino acid encoded by the hinge exon (KTHTCPPCP), and a portion of the human IGHG3 M1 domain (residues 225 to 232).
  • the two distinct pre-Fc polypeptides have lengths of 256 and 257 residues, respectively.
  • the N-terminal cysteine residue is underlined. (IGHG1, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P01857, Ig gamma-1 chain C region, Homo sapiens ).
  • FIGS. 38A-38B Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit, with an N-terminal-S-terminus and a C-terminal-X-terminus.
  • Part (i) shows three distinct pre-Fc-intein polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human sonic hedgehog (SHH), human interferon alpha-2 (IFN), or human cholesterol ester transferase (CETP) signal sequences (residues ⁇ 23 to ⁇ 1, ⁇ 23 to ⁇ 1, or ⁇ 17 to ⁇ 1, respectively), the human IGHG1 Fc domain (residues 1 to 226) beginning at the fifth amino acid encoded by the hinge exon (CDKTHTCPPCP), the human IGHG3 M1 domain (residues 227 to 243), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 244 to 443).
  • SHH human sonic hedgehog
  • IFN human interferon alpha-2
  • CETP human cholesterol ester transferase
  • the three distinct pre-Fc-intein chimeric polypeptides have lengths of 466, 466 and 460 residues, respectively.
  • the N-terminal cysteine residue and C-terminal X amino acid residue are underlined.
  • IGHG1 UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P01857, Ig gamma-1 chain C region, Homo sapiens ; IGHG3, NCBI/GenBank accession BAA11363, membrane-bound-type Ig gamma-chain, Homo sapiens ).
  • FIGS. 39A-39B Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit, with an N-terminal-X-terminus and a C-terminal-X-terminus.
  • Part (i) shows three distinct pre-Fc-intein polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human sonic hedgehog (SHH), human interferon alpha-2 (IFN), or human cholesterol ester transferase (CETP) signal sequences (residues ⁇ 23 to ⁇ 1, ⁇ 23 to ⁇ 1, or ⁇ 17 to ⁇ 1, respectively), the human IGHG1 Fc domain (residues 1 to 220) beginning at the eleventh amino acid encoded by the hinge exon (CPPCP), the human IGHG3 M1 domain (residues 221 to 237), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 238 to 437).
  • SHH human sonic hedgehog
  • IFN human interferon alpha-2
  • CETP human cholesterol ester transferase
  • the three distinct pre-Fc-intein chimeric polypeptides have lengths of 460, 460 and 454 residues, respectively.
  • the N-terminal X amino acid (e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine) is underlined.
  • the N-terminal X amino acid residue and C-terminal thio-glycine residue (Z) are underlined.
  • the N-terminal X amino acid residue and C-terminal X amino acid residue are underlined.
  • IGHG1 UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P01857, Ig gamma-1 chain C region, Homo sapiens ; IGHG3, NCBI/GenBank accession BAA11363, membrane-bound-type Ig gamma-chain, Homo sapiens ).
  • FIGS. 40A-40B Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human CD4 symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus.
  • (A) Part (i) shows the pre-CD4-intein polypeptide (length 596) comprising the human CD4 signal sequence (residues ⁇ 25 to ⁇ 1) and extracellular domain (residues 1 to 371), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 372 to 571).
  • FIGS. 41A-41B Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a Di62-VH symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus.
  • (A) Part (i) shows the pre-Di62-VH-intein polypeptide (length 444) comprising the mouse Di62-VH signal sequence (residues ⁇ 19 to ⁇ 1) and variable domain (residues 1 to 117), the human CH1 contant domain (residues 118 to 225), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 226 to 425).
  • the C-terminal X amino acid residue (e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine) is underlined. (Di62-VH, NCBI/GenBank accession CAA05416, IgG heavy chain, antigen binding of human TNF alpha subunit, Mus musculus ).
  • FIG. 42 Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide synthetic intermediates of a Di62-Vk symmetroadhesin precursor subunit.
  • Di62-Vk NCBI/GenBank accession CAA05417, IgG light chain, antigen binding of human TNF alpha subunit, Mus musculus ).
  • FIG. 43 Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human TNR1A symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus.
  • TNR1A UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P19438, Tumor necrosis factor receptor superfamily member 1A).
  • FIG. 44A Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human TNR1B symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus.
  • TNR1B UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry 20333, Tumor necrosis factor receptor superfamily member 1B).
  • FIG. 44B Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide synthetic intermediates of a TNR1B immunoadhesin precursor subunit.
  • FIGS. 45A-45C Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human VGFR1 symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus.
  • VGFR1 UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P17948, Vascular endothelial growth factor receptor 1).
  • FIGS. 46A-46C Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human VGFR2 symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus.
  • VGFR2 UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P35968, Vascular endothelial growth factor receptor 2.
  • FIGS. 47A-47C Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human VGFR3 symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus.
  • VGFR3 UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P35916, Vascular endothelial growth factor receptor 3).
  • FIGS. 48A-48B Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human ERBB1 symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus.
  • (A) Part (i) shows the pre-ERBB1-intein polypeptide (length 845) comprising the human ERBB1 signal sequence (residues ⁇ 24 to ⁇ 1) and extracellular domain (residues 1 to 621), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 622 to 821).
  • ERBB1 UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P00533, Epidermal growth factor receptor.
  • FIGS. 49A-49B Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human ERBB2 symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus.
  • ERBB2 UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P04626, Receptor tyrosine-protein kinase erbB-2).
  • FIGS. 50A-50B Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human ERBB3 symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus.
  • ERBB4 UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry Q15303, Receptor tyrosine-protein kinase erbB-4).
  • FIG. 52 Expression in 293 kidney cells of human IgG1 Fc symmetroadhesin subunits with N-terminal-S-termini. Lanes 1-6 and lanes 7-12 show the IgG1 Fc polypeptides of FIG. 35A (ii) and FIG. 36A (ii), respectively. Cell supernatants: lanes 1, 3, 5, 7, 9 and 11; cell lysates: lanes 2, 4, 6, 8, 10 and 12. Signal sequences used: SHH (lanes 1, 2, 7 and 8); IFN ⁇ (lanes 3, 4, 9, 10); CETP (lanes 5, 6, 11 and 12).
  • FIG. 53 Expression in 293 kidney cells of human IgG1 Fc symmetroadhesin subunits. Lanes 1-2, 3-4 and 5-6 show the IgG1 Fc polypeptides of FIG. 35A (ii), FIG. 36A (ii) and FIG. 37B (ii), respectively. Cell supernatants: (lanes 1-6). Signal sequences used: SHH (lanes 1-6).
  • FIG. 54 Protein A purification of human IgG1 Fc symmetroadhesin subunits expressed in 293 kidney cells. Lane 2 and 8 show the IgG1 Fc polypeptides of FIG. 36A and FIG. 35A , respectively. Lanes 1-7: proteinA-sepharose column fractions for the IgG1 Fc polypeptide of FIG. 36A .
  • FIG. 55 Thiol-sepharose binding of proteinA-purified human IgG1 Fc symmetroadhesin subunits shown in FIG. 54 .
  • Lanes 1-3 and lanes 4-6 show the human IgG1 Fc polypeptides of FIG. 35A and FIG. 36A , respectively.
  • Lanes 1 and 4 starting material; lanes 2 and 5: thiol-sepharose flow-thru fraction; lanes 3 and 6: thiol-sepharose bound fraction.
  • FIG. 56 Expression in human 293 kidney cells of human CD4-intein fusion proteins. Lanes 1-4 show the CD4-intein fusion polypeptide of FIG. 40A (ii). Cell supernatants: lanes 1 and 3; cell lysates: lanes 2 and 4.
  • FIG. 58 TNR1B symmetroadhesin subunits with C-terminal-S-termini.
  • Lanes 1-2 show the TNR1B polypeptide of FIG. 44A (iii) following purification by chitin affinity chromatography and cleavage/elution with MESNA.
  • Lanes 3 shows the native ligation product between the TNR1B polypeptide of FIG. 44A (iii) with a fluorescent-labeled peptide (New England Biolabs).
  • panel (ii) western blot with anti-TNR1B antibody (R&D Systems);
  • FIG. 59 TNR1B symmetroadhesin subunits with C-terminal-S-termini.
  • Lane 5 shows the TNR1B polypeptide of FIG. 44A (iv) following purification by chitin affinity chromatography and cleavage/elution with cysteine.
  • Lanes 1-4 show TNR1B-immunoadhesin.
  • FIG. 60 TNR1B symmetroadhesin.
  • Lanes 1-4 show the TNR1B symmetroadhesin of FIG. 44A (iv) before oxidation (lanes 1 and 4) and after oxidation in the presence of 10 mM CuSO4.
  • Lanes 3 and 6 show a TNR1B-immunoadhesin control. Lanes 1-3: reducing conditions; lanes 4-6: non-reducing conditions.
  • the TNR1B symmetroadhesin monomer (42 kd) and dimer (84 kd) are apparent in lanes 2 and 5, and lane 5, respectively.
  • FIG. 61A-61C TNF-alpha saturation binding analysis with various TNR1B polypeptides on the Biacore T-100.
  • A The TNR1B symmetroadhesin of FIG. 44A (iv) was covalently coupled to a Biacore CM-5 chip using standard Biacore amine chemistry.
  • B TNR1B immunoadhesin (R&D Systems) was covalently coupled to a Biacore CM-5 chip using standard Biacore amine chemistry.
  • C The TNR1B symmetroadhesin of FIG. 44A (iv) was covalently coupled to a Biacore CM-5 chip using standard Biacore thiol chemistry. Following coupling, saturation binding analysis was carried out using TNF-alpha (R&D Systems) at the indicated concentations.
  • FIG. 62A-62C Scatchard analysis of the TNF-alpha saturation binding analysis shown in FIG. 61A-61C .
  • This invention provides a compound comprising a first stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which comprises a binding site for a target; and a second stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which is identical to the sequence of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and which comprises an identical binding site for the target; wherein each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids has at a predefined end thereof a cysteine residue or a selenocysteine residue and such cysteine residues or such selenocysteine residues are joined by a bond having the structure:
  • each X is the same and represents a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and each C represents a beta-carbon of one of such cysteine or selenocysteine residues.
  • the bond has the structure:
  • the residue at the predefined end of each of the first stretch and the second stretch of consecutive amino acids is a cysteine residue. In an embodiment the residue at the predefined end of each of the first stretch and the second stretch of consecutive amino acids is a selenocysteine residue.
  • each X may be the same or different and represents a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and each C represents a beta-carbon of one of such cysteine or selenocysteine residues.
  • both of the residues at the predefined ends of each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids are cysteine residues. In an embodiment both of the residues at the predefined ends of each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids are selenocysteine residues. In an embodiment the residue at one predefined end of one of the first stretch or second stretch of consecutive amino acids is a cysteine residue and the residue at the other predefined end is a selenocysteine residue.
  • This invention provides a multimer comprising two or more identical instant compounds joined together by at least one bond.
  • the multimer is a dimer.
  • the multimer is a trimer.
  • the multimer is a tetramer.
  • the one or more bonds comprises a disulfide bond.
  • the predefined end of both the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids is a N-terminal end thereof. In an embodiment the predefined end of both the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids is a C-terminal end thereof. In an embodiment the predefined end of one of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids is a C-terminal end and the other predefined end is a N-terminal end.
  • the first stretch of amino acids comprises L-amino acids. In an embodiment, the first stretch of amino acids comprises D-amino acids. In an embodiment, the first stretch of amino acids comprises L-amino acids and D-amino acids
  • the second stretch of amino acids comprises L-amino acids. In an embodiment, the second stretch of amino acids comprises D-amino acids. In an embodiment, the second stretch of amino acids comprises L-amino acids and D-amino acids.
  • the first stretch of amino acids comprises at least 50 consecutive amino acids.
  • the second stretch of amino acids comprises at least 50 consecutive amino acids.
  • the first and/or second stretch of amino acids is between 1 and 100, 100 and 200 or 200 and 300 amino acids in length. In an embodiment the first stretch or second stretch of amino acids comprises at least 20, 25, 30, 35, 40, or 45 consecutive amino acids.
  • the first stretch of amino acids comprises more than one type of amino acid.
  • the second stretch of amino acids comprises more than one type of amino acid.
  • the sequence of the first and/or second stretch of amino acids corresponds to the sequence of a constant region of an immunoglobulin.
  • the immunoglobulin is a human immunoglobulin.
  • the constant region of the immunoglobulin is a constant region of an IgG, an IgA, an IgE, an IgD, or an IgM immunoglobulin.
  • the constant region of the immunoglobulin is a constant region of an IgG-1, IgG-2, IgG-3 or IgG-4 immunoglobulin.
  • the constant region of the immunoglobulin which is a constant region of an IgG-1, IgG-2, IgG-3 or IgG-4 immunoglobulin has one of the sequences set forth herein.
  • the constant region of the immunoglobulin is a constant region of an IgG immunoglobulin and comprises a hinge region, a CH6 region and a CH3 region.
  • the different moiety is an immunoeffector or immunoregulator.
  • the first or second stretch of consecutive amino acids comprises the amino acid sequence set forth of any one of TNFRSF1a, TNFRSF1b, VEGFR1, VEGFR6, VEGFR3, human Erb1, human Erb2, human Erb6, human Erb3, or human Erb4).
  • This invention provides a composition comprising any of the instant compounds in an amount effective to bind the target, and a carrier.
  • the compound is in an amount effective to bind the target, and a carrier.
  • the compound is a multimer and is in an amount effective to bind the target, and a carrier.
  • the multimer is also present in an amount effective to bind the different moiety.
  • the carrier is a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • the carrier is a phosphate-buffered saline. Such a composition may be lyophilized.
  • This invention provides a method of affecting the activity of a target comprising contacting the target with the composition of one or more of the instant compounds, under conditions such that the compound binds to and affects the activity of the target.
  • the binding of the composition to the target increases the activity of the target.
  • the binding of the composition to the target decreases the activity of the target.
  • the target is an EGF receptor, a HER2 protein, a VEGF receptor, a CD20 antigen, a CD11a, an IgE immunoglobulin, a glycoprotein IIa receptor, a glycoprotein IIIa receptor, a gp40, a gp120, a TNF alpha, or a TNF receptor.
  • This invention provides a complex comprising the composition of any of the instant compounds and a third stretch of consecutive amino acids, wherein the third stretch of consecutive amino acids is bound to the one of the first or second stretch of consecutive amino acids by one or more bonds.
  • the one or more bonds comprise van der Waals forces.
  • the one or more bonds comprise a hydrogen bond.
  • the one or bonds comprise a covalent bond.
  • the one or bonds comprise a disulfide bond.
  • the at least one bond is a disulfide bond.
  • the disulfide bond is between two non-terminal amino acid residues.
  • the disulfide bond is between two amino acid residues, at least one of which is a non-terminal amino acid residue.
  • This invention provides a process of making one of the instant compounds comprising:
  • the recombinant nucleic acid has the sequence set forth in any one of SEQ ID NOs. 1-8.
  • the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is an intein-chitin binding domain.
  • the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain.
  • the chimeric polypeptide is isolated in step b) by affinity chromatography.
  • the chimeric polypeptide is isolated in step b) by exposure of the product to a chitin-derivatized resin.
  • the oxidizing conditions permit formation of a disulfide bond between the C-terminal cysteine of each of the products.
  • This invention provides a compound comprising an independently folding protein domain fused to a second independently folding protein domain by non-peptide bond.
  • This invention provides a compound comprising a first polypeptide chain, comprising a terminal cysteine residue, fused at its S-terminus to a S-terminus of a second polypeptide chain comprising a terminal cysteine residue.
  • This invention provides a compound comprising a first polypeptide chain, comprising a terminal selenocysteine residue, fused at its Se-terminus to a S-terminus of a second polypeptide chain comprising a terminal cysteine residue.
  • This invention provides a compound comprising a first polypeptide chain, comprising a terminal selenocysteine residue, fused at its Se-terminus to a Se-terminus of a second polypeptide chain comprising a terminal selenocysteine residue.
  • This invention provides a multimer comprising two or more identical compounds according to any one of claims 66 - 69 joined together by at least one bond.
  • This invention provides a method of making a stretch of consecutive amino acids comprising an N-terminal cysteine comprising:
  • the stretch of consecutive amino acids is isolated in step (b).
  • the stretch of consecutive amino acids comprises an immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide.
  • the immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide is a human immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide.
  • the N-terminal cysteine residue is a cys-5 residue of the human immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide.
  • the cell is a 293 human embryonic cell or a CHO-K1 hamster ovary cell.
  • the transfection is performed with a plasmid pSA.
  • N-terminal signal sequence is selected from a protein having a N-terminal cysteine.
  • the signal peptide is sonic hedgehog, interferon alpha-2 or cholesterol ester transferase.
  • the stretch of consecutive amino acids is recovered by affinity chromatography.
  • the cleavage of the chimeric polypeptide within the cell is effected by a cellular signal peptidase.
  • This invention provides a method of making a stretch of consecutive amino acids comprising an N-terminal cysteine or selenocysteine comprising:
  • the stretch of consecutive amino acids comprises an immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide.
  • the immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide is a human immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide.
  • the N-terminal cysteine residue is a cys-5 residue of the human immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide.
  • the N-terminal cysteine residue is a cys-11 residue of the human immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide.
  • the peptide in step (b) comprises the amino acid sequence cys-asp-lys-thr-his-thr and the stretch of consecutive amino acids produced comprises an N-terminal cysteine.
  • peptide in step (b) comprises the amino acid sequence sec-asp-lys-thr-his-thr and the stretch of consecutive amino acids produced comprises an N-terminal selenocysteine.
  • the peptide in step (b) is protected with a N-terminal Msc protecting group prior to ligation.
  • the cell is a 293 human embryonic cell or a CHO-K1 hamster ovary cell.
  • the transfection is performed with a plasmid pSA.
  • the N-terminal signal sequence is selected from a protein having a N-terminal cysteine.
  • the signal peptide is sonic hedgehog, interferon alpha-2 or cholesterol ester transferase.
  • the stretch of consecutive amino acids is recovered by affinity chromatography.
  • the cleavage of the chimeric polypeptide within the cell is effected by a cellular signal peptidase. In embodiments other short peptide sequences with a N-terminal cysteine or selenocysteine are employed in place of those set forth above.
  • This invention provides process of making a stretch of consecutive amino acids comprising a C-terminal cysteine or a C-terminal selenocysteine, comprising:
  • the stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous comprises an IgG immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide and an IgG M1 exon.
  • the IgG immunoglobulin is a human IgG immunoglobulin.
  • the stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous comprises a CD4 extracellular domain.
  • the N-terminal signal sequence is selected from a protein having a N-terminal lysine.
  • the N-terminal signal sequence is a CD2 T-cell surface glycoprotein or a CD4 T-cell surface glycoprotein.
  • the cell is a 293 human embryonic cell or a CHO-K1 hamster ovary cell.
  • the transfection is performed with a plasmid pSA.
  • the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is an intein-chitin binding domain.
  • the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain.
  • the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is a self-splicing intein-containing binding domain.
  • the chimeric polypeptide is isolated in step b) by exposure of the product to a chitin-derivatized resin.
  • the cleavage of the second chimeric polypeptide within the cell is effected by a cellular signal peptidase.
  • the product of step (c) is ligated with a cysteine residue.
  • the product of step (c) is ligated with a selenocysteine residue.
  • This invention provides a process of making a stretch of consecutive amino acids comprising a N-terminal cysteine and a C-terminal cysteine or selenocysteine comprising:
  • the stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous comprises an IgG immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide and an IgG M1 exon.
  • the IgG immunoglobulin is a human IgG immunoglobulin.
  • the N-terminal signal sequence is selected from a protein having a N-terminal cysteine.
  • the N-terminal cysteine residue is a cys-5 residue of the human immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide.
  • the N-terminal cysteine residue is a cys-11 residue of the human immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide.
  • the N-terminal signal is a sonic hedgehog, interferon alpha-2 or cholesterol ester transferase.
  • the cell is a 293 human embryonic cell or a CHO-K1 hamster ovary cell.
  • the transfection is performed with a plasmid pSA.
  • the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is an intein-chitin binding domain.
  • the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain.
  • the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is a self-splicing intein-containing binding domain
  • the second chimeric polypeptide is isolated in step b) by exposure of the product to a chitin-derivatized resin.
  • the product is recovered in step e) by affinity chromatography.
  • the cleavage of the chimeric polypeptide within the cell is effected by a cellular signal peptidase.
  • the product of step (c) is ligated with a cysteine residue.
  • the product of step (c) is ligated with a selenocysteine residue.
  • This invention provides a process of making a stretch of consecutive amino acids comprising a N-terminal cysteine or selenocysteine and a C-terminal cysteine or selenocysteine comprising:
  • the stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous comprises an IgG immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide and an IgG M1 exon.
  • the IgG immunoglobulin is a human IgG immunoglobulin.
  • the N-terminal signal sequence is selected from a protein having a N-terminal cysteine.
  • the N-terminal cysteine residue is a cys-11 residue of the human immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide.
  • N-terminal signal sequence is selected from a protein having a N-terminal cysteine.
  • the N-terminal signal is a sonic hedgehog, interferon alpha-2 or cholesterol ester transferase.
  • the cell is a 293 human embryonic cell or a CHO-K1 hamster ovary cell.
  • the transfection is performed with a plasmid pSA.
  • the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is an intein-chitin binding domain.
  • the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain.
  • the chimeric polypeptide is isolated in step (b) by exposure of the product to a chitin-derivatized resin.
  • the immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide is a human immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide.
  • the N-terminal cysteine residue of the Fc polypeptide is a cys-11 residue.
  • the peptide in step (c) (i) comprises the amino acid sequence cys-asp-lys-thr-his-thr and the stretch of consecutive amino
  • the peptide in step (c) (i) comprises the amino acid sequence sec-asp-lys-thr-his-thr and the stretch of consecutive amino acids produced comprises an N-terminal selenocysteine.
  • This invention provides a process for making a compound comprising contacting a stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which comprises a binding site for a target with a second stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which is identical to the sequence of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and which comprises an identical binding site for the target, wherein each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids has at a predefined end thereof a cysteine residue or a selenocysteine residue, under reducing conditions so as to make the compound.
  • This invention provides a process for making a compound comprising contacting a stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which comprises a binding site for a target with a second stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which is different to the sequence of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and which comprises an identical binding site for the target, wherein each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids has at a predefined end thereof a cysteine residue or a selenocysteine residue, under reducing conditions so as to make the compound.
  • the reducing conditions do not denature the stretches of consecutive amino acids.
  • the reducing conditions comprise exposing the stretches of consecutive amino acids to a buffer comprising Tris-HCL and mercaptoethanol.
  • the buffer is between pH 7.6 and 8.4.
  • the buffer is pH 8.
  • the method further comprises exchanging the product into oxidation buffer.
  • the stretches of consecutive amino acids comprises a CD4 extracellular domain.
  • the stretches of consecutive amino acids comprises a sequence of an immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide.
  • the immunoglobulin is a human immunoglobulin.
  • the transfected cells of the instant methods are grown under conditions suitable to permit expression of the polypeptide.
  • a compound comprising a first stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which comprises a binding site for a target;
  • each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids has at a predefined end thereof, independently, a natural amino acid or non-natural amino having a linear aliphatic side-chain acid comprising a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and wherein such sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) are joined by a bond having the structure:
  • each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids has at a predefined end thereof, independently, a natural amino acid or non-natural amino having a linear aliphatic side-chain acid comprising a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and wherein such sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) are joined by a bond having the structure:
  • the natural amino acid is homocysteine of homoselenocysteine.
  • the first stretch and second stretch of amino acids have a homocysteine at the predefined end thereof.
  • the first stretch and second stretch of amino acids have a homoselenocysteine at the predefined end thereof.
  • the first stretch and second stretch of amino acids have a homocysteine at the predefined end thereof.
  • the predefined end is a C-terminus.
  • a composition comprising a polypeptide attached to a solid surface through a terminal disulfide bond.
  • the solid surface is a chip or a bead.
  • a compound comprising:
  • each X represents, independently, a chalcogen
  • C 1 represents a side chain carbon of the amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids
  • C 2 represents a side chain carbon of the second stretch of consecutive amino acids.
  • At least wherein at least 91, 92, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 99 or 100 consecutive amino acids of the second stretch of consecutive amino acids have a sequence identical to portion of a human immunoglobulin constant region polypeptide.
  • At least one of C 1 and C 2 is a beta carbon of amino acid.
  • the bond has the structure:
  • the amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain at the predefined terminus of the second stretch of amino acids is a cysteine.
  • the amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain at the predefined terminus of the second stretch of amino acids is a selenocysteine, homocysteine or homoseleneocysteine.
  • the amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids is a cysteine.
  • the amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain of the first stretch of amino acids is a selenocysteine, homocysteine or homoseleneocysteine.
  • the amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids is a terminal residue.
  • the amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids is a penultimate, antepenultimate, or pre-antepenultimate terminal residue.
  • the second stretch of consecutive amino acids has a sequence identical to a human immunoglobulin constant region. In an embodiment, the second stretch of consecutive amino acids is a portion of a human immunoglobulin constant region. In an embodiment, the first stretch of consecutive amino acids has a sequence identical to a human immunoglobulin constant region.
  • the human immunoglobulin constant region polypeptide is a human IgG1, human IgG2, human IgG3, or human IgG4.
  • a compound is provided wherein the side chain of at least one of amino acid residues having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain comprises a C1-C10 alkylene.
  • a composition comprising two of the instant compounds bonded together via at least one disulfide bond between the second stretch of consecutive amino acids of each of the compounds.
  • a composition comprising a polypeptide comprising consecutive amino acids having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:35 through 46, or having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:53 through 67, or having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:74 through 82, or having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:89 through 97, wherein the polypeptide does not consist of a naturally-occurring immunoglobulin polypeptide, including enzyme-cleaved fragments thereof.
  • a composition comprising a polypeptide is provided consisting of consecutive amino acids having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:35 through 46, or having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:53 through 67, or having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:74 through 82, or having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:89 through 97.
  • composition comprising the instant polypeptide is provided and a carrier.
  • the carrier is phosphate-buffered saline.
  • a composition comprising two of the instant independently chosen polypeptides, joined by a non-peptide bond.
  • the bond is a di-chalcogenide bond.
  • the bond is a disulfide bond.
  • a composition comprising two of the instant polypeptides bonded together via at least one disulfide bond between the two polypeptides is provided.
  • a composition comprising a polypeptide is provided consisting of consecutive amino acids having a sequence identical to a portion of the sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO:44, SEQ ID NO:64, SEQ ID NO:81 or SEQ ID NO:96, wherein at least one of the terminal residues of the polypeptide has a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain.
  • the terminal residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain is a cysteine or analog thereof.
  • N-terminal signal sequences plasmids, expression vecots, recombinant nucleic acids, stretches of consecutive amino acids, intein binding domains, cell types, recovery/isolation methods, etc set forth hereinabove are non-limiting examples, further of which are set forth in the Examples below.
  • Stretch of consecutive amino acids a plurality of amino acids arranged in a chain, each of which is joined to a preceding amino acid by a peptide bond, excepting that the first amino acid in the chain is not joined to a preceding amino acid.
  • the amino acids of the chain may be naturally or non-naturally occurring, or may comprise a mixture thereof.
  • the amino acids, unless otherwise indicated, may be genetically encoded, naturally-occurring but not genetically encoded, or non-naturally occurring, and any selection thereof.
  • a stretch of consecutive amino acids has biological activity, including, but not limited to, target-binding activity or an immunoeffector activity, which biological activity is retained on the bonding of the stretch of consecutive amino acids to another stretch of consecutive amino acids by an —X—X— bond (e.g. —S—S—, —S—Se—, —Se—Se—, or —Se—S— bond).
  • —X—X— bond e.g. —S—S—, —S—Se—, —Se—Se—, or —Se—S— bond.
  • a “segment of consecutive amino acids” is an alternative description of “a stretch of amino acids”.
  • N-terminal amino acid residue the terminal residue of a stretch of two or more consecutive amino acids having a free ⁇ -amino (NH 2 ) functional group, or a derivative of an ⁇ -amino (NH 2 ) functional group.
  • N-terminus the free ⁇ -amino (NH 2 ) group (or derivative thereof) of a N-terminal amino acid residue.
  • C-terminal amino acid residue the terminal residue of a stretch of two or more consecutive amino acids having a free ⁇ -carboxyl (COOH) functional group, or a derivative of a ⁇ -carboxyl (COOH) functional group.
  • C-terminus the free ⁇ -carboxyl (COOH) group (or derivative thereof) of a C-terminal amino acid residue.
  • S-terminal cysteine residue a cysteine which is the N- and/or C-terminal residue(s) of a stretch of consecutive amino acids, and which has a free ⁇ -sulfhydryl (SH) functional group, or a derivative of a ⁇ -sulfhydryl (SH) functional group.
  • S-terminus the free ⁇ -sulfhydryl (SH) group (or derivative thereof) of a S-terminal cysteine residue.
  • Se-terminal selenocysteine residue a selenocysteine which is the N- and/or C-terminal residue(s) of a stretch of consecutive amino acids, and which has a free ⁇ -selenohydryl (SeH) functional group, or a derivative of a ⁇ -selenohydryl (SeH) functional group.
  • Se-terminus the free ⁇ -selenohydryl (SeH) group (or derivative thereof) of a Se-terminal selenocysteine residue.
  • X-terminal amino acid residue a cysteine (or cysteine derivative) or homocysteine (or homocysteine derivative), selenocysteine (or selenocysteine derivative) or homoselenocysteine (or homoselenocysteine derivative), which is the N- and/or C-terminal residue(s) of a stretch of consecutive amino acids, and which has a free ⁇ -sulfhydryl (SH) or ⁇ -selenohydryl (SeH) functional group, respectively, or a sulfur-containing or selenium-containing derivative thereof.
  • SH free ⁇ -sulfhydryl
  • SeH ⁇ -selenohydryl
  • X-terminus the free ⁇ -sulfhydryl (SH) or ⁇ -selenohydryl (SeH) group of a S-terminal cysteine/cysteine derivative residue or of a Se-terminal selenocysteine/selenocysteine derivative residue, respectively.
  • an X-terminus can be the free ⁇ -sulfhydryl (SH) or ⁇ -selenohydryl (SeH) group of a S-terminal homocysteine residue or Se-terminal homoselenocysteine residue.
  • Target an entity which binds to a discrete selection of a stretch of consecutive amino acids or a portion of a tertiary structure thereof and includes, but is not limited to, receptors, carrier proteins, hormones, cellular adhesive proteins, tissue-specific adhesion factors, growth factors, and enzymes.
  • targets include a human EGF receptor, a HER2 protein, a VEGF receptor, a human CD20 antigen, a human CD11a, a human IgE immunoglobulin, a human glycoprotein IIa receptor, a human glycoprotein IIIa receptor, a human TNF alpha, and a TNF receptor.
  • a “bond”, unless otherwise specified, or contrary to context, is understood to include a covalent bond, a dipole-dipole interaction such as a hydrogen bond, and intermolecular interactions such as van der Waals forces.
  • a “Signal Sequence” is a short (3-60 amino acids long) peptide chain that directs the post-translational transport of a polypeptide.
  • amino acid as used herein, in one embodiment, means a L or D isomer of the genetically encoded amino acids, i.e. isoleucine, alanine, leucine, asparagine, lysine, aspartate, methionine, cysteine, phenylalanine, glutamate, threonine, glutamine, tryptophan, glycine, valine, proline, arginine, serine, histidine, tyrosine, selenocysteine, pyrolysine and also includes homocysteine and homoselenocysteine.
  • amino acids i.e. isoleucine, alanine, leucine, asparagine, lysine, aspartate, methionine, cysteine, phenylalanine, glutamate, threonine, glutamine, tryptophan, glycine, valine, proline, arginine, serine, histidine, t
  • amino acids include an L or D isomer of taurine, gaba, dopamine, lanthionine, 2-aminoisobutyric acid, dehydroalanine, ornithine and citrulline, as well as non-natural homologues and synthetically modified forms thereof including amino acids having alkylene chains shortened or lengthened by up to two carbon atoms, amino acids comprising optionally substituted aryl groups, and amino acids comprising halogenated groups, including halogenated alkyl and aryl groups as well as beta or gamma amino acids, and cyclic analogs.
  • the amino acids in these embodiments may be in the form of acidic or basic salts, or may be in neutral forms. Individual amino acid residues may also be modified by oxidation or reduction. Other contemplated modifications include hydroxylation of proline and lysine, phosphorylation of hydroxyl groups of seryl or threonyl residues, and methylation of the alpha-amino groups of lysine, arginine, and histidine side chains.
  • Covalent derivatives may be prepared by linking particular functional groups to the amino acid side chains or at the N- or C-termini.
  • Chalcogen as used herein is limited to sulfur, selenium, tellurium and polonium only, i.e. as used herein, “chalcogen” excludes oxygen and ununhexium.
  • Chalcogen functional group containing side chain is an amino acid residue side chain containing a terminally reactive non-oxygen, non-ununhexium chalcogen atom.
  • an amino acid having a chalcogen functional group containing side chain would be cysteine, selenocysteine, homocysteine etc., but would not include methionine, for example, which contains a chalcogen atom (S), but not a terminally reactive chalcogen atom.
  • Natural amino acid as used herein means a L or D isomer of the genetically encoded amino acids, i.e. isoleucine, alanine, leucine, asparagine, lysine, aspartate, methionine, cysteine, phenylalanine, glutamate, threonine, glutamine, tryptophan, glycine, valine, proline, arginine, serine, histidine, tyrosine, selenocysteine, pyrolysine and homocysteine and homoselenocysteine.
  • Non-natural amino acid as used herein means a chemically modified L or D isomer of isoleucine, alanine, leucine, asparagine, lysine, aspartate, methionine, cysteine, phenylalanine, glutamate, threonine, glutamine, tryptophan, glycine, valine, proline, arginine, serine, histidine, tyrosine, selenocysteine, pyrolysine, homocysteine, homoselenocysteine, taurine, gaba, dopamine, lanthionine, 2-aminoisobutyric acid, dehydroalanine, ornithine or citrulline, including cysteine and selenocysteine derivatives having C 3 -C 10 aliphatic side chains between the alpha carbon and the S or Se.
  • the aliphatic side chain is an alkylene.
  • the aliphatic side chain is an alkylene.
  • variants thereof can be prepared by introducing appropriate nucleotide changes into the encoding DNA, and/or by synthesis of the desired consecutive amino acid sequences.
  • amino acid changes may alter post-translational processes of the stretches of consecutive amino acids described herein when expression is the chosen method of synthesis (rather than chemical synthesis for example), such as changing the number or position of glycosylation sites or altering the membrane anchoring characteristics.
  • Variations in the sequences described herein can be made, for example, using any of the techniques and guidelines for conservative and non-conservative mutations set forth, for instance, in U.S. Pat. No. 5,364,934.
  • Variations may be a substitution, deletion or insertion of one or more codons encoding the consecutive amino acid sequence of interest that results in a change in the amino acid sequence as compared with the native sequence.
  • the variation is by substitution of at least one amino acid with any other amino acid in one or more of the domains.
  • Guidance in determining which amino acid residue may be inserted, substituted or deleted without adversely affecting the desired activity may be found by comparing the sequence with that of homologous known protein molecules and minimizing the number of amino acid sequence changes made in regions of high homology.
  • Amino acid substitutions can be the result of replacing one amino acid with another amino acid having similar structural and/or chemical properties, such as the replacement of a leucine with a serine, i.e., conservative amino acid replacements.
  • Insertions or deletions may optionally be in the range of about 1 to 5 amino acids. The variation allowed may be determined by systematically making insertions, deletions or substitutions of amino acids in the sequence and testing the resulting variants for activity exhibited by the full-length or mature native sequence. It is understood that any terminal variations are made within the context of the invention disclosed herein.
  • Amino acid sequence variants of the binding partner are prepared with various objectives in mind, including increasing the affinity of the binding partner for its ligand, facilitating the stability, purification and preparation of the binding partner, modifying its plasma half life, improving therapeutic efficacy, and lessening the severity or occurrence of side effects during therapeutic use of the binding partner.
  • Amino acid sequence variants of these sequences are also contemplated herein including insertional, substitutional, or deletional variants.
  • Such variants ordinarily can prepared by site-specific mutagenesis of nucleotides in the DNA encoding the target-binding monomer, by which DNA encoding the variant is obtained, and thereafter expressing the DNA in recombinant cell culture. Fragments having up to about 100-150 amino acid residues can also be prepared conveniently by in vitro synthesis.
  • Such amino acid sequence variants are predetermined variants and are not found in nature. The variants exhibit the qualitative biological activity (including target-binding) of the nonvariant form, though not necessarily of the same quantative value.
  • the mutation per se need not be predetermined.
  • random or saturation mutagenesis (where all 20 possible residues are inserted) is conducted at the target codon and the expressed variant is screened for the optimal combination of desired activities. Such screening is within the ordinary skill in the art.
  • Amino acid insertions usually will be on the order of about from 1 to 10 amino acid residues; substitutions are typically introduced for single residues; and deletions will range about from 1 to 30 residues. Deletions or insertions preferably are made in adjacent pairs, i.e. a deletion of 2 residues or insertion of 2 residues. It will be amply apparent from the following discussion that substitutions, deletions, insertions or any combination thereof are introduced or combined to arrive at a final construct.
  • the invention concerns a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids having at least about 80% sequence identity, preferably at least about 81% sequence identity, more preferably at least about 82% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 83% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 84% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 85% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 86% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 87% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 88% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 89% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 90% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 91% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 92% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 93% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 94% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 95% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 96% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 97% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 98% sequence identity and yet more preferably at least about 99% sequence identity to an amino acid
  • % amino acid sequence identity values can be readily obtained using, for example, the WU-BLAST-2 computer program (Altschul et al., Methods in Enzymology 266:460-480 (1996)).
  • fragments of native sequences are provided herein. Such fragments may be truncated at the N-terminus or C-terminus, or may lack internal residues, for example, when compared with a full length native protein. Again, it is understood that any terminal variations are made within the context of the invention disclosed herein. Certain fragments lack amino acid residues that are not essential for a desired biological activity of the sequence of interest.
  • Desired peptide fragments or fragments of stretches of consecutive amino acids may be chemically synthesized.
  • An alternative approach involves generating fragments by enzymatic digestion, e.g. by treating the protein with an enzyme known to cleave proteins at sites defined by particular amino acid residues, or by digesting the DNA with suitable restriction enzymes and isolating the desired fragment.
  • Yet another suitable technique involves isolating and amplifying a DNA fragment encoding a desired polypeptide/sequence fragment, by polymerase chain reaction (PCR). Oligonucleotides that define the desired termini of the DNA fragment are employed at the 5′ and 3′ primers in the PCR.
  • conservative substitutions of interest are shown in Table 1 under the heading of preferred substitutions. If such substitutions result in a change in biological activity, then more substantial changes, denominated exemplary substitutions in Table 1, or as further described below in reference to amino acid classes, are introduced and the products screened.
  • Substantial modifications in function or immunological identity of the sequence are accomplished by selecting substitutions that differ significantly in their effect on maintaining (a) the structure of the polypeptide backbone in the area of the substitution, for example, as a sheet or helical conformation, (b) the charge or hydrophobicity of the molecule at the target site, or (c) the bulk of the side chain.
  • Naturally occurring residues are divided into groups based on common side-chain properties:
  • hydrophobic norleucine, met, ala, val, leu, ile
  • neutral hydrophilic cys, ser, thr
  • acidic asp, glu
  • basic asn, gln, his, lys, arg
  • residues that influence chain orientation gly, pro
  • aromatic trp, tyr, phe.
  • Non-conservative substitutions will entail exchanging a member of one of these classes for another class. Such substituted residues also may be introduced into the conservative substitution sites or, more preferably, into the remaining (non-conserved) sites.
  • the variations can be made using methods known in the art such as oligonucleotide-mediated (site-directed) mutagenesis, alanine scanning, and PCR mutagenesis.
  • Site-directed mutagenesis Carter et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 13:4331 (1986); Zoller et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 10:6487 (1987)
  • cassette mutagenesis Wells et al., Gene, 34:315 (1985)
  • restriction selection mutagenesis Wells et al., Philos. Trans. R. Soc. London SerA, 317:415 (1986)
  • other known techniques can be performed on the cloned DNA to produce the variant DNA.
  • Scanning amino acid analysis can also be employed to identify one or more amino acids along a contiguous sequence.
  • preferred scanning amino acids are relatively small, neutral amino acids.
  • Such amino acids include alanine, glycine, serine, and cysteine.
  • Alanine is typically a preferred scanning amino acid among this group because it eliminates the side-chain beyond the beta-carbon and is less likely to alter the main-chain conformation of the variant (Cunningham and Wells, Science, 244:1081-1085 (1989)). Alanine is also typically preferred because it is the most common amino acid. Further, it is frequently found in both buried and exposed positions (Creighton, The Proteins, (W.H. Freeman & Co., N.Y.); Chothia, J. Mol. Biol., 150:1 (1976)). If alanine substitution does not yield adequate amounts of variant, an isoteric amino acid can be used.
  • Covalent modifications The stretches of consecutive amino acids may be covalently modified.
  • One type of covalent modification includes reacting targeted amino acid residues with an organic derivatizing agent that is capable of reacting with selected side chains or the N- or C-terminal residues that are not involved in an -x-x- bond.
  • Derivatization with bifunctional agents is useful, for instance, for crosslinking to a water-insoluble support matrix or surface for use in the method for purifying anti-sequence of interest antibodies, and vice-versa.
  • crosslinking agents include, e.g., 1,1-bis(diazoacetyl)-2-phenylethane, glutaraldehyde, N-hydroxysuccinimide esters, for example, esters with 4-azidosalicylic acid, homobifunctional imidoesters, including disuccinimidyl esters such as 3,3′-dithiobis(succinimidylpropionate), bifunctional maleimides such as bis-N-maleimido-1,8-octane and agents such as methyl-3-((p-azidophenyl)dithio)propioimidate.
  • 1,1-bis(diazoacetyl)-2-phenylethane glutaraldehyde
  • N-hydroxysuccinimide esters for example, esters with 4-azidosalicylic acid
  • homobifunctional imidoesters including disuccinimidyl esters such as 3,3′-dithiobis(s
  • Another type of covalent modification comprises altering the native glycosylation pattern of the consecutive stretch of amino acids or of a polypeptide.
  • “Altering the native glycosylation pattern” is intended for purposes herein to mean deleting one or more carbohydrate moieties found in amino acid sequences (either by removing the underlying glycosylation site or by deleting the glycosylation by chemical and/or enzymatic means), and/or adding one or more glycosylation sites that are not present in the native sequence.
  • the phrase includes qualitative changes in the glycosylation of the native proteins, involving a change in the nature and proportions of the various carbohydrate moieties present.
  • Addition of glycosylation sites to the amino acid sequence may be accomplished by altering the amino acid sequence.
  • the alteration may be made, for example, by the addition of, or substitution by, one or more serine or threonine residues to the native sequence (for O-linked glycosylation sites).
  • the amino acid sequence may optionally be altered through changes at the DNA level, particularly by mutating the DNA encoding the amino acid sequence at preselected bases such that codons are generated that will translate into the desired amino acids.
  • Another means of increasing the number of carbohydrate moieties on the amino acid sequence is by chemical or enzymatic coupling of glycosides to the polypeptide. Such methods are described in the art, e.g., in WO 87/05330 published Sep. 11, 1987, and in Aplin and Wriston, CRC Crit. Rev. Biochem., pp. 259-306 (1981).
  • Removal of carbohydrate moieties present on the amino acid sequence may be accomplished chemically or enzymatically or by mutational substitution of codons encoding for amino acid residues that serve as targets for glycosylation.
  • Chemical deglycosylation techniques are known in the art and described, for instance, by Hakimuddin, et al., Arch. Biochem. Biophys., 259:52 (1987) and by Edge et al., Anal. Biochem., 118:131 (1981).
  • Enzymatic cleavage of carbohydrate moieties on polypeptides can be achieved by the use of a variety of endo- and exo-glycosidases as described by Thotakura et al., Meth. Enzymol., 138:350 (1987).
  • Another type of covalent modification comprises linking the amino acid sequence to one of a variety of nonproteinaceous polymers, e.g., polyethylene glycol (PEG), polypropylene glycol, or polyoxyalkylenes, in the manner set forth in U.S. Pat. No. 4,640,835; 4,496,689; 4,301,144; 4,670,417; 4,791,192 or 4,179,337, or to a tag polypeptide which provides an epitope to which an anti-tag antibody can selectively bind.
  • Various tag polypeptides and their respective antibodies are well known in the art.
  • poly-histidine poly-his
  • poly-histidine-glycine poly-his-gly
  • flu HA tag polypeptide and its antibody 12CA5 Fluorescence Activated Cell-binding protein 5
  • c-myc tag and the 8F9, 3C7, 6E10, G4, B7 and 9E10 antibodies thereto
  • van et al. Molecular and Cellular Biology, 5:3610-3616 (1985)
  • Herpes Simplex virus glycoprotein D (gD) tag and its antibody Paborsky et al., Protein Engineering, 3(6):547-553 (1990)
  • tag polypeptides include the Flag-peptide (Hopp et al., BioTechnology, 6:1204-1210 (1988)); the KT3 epitope peptide (Martin et al., Science, 255:192-194 (1992)); an alpha-tubulin epitope peptide (Skinner et al., J. Biol. Chem., 266:15163-15166 (1991)); and the T7 gene 10 protein peptide tag (Lutz-Freyermuth et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 87:6393-6397 (1990)).
  • Salts of the compounds disclosed herein are within the scope of the invention.
  • a “salt” is salt of the instant compounds which has been modified by making acid or base salts of the compounds.
  • the salt can be pharmaceutically acceptable.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable salts include, but are not limited to, mineral or organic acid salts of basic residues such as amines; alkali or organic salts of acidic residues such as carboxcylic acids.
  • the salts can be made using an organic or inorganic acid.
  • Such acid salts are chlorides, bromides, sulfates, nitrates, phosphates, sulfonates, formates, tartrates, maleates, malates, citrates, benzoates, salicylates, ascorbates, and the like.
  • Carboxylate salts are the alkaline earth metal salts, sodium, potassium or lithium.
  • compositions disclosed here can be prepared in any conventional manner, for example by treating a solution or suspension of the corresponding free base or acid with one chemical equivalent of a pharmaceutically acceptable acid or base.
  • Conventional concentration or crystallization techniques can be employed to isolate the salts.
  • suitable acids are acetic, lactic, succinic, maleic, tartaric, citric, gluconic, ascorbic, benzoic, cinnamic, fumaric, sulfuric, phosphoric, hydrochloric, hydrobromic, hydroiodic, sulfamic, sulfonic acids such as methanesulfonic, benzene sulfonic, p-toluenesulfonic, and related acids.
  • Illustrative bases are sodium, potassium, and calcium.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable carrier is understood to include excipients, carriers or diluents.
  • the particular carrier, diluent or excipient used will depend upon the means and purpose for which the active ingredient is being applied.
  • the compounds of this invention may be administered alone or in combination with one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, in either single or multiple doses.
  • suitable pharmaceutical carriers include inert solid diluents or fillers, sterile aqueous solutions and various organic solvents.
  • the pharmaceutical compositions disclosed herein can be readily administered in a variety of dosage forms such as injectable solutions, tablets, powders, lozenges, syrups, and the like. These pharmaceutical compositions can, if desired, contain additional ingredients such as flavorings, binders, excipients and the like. Additionally, lubricating agents such as magnesium stearate, sodium lauryl sulfate and talc may be used for tabletting purposes.
  • Solid compositions of a similar type may also be employed as fillers in soft and hard filled gelatin capsules.
  • Preferred materials for this include lactose or milk sugar and high molecular weight polyethylene glycols.
  • the essential active ingredient therein may be combined with various sweetening or flavoring agents, coloring matter or dyes and, if desired, emulsifying or suspending agents, together with diluents such as water, ethanol, propylene glycol, glycerin and combinations thereof.
  • solutions containing a compound of this invention or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof in sterile aqueous solution may be employed.
  • aqueous solutions should be suitably buffered if necessary and the liquid diluent first rendered isotonic with sufficient saline or glucose.
  • aqueous solutions are especially suitable for intravenous, intramuscular, subcutaneous and intraperitoneal administration.
  • the sterile aqueous media employed are all readily available by standard techniques known to those skilled in the art.
  • the final pharmaceutical composition can be processed into a unit dosage form (e.g., powdered or lyophilized in a vial, a solution in a vial, tablet, capsule or sachet) and then packaged for distribution.
  • a unit dosage form e.g., powdered or lyophilized in a vial, a solution in a vial, tablet, capsule or sachet
  • the processing step will vary depending upon the particular unit dosage form. For example, a tablet is generally compressed under pressure into a desired shape and a capsule or sachet employs a simple fill operation. Those skilled in the art are well aware of the procedures used for manufacturing the various unit dosage forms.
  • compositions of this invention may be in a variety of forms. These include, for example, liquid, semi-solid and solid dosage forms, such as liquid solutions (e.g., injectable and infusible solutions), dispersions or suspensions, tablets, pills, powders, liposomes and suppositories.
  • liquid solutions e.g., injectable and infusible solutions
  • dispersions or suspensions tablets, pills, powders, liposomes and suppositories.
  • the preferred form depends on the intended mode of administration and therapeutic application.
  • Some compositions are in the form of injectable or infusible solutions.
  • a mode of administration is parenteral (e.g., intravenous, subcutaneous, intraperitoneal, intramuscular).
  • the compound is administered by intravenous infusion or injection.
  • the compound is administered by intramuscular or subcutaneous injection.
  • compositions as contemplated herein typically must be sterile and stable under the conditions of manufacture and storage.
  • the composition can be formulated as a solution, microemulsion, dispersion, liposome, or other ordered structure suitable to high drug concentration.
  • Sterile injectable solutions can be prepared by incorporating the compound in the required amount in an appropriate solvent with one or a combination of ingredients as required, followed by filtered sterilization.
  • dispersions are prepared by incorporating the active compound into a sterile vehicle that contains a basic dispersion medium and the required other ingredients from those enumerated above.
  • the preferred methods of preparation are vacuum drying and freeze-drying that yields a powder of the active ingredient plus any additional desired ingredient from a previously sterile-filtered solution thereof.
  • the proper fluidity of a solution can be maintained, for example, by the use of a coating such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersion and by the use of surfactants.
  • Prolonged absorption of injectable compositions can be brought about by including in the composition an agent that delays absorption, for example, monostearate salts and gelatin.
  • the active compound may be prepared with a carrier that will protect the compound against rapid release, such as a controlled release formulation, including implants, transdermal patches, and microencapsulated delivery systems.
  • a controlled release formulation including implants, transdermal patches, and microencapsulated delivery systems.
  • Biodegradable, biocompatible polymers can be used, such as ethylene vinyl acetate, polyanhydrides, polyglycolic acid, collagen, polyorthoesters, and polylactic acid. Many methods for the preparation of such formulations are patented or generally known to those skilled in the art. See, e.g., Sustained and Controlled Release Drug Delivery Systems, J. R. Robinson, ed., Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, 1978.
  • the compounds of the invention may be orally administered, for example, with an inert diluent or an assimilable edible carrier.
  • the compound (and other ingredients, if desired) may also be enclosed in a hard or soft shell gelatin capsule, compressed into tablets, or incorporated directly into the subject's diet.
  • the compounds may be incorporated with excipients and used in the form of ingestible tablets, buccal tablets, troches, capsules, elixirs, suspensions, syrups, wafers, and the like.
  • the compound may be coated with, or co-administered with, a material to prevent its inactivation.
  • Supplementary active compounds can also be incorporated into the compositions, for example a chemotherapeutic agent, an antineoplastic agent or an anti-tumor agent.
  • the compounds of the invention may be coformulated and/or coadministered with one or more additional therapeutic agents.
  • additional therapeutic agents include, without limitation, antibodies that bind other targets (e.g., antibodies that bind one or more growth factors or cytokines, their cell surface receptors), binding proteins, antineoplastic agents, chemotherapeutic agents, anti-tumor agents, antisense oligonucleotides, growth factors.
  • a pharmaceutical composition of the compounds disclosed herein may comprise one or more additional therapeutic agent.
  • compositions disclosed here can be administered in various manners, including soluble form by bolus injection, continuous infusion, sustained release from implants, oral ingestion, local injection (e.g. intracrdiac, intramuscular), systemic injection, or other suitable techniques well known in the pharmaceutical arts.
  • Other methods of pharmaceutical administration include, but are not limited to oral, subcutaneously, transdermal, intravenous, intramuscular and parenteral methods of administration.
  • a soluble composition will comprise a purified compound in conjunction with physiologically acceptable carriers, excipients or diluents. Such carriers will be nontoxic to recipients at the dosages and concentrations employed.
  • compositions can entail combining a compound with buffers, antioxidants, carbohydrates including glucose, sucrose or dextrins, chelating agents such as EDTA, glutathione and other stabilizers and excipients.
  • buffers antioxidants
  • carbohydrates including glucose, sucrose or dextrins
  • chelating agents such as EDTA, glutathione and other stabilizers and excipients.
  • Neutral buffered saline or saline mixed with conspecific serum albumin are exemplary appropriate diluents.
  • the product can be formulated as a lyophilizate using appropriate excipient solutions (e.g., sucrose) as diluents.
  • Nonproteinaceous polymer ordinarily is a hydrophilic synthetic polymer, i.e., a polymer not otherwise found in nature.
  • hydrophilic polyvinyl polymers fall within the scope of this invention, e.g. polyvinylalcohol and polyvinylpyrrolidone.
  • polyalkylene ethers such as polyethylene glycol, polypropylene glycol, polyoxyethylene esters or methoxy polyethylene glycol
  • polyoxyalkylenes such as polyoxyethylene, polyoxypropylene, and block copolymers of polyoxyethylene and polyoxypropylene (Pluronics); polymethacrylates; carbomers; branched or unbranched polysaccharides which comprise the saccharide monomers D-mannose, D- and L-galactose, fucose, fructose, D-xylose, L-arabinose, D-glucuronic acid, sialic acid, D-galacturontc acid, D-mannuronic acid (e.g.
  • polymannuronic acid or alginic acid
  • D-glucosamine D-galactosamine
  • D-glucose and neuraminic acid including homopolysaccharides and heteropolysaccharides such as lactose, amylopectin, starch, hydroxyethyl starch, amylose, dextran sulfate, dextran, dextrins, glycogen, or the polysaccharide subunit of acid mucopolysaccharides, e.g. hyaluronic acid; polymers of sugar alcohols such as polysorbitol and polymannitol; as well as heparin or heparon.
  • compositions of the invention may include a “therapeutically effective amount” or a “prophylactically effective amount” of a compound of the invention.
  • a “therapeutically effective amount” refers to an amount effective, at dosages and for periods of time necessary, to achieve the desired therapeutic result.
  • a therapeutically effective amount of the compound may vary according to factors such as the disease state, age, sex, and weight of the individual.
  • a therapeutically effective amount is also one in which any toxic or detrimental effects of the compound are outweighed by the therapeutically beneficial effects.
  • a “prophylactically effective amount” refers to an amount effective, at dosages and for periods of time necessary, to achieve the desired prophylactic result. Typically, since a prophylactic dose is used in subjects prior to or at an earlier stage of disease, the prophylactically effective amount will be less than the therapeutically effective amount.
  • compositions and dosages are set forth as follows:
  • compositions comprising a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids which comprises consecutive amino acids having the sequence of bevacizumab (e.g. Avastin) may comprise trehalose dihydrate, sodium phosphate (monobasic, monohydrate), sodium phosphate (dibasic, anhydrous), polysorbate 20, and Water for Injection, USP.
  • the composition may also be lyophilized, to which the water can be added for reconstitution.
  • the composition has a pH of 6.2 or about 6.2.
  • the compound can be administered combination with a chemotherapeutic such as intravenous 5-fluorouracil for treatment of patients with metastatic carcinoma of the colon or rectum.
  • the compound is administered in a dose of between 0.1 and 10 mg/kg given once every 14 days as an IV infusion. In a further embodiment the dose is 5 mg/kg given once every 14 days. In an embodiment the dose is between 1.0 and 2.0 mg/kg given once every 14 days. In an embodiment the dose is between 0.01 and 1.5 mg/kg given once every 14 days. In an embodiment the dose is between 0.001 and 10 mg/kg given once every 1-21 days.
  • compositions comprising a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids which comprises consecutive amino acids having the sequence of trastuzumab (e.g. Herceptin) may comprise trehalose dihydrate, L-histidine HCl, L-histidine, and polysorbate 20, USP. This can be reconstituted with Bacteriostatic Water for Injection (BWFI), USP, or equivalents thereof, containing 1.1% benzyl alcohol as a preservative or equivalents thereof.
  • BWFI Bacteriostatic Water for Injection
  • the composition has a pH of about 6.0.
  • the composition may also be lyophilized, to which the water can be added for reconstitution.
  • the compound can be administered to subjects with metatastic breast cancer whose tumor overexpresses HER2 protein.
  • the subject has received/is receiving chemotherapy.
  • the compound is administered in combination with paclitaxel to subjects with metastatic breast cancer whose tumors overexpress the HER2 protein and who have not received chemotherapy for their metastatic disease.
  • the compound is administered in an initial dose of between 0.1 and 10 mg/kg in a continuous 45-120 minute infusion IV infusion.
  • the compound is administered in a dose of 4 mg/kg in a 90 minute infusion.
  • a weekly maintenance dose is administered to the subject at a dose of 2 mg/kg in a 30 minute infusion.
  • the compound is administered in a dose of 0.5 to 1.5 mg/kg in a 90 minute infusion.
  • a weekly maintenance dose is administered to the subject at a dose of 0.5-1.0 mg/kg in a 30 minute infusion.
  • the compound is administered in a dose of 0.04 to 0.5 mg/kg in a 90 minute infusion.
  • the compound is administered in a dose of between 0.001 to 10 mg/kg in a 90 minute infusion.
  • Compositions comprising a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids which comprises consecutive amino acids having the sequence of rituximab (e.g. Rituxin) may comprise sodium chloride, sodium citrate dihydrate, polysorbate 80, and Water for Injection (USP), or equivalents thereof.
  • the pH of the composition is adjusted to 6.5.
  • the composition may also be lyophilized, to which the water can be added for reconstitution.
  • the compound is administered to a subject for the treatment of relapsed or refractory, low-grade or follicular, CD20-positive, B-cell non-Hodgkin's lymphoma.
  • the compound is administered at a dose of 250-500 mg/m2 IV infusion once weekly for 4 or 8 doses. In a further embodiment the compound is administered at 375 mg/m2 IV infusion once weekly for 4 or 8 doses. In one embodiment the compound is administered at a dose of 150-250 mg/m2 IV infusion once weekly for 4 or 8 doses. In one embodiment the compound is administered at a dose of 1.5 to 5 mg/m2 IV infusion once weekly for 4 or 8 doses. In one embodiment the compound is administered at a dose of between 1.0 and 500 mg/m2 IV infusion once weekly for 4 or 8 doses
  • compositions comprising a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids which comprises consecutive amino acids having the sequence of efalizumab (e.g. Raptiva) may comprise sucrose, L-histidine hydrochloride monohydrate, L-histidine and polysorbate 20.
  • a composition may be diluted to an approporiate dosage form with sterile non-USP water, or Sterile Water for Injection, USP, or equivalents thereof.
  • the composition may also be lyophilized, to which the water can be added for reconstitution.
  • the compound is administered to a subject for the treatment of chronic moderate to severe plaque psoriasis.
  • a subject may be a candidate for systemic therapy or phototherapy.
  • the compound is administered in a single 0.1-1.1 mg/kg subcutaneous (SC) conditioning dose followed by weekly SC doses of 0.8-1.5 mg/kg (maximum single dose not to exceed a total of 250 mg). In a further embodiment the compound is administered in a single 0.7 mg/kg SC conditioning dose followed by weekly SC doses of 1 mg/kg (maximum single dose not to exceed a total of 200 mg). In an embodiment the compound is administered in a single 0.001-1.0 mg/kg subcutaneous (SC) conditioning dose followed by weekly SC doses of 0.008-0.015 mg/kg.
  • SC subcutaneous
  • compositions comprising a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids which comprises consecutive amino acids having the sequence of omalizumab (e.g. Xolair) may comprise sucrose, L-histidine hydrochloride monohydrate, L-histidine, and polysorbate 20. Such a composition may lyophilized. In an embodiment the composition is diluted to an appropriate dosage form with Sterile Water for Injection, USP, or equivalents thereof. In one embodiment the compound is administered to a subject for the treatment of moderate to severe persistent asthma.
  • the compound is administered to a subject who has a positive skin test or in vitro reactivity to a perennial aeroallergen and whose symptoms are inadequately controlled with inhaled corticosteroids in order to decrease the incidence of asthma exacerbations.
  • the compound is administered at a dose of 100 to 400 mg subcutaneously every 2 or 4 weeks.
  • the compound is administered at a dose of 150 to 375 mg SC every 2 or 4 weeks.
  • the compound is administered at a dose of 25 to 150 mg subcutaneously every 2 or 4 weeks.
  • the compound is administered at a dose of 1 to 4 mg subcutaneously every 2 or 4 weeks.
  • compositions comprising a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids which comprises consecutive amino acids having the sequence of etanercept (e.g. Enbrel) may comprise mannitol, sucrose, and tromethamine.
  • the composition is in the form of a lyophilizate.
  • the composition is reconstituted with, for example, Sterile Bacteriostatic Water for Injection (BWFI), USP (containing 0.9% benzyl alcohol).
  • BWFI Sterile Bacteriostatic Water for Injection
  • USP containing 0.9% benzyl alcohol
  • the compound is administered to a subject for reducing signs and symptoms, inducing major clinical response, inhibiting the progression of structural damage, and improving physical function in subjects with moderately to severely active rheumatoid arthritis.
  • the compound may be initiated in combination with methotrexate (MTX) or used alone.
  • MTX methotrexate
  • the compound is administered to a subject for reducing signs and symptoms of moderately to severely active polyarticular-course juvenile rheumatoid arthritis in subjects who have had an inadequate response to one or more DMARDs.
  • the compound is administered to a subject for reducing signs and symptoms, inhibiting the progression of structural damage of active arthritis, and improving physical function in subjects with psoriatic arthritis.
  • the compound is administered to a subject for reducing signs and symptoms in subjects with active ankylosing spondylitis.
  • the compound is administered to a subject for the treatment of chronic moderate to severe plaque psoriasis.
  • the compound is administered at 25-75 mg per week given as one or more subcutaneous (SC) injections. In a further embodiment the compound is administered at 50 mg per week in a single SC injection. In an embodiment wherein the subject has plaque psoriasis the compound is administered at 25-75 mg twice weekly or 4 days apart for 3 months followed by a reduction to a maintenance dose of 25-75 mg per week. In a further embodiment the compound is administered at a dose of at 50 mg twice weekly or 4 days apart for 3 months followed by a reduction to a maintenance dose of 50 mg per week.
  • the dose is between 2 ⁇ and 10 ⁇ less than the doses set forth herein.
  • the compound may be administered at a dose of 0.2-1.2 mg/kg per week (up to a maximum of 75 mg per week).
  • the compound is administered at a dose of 0.8 mg/kg per week (up to a maximum of 50 mg per week).
  • the dose is between 2 ⁇ and 100 ⁇ less than the doses set forth hereinabove.
  • compositions comprising a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids which comprises consecutive amino acids having the sequence of infliximab (e.g. Remicade) may comprise sucrose, polysorbate 80, monobasic sodium phosphate, monohydrate, and dibasic sodium phosphate, dihydrate. Preservatives are not present in one embodiment.
  • the composition is in the form of a lyophilizate.
  • the composition is reconstituted with, for example, Water for Injection (BWFI), USP.
  • BWFI Water for Injection
  • the pH of the composition is 7.2 or is about 7.2.
  • the compound is administered is administered to a subject with rheumatoid arthritis in a dose of 2-4 mg/kg given as an intravenous infusion followed with additional similar doses at 2 and 6 weeks after the first infusion then every 8 weeks thereafter.
  • the compound is administered in a dose of 3 mg/kg given as an intravenous infusion followed with additional similar doses at 2 and 6 weeks after the first infusion then every 8 weeks thereafter.
  • the dose is adjusted up to 10 mg/kg or treating as often as every 4 weeks.
  • the compound is administered in combination with methotrexate.
  • the compound is administered is administered to a subject with Crohn's disease or fistulizing Crohn's disease at dose of 2-7 mg/kg given as an induction regimen at 0, 2 and 6 weeks followed by a maintenance regimen of 4-6 mg/kg every 8 weeks thereafter for the treatment of moderately to severely active Crohn's disease or fistulizing disease.
  • the compound is administered at a dose of 5 mg/kg given as an induction regimen at 0, 2 and 6 weeks followed by a maintenance regimen of 5 mg/kg every 8 weeks thereafter for the treatment of moderately to severely active Crohn's disease or fistulizing disease.
  • the dose is adjusted up to 10 mg/kg.
  • the compound is administered to a subject with ankylosing spondylitis at a dose of 2-7 mg/kg given as an intravenous infusion followed with additional similar doses at 2 and 6 weeks after the first infusion, then every 6 weeks thereafter.
  • the compound is administered at a dose of 5 mg/kg given as an intravenous infusion followed with additional similar doses at 2 and 6 weeks after the first infusion, then every 6 weeks thereafter.
  • the compound is administered to a subject with psoriatic arthritis at a dose of 2-7 mg/kg given as an intravenous infusion followed with additional similar doses at 2 and 6 weeks after the first infusion then every 8 weeks thereafter.
  • the compound is administered at a dose of 5 mg/kg given as an intravenous infusion followed with additional similar doses at 2 and 6 weeks after the first infusion then every 8 weeks thereafter.
  • the compound is administered with methotrexate.
  • the compound is administered to a subject with ulcerative colitis at a dose of 2-7 mg/kg given as an induction regimen at 0, 2 and 6 weeks followed by a maintenance regimen of 2-7 mg/kg every 8 weeks thereafter for the treatment of moderately to severely active ulcerative colitis.
  • the compound is administered to a subject with ulcerative colitis at a dose of 5 mg/kg given as an induction regimen at 0, 2 and 6 weeks followed by a maintenance regimen of 5 mg/kg every 8 weeks thereafter.
  • the dose is between 2 ⁇ and 100 ⁇ less than the doses set forth hereinabove for treating the indivisual diseases.
  • compositions comprising a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids which comprises consecutive amino acids having the sequence of cetuximab (e.g. Erbitux) may comprise a preservative-free composition including sodium chloride, sodium phosphate dibasic heptahydrate, sodium phosphate monobasic monohydrate.
  • the composition is in the form of a lyophilizate.
  • the composition is reconstituted with, for example, Water for Injection, USP.
  • the pH of the composition is in the range of about 7.0 to about 7.4.
  • the compound is administered to a subject for the treatment of EGFR-expressing, metastatic colorectal carcinoma.
  • the compound is used in combination with irinotecan for the treatment in patients who are refractory to irinotecan-based chemotherapy.
  • the compound is administered at a dose of 300-500 mg/m2 as an initial loading dose (first infusion) administered as a 120-minute IV infusion (maximum infusion rate 5 mL/min).
  • the compound is administered at a dose of 400 mg/m2 as an initial loading dose (first infusion) administered as a 120-minute IV infusion (maximum infusion rate 5 mL/min).
  • the weekly maintenance dose is 200-300 mg/m2 infused over 60 minutes (maximum infusion rate 5 mL/min).
  • the weekly maintenance dose (all other infusions) is 250 mg/m2 infused over 60 minutes (maximum infusion rate 5 mL/min). In some embodiments the dose is between 2 ⁇ and 100 ⁇ less than the doses set forth hereinabove.
  • compositions comprising a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids which comprises consecutive amino acids having the sequence of abciximab (e.g. Reopro) may comprise, a preservative-free composition including sodium phosphate, sodium chloride and polysorbate 80.
  • the composition is in the form of a lyophilizate.
  • the composition is diluted in, or reconstituted with, for example, Water for Injection, USP.
  • the pH of the composition is 7.2 or is about 7.2.
  • the composition is used as an adjunct to percutaneous coronary intervention (PCI). In such a use the compositions may be administered as an intravenous bolus of 0.15 to 0.35 mg/kg at 10-60 minutes before the start of PCI.
  • PCI percutaneous coronary intervention
  • the dose is 0.2 mg/kg.
  • the bolus is followed by continuous intravenous infusion of 0.1 to 0.15 g/kg/min for up to 12 hours.
  • the dose is 0.125 g/kg/min for up to 12 hours.
  • the composition is used as an adjunct to percutaneous coronary intervention (PCI) in subjects suffering from unstable angina.
  • PCI percutaneous coronary intervention
  • the compositions may be administered as an intravenous bolus at 0.1 to 0.4 mg/kg before the start of PCI followed by continuous intravenous infusion of 5-15 g/min for up to 24 hours, concluding 1 hour after the PCI.
  • composition is administered as an intravenous bolus at 0.25 mg/kg before the start of PCI followed by continuous intravenous infusion of 10 g/min for up to 24 hours, concluding 1 hour after the PCI.
  • dose is between 2 ⁇ and 100 ⁇ less than the doses set forth hereinabove.
  • compositions when in the form of a lyophilizate, may be reconstituted with, for example, sterile aqueous solutions, sterile water, Sterile Water for Injections (USP), Sterile Bacteriostatic Water for Injections (USP), and equivalents thereof known to those skilled in the art.
  • USP Sterile Water for Injections
  • USP Sterile Bacteriostatic Water for Injections
  • the compound in administration of any of the instant compounds, may be administered in isolation, in a carrier, as part of a pharmaceutical composition, or in any appropriate vehicle.
  • the invention disclosed herein also contemplates each integer dose, and tenth thereof, between the upper and lower limits. In the case of the example given, therefore, the invention contemplates 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7, 1.8, 1.9, 2.0, 2.1, 2.2, 2.3, 2.4 etc. mg/kg up to 10 mg/kg.
  • the compounds of the present invention can be administered as a single dose or may be administered as multiple doses.
  • the daily dosage for treating a disorder or condition according to the methods described above will generally range from about 0.01 to about 10.0 mg/kg body weight of the subject to be treated.
  • Variations based on the aforementioned dosage ranges may be made by a physician of ordinary skill taking into account known considerations such as the weight, age, and condition of the person being treated, the severity of the affliction, and the particular route of administration chosen.
  • kits comprising the compounds disclosed herein and the pharmaceutical compositions comprising these compounds.
  • a kit may include, in addition to the compound or pharmaceutical composition, diagnostic or therapeutic agents.
  • a kit may also include instructions for use in a diagnostic or therapeutic method.
  • the kit includes the compound or a pharmaceutical composition thereof and a diagnostic agent.
  • the kit includes the antibody or a pharmaceutical composition thereof and one or more therapeutic agents, such as an additional antineoplastic agent, anti-tumor agent or chemotherapeutic agent.
  • the subject is a human. In an embodiment the subject is 18 years or older. In another embodiment the subject is less than 18 years old.
  • This patent specification describes genetic devices which are devices comprising functional stretches of consecutive amino acids joined in a novel manner.
  • proteins have been genetically engineered to create new functions by virtue of their adopting a novel fixed structure or conformation.
  • the genetic devices disclosed herein comprise two or more distinguishable protein domains that are connected by novel chemical bonds in a manner permitting relative motion to occur between the domains.
  • the relative motion between protein domains constitutes the moving parts of the genetic devices, and the useful work which they are able to thereby carry out.
  • Input energy for this work is provided by the kinetic and rotational energies intrinsic to the protein domains themselves, as well as the energy of mechanical interactions between the protein domains and solvent molecules, and the like.
  • Symmetroadhesins comprise two or more chemically-bonded adhesins (independently folding polypeptide binding domains or stretches of consecutive amino acids). These chemically-bonded adhesins are capable of relative motion with respect to one another, resulting in the formation of two or more symmetrically-oriented binding domains useful in binding dimeric ligands, trimeric ligands, tetrameric ligands, and the like, with greatly increased affinity. Symmetroadhesin-Fc hybrid proteins are a particularly useful embodiment of the genetic devices.
  • symmetry in the effectiveness of therapeutic proteins is due to the fact that most protein disease targets themselves display such a higher-order symmetric structure. For example, if the disease target consists of two proteins it is said to be a dimer, if it consists of three proteins it is said to be a trimer, and so forth. If a protein therapeutic binds to the protein disease target only on a one-at-a-time basis, then the strength of the binding is typically on the order of the nano-molar range. At this ordinary level of binding, which is typical of present-day therapeutic proteins, it becomes necessary to flood the body with an enormous and wasteful excess of the therapeutic protein relative to the protein disease target (one million-to-one basis).
  • Each symmetroadhesin is engineered using a simple set of rules that makes proteins into more useful therapeutics by making them more symmetric.
  • the strength of binding will be on the order of the nano H nano-molar range. Cooperative binding permits such an extraordinary level of binding. At this extraordinary level of binding, it is only necessary to administer much less of the therapeutic protein relative to the protein disease target (one to one basis).
  • All proteins consist of one or more polypeptide chains, stretches of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond. Due to resonance between the single bond form (—C—N—) and double bond form (—C ⁇ N—) which occur in amides, the peptide bond has a significant degree of double bond character (—C ⁇ N—C ⁇ —C ⁇ N—). As a consequence, peptide bonds in proteins are approximately planar. Although the adjoining N—C ⁇ and C ⁇ —C bonds are relatively free to rotate, the rigidly of the peptide bond reduces the degrees of freedom of the folded polypeptide chain to the point where it behaves like a single, static object.
  • the chimeric polypeptide like either of its progenitors, is a single stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is also joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond.
  • the folded chimeric polypeptide chain will thus also generally behave like a single, static object.
  • genetic devices which like mechanical devices are dynamic objects with two or more moving parts that are interconnected in a manner to permit relative movement.
  • Each part, or domain, in a genetic device is a stretch of consecutive amino acids, and each interconnection is made by a non-peptide bond joining a predefined end of each stretch of consecutive amino acids.
  • the domains in a genetic device are binding domains.
  • Three distinct types of genetic devices are distinguished by the topology of their interconnections as shown in 3, 4, and 5:
  • hemi-symmetroadhesins are have structures with point symmetry they are not capable of rotating both their binding domains independently, and thus, they are generally not able to bind symmetrically to more than one binding site in a symmetric target.
  • This invention also provides protein-like molecules capable of binding symmetrically to two or more binding sites in a symmetric target (i.e., cooperatively).
  • Genetic devices that are capable of binding symmetric targets symmetrically are termed herein symmetroadhesins.
  • symmetroadhesins Like a human body grasping a oversized, yet symmetric object (e.g., a medicine ball) with two hands instead of one, the ability of symmetroadhesins to bind symmetric targets is generally much greater than proteins.
  • Tables 2-11 set forth various non-limiting embodiments of different symmetroadhesins.
  • Table 2 describing CD4-symmetroadhesins, shows in the top line the configuration of a CD4 hemi-symmetroadhesin, i.e. a CD4 domain with a C-terminal X-terminus, e.g.
  • a dimer of the CD4 hemi-symmetroadhesin and a Fc hemisymmetroadhesin to form an immuno-symmetroadhesin is set forth in the second row of Table 2, for example, described as [CD4-Xc-Sn-Fc] 2 .
  • Xc represents a C-terminal X-terminus; Xn a N-terminal X-terminus, Sn a N-terminal cysteine residue
  • stretches of consecutive amino acids as referred to herein include, but are not limited to, consecutive amino acids including binding domains such as secreted or transmembrane proteins, intracellular binding domains and antibodies (whole or portions thereof) and modified versions thereof.
  • binding domains such as secreted or transmembrane proteins, intracellular binding domains and antibodies (whole or portions thereof) and modified versions thereof.
  • binding domains such as secreted or transmembrane proteins, intracellular binding domains and antibodies (whole or portions thereof) and modified versions thereof.
  • Immunoglobulins are molecules containing polypeptide chains held together by intra-chain disulfide bonds, wherein at least one of the bonded amino acids is not a terminus residue, typically having two light chains and two heavy chains.
  • one domain (V) has a variable amino acid sequence depending on the antibody specificity of the molecule.
  • the other domains (C) have a rather constant sequence common among molecules of the same class. The domains are numbered in sequence from the amino-terminal end.
  • the immunoglobulin gene superfamily consists of molecules with immunoglobulin-like domains. Members of this family include class I and class II major histocompatibility antigens, immunoglobulins, T-cell receptor alpha, beta, gamma and delta chains, CD1, CD2, CD4, CD8, CD28, the gamma, delta and epsilon chains of CD3, OX-2, Thy-1, the intercellular or neural cell adhesion molecules (1-CAM or N-CAM), lymphocyte function associated antigen-3 (LFA-3), neurocytoplasmic protein (NCP-3), poly-Ig receptor, myelin-associated glycoprotein (MAG), high affinity IgE receptor, the major glycoprotein of peripheral myelin (Po), platelet derived growth factor receptor, colony stimulating factor-1 receptor, macrophage Fc receptor, Fc gamma receptors and carcinoembryonic antigen.
  • class I and class II major histocompatibility antigens include class I and class II major histocompatibility antigens, immunoglob
  • variable domains including hypervariable regions
  • heterofunctional immunoadhesin comprising a fusion protein in which a polypeptide comprising a human CD4 antigen variable (V) region is fused at its C-terminus to the N-terminus of a polypeptide comprising a constant region of an immunoglobulin chain disulfide bonded to a companion immunoglobulin heavy chain-light chain pair bearing a antibody combining site capable of binding a predetermined antigen.
  • V human CD4 antigen variable
  • Components of immunoglobulins include antibody fragments comprise a portion of an intact antibody, preferably the antigen binding or variable region of the intact antibody.
  • antibody fragments include Fab, Fab′, F(ab′) 2 , and Fv fragments; diabodies; linear antibodies (Zapata et al., Protein Eng. 8(10): 1057-1062 (1995)); single-chain antibody molecules; and multispecific antibodies formed from antibody fragments.
  • Papain digestion of antibodies produces two identical antigen-binding fragments, called “Fab” fragments, each with a single antigen-binding site, and a residual “Fc” fragment, a designation reflecting the ability to crystallize readily.
  • Pepsin treatment yields an F(ab′) 2 fragment that has two antigen-combining sites and is still capable of cross-linking antigen.
  • “Fv” is the minimum antibody fragment which contains a complete antigen-recognition and -binding site. This region consists of a dimer of one heavy- and one light-chain variable domain in tight, non-covalent association. It is in this configuration that the three CDRs of each variable domain interact to define an antigen-binding site on the surface of the V H -V L dimer. Collectively, the six CDRs confer antigen-binding specificity to the antibody. However, even a single variable domain (or half of an Fv comprising only three CDRs specific for an antigen) has the ability to recognize and bind antigen, although at a lower affinity than the entire binding site.
  • the Fab fragment also contains the constant domain of the light chain and the first constant domain (CH1) of the heavy chain.
  • Fab fragments differ from Fab′ fragments by the addition of a few residues at the carboxy terminus of the heavy chain CH1 domain including one or more cysteines from the antibody hinge region.
  • Fab′-SH is the designation herein for Fab′ in which the cysteine residue(s) of the constant domains bear a free thiol group.
  • F(ab′) 2 antibody fragments originally were produced as pairs of Fab′ fragments which have hinge cysteines between them. Other chemical couplings of antibody fragments are also known.
  • immunoglobulins can be assigned to different classes. There are five major classes of immunoglobulins: IgA, IgD, IgE, IgG, and IgM, and several of these may be further divided into subclasses (isotypes), e.g., IgG1, IgG2, IgG3, IgG4, IgA, and IgA2.
  • Single-chain Fv or “sFv” antibody fragments comprise the V H and V L domains of antibody, wherein these domains are present in a single polypeptide chain.
  • the Fv polypeptide further comprises a polypeptide linker between the V H and V L domains which enables the sFv to form the desired structure for antigen binding.
  • the invention described herein provides novel hybrid molecules which include one or more immunoglobulin components.
  • Extracellular proteins play important roles in, among other things, the formation, differentiation and maintenance of multicellular organisms.
  • a discussion of various intracellular proteins of interest is set forth in U.S. Pat. No. 6,723,535, Ashkenazi et al., issued Apr. 20, 2004, hereby incorporated by reference.
  • Secreted proteins have various industrial applications, including as pharmaceuticals, diagnostics, biosensors and bioreactors.
  • Most protein drugs available at present, such as thrombolytic agents, interferons, interleukins, erythropoietines, colony stimulating factors, and various other cytokines, are secretory proteins.
  • Their receptors, which are membrane proteins, also have potential as therapeutic or diagnostic agents.
  • Efforts are being undertaken by both industry and proficient to identify new, native secreted proteins. Many efforts are focused on the screening of mammalian recombinant DNA libraries to identify the coding sequences for novel secreted proteins. Examples of screening methods and techniques are described in the literature (see, for example, Klein et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 93:7108-7113 (1996); U.S. Pat. No. 5,536,637)).
  • Membrane-bound proteins and receptors can play important roles in, among other things, the formation, differentiation and maintenance of multicellular organisms.
  • membrane-bound proteins and cell receptors include, but are not limited to, cytokine receptors, receptor kinases, receptor phosphatases, receptors involved in cell-cell interactions, and cellular adhesin molecules like selectins and integrins. For instance, transduction of signals that regulate cell growth and differentiation is regulated in part by phosphorylation of various cellular proteins. Protein tyrosine kinases, enzymes that catalyze that process, can also act as growth factor receptors. Examples include fibroblast growth factor receptor and nerve growth factor receptor.
  • Membrane-bound proteins and receptor molecules have various industrial applications, including as pharmaceutical and diagnostic agents.
  • Receptor immunoadhesins for instance, can be employed as therapeutic agents to block receptor-ligand interactions.
  • the membrane-bound proteins can also be employed for screening of potential peptide or small molecule inhibitors of the relevant receptor/ligand interaction.
  • proteins examples include EGF and growth factors.
  • Epidermal growth factor is a conventional mitogenic factor that stimulates the proliferation of various types of cells including epithelial cells and fibroblasts. EGF binds to and activates the EGF receptor (EGFR), which initiates intracellular signaling and subsequent effects.
  • EGFR EGF receptor
  • the EGFR is expressed in neurons of the cerebral cortex, cerebellum, and hippocampus in addition to other regions of the central nervous system (CNS). In addition, EGF is also expressed in various regions of the CNS. Therefore, EGF acts not only on mitotic cells, but also on postmitotic neurons. In fact, many studies have indicated that EGF has neurotrophic or neuromodulatory effects on various types of neurons in the CNS.
  • EGF acts directly on cultured cerebral cortical and cerebellar neurons, enhancing neurite outgrowth and survival.
  • EGF also acts on other cell types, including septal cholinergic and mesencephalic dopaminergic neurons, indirectly through glial cells.
  • Evidence of the effects of EGF on neurons in the CNS is accumulating, but the mechanisms of action remain essentially unknown.
  • EGF-induced signaling in mitotic cells is better understood than in postmitotic neurons.
  • Studies of cloned pheochromocytoma PC12 cells and cultured cerebral cortical neurons have suggested that the EGF-induced neurotrophic actions are mediated by sustained activation of the EGFR and mitogen-activated protein kinase (MAPK) in response to EGF.
  • MAPK mitogen-activated protein kinase
  • EGF is produced by the salivary and Brunner's glands of the gastrointestinal system, kidney, pancreas, thyroid gland, pituitary gland, and the nervous system, and is found in body fluids such as saliva, blood, cerebrospinal fluid (CSF), urine, amniotic fluid, prostatic fluid, pancreatic juice, and breast milk, Plata-Salaman, Peptides 12:653-663 (1991).
  • body fluids such as saliva, blood, cerebrospinal fluid (CSF), urine, amniotic fluid, prostatic fluid, pancreatic juice, and breast milk, Plata-Salaman, Peptides 12:653-663 (1991).
  • EGF is mediated by its membrane specific receptor, which contains an intrinsic tyrosine kinase. Stoscheck et al., J. Cell Biochem. 31:135-152 (1986). EGF is believed to function by binding to the extracellular portion of its receptor which induces a transmembrane signal that activates the intrinsic tyrosine kinase.
  • Non isolated peptides having this motif include TGF-alpha, amphiregulin, schwannoma-derived growth factor (SDGF), heparin-binding EGF-like growth factors and certain virally encoded peptides (e.g., Vaccinia virus, Reisner, Nature 313:801-803 (1985), Shope fibroma virus, Chang et al., Mol Cell Biol. 7:535-540 (1987), Molluscum contagiosum, Porter and Archard, J. Gen. Virol. 68:673-682 (1987), and Myxoma virus, Upton et al., J. Virol. 61:1271-1275 (1987), Prigent and Lemoine, Prog. Growth Factor Res. 4:1-24 (1992).
  • EGF-like domains are not confined to growth factors but have been observed in a variety of cell-surface and extracellular proteins which have interesting properties in cell adhesion, protein-protein interaction and development, Laurence and Gusterson, Tumor Biol. 11:229-261 (1990). These proteins include blood coagulation factors (factors VI, IX, X, XII, protein C, protein S, protein Z, tissue plasminogen activator, urokinase), extracellular matrix components (laminin, cytotactin, entactin), cell surface receptors (LDL receptor, thrombomodulin receptor) and immunity-related proteins (complement C1r, uromodulin).
  • blood coagulation factors factors VI, IX, X, XII, protein C, protein S, protein Z, tissue plasminogen activator, urokinase
  • extracellular matrix components laminin, cytotactin, entactin
  • LDL receptor thrombomodulin receptor
  • immunity-related proteins complement
  • EGF-like precursors are preserved through lower organisms as well as in mammalian cells.
  • a number of genes with developmental significance have been identified in invertebrates with EGF-like repeats.
  • the notch gene of Drosophila encodes 36 tandemly arranged 40 amino acid repeats which show homology to EGF, Wharton et al., Cell 43:557-581 (1985).
  • Hydropathy plots indicate a putative membrane spanning domain, with the EGF-related sequences being located on the extracellular side of the membrane.
  • Other homeotic genes with EGF-like repeats include Delta, 95F and 5ZD which were identified using probes based on Notch, and the nematode gene Lin-12 which encodes a putative receptor for a developmental signal transmitted between two specified cells.
  • EGF has been shown to have potential in the preservation and maintenance of gastrointestinal mucosa and the repair of acute and chronic mucosal lesions, Konturek et al., Eur. J. Gastroenterol Hepatol. 7 (10), 933-37 (1995), including the treatment of necrotizing enterocolitis, Zollinger-Ellison syndrome, gastrointestinal ulceration gastrointestinal ulcerations and congenital microvillus atrophy, Guglietta and Sullivan, Eur. J. Gastroenterol Hepatol, 7(10), 945-50 (1995). Additionally, EGF has been implicated in hair follicle differentiation; du Cros, J. Invest. Dermatol. 101 (1 Suppl.), 106S-113S (1993), Hillier, Clin.
  • kidney function Hamm et al., Semin. Nephrol. 13(1): 109-15 (1993), Harris, Am. J. Kidney Dis. 17(6): 627-30 (1991); tear fluid, van Setten et al., Int. Opthalmol 15(6); 359-62 (1991); vitamin K mediated blood coagulation, Stenflo et al., Blood 78(7): 1637-51 (1991).
  • EGF is also implicated various skin disease characterized by abnormal keratinocyte differentiation, e.g., psoriasis, epithelial cancers such as squamous cell carcinomas of the lung, epidermoid carcinoma of the vulva and gliomas. King et al., Am. J. Med. Sci. 296:154-158 (1988).
  • Growth factors are molecular signals or mediators that enhance cell growth or proliferation, alone or in concert, by binding to specific cell surface receptors. However, there are other cellular reactions than only growth upon expression to growth factors. As a result, growth factors are better characterized as multifunctional and potent cellular regulators. Their biological effects include proliferation, chemotaxis and stimulation of extracellular matrix production. Growth factors can have both stimulatory and inhibitory effects.
  • TGF-beta transforming growth factor
  • TGF-beta is highly pleiotropic and can stimulate proliferation in some cells, especially connective tissue, while being a potent inhibitor of proliferation in others, such as lymphocytes and epithelial cells.
  • Peptide growth factors are elements of a complex biological language, providing the basis for intercellular communication. They permit cells to convey information between each other, mediate interaction between cells and change gene expression. The effect of these multifunctional and pluripotent factors is dependent on the presence or absence of other peptides.
  • FGF-8 is a member of the fibroblast growth factors (FGFs) which are a family of heparin-binding, potent mitogens for both normal diploid fibroblasts and established cell lines, Gospodarowicz et al. (1984), Proc. Nat. Acad. Sci. USA 81:6963.
  • the FGF family comprises acidic FGF (FGF-1), basic FGF (FGF-2), INT-2 (FGF-3), K-FGF/HST (FGF-4), FGF-5, FGF-6, KGF (FGF-7), AIGF (FGF-8) among others. All FGFs have two conserved cysteine residues and share 30-50% sequence homology at the amino acid level.
  • Fibroblast growth factors can also stimulate a large number of cell types in a non-mitogenic manner. These activities include promotion of cell migration into wound area (chemotaxis), initiation of new blood vessel formulation (angiogenesis), modulation of nerve regeneration and survival (neurotrophism), modulation of endocrine functions, and stimulation or suppression of specific cellular protein expression, extracellular matrix production and cell survival. Baird & Bohlen, Handbook of Exp. Pharmacol. 95(1): 369418, Springer, (1990). These properties provide a basis for using fibroblast growth factors in therapeutic approaches to accelerate wound healing, nerve repair, collateral blood vessel formation, and the like. For example, fibroblast growth factors have been suggested to minimize myocardium damage in heart disease and surgery (U.S. Pat. No. 4,378,347).
  • FGF-8 also known as androgen-induced growth factor (AIGF)
  • AIGF androgen-induced growth factor
  • FGF-8 has been proposed to be under androgenic regulation and induction in the mouse mammary carcinoma cell line SC3. Tanaka et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 89:8928-8932 (1992); Sato et al., J. Steroid Biochem. Molec. Biol. 47:91-98 (1993).
  • FGF-8 may have a local role in the prostate, which is known to be an androgen-responsive organ.
  • FGF-8 can also be oncogenic, as it displays transforming activity when transfected into NIH-3T3 fibroblasts. Kouhara et al., Oncogene 9 455-462 (1994). While FGF-8 has been detected in heart, brain, lung, kidney, testis, prostate and ovary, expression was also detected in the absence of exogenous androgens. Schmitt et al., J. Steroid Biochem. Mol. Biol. 57 (34): 173-78 (1996).
  • FGF-8 shares the property with several other FGFs of being expressed at a variety of stages of murine embryogenesis, which supports the theory that the various FGFs have multiple and perhaps coordinated roles in differentiation and embryogenesis. Moreover, FGF-8 has also been identified as a protooncogene that cooperates with Wnt-1 in the process of mammary tumorigenesis (Shackleford et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 90, 740-744 (1993); Heikinheimo et al., Mech. Dev. 48:129-138 (1994)).
  • FGF-8 exists as three protein isoforms, as a result of alternative splicing of the primary transcript. Tanaka et al., supra. Normal adult expression of FGF-8 is weak and confined to gonadal tissue, however northern blot analysis has indicated that FGF-8 mRNA is present from day 10 through day 12 or murine gestation, which suggests that FGF-8 is important to normal development. Heikinheimo et al., Mech Dev. 48(2): 129-38 (1994).
  • FGF-8 was expressed in the surface ectoderm of the forelimb and hindlimb buds, the nasal its and nasopharynx, the infundibulum and in the telencephalon, diencephalon and metencephalon. Expression continues in the developing hindlimbs through day 13 of gestation, but is undetectable thereafter. The results suggest that FGF-8 has a unique temporal and spatial pattern in embryogenesis and suggests a role for this growth factor in multiple regions of ectodermal differentiation in the post-gastrulation embryo.
  • TGF-beta supergene family or simply TGF-beta superfamily, a group of secreted proteins, includes a large number of related growth and differentiation factors expressed in virtually all phyla.
  • Superfamily members bind to specific cell surface receptors that activate signal transduction mechanisms to elicit their multifunctional cytokine effects. Kolodziejczyk and Hall, Biochem. Cell. Biol., 74:299-314 (1996); Attisano and Wrana, Cytokine Growth Factor Rev., 7:327-339 (1996); and Hill, Cellular Signaling, 8:533-544 (1996).
  • TGF-beta TGF-beta
  • Sporn and Roberts in Peptide Growth Factors and Their Receptors, Sporn and Roberts, eds. (Springer-Verlag: Berlin, 1990) pp.
  • the proteins of the TGF-beta superfamily are disulfide-linked homo- or heterodimers encoded by larger precursor polypeptide chains containing a hydrophobic signal sequence, a long and relatively poorly conserved N-terminal pro region of several hundred amino acids, a cleavage site (usually polybasic), and a shorter and more highly conserved C-terminal region.
  • This C-terminal region corresponds to the processed mature protein and contains approximately 100 amino acids with a characteristic cysteine motif, i.e. the conservation of seven of the nine cysteine residues of TGF-beta among all known family members.
  • TGF-beta1 There are at least five forms of TGF-beta currently identified, TGF-beta1, TGF-beta2, TGF-beta3, TGF-beta4, and TGF-beta5.
  • the activated form of TGF-beta1 is a homodimer formed by dimerization of the carboxy-terminal 112 amino acids of a 390 amino acid precursor.
  • Recombinant TGF-beta1 has been cloned (Derynck et al., Nature, 316:701-705 (1985)) and expressed in Chinese hamster ovary cells (Gentry et al., Mol. Cell. Biol. 7:3418-3427 (1987)).
  • TGF-beta2 has a precursor form of 414 amino acids and is also processed to a homodimer from the carboxy-terminal 112 amino acids that shares approximately 70% homology with the active form of TGF-beta1 (Marquardt et al., J.
  • TGF-beta4 and TGF-beta5 were cloned from a chicken chondrocyte cDNA library (Jakowlew et al., Molec. Endocrinol., 2:1186-1195 (1988)) and from a frog oocyte cDNA library, respectively.
  • the pro region of TGF-beta associates non-covalently with the mature TGF-beta dimer (Wakefield et al., J. Biol. Chem., 263:7646-7654 (1988); Wakefield et al., Growth Factors, 1:203-218 (1989)), and the pro regions are found to be necessary for proper folding and secretion of the active mature dimers of both TGF-beta and activin (Gray and Mason, Science, 247:1328-1330 (1990)).
  • the association between the mature and pro regions of TGF-beta masks the biological activity of the mature dimer, resulting in formation of an inactive latent form. Latency is not a constant of the TGF-beta superfamily, since the presence of the pro region has no effect on activin or inhibin biological activity.
  • TGF-beta A unifying feature of the biology of the proteins from the TGF-beta superfamily is their ability to regulate developmental processes.
  • TGF-beta has been shown to have numerous regulatory actions on a wide variety of both normal and neoplastic cells.
  • TGF-beta is multifunctional, as it can either stimulate or inhibit cell proliferation, differentiation, and other critical processes in cell function (Sporn and Roberts, supra).
  • EBAF TGF-beta superfamily
  • the predicted protein sequence of EBAF showed a strong homology to the protein encoded by mouse lefty/stra3 of the TGF-beta superfamily.
  • a motif search revealed that the predicted EBAF protein contains most of the cysteine residues which are conserved among the TGF-beta-related proteins and which are necessary for the formation of the cysteine knot structure.
  • the EBAF sequence contains an additional cysteine residue, 12 amino acids upstream from the first conserved cysteine residue.
  • the only other family members known to contain an additional cysteine residue are TGF-betas, inhibins, and GDF-3.
  • EBAF similar to LEFTY, GDF-3/Vgr2, and GDF-9, lacks the cysteine residue that is known to form the intermolecular disulfide bond. Therefore, EBAF appears to be an additional member of the TGF-beta superfamily with an unpaired cysteine residue that may not exist as a dimer. However, hydrophobic contacts between the two monomer subunits may promote dimer formation. Fluorescence in situ hybridization showed that the ebaf gene is located on human chromosome 1 at band q42.1.
  • the invention also pertains to conjugates of symmtroadhesins/immunosymmetroadhesins.
  • a cytotoxic agent such as a chemotherapeutic agent, toxin (e.g., an enzymatically active toxin of bacterial, fungal, plant, or animal origin, or fragments thereof), or a radioactive isotope (i.e., a radioconjugate).
  • Enzymatically active toxins and fragments thereof that can be used include diphtheria A chain, nonbinding active fragments of diphtheria toxin, exotoxin A chain (from Pseudomonas aeruginosa ), ricin A chain, abrin A chain, modeccin A chain, alpha-sarcin, Aleurites fordii proteins, dianthin proteins, Phytolaca americana proteins (PAPI, PAPH, and PAP-S), momordica charantia inhibitor, curcin, crotin, sapaonaria officinalis inhibitor, gelonin, mitogellin, restrictocin, phenomycin, enomycin, and the tricothecenes.
  • a variety of radionuclides are available for the production of radioconjugated antibodies. Examples include 212 Bi, 131 I, 113 In, 90 Y, and 186 Re.
  • Conjugates of the compositions of the invention including cytotoxic agent are made using a variety of bifunctional protein-coupling agents such as N-succinimidyl-3-(2-pyridyldithiol) propionate (SPDP), iminothiolane (IT), bifunctional derivatives of imidoesters (such as dimethyl adipimidate HCL), active esters (such as disuccinimidyl suberate), aldehydes (such as glutareldehyde), bis-azido compounds (such as bis(p-azidobenzoyl)hexanediamine), bis-diazonium derivatives (such as bis-(p-diazoniumbenzoyl)-ethylenediamine), diisocyanates (such as tolyene 2,6-diisocyanate), and bis-active fluorine compounds (such as 1,5-difluoro-2,4-dinitrobenzene).
  • SPDP N-succinimidyl
  • a ricin immunotoxin can be prepared as described in Vitetta et al., Science, 238:1098 (1987).
  • Carbon-14-labeled 1-isothiocyanatobenzyl-3-methyldiethylene triaminepentaacetic acid (MX-DTPA) is an exemplary chelating agent for conjugation of radionucleotide to the antibody. See WO94111026.
  • the genetic devices disclosed herein may be synthesized by various routes.
  • One particular route is to synthesize components in vivo by recombinant DNA technology and then to chemically modify the secreted or procured products under conditions so as to form the compounds.
  • Alternative routes include solid-state synthesis.
  • amino acid sequence or portions thereof, may be produced by direct peptide synthesis using solid-phase techniques (see, e.g., Stewart et al., Solid-Phase Peptide Synthesis, W.H. Freeman Co., San Francisco, Calif. (1969); Merrifield, J. Am. Chem. Soc., 85:2149-2154 (1963)). In vitro protein synthesis may be performed using manual techniques or by automation.
  • Automated synthesis may be accomplished, for instance, using an Applied Biosystems Peptide Synthesizer (Foster City, Calif.) using manufacturer's instructions.
  • Various portions of the stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest may be chemically synthesized separately and combined using chemical or enzymatic methods to produce the full-length stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest.
  • Encoding DNA may be obtained from a cDNA library prepared from tissue believed to possess the mRNA of interest and to express it at a detectable level. Accordingly, human DNA can be conveniently obtained from a cDNA library prepared from human tissue, and so forth. An encoding gene may also be obtained from a genomic library or by known synthetic procedures (e.g., automated nucleic acid synthesis).
  • Probes such as antibodies to the stretch of consecutive amino acids or oligonucleotides of at least about 20-80 bases
  • Screening the cDNA or genomic library with the selected probe may be conducted using standard procedures, such as described in Sambrook et al., Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual (New York: Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, 1989).
  • An alternative means to isolate the encoding gene is to use PCR methodology (Sambrook et al., supra; Dieffenbach et al., PCR Primer: A Laboratory Manual (Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, 1995)).
  • the oligonucleotide sequences selected as probes should be of sufficient length and sufficiently unambiguous that false positives are minimized.
  • the oligonucleotide is preferably labeled such that it can be detected upon hybridization to DNA in the library being screened. Methods of labeling are well known in the art, and include the use of radiolabels like 32 P-labeled ATP, biotinylation or enzyme labeling. Hybridization conditions, including moderate stringency and high stringency, are provided in Sambrook et al., supra.
  • Sequences identified in such library screening methods can be compared and aligned to other known sequences deposited and available in public databases such as GenBank or other private sequence databases. Sequence identity (at either the amino acid or nucleotide level) within defined regions of the molecule or across the full-length sequence can be determined using methods known in the art and as described herein.
  • Nucleic acid having protein coding sequence may be obtained by screening selected cDNA or genomic libraries using the deduced amino acid sequence disclosed herein for the first time, and, if necessary, using conventional primer extension procedures as described in Sambrook et al., supra, to detect precursors and processing intermediates of mRNA that may not have been reverse-transcribed into cDNA.
  • Host cells are transfected or transformed with expression or cloning vectors described herein for production and cultured in conventional nutrient media modified as appropriate for inducing promoters, selecting transformants, or amplifying the genes encoding the desired sequences.
  • the culture conditions such as media, temperature, pH and the like, can be selected by the skilled artisan without undue experimentation. In general, principles, protocols, and practical techniques for maximizing the productivity of cell cultures can be found in Mammalian Cell Biotechnology: a Practical Approach, M. Butler, ed. (IRL Press, 1991) and Sambrook et al., supra.
  • Methods of eukaryotic cell transfection and prokaryotic cell transformation are known to the ordinarily skilled artisan, for example, CaCl 2 , CaPO 4 , liposome-mediated and electroporation. Depending on the host cell used, transformation is performed using standard techniques appropriate to such cells.
  • the calcium treatment employing calcium chloride, as described in Sambrook et al., supra, or electroporation is generally used for prokaryotes.
  • Infection with Agrobacterium tumefaciens is used for transformation of certain plant cells, as described by Shaw et al., Gene, 23:315 (1983) and WO 89/05859 published Jun. 29, 1989.
  • DNA into cells such as by nuclear microinjection, electroporation, bacterial protoplast fusion with intact cells, or polycations, e.g., polybrene, polyornithine, may also be used.
  • polycations e.g., polybrene, polyornithine.
  • Suitable host cells for cloning or expressing the DNA in the vectors herein include prokaryote, yeast, or higher eukaryote cells.
  • Suitable prokaryotes include but are not limited to eubacteria, such as Gram-negative or Gram-positive organisms, for example, Enterobacteriaceae such as E. coli .
  • Various E. coli strains are publicly available, such as E. coli K12 strain MM294 (ATCC 31,446); E. coli X1776 (ATCC 31,537); E. coli strain W3110 (ATCC 27,325) and K5772 (ATCC 53,635).
  • suitable prokaryotic host cells include Enterobacteriaceae such as Escherichia , e.g., E. coli, Enterobacter, Erwinia, Klebsiella, Proteus, Salmonella , e.g., Salmonella typhimurium, Serratia , e.g., Serratia marcescans , and Shigella , as well as Bacilli such as B. subtilis and B. licheniformis (e.g., B. licheniformis 41P disclosed in DD 266,710 published Apr. 12, 1989), Pseudomonas such as P. aeruginosa , and Streptomyces . These examples are illustrative rather than limiting.
  • Strain W3110 is one particularly preferred host or parent host because it is a common host strain for recombinant DNA product fermentations. Preferably, the host cell secretes minimal amounts of proteolytic enzymes.
  • strain W3110 may be modified to effect a genetic mutation in the genes encoding proteins endogenous to the host, with examples of such hosts including E. coli W3110 strain 1A2, which has the complete genotype tonA; E. coli W3110 strain 9E4, which has the complete genotype tonA ptr3; E.
  • E. coli W3110 strain 27C7 (ATCC 55,244), which has the complete genotype tonAptr3phoA E15 (argF-lac)169 degP ompT kan.sup.r; E. coli W3110 strain 37D6, which has the complete genotype tonA ptr3 phoA E15 (argF-lac)169 degP ompT rbs7 ilvG kan.sup.r, E. coli W3110 strain 40B4, which is strain 37D6 with a non-kanamycin resistant degP deletion mutation; and an E. coli strain having mutant periplasmic protease disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 4,946,783 issued Aug. 7, 1990.
  • in vitro methods of cloning e.g., PCR or other nucleic acid polymerase reactions, are suitable.
  • eukaryotic microbes such as filamentous fungi or yeast are suitable cloning or expression hosts for encoding vectors.
  • Saccharomyces cerevisiae is a commonly used lower eukaryotic host microorganism.
  • Others include Schizosaccharomyces pombe (Beach and Nurse, Nature, 290:140 (1981); EP 139,383 published May 2, 1985); Kluyveromyces hosts (U.S. Pat. No. 4,943,529; Fleer et al., Bio/Technology, 9:968-975 (1991)) such as, e.g., K.
  • lactis (MW98-8C, CBS683, CBS4574; Louvencourt et al., J. Bacteriol., 737 (1983)), K. fragilis (ATCC 12,424), K. bulgaricus (ATCC 16,045), K. wickeramii (ATCC 24,178), K. waltii (ATCC 56,500), K. drosophilarum (ATCC 36,906; Van den Berg et al., Bio/Technology, 8:135 (1990)), K. thermotolerans , and K. marxianus; yarrowia (EP 402,226); Pichia pastoris (EP 183,070; Sreekrishna et al., J.
  • Methylotropic yeasts are suitable herein and include, but are not limited to, yeast capable of growth on methanol selected from the genera consisting of Hansenula, Candida, Kloeckera, Pichia, Saccharomyces, Torulopsis , and Rhodotorula .
  • yeast capable of growth on methanol selected from the genera consisting of Hansenula, Candida, Kloeckera, Pichia, Saccharomyces, Torulopsis , and Rhodotorula .
  • a list of specific species that are exemplary of this class of yeasts may be found in C. Anthony, The Biochemistry of Methylotrophs, 269 (1982).
  • Suitable host cells for the expression of glycosylated stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest are derived from multicellular organisms.
  • invertebrate cells include insect cells such as Drosophila S2 and Spodoptera Sf9, as well as plant cells.
  • useful mammalian host cell lines include Chinese hamster ovary (CHO) and COS cells. More specific examples include monkey kidney CV1 line transformed by SV40 (COS-7, ATCC CRL 1651); human embryonic kidney line (293 or 293 cells subcloned for growth in suspension culture, Graham et al., J. Gen Virol., 36:59 (1977)); Chinese hamster ovary cells/ ⁇ DHFR (CHO, Urlaub and Chasin, Proc. Natl.
  • mice sertoli cells TM4, Mather, Biol. Reprod., 23:243-251 (1980)
  • human lung cells W138, ATCC CCL 75
  • human liver cells Hep G2, HB 8065
  • mouse mammary tumor MMT 060562, ATCC CCL51. The selection of the appropriate host cell is deemed to be within the skill in the art.
  • the nucleic acid (e.g., cDNA or genomic DNA) encoding the stretch of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest may be inserted into a replicable vector for cloning (amplification of the DNA) or for expression.
  • a replicable vector for cloning (amplification of the DNA) or for expression.
  • the vector may, for example, be in the form of a plasmid, cosmid, viral particle, or phage.
  • the appropriate nucleic acid sequence may be inserted into the vector by a variety of procedures. In general, DNA is inserted into an appropriate restriction endonuclease site(s) using techniques known in the art.
  • Vector components generally include, but are not limited to, one or more of a signal sequence, an origin of replication, one or more marker genes, an enhancer element, a promoter, and a transcription termination sequence. Construction of suitable vectors containing one or more of these components employs standard ligation techniques which are known to the skilled artisan.
  • the stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest may be produced recombinantly not only directly, but also as a fusion polypeptide with a heterologous polypeptide, which may be a signal sequence or other polypeptide having a specific cleavage site at the N-terminus of the mature protein or polypeptide.
  • a heterologous polypeptide which may be a signal sequence or other polypeptide having a specific cleavage site at the N-terminus of the mature protein or polypeptide.
  • the signal sequence may be a component of the vector, or it may be a part of the encoding DNA that is inserted into the vector.
  • the signal sequence may be a prokaryotic signal sequence selected, for example, from the group of the alkaline phosphatase, penicillinase, lpp, or heat-stable enterotoxin II leaders.
  • the signal sequence may be, e.g., the yeast invertase leader, alpha factor leader (including Saccharomyces and Kluyveromyces alpha-factor leaders, the latter described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,010,182), or acid phosphatase leader, the C. albicans glucoamylase leader (EP 362,179 published Apr. 4, 1990), or the signal described in WO 90/13646 published Nov. 15, 1990.
  • mammalian signal sequences may be used to direct secretion of the protein, such as signal sequences from secreted polypeptides of the same or related species, as well as viral secretory leaders.
  • Both expression and cloning vectors contain a nucleic acid sequence that enables the vector to replicate in one or more selected host cells. Such sequences are well known for a variety of bacteria, yeast, and viruses.
  • the origin of replication from the plasmid pBR322 is suitable for most Gram-negative bacteria, the 2mu plasmid origin is suitable for yeast, and various viral origins (SV40, polyoma, adenovirus, VSV or BPV) are useful for cloning vectors in mammalian cells.
  • Selection genes will typically contain a selection gene, also termed a selectable marker.
  • Typical selection genes encode proteins that (a) confer resistance to antibiotics or other toxins, e.g., ampicillin, neomycin, methotrexate, or tetracycline, (b) complement auxotrophic deficiencies, or (c) supply critical nutrients not available from complex media, e.g., the gene encoding D-alanine racemase for Bacilli.
  • selectable markers for mammalian cells are those that enable the identification of cells competent to take up the encoding nucleic acid, such as DHFR or thymidine kinase.
  • An appropriate host cell when wild-type DHFR is employed is the CHO cell line deficient in DHFR activity, prepared and propagated as described by Urlaub et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 77:4216 (1980).
  • a suitable selection gene for use in yeast is the trp1 gene present in the yeast plasmid YRp7 (Stinchcomb et al., Nature, 282:39 (1979); Kingsman et al., Gene, 7:141 (1979); Tschemper et al., Gene, 10:157 (1980)).
  • the trp1 gene provides a selection marker for a mutant strain of yeast lacking the ability to grow in tryptophan, for example, ATCC No. 44076 or PEP4-1 (Jones, Genetics, 85:12 (1977)).
  • Expression and cloning vectors usually contain a promoter operably linked to the encoding nucleic acid sequence to direct mRNA synthesis. Promoters recognized by a variety of potential host cells are well known. Promoters suitable for use with prokaryotic hosts include the beta-lactamase and lactose promoter systems (Chang et al., Nature, 275:615 (1978); Goeddel et al., Nature, 281:544 (1979)), alkaline phosphatase, a tryptophan (trp) promoter system (Goeddel, Nucleic Acids Res., 8:4057 (1980); EP 36,776), and hybrid promoters such as the tac promoter (deBoer et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 80:21-25 (1983)). Promoters for use in bacterial systems also will contain a Shine-Dalgarno (S.D.) sequence operably linked to the encoding DNA.
  • Suitable promoting sequences for use with yeast hosts include the promoters for 3-phosphoglycerate kinase (Hitzeman et al., J. Biol. Chem., 255:2073 (1980)) or other glycolytic enzymes (Hess et al., J. Adv.
  • yeast promoters which are inducible promoters having the additional advantage of transcription controlled by growth conditions, are the promoter regions for alcohol dehydrogenase 2, isocytochrome C, acid phosphatase, degradative enzymes associated with nitrogen metabolism, metallothionein, glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase, and enzymes responsible for maltose and galactose utilization. Suitable vectors and promoters for use in yeast expression are further described in EP 73,657.
  • Transcription from vectors in mammalian host cells is controlled, for example, by promoters obtained from the genomes of viruses such as polyoma virus, fowlpox virus (UK 2,211,504 published Jul. 5, 1989), adenovirus (such as Adenovirus 2), bovine papilloma virus, avian sarcoma virus, cytomegalovirus, a retrovirus, hepatitis-B virus and Simian Virus 40 (SV40), from heterologous mammalian promoters, e.g., the actin promoter or an immunoglobulin promoter, and from heat-shock promoters, provided such promoters are compatible with the host cell systems.
  • viruses such as polyoma virus, fowlpox virus (UK 2,211,504 published Jul. 5, 1989), adenovirus (such as Adenovirus 2), bovine papilloma virus, avian sarcoma virus, cytomegalovirus, a retrovirus
  • Enhancers are cis-acting elements of DNA, usually about from 10 to 300 bp, that act on a promoter to increase its transcription.
  • Many enhancer sequences are now known from mammalian genes (globin, elastase, albumin, alpha-fetoprotein, and, insulin). Typically, however, one will use an enhancer from a eukaryotic cell virus.
  • Examples include the SV40 enhancer on the late side of the replication origin (bp 100-270), the cytomegalovirus early promoter enhancer, the polyoma enhancer on the late side of the replication origin, and adenovirus enhancers.
  • the enhancer may be spliced into the vector at a position 5′ or 3′ to the coding sequence, but is preferably located at a site 5′ from the promoter.
  • Expression vectors used in eukaryotic host cells will also contain sequences necessary for the termination of transcription and for stabilizing the mRNA. Such sequences are commonly available from the 5′ and, occasionally 3′, untranslated regions of eukaryotic or viral DNAs or cDNAs. These regions contain nucleotide segments transcribed as polyadenylated fragments in the untranslated portion of the mRNA encoding stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest.
  • Gene amplification and/or expression may be measured in a sample directly, for example, by conventional Southern blotting, Northern blotting to quantitate the transcription of mRNA (Thomas, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 77:5201-5205 (1980)), dot blotting (DNA analysis), or in situ hybridization, using an appropriately labeled probe, based on the sequences provided herein.
  • antibodies may be employed that can recognize specific duplexes, including DNA duplexes, RNA duplexes, and DNA-RNA hybrid duplexes or DNA-protein duplexes. The antibodies in turn may be labeled and the assay may be carried out where the duplex is bound to a surface, so that upon the formation of duplex on the surface, the presence of antibody bound to the duplex can be detected.
  • Gene expression may be measured by immunological methods, such as immunohistochemical staining of cells or tissue sections and assay of cell culture or body fluids, to quantitate directly the expression of gene product.
  • Antibodies useful for immunohistochemical staining and/or assay of sample fluids may be either monoclonal or polyclonal, and may be prepared in any mammal. Conveniently, the antibodies may be prepared against a native sequence stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest or against a synthetic peptide based on the DNA sequences provided herein or against exogenous sequence fused to DNA encoding a stretch of consecutive amino acids or polypeptide of interest and encoding a specific antibody epitope.
  • Forms of the stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest may be recovered from culture medium or from host cell lysates. If membrane-bound, it can be released from the membrane using a suitable detergent solution (e.g. Triton-X 100) or by enzymatic cleavage. Cells employed in expression of the stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest can be disrupted by various physical or chemical means, such as freeze-thaw cycling, sonication, mechanical disruption, or cell lysing agents.
  • the following procedures are exemplary of suitable purification procedures: by fractionation on an ion-exchange column; ethanol precipitation; reverse phase HPLC; chromatography on silica or on a cation-exchange resin such as DEAE; chromatofocusing; SDS-PAGE; ammonium sulfate precipitation; gel filtration using, for example, Sephadex G-75; protein A Sepharose columns to remove contaminants such as IgG; and metal chelating columns to bind epitope-tagged forms.
  • the DNA sequence encoding the desired amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide is initially amplified using selected PCR primers.
  • the primers should contain restriction enzyme sites which correspond to the restriction enzyme sites on the selected expression vector.
  • restriction enzyme sites A variety of expression vectors may be employed.
  • An example of a suitable vector is pBR322 (derived from E. coli ; see Bolivar et al., Gene, 2:95 (1977)) which contains genes for ampicillin and tetracycline resistance.
  • the vector is digested with restriction enzyme and dephosphorylated.
  • the PCR amplified sequences are then ligated into the vector.
  • the vector will preferably include sequences which encode for an antibiotic resistance gene, a trp promoter, a polyhis leader (including the first six STII codons, polyhis sequence, and enterokinase cleavage site), the specific amino acid sequence of interest/polypeptide coding region, lambda transcriptional terminator, and an argU gene.
  • the ligation mixture is then used to transform a selected E. coli strain using the methods described in Sambrook et al., supra. Transformants are identified by their ability to grow on LB plates and antibiotic resistant colonies are then selected. Plasmid DNA can be isolated and confirmed by restriction analysis and DNA sequencing.
  • Selected clones can be grown overnight in liquid culture medium such as LB broth supplemented with antibiotics.
  • the overnight culture may subsequently be used to inoculate a larger scale culture.
  • the cells are then grown to a desired optical density, during which the expression promoter is turned on.
  • the cells After culturing the cells for several more hours, the cells can be harvested by centrifugation.
  • the cell pellet obtained by the centrifugation can be solubilized using various agents known in the art, and the solubilized amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide can then be purified using a metal chelating column under conditions that allow tight binding of the protein.
  • the primers can contain restriction enzyme sites which correspond to the restriction enzyme sites on the selected expression vector, and other useful sequences providing for efficient and reliable translation initiation, rapid purification on a metal chelation column, and proteolytic removal with enterokinase.
  • the PCR-amplified, poly-His tagged sequences can be ligated into an expression vector used to transform an E. coli host based on, for example, strain 52 (W3110 fuhA(tonA) Ion galE rpoHts(htpRts) clpP(lacIq). Transformants can first be grown in LB containing 50 mg/ml carbenicillin at 30° C. with shaking until an O.D.600 of 3-5 is reached.
  • Cultures are then diluted 50-100 fold into C RAP media (prepared by mixing 3.57 g (NH 4 ) 2 SO 4 , 0.71 g sodium citrate-2H 2 O, 1.07 g KCl, 5.36 g Difco yeast extract, 5.36 g Sheffield hycase SF in 500 mL water, as well as 110 mM MPOS, pH 7.3, 0.55% (w/v) glucose and 7 mM MgSO 4 ) and grown for approximately 20-30 hours at 30° C. with shaking. Samples were removed to verify expression by SDS-PAGE analysis, and the bulk culture is centrifuged to pellet the cells. Cell pellets were frozen until purification and refolding.
  • C RAP media prepared by mixing 3.57 g (NH 4 ) 2 SO 4 , 0.71 g sodium citrate-2H 2 O, 1.07 g KCl, 5.36 g Difco yeast extract, 5.36 g Sheffield hycase SF in 500 mL water, as well as 110 mM MPOS,
  • E. coli paste from 0.5 to 1 L fermentations (6-10 g pellets) was resuspended in 10 volumes (w/v) in 7 M guanidine, 20 mM Tris, pH 8 buffer.
  • Solid sodium sulfite and sodium tetrathionate is added to make final concentrations of 0.1M and 0.02 M, respectively, and the solution was stirred overnight at 4° C. This step results in a denatured protein with all cysteine residues blocked by sulfitolization.
  • the solution was centrifuged at 40,000 rpm in a Beckman Ultracentifuge for 30 min.
  • the supernatant was diluted with 3-5 volumes of metal chelate column buffer (6 M guanidine, 20 mM Tris, pH 7.4) and filtered through 0.22 micron filters to clarify. Depending the clarified extract was loaded onto a 5 mil Qiagen Ni-NTA metal chelate column equilibrated in the metal chelate column buffer. The column was washed with additional buffer containing 50 mM imidazole (Calbiochem, Utrol grade), pH 7.4. The protein was eluted with buffer containing 250 mM imidazole. Fractions containing the desired protein were pooled and stored at 4.degree. C. Protein concentration was estimated by its absorbance at 280 nm using the calculated extinction coefficient based on its amino acid sequence.
  • This general example illustrates a preparation of a glycosylated form of a desired amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component by recombinant expression in mammalian cells.
  • the vector pRK5 (see EP 307,247, published Mar. 15, 1989) can be employed as the expression vector.
  • the encoding DNA is ligated into pRK5 with selected restriction enzymes to allow insertion of the DNA using ligation methods such as described in Sambrook et al., supra.
  • the selected host cells may be 293 cells.
  • Human 293 cells (ATCC CCL 1573) are grown to confluence in tissue culture plates in medium such as DMEM supplemented with fetal calf serum and optionally, nutrient components and/or antibiotics.
  • About 10 ⁇ g of the ligated vector DNA is mixed with about 1 ⁇ g DNA encoding the VA RNA gene [Thimmappaya et al., Cell 31:543 (1982)] and dissolved in 500 ⁇ l of 1 mM Tris-HCl, 0.1 mM EDTA, 0.227 M CaCl 2 To this mixture is added, dropwise, 500 ⁇ l of 50 mM HEPES (pH 7.35), 280 mM NaCl, 1.5 mM NaPO 4 , and a precipitate is allowed to form for 10 minutes at 25° C. The precipitate is suspended and added to the 293 cells and allowed to settle for about four hours at 37° C. The culture medium is aspirated off and 2 ml of 20% glycerol in PBS is added for 30 seconds. The 293 cells are then washed with serum free medium, fresh medium is added and the cells are incubated for about 5 days.
  • the culture medium is removed and replaced with culture medium (alone) or culture medium containing 200 ⁇ Ci/ml 35 S-cysteine and 200 ⁇ Ci/ml 35 S-methionine.
  • culture medium alone
  • culture medium containing 200 ⁇ Ci/ml 35 S-cysteine and 200 ⁇ Ci/ml 35 S-methionine After a 12 hour incubation, the conditioned medium is collected, concentrated on a spin filter, and loaded onto a 15% SDS gel.
  • the processed gel may be dried and exposed to film for a selected period of time to reveal the presence of amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component.
  • the cultures containing transfected cells may undergo further incubation (in serum free medium) and the medium is tested in selected bioassays.
  • the nucleic acid amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component may be introduced into 293 cells transiently using the dextran sulfate method described by Somparyrac et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci., 12:7575 (1981). 293 cells are grown to maximal density in a spinner flask and 700 ⁇ g of the ligated vector is added. The cells are first concentrated from the spinner flask by centrifugation and washed with PBS. The DNA-dextran precipitate is incubated on the cell pellet for four hours.
  • the cells are treated with 20% glycerol for 90 seconds, washed with tissue culture medium, and re-introduced into the spinner flask containing tissue culture medium, 5 ⁇ g/ml bovine insulin and 0.1 ⁇ g/ml bovine transferrin. After about four days, the conditioned media is centrifuged and filtered to remove cells and debris. The sample containing expressed amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component can then be concentrated and purified by any selected method, such as dialysis and/or column chromatography.
  • the amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component can be expressed in CHO cells.
  • the amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component can be transfected into CHO cells using known reagents such as CaPO 4 or DEAE-dextran.
  • the cell cultures can be incubated, and the medium replaced with culture medium (alone) or medium containing a radiolabel such as 35 S-methionine.
  • the culture medium may be replaced with serum free medium.
  • the cultures are incubated for about 6 days, and then the conditioned medium is harvested.
  • the medium containing the expressed amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component can then be concentrated and purified by any selected method.
  • Epitope-tagged amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component may also be expressed in host CHO cells.
  • the amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component may be subcloned out of a pRK5 vector.
  • the subclone insert can undergo PCR to fuse in frame with a selected epitope tag such as a poly-his tag into a Baculovirus expression vector.
  • the poly-his tagged amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component insert can then be subcloned into a SV40 driven vector containing a selection marker such as DHFR for selection of stable clones.
  • the CHO cells can be transfected (as described above) with the SV40 driven vector. Labeling may be performed, as described above, to verify expression.
  • the culture medium containing the expressed poly-His tagged amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component can then be concentrated and purified by any selected method, such as by Ni 2+ -chelate affinity chromatography.
  • amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component are expressed as an IgG construct (immunoadhesin), in which the coding sequences for the soluble forms (e.g. extracellular domains) of the respective proteins are fused to an IgG1 constant region sequence containing the hinge, CH2 and CH2 domains and/or is a poly-His tagged form.
  • IgG construct immunoadhesin
  • CHO expression vectors are constructed to have compatible restriction sites 5′ and 3′ of the DNA of interest to allow the convenient shuttling of cDNA's.
  • the vector used in expression in CHO cells is as described in Lucas et al., Nucl. Acids Res. 24:9 (1774-1779 (1996), and uses the SV40 early promoter/enhancer to drive expression of the cDNA of interest and dihydrofolate reductase (DHFR).
  • DHFR expression permits selection for stable maintenance of the plasmid following transfection.
  • the following method describes recombinant expression of a desired amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component in yeast.
  • yeast expression vectors are constructed for intracellular production or secretion of a stretch of consecutive amino acids from the ADH2/GAPDH promoter.
  • DNA encoding a desired amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component, a selected signal peptide and the promoter is inserted into suitable restriction enzyme sites in the selected plasmid to direct intracellular expression of the amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component.
  • DNA encoding the stretch of consecutive amino acids can be cloned into the selected plasmid, together with DNA encoding the ADH2/GAPDH promoter, the yeast alpha-factor secretory signal/leader sequence, and linker sequences (if needed) for expression of the stretch of consecutive amino acids.
  • yeast cells such as yeast strain AB110
  • yeast cells can then be transformed with the expression plasmids described above and cultured in selected fermentation media.
  • the transformed yeast supernatants can be analyzed by precipitation with 10% trichloroacetic acid and separation by SDS-PAGE, followed by staining of the gels with Coomassie Blue stain.
  • Recombinant amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component can subsequently be isolated and purified by removing the yeast cells from the fermentation medium by centrifugation and then concentrating the medium using selected cartridge filters.
  • the concentrate containing the amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component may further be purified using selected column chromatography resins.
  • the following method describes recombinant expression of stretches of consecutive amino acids in Baculovirus-infected insect cells.
  • the desired nucleic acid encoding the stretch of consecutive amino acids is fused upstream of an epitope tag contained with a baculovirus expression vector.
  • epitope tags include poly-his tags and immunoglobulin tags (like Fc regions of IgG).
  • a variety of plasmids may be employed, including plasmids derived from commercially available plasmids such as pVL1393 (Novagen). Briefly, the amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component or the desired portion of the amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component (such as the sequence encoding the extracellular domain of a transmembrane protein) is amplified by PCR with primers complementary to the 5′ and 3′ regions. The 5′ primer may incorporate flanking (selected) restriction enzyme sites. The product is then digested with those selected restriction enzymes and subcloned into the expression vector.
  • Recombinant baculovirus is generated by co-transfecting the above plasmid and BaculoGoldTM virus DNA (Pharmingen) into Spodoptera frugiperda (“Sf9”) cells (ATCC CRL 1711) using lipofectin (commercially available from GIBCO-BRL). After 4-5 days of incubation at 28° C., the released viruses are harvested and used for further amplifications. Viral infection and protein expression is performed as described by O'Reilley et al., Baculovirus expression vectors: A laboratory Manual, Oxford: Oxford University Press (1994).
  • Expressed poly-his tagged amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component can then be purified, for example, by Ni 2+ -chelate affinity chromatography as follows. Extracts are prepared from recombinant virus-infected Sf9 cells as described by Rupert et al., Nature, 362:175-179 (1993). Briefly, Sf9 cells are washed, resuspended in sonication buffer (25 mL Hepes, pH 7.9; 12.5 mM MgCl 2 ; 0.1 mM EDTA; 10% Glycerol; 0.1% NP40; 0.4 M KCl), and sonicated twice for 20 seconds on ice.
  • sonication buffer 25 mL Hepes, pH 7.9; 12.5 mM MgCl 2 ; 0.1 mM EDTA; 10% Glycerol; 0.1% NP40; 0.4 M KCl
  • the sonicates are cleared by centrifugation, and the supernatant is diluted 50-fold in loading buffer (50 mM phosphate, 300 mM NaCl, 10% Glycerol, pH 7.8) and filtered through a 0.45 ⁇ m filter.
  • loading buffer 50 mM phosphate, 300 mM NaCl, 10% Glycerol, pH 7.8
  • a Ni 2+ -NTA agarose column (commercially available from Qiagen) is prepared with a bed volume of 5 mL, washed with 25 mL of water and equilibrated with 25 mL of loading buffer.
  • the filtered cell extract is loaded onto the column at 0.5 mL per minute.
  • the column is washed to baseline A 280 with loading buffer, at which point fraction collection is started.
  • the column is washed with a secondary wash buffer (50 mM phosphate; 300 mM NaCl, 10% Glycerol, pH 6.0), which elutes nonspecifically bound protein.
  • a secondary wash buffer 50 mM phosphate; 300 mM NaCl, 10% Glycerol, pH 6.0
  • the column is developed with a 0 to 500 mM Imidazole gradient in the secondary wash buffer.
  • One mL fractions are collected and analyzed by SDS-PAGE and silver staining or western blot with Ni 2+ -NTA-conjugated to alkaline phosphatase (Qiagen). Fractions containing the eluted His 10 -tagged sequence are pooled and dialyzed against loading buffer.
  • purification of the IgG tagged (or Fc tagged) amino acid sequence can be performed using known chromatography techniques, including for instance, Protein A or Protein G column chromatography.
  • Immunoadhesin (Fc containing) constructs of proteins can be purified from conditioned media as follows.
  • the conditioned media is pumped onto a 5 ml Protein A column (Pharmacia) which is equilibrated in 20 mM Na phosphate buffer, pH 6.8. After loading, the column is washed extensively with equilibration buffer before elution with 100 mM citric acid, pH 3.5.
  • the eluted protein is immediately neutralized by collecting 1 ml fractions into tubes containing 275 mL of 1 M Tris buffer, pH 9.
  • the highly purified protein is subsequently desalted into storage buffer as described above for the poly-His tagged proteins.
  • the homogeneity of the proteins is verified by SDS polyacrylamide gel (PEG) electrophoresis and N-terminal amino acid sequencing by Edman degradation.
  • inteins are the protein equivalent of the self-splicing RNA introns (see Perler et al., Nucleic Acids Res. 22:1125-1127 (1994)), which catalyze their own excision from a precursor protein with the concomitant fusion of the flanking protein sequences, known as exteins (reviewed in Perler et al., Curr. Opin. Chem. Biol. 1:292-299 (1997); Perler, F. B. Cell 92(1):1-4 (1998); Xu et al., EMBO J. 15(19):5146-5153 (1996)).
  • the bacterially expressed protein with the C-terminal thioester is then fused to a chemically-synthesized peptide with an N-terminal cysteine using the chemistry described for “native chemical ligation” (Evans et al., Protein Sci. 7:2256-2264 (1998); Muir et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 95:6705-6710 (1998)).
  • IPL intein-mediated protein ligation
  • IPL technology was significantly expanded when an expressed protein with a predetermined N-terminus, such as cysteine, was generated, as described for example in U.S. Pat. No. 6,849,428.
  • This allows the fusion of one or more expressed proteins from a host cell, such as bacterial, yeast or mammalian cells.
  • a host cell such as bacterial, yeast or mammalian cells.
  • the intein a modified RIR1 Methanobacterium thermoautotrophicum is that cleaves at either the C-terminus or N-terminus is used which allows for the release of a bacterially expressed protein during a one-column purification, thus eliminating the need proteases entirely.
  • the subunits of the compounds of the invention are obtained by transfecting suitable cells, capable of expressing and secreting mature chimeric polypeptides, wherein such polypeptides comprise, for example, an adhesin domain contiguous with an isolatable c-terminal intein domain (see U.S. Pat. No. 6,849,428, Evans et al., issued Feb. 1, 2005, hereby incorporated by reference).
  • the cells such as mammalian cells or bacterial cells, are transfected using known recombinant DNA techniques.
  • the secreted chimeric polypeptide can then be isolated, e.g.
  • a chitin-derivatized resin in the case of an intein-chitin binding domain (see U.S. Pat. No. 6,897,285, Xu et al., issued May 24, 2005, hereby incorporated by reference), and is then treated under conditions permitting thiol-mediated cleavage and release of the now C-terminal thioester-terminated adhesion subunit.
  • the thioester-terminated adhesion subunit is readily converted to a C-terminal cysteine terminated subunit.
  • These subunits can be treated under oxidizing conditions to permit formation of, for example, a disulfide bond between the two terminal cysteine residues, thus forming a symmetroadhesin.
  • this technique can be used to make the symmetroadhesin-Fc hybrid subunits by treating the individual adhesion-Fc heterodimers under conditions permitting formation of bonds between the Fc portions of the heterodimers.
  • IgG immunoglobulin
  • papain yields two Fab fragments and one Fc fragment (Porter (1959) Biochem. 73, 119-126).
  • the site of proteolysis in human IgG is the heavy chain hinge region between the cys-5 and cys-11 residues, EPKS C DKTHT C PPCP, (Fleischman et al., Biochem J. (1963) 88, 220-227; Edelman et al. (1969) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 63, 78-85).
  • the cys-5 residue normally forms a disulfide bond with the human IgG light chain, which is easily cleaved under mild reducing conditions, making it an ideal candidate for Fc-like molecules with N-terminal-S-termini (S-Fc).
  • host cells were transfected with expression vectors encoding IgG1 pre-Fc chimeric polypeptides consisting of a signal peptide joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of an Fc domain beginning at the cys-5 residue, C DKTHTCPPCP ( FIG. 35A ).
  • the heterologous signal peptides used are selected from proteins with N-terminal cysteines (part i). Thus, cleavage by the cellular signal peptidase will provide a mature S-Fc protein having cys-5 at the N-terminus (part ii).
  • the sequences of the IgG1 precursor polypeptides of FIG. 35A are shown in SEQ ID NO: 32, SEQ ID NO:33, and SEQ ID NO:34.
  • the sequence of the mature IgG1 polypeptide of FIG. 35A is shown in SEQ ID NO: 35.
  • Other mature IgG1 polypeptides made by methods described in EXAMPLES 1 to 5 are shown in SEQ ID NO: 36 through SEQ ID NO: 46.
  • Host cells are transfected with expression vectors encoding IgG2 pre-Fc chimeric polypeptides consisting of a signal peptide joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of an Fc domain beginning at the cys-4 residue, CCVE CPPCP ( FIG. 35B ).
  • the heterologous signal peptides used are selected from proteins with N-terminal cysteines (part i). Thus, cleavage by the cellular signal peptidase will provide a mature S-Fc protein having cys-4 at the N-terminus (part ii).
  • the sequences of the IgG2 precursor polypeptides of FIG. 35B are shown in SEQ ID NO:50, SEQ ID NO:51, and SEQ ID NO:52.
  • the sequence of the mature IgG2 polypeptide of FIG. 35B is shown in SEQ ID NO:53.
  • Other mature IgG2 polypeptides made by methods described in EXAMPLES 1 to 5 are shown in SEQ ID NO:54 through SEQ ID NO:67.
  • Host cells are transfected with expression vectors encoding IgG3 pre-Fc chimeric polypeptides consisting of a signal peptide joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of an Fc domain beginning at the cys-13 residue, CPR CP ( FIG. 35C ).
  • the heterologous signal peptides used are selected from proteins with N-terminal cysteines (part i). Thus, cleavage by the cellular signal peptidase will provide a mature S-Fc protein having cys-13 at the N-terminus (part ii).
  • Host cells are transfected with expression vectors encoding IgG4 pre-Fc chimeric polypeptides consisting of a signal peptide joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of an Fc domain beginning at the cys-8 residue, CPS CP ( FIG. 35D ).
  • the heterologous signal peptides used are selected from proteins with N-terminal cysteines (part i). Thus, cleavage by the cellular signal peptidase will provide a mature S-Fc protein having cys-8 at the N-terminus (part ii).
  • the sequences of the IgG4 precursor polypeptides of FIG. 35D are shown in SEQ ID NO:86, SEQ ID NO:87, and SEQ ID NO:88.
  • the sequence of the mature IgG4 polypeptide of FIG. 35D is shown in SEQ ID NO:89.
  • Other mature IgG4 polypeptides made by methods described in EXAMPLES 1 to 5 are shown in SEQ ID NO:90 through SEQ ID NO:97.
  • Suitable host cells include 293 human embryonic cells (ATCC CRL-1573) and CHO-K1 hamster ovary cells (ATCC CCL-61) obtained from the American Type Culture Collection (Rockville, Md.). Cells are grown at 37° C. in an atmosphere of air, 95%; carbon dioxide, 5%. 293 cells are maintained in Minimal essential medium (Eagle) with 2 mM L-glutamine and Earle's BSS adjusted to contain 1.5 g/L sodium bicarbonate, 0.1 mM non-essential amino acids, and 1.0 mM sodium pyruvate, 90%; fetal bovine serum, 10%.
  • Minimal essential medium Eagle
  • 2 mM L-glutamine and Earle's BSS adjusted to contain 1.5 g/L sodium bicarbonate, 0.1 mM non-essential amino acids, and 1.0 mM sodium pyruvate, 90%; fetal bovine serum, 10%.
  • CHO-K1 cells are maintained in Ham's F12K medium with 2 mM L-glutamine adjusted to contain 1.5 g/L sodium bicarbonate, 90%; fetal bovine serum, 10%.
  • Other suitable host cells include CV1 monkey kidney cells (ATCC CCL-70), COS-7 monkey kidney cells (ATCC CRL-1651), VERO-76 monkey kidney cells (ATCC CRL-1587), HELA human cervical cells (ATCC CCL-2), W138 human lung cells (ATCC CCL-75), MDCK canine kidney cells (ATCC CCL-34), BRL3A rat liver cells (ATCC CRL-1442), BHK hamster kidney cells (ATCC CCL-10), MMT060562 mouse mammary cells (ATCC CCL-51), and human CD8 + T lymphocytes (described in U.S. Ser. No. 08/258,152 incorporated herein in its entirety by reference).
  • Plasmid pSA contains the following DNA sequence elements: 1) pBluescriptIIKS(+) (nucleotides 912 to 2941/1 to 619, GenBank Accession No. X52327), 2) a human cytomegalovirus promoter, enhancer, and first exon splice donor (nucleotides 63 to 912, GenBank Accession No. K03104), 3) a human alpha1-globin second exon splice acceptor (nucleotides 6808 to 6919, GenBank Accession No.
  • an EcoRI-BglII DNA fragment encoding the polypeptide is inserted into plasmid pSA between the EcoRI and BglII restriction sites located at positions 1,608 and 1,632, respectively.
  • Other suitable expression vectors include plasmids pSVeCD4DHFR and pRKCD4 (U.S. Pat. No.
  • Suitable selectable markers include the Tn5 transposon neomycin phosphotransferase (NEO) gene (Southern and Berg (1982) J. Mol. Appl. Gen. 1, 327-341), and the dihydrofolate reductase (DHFR) cDNA (Lucas et al. (1996) Nucl. Acids Res. 24, 1774-1779).
  • NEO Tn5 transposon neomycin phosphotransferase
  • DHFR dihydrofolate reductase
  • One example of a suitable expression vector that incorporates a NEO gene is plasmid pSA-NEO, which is constructed by ligating a first DNA fragment, prepared by digesting SEQ ID NO:2 with EcoRI and BglII, with a second DNA fragment, prepared by digesting SEQ ID NO:1 with EcoRI and BglII.
  • SEQ ID NO:2 incorporates a NEO gene (nucleotides 1551 to 2345, Genbank Accession No. U00004) preceded by a sequence for translational initiation (Kozak (1991) J. Biol. Chem, 266, 19867-19870).
  • a suitable expression vector that incorporates a NEO gene and a DHFR cDNA is plasmid pSVe-NEO-DHFR, which is constructed by ligating a first DNA fragment, prepared by digesting SEQ ID NO:2 with EcoRI and BglII, with a second DNA fragment, prepared by digesting pSVeCD4DHFR with EcoRI and BglII.
  • Plasmid pSVe-NEO-DHFR uses SV40 early promoter/enhancers to drive expression of the NEO gene and the DHFR cDNA.
  • Other suitable selectable markers include the XPGT gene (Mulligan and Berg (1980) Science 209, 1422-1427) and the hygromycin resistance gene (Sugden et al. (1985) Mol. Cell. Biol. 5, 410-413).
  • Suitable examples of signal peptides are sonic hedgehog (SHH) (GenBank Acc. No. NM — 000193), interferona-2 (IFN) (GenBank Acc. No. NP — 000596), and cholesterol ester transferase (CETP) (GenBank Accession No. NM — 000078).
  • SHH sonic hedgehog
  • IFN interferona-2
  • CETP cholesterol ester transferase
  • Other suitable examples include Indian hedgehog (Genbank Acc. No. NM — 002181), desert hedgehog (Genbank Acc. No. NM — 021044), IFN ⁇ -1 (Genbank Acc. No. NP — 076918), IFN ⁇ -4 (Genbank Acc. No. NM — 021068), IFN ⁇ -5 (Genbank Acc. No.
  • NM — 002169 IFN ⁇ -6 (Genbank Acc. No. NM — 021002), IFN ⁇ -7 (Genbank Acc. No. NM — 021057), IFN ⁇ -8 (Genbank Acc. No. NM — 002170), IFN ⁇ -10 (Genbank Acc. No. NM — 002171), IFN ⁇ -13 (Genbank Acc. No. NM — 006900), IFN ⁇ -14 (Genbank Acc. No. NM — 002172), IFN ⁇ -16 (Genbank Acc. No. NM — 002173), IFN ⁇ -17 (Genbank Acc. No. NM — 021268) and IFN ⁇ -21 (Genbank Acc. No. NM — 002175).
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert and vector fragment prepared by digestion with EcoRI and BglII.
  • plasmid pSHH-Fc5 (SHH signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:3 and SEQ ID NO:1
  • plasmid pIFN-Fc5 (IFN signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:4 and SEQ ID NO:1
  • plasmid pCETP-Fc5 CETP signal
  • plasmid PSHH-Fc5-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:3 and pSVeCD4DHFR (U.S. Pat. No.
  • pIFN-Fc5-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:4 and pSVeCD4DHFR
  • pCETP-Fc5-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:5 and pSVeCD4DHFR.
  • Suitable expression vectors for human IgG1 Fc polypeptides were constructed by ligation of an insert fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and EagI and a vector fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and PspOM1.
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-SHH-IgG1-Fc (SHH signal) was constructed using SEQ ID NO:29 and pCDNA3.1(+)
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-IFN-IgG1-Fc IFN signal
  • IFN signal plasmid pCDNA3-IFN-IgG1-Fc
  • CETP signal was constructed using SEQ ID NO:31 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • Suitable expression vectors for human IgG2 Fc polypeptides are constructed by ligation of an insert fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and EagI and a vector fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and PspOM1.
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-SHH-IgG2-Fc (SHH signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:47 and pCDNA3.1(+)
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-IFN-IgG2-Fc IFN signal
  • IFN signal plasmid pCDNA3-IFN-IgG2-Fc
  • CETP signal is constructed using SEQ ID NO:49 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • Suitable expression vectors for human IgG3 Fc polypeptides are constructed by ligation of an insert fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and EagI and a vector fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and PspOM1.
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-SHH-IgG3-Fc (SHH signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:68 and pCDNA3.1(+)
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-IFN-IgG3-Fc IFN signal
  • IFN signal plasmid pCDNA3-IFN-IgG3-Fc
  • CETP signal is constructed using SEQ ID NO:70 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • Suitable expression vectors for human IgG4 Fc polypeptides are constructed by ligation of an insert fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and EagI and a vector fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and PspOM1.
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-SHH-IgG4-Fc (SHH signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:83 and pCDNA3.1(+)
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-IFN-IgG4-Fc IFN signal
  • plasmid pCDNA3-IgG4-Fc CETP signal
  • cells are transfected by the calcium phosphate method of Graham et al. (1977) J. Gen. Virol. 36, 59-74.
  • a DNA mixture (10 micrograms) is dissolved in 0.5 ml of 1 mM Tris-HCl, 0.1 mM EDTA, and 227 mM CaCl 2 .
  • the DNA mixture contains (in a ratio of 10:1:1) the expression vector DNA, the selectable marker DNA, and a DNA encoding the VA RNA gene (Thimmappaya et al. (1982) Cell 31, 543-551).
  • cells are transiently transfected by the dextran sulfate method of Somparyrac et al. (1981) Proc. Nat. Acad. Sci. 12, 7575-7579.
  • Cells are grown to maximal density in spinner flasks, concentrated by centrifugation, and washed with PBS.
  • the DNA-dextran precipitate is incubated on the cell pellet. After 4 hours at 37° C., the DEAE-dextran is aspirated and 20% glycerol in PBS is added for 1.5 minutes.
  • the cells are then washed with serum-free medium, and re-introduced into spinner flasks containing fresh culture medium with 5 micrograms/ml bovine insulin and 0.1 micrograms/ml bovine transferring, and the cells are incubated for 4 days. Following transfection by either method, the conditioned media is centrifuged and filtered to remove the host cells and debris. The sample contained the S-Fc domain is then concentrated and purified by any selected method, such as dialysis and/or column chromatography (see below).
  • the culture medium is removed 24 hours after transfection and replaced with culture medium containing 200 microCi/ml each of 35 S-methionine and 35 S-cysteine. After a 12 hour incubation, the conditioned medium is collected by centrifugation to remove the host cells and debris, concentrated on a spin dialysis filter. The labeled supernatants is analyzed by immunoprecipitation with protein A sepharose beads in the absence of added antibodies. The precipitated proteins are analyzed on 7.5% polyacrylamide-SDS gels either with or without reduction with ⁇ -mercaptoethanol. The processed gel is dried and exposed to x-ray film to reveal the presence of the S-Fc domain.
  • plasmids pSHH-Fc-5, pIFN-Fc-5 and pCETP-Fc-5 are transfected into human 293 cells (Graham et al., J. Gen. Virol. 36:59 74 (1977)), using a high efficiency procedure (Gorman et al., DNA Prot. Eng. Tech. 2:3 10 (1990)). Media is changed to serum-free and harvested daily for up to five days.
  • the S-Fc proteins are purified from the cell culture supernatant using protein A-Sepharose CL-4B (Pharmacia).
  • the eluted S-Fc protein is buffer-exchanged into PBS using a Centricon-30 (Amicon), concentrated to 0.5 ml, sterile filtered using a Millex-GV (Millipore) and stored at 4° C.
  • plasmids pCDNA3-SHH-IgG1-Fc, pCDA3-IFN-IgG1-Fc and pCDA-3-CETP-IgG1-Fc were transfected into human 293 cells (Graham et al., J. Gen. Virol. 36:59 74 (1977)), using a high efficiency procedure (Gorman et al., DNA Prot. Eng. Tech. 2:3 10 (1990)). Media was changed to serum-free and harvested daily for up to five days. The S-Fc proteins were purified from the cell culture supernatant using protein A-Sepharose CL-4B (Pharmacia).
  • the eluted S-Fc protein was buffer-exchanged into PBS using a Centricon-30 (Amicon), concentrated to 0.5 ml, sterile filtered using a Millex-GV (Millipore) and stored at 4° C.
  • FIG. 52 shows expression in 293 kidney cells of human IgG1 Fc symmetroadhesin subunits with N-terminal-S-termini.
  • Lanes 1-6 and lanes 7-12 show the IgG1 Fc polypeptides of FIG. 35A (ii) and FIG. 36A (ii), respectively.
  • Cell supernatants lanes 1, 3, 5, 7, 9 and 11; cell lysates: lanes 2, 4, 6, 8, 10 and 12.
  • FIG. 53 shows expression in 293 kidney cells of human IgG1 Fc symmetroadhesin subunits. Lanes 1-2, 3-4 and 5-6 show the IgG1 Fc polypeptides of FIG. 35A (ii), FIG. 36A (ii) and FIG. 37B (ii), respectively. Cell supernatants: (lanes 1-6). Signal sequences used: SHH (lanes 1-6).
  • FIG. 54 shows Protein A purification of human IgG1 Fc symmetroadhesin subunits expressed in 293 kidney cells.
  • Lane 2 and 8 show the IgG1 Fc polypeptides of FIG. 36A and FIG. 35A , respectively.
  • Lanes 1-7 proteinA-sepharose column fractions for the IgG1 Fc polypeptide of FIG. 36A .
  • FIG. 55 shows Thiol-sepharose binding of proteinA-purified human IgG1 Fc symmetroadhesin subunits shown in FIG. 54 .
  • Lanes 1-3 and lanes 4-6 show the human IgG1 Fc polypeptides of FIG. 35A and FIG. 36A , respectively.
  • Lanes 1 and 4 starting material; lanes 2 and 5: thiol-sepharose flow-thru fraction; lanes 3 and 6: thiol-sepharose bound fraction.
  • CHO cells are transfected with dicistronic vectors pSHH-Fc5-DHFR, pIFN-Fc-5-DHFR and pCETP-Fc-5-DHFR which co-express a DHFR cDNA. Plasmids are introduced into CHO-K1 DUX B11 cells developed by L. Chasin (Columbia University) via lipofection and selected for growth in GHT-free medium (Chisholm (1996) High efficiency gene transfer in mammalian cells. In: Glover, D M, Hames, B D. DNA Cloning vol 4. Mammalian systems. Oxford Univ. Press, pp 1-41).
  • Approximately 20 unamplified clones are randomly chosen and reseeded into 96 well plates. Relative specific productivity of each colony is monitored using an ELISA to quantitate the S-Fc protein accumulated in each well after 3 days and a fluorescent dye, Calcien AM, as a surrogate marker of viable cell number per well. Based on these data, several unamplified clones are chosen for further amplification in the presence of increasing concentrations of methotrexate. Individual clones surviving at 10, 50, and 100 nM methotrexate are chosen and transferred to 96 well plates for productivity screening. Suitable clones, which reproducibly exhibit high specific productivity, are expanded in T-flasks and used to inoculate spinner cultures.
  • the suspension-adapted cells are used to inoculate production cultures in GHT-containing, serum-free media supplemented with various hormones and protein hydrolysates.
  • Harvested cell culture fluid containing the S-Fc protein is purified using protein A-Sepharose CL-4B.
  • Selenocysteine (sec) is the 21 st amino acid incorporated during ribosome-mediated protein synthesis (Zinoni et al. (1986) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 83, 4650-4654; Chambers et al. (1986) EMBO J. 5, 1221-1227). The process is complex and distinct from cysteine incorporation, requiring an mRNA selenocysteine insertion element in order to decode a UGA stop codon. Protein semi-synthesis offers an alternative means for preparing Fc-like molecules having N-terminal-X-termini (X-Fc) that begin at cysteine (cys) and/or selenocysteine (sec).
  • X-Fc N-terminal-X-termini
  • host cells are transfected with constructs that encode pre-Fc chimeric polypeptides consisting of a signal peptide joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of an Fc domain beginning at cys-11, CDKTHT C PPCP ( FIG. 36A ) and cys-14 CDKTHTCPP C P ( FIG. 36B ).
  • the heterologous signal peptides used are selected from proteins with N-terminal cysteines (part i).
  • cleavage by the cellular signal peptidase will provide a mature S-Fc protein having cys-11 at the N-terminus (part ii).
  • Native chemical ligation is then employed to prepare mature X-Fc proteins having cys-5 or sec-5 at the N-terminus, X DKTHTCPPCP (part iii).
  • the sequences of the IgG1 precursor polypeptides of FIG. 36A are shown in SEQ ID NO: 101, SEQ ID NO:102, and SEQ ID NO:103.
  • the sequence of the mature IgG1 polypeptide of FIG. 35A is shown in SEQ ID NO: 104.
  • the sequences of the IgG1 precursor polypeptides of FIG. 36B are shown in SEQ ID NO: 109, SEQ ID NO:110, and SEQ ID NO:111.
  • the sequence of the mature IgG1 polypeptide of FIG. 35B is shown in SEQ ID NO: 112.
  • host cells are transfected with constructs that encode pre-Fc chimeric polypeptides consisting of a signal peptide joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of an Fc domain beginning at cys-14, CDKTHTCPPC P ( FIG. 36B ).
  • the heterologous signal peptides used are selected from proteins with N-terminal cysteines (part i).
  • cleavage by the cellular signal peptidase will provide a mature S-Fc protein having cys-11 at the N-terminus (part ii).
  • Native chemical ligation is then employed to prepare mature X-Fc proteins having cys-11 or sec-11 at the N-terminus, X PPCP (part iii).
  • plasmid pSHH-Fc11 (SHH signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:6 and SEQ ID NO:1
  • plasmid pIFN-Fc11 (IFN signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO 7 and SEQ ID NO:1
  • plasmid pCETP-Fc11 (CETP signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:8 and SEQ ID NO:1.
  • plasmid pSHH-Fc11-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:6 and pSVeCD4DHFR
  • plasmid pIFN-Fc11-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:7 and pSVeCD4DHFR
  • plasmid pCETP-Fc11-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:8 and pSVeCD4DHFR.
  • Suitable expression vectors for human IgG1 Fc are constructed by ligation of an insert fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and EagI and a vector fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and PspOM1.
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-SHH-IgG1-Fc11 (SHH signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:98 and pCDNA3.1(+)
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-IFN-IgG1-Fc11 IFN signal
  • IFN signal plasmid pCDNA3-IFN-IgG1-Fc11
  • CETP signal is constructed using SEQ ID NO:100 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-SHH-IgG1-Fc14 (SHH signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:106 and pCDNA3.1(+), plasmid pCDNA3-IFN-IgG1-Fc14 (IFN signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:107 and pCDNA3.1(+), and plasmid pCDNA3-IgG1-Fc14 (CETP signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:108 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • Peptide synthesis is carried out by manual a solid-phase procedure using an in situ neutralization/HBTU activation procedure for Boc chemistry (Schnolzer et al. (1992) Int. J. Pept. Protein Res. 40, 180-193). After each coupling step, yields are determined by measuring residual free amine with the quantitative ninhydrin assay (Sarin et al. (1981) Anal. Biochem. 117, 147-157). Side chain protected amino acids are Boc-Asp(O-cyclohexyl)-OH, Boc-Cys(4-methylbenzyl)-OH, Boc-Lys(2-Cl-Z)-OH, and Boc-Thr(benzyl)-OH. After chain assembly is completed, peptides are deprotected and cleaved from the resin by treatment with anhydrous HF for 1 hour at 0° C. with 4% anisole as scavenger.
  • Peptides Fc-A and Fc-B are synthesized on trityl-associated mercaptopropionic acid leucine (TAMPAL) resin to yield C-terminal MPAL-activated thioesters (Hackeng et al. (1999) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 96, 10068-10073).
  • TAMPAL trityl-associated mercaptopropionic acid leucine
  • the thioester-activated peptides are deprotected and cleaved from the TAMPAL resin, HPLC-purified, lyophilized, and stored until use at ⁇ 20° C.
  • Preparative reversed-phase HPLC is performed using a Vydac C-18 column (10 micrometer, 1.0 cm ⁇ 25 cm).
  • the bound peptides are eluted using a linear gradient of acetonitrile in H 2 0/10% trifluoroacetic acid.
  • the solution is concentrated with a Centriprep 3/30 apparatus (Millipore, Mass.), then with a Centricon 3/10 apparatus to a final concentration of 0.15 to 1.2 mM for the S-Fc protein.
  • Ligations are incubated overnight at 4° C. and visualized using SDS-page electrophoresis. After native chemical ligation, the N-terminal Msc protecting group is removed by a brief incubation ( ⁇ 5 minute) at pH 13.
  • the X-Fc product is purified to remove unreacted peptides by affinity chromatography with protein A sepharose using the procedure in EXAMPLE 1.
  • IgG is expressed in two abundant forms, the soluble antibody molecule and the cell-bound B-cell receptor. Both forms arise from a single messenger RNA by alternative splicing with the result that two additional exons are added to the IgG heavy chain coding region (Tyler et al. (1982) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 79, 2008-2012; Yamawaki-Kataoka et al. (1982) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 79, 2623-2627).
  • the first exon added encodes a stretch of 18 amino acids, ELQLEESCAEAQDGELDG, which flexibly tethers IgG to the cell surface, making it a good choice for novel Fc-like molecules with a C-terminal-X-terminus (Fc-X).
  • the C-terminal gly-18 residue of the M1 domain is also well-suited for preparing Fc-intein fusion proteins used in generating a C-terminal activated thioester. Following an intein autocleavage reaction, a thioester intermediate is generated that permits the facile addition of cysteine or selenocysteine to the C-terminus by native chemical ligation.
  • host cells are transfected with expression vectors that encode pre-Fc-intein chimeric polypeptides containing the M1 domain joined at its C-terminus, ELQLEESCAEAQDGELD G , by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site ( FIG. 37A ), or the Fc protein containing a portion of the M1 domain, ELQLEESC ( FIG. 37B ).
  • heterologous signal peptides are used that are cleaved by the cellular signal peptidase before lysine residues (part i).
  • cleavage by the cellular signal peptidase will provide a Fc-intein fusion protein with lys-7, EPKSCD K THTCPPCP, at the N-terminus (part ii).
  • Excision of the intein domain by protein splicing provides an Fc-thioester intermediate (part iii).
  • native chemical ligation of the Fc-thioester with free cysteine and/or selenocysteine is employed to prepare Fc-X proteins having the C-terminal-X-terminus, ELQLEESCAEAQDGELDG X (part iv).
  • the sequences of the IgG1 precursor polypeptides of FIG. 37A are shown in SEQ ID NO:116, and SEQ ID NO:117.
  • the sequence of the mature and modified IgG1 polypeptides of FIG. 37A is shown in SEQ ID NO:118 to SEQ ID NO:120.
  • the sequences of the IgG1 precursor polypeptides of FIG. 37B are shown in SEQ ID NO:123, and SEQ ID NO:124.
  • the sequence of the mature IgG1 polypeptide of FIG. 37B is shown in SEQ ID NO:125.
  • the Fc-intein fusion protein with lys-7 at the N-terminus is prepared using the procedures described in EXAMPLE 1.
  • the initial purification step is carried out using affinity chromatography with a chitin resin instead of protein A sepharose. After cleavage from the resin, the activated Fc-thioester intermediate is used directly for native ligation with cysteine and/or selenocysteine.
  • signal peptides are the CD2 T-cell surface glycoprotein (CD2) (GenBank Acc. No. NM — 001767), and the CD4 T-cell surface glycoprotein (CD4) (GenBank Acc. No. NP — 000616).
  • MthRIR1 Methanobacterium thermoautotrophicum ribonucleotide reductase large subunit
  • an Mth RRI intein sequence fused to a Bacillus circulans chitin binding domain is used to facilitate the purification of the Fc-intein chimeric polypeptide by affinity chromatography.
  • a suitable sequence for the modified MthRIR1 intein is found in plasmid pTWIN-2 (New England BioLabs, MA).
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert and vector fragment prepared by digestion with EcoRI and BglII.
  • plasmid pCD2-Fc7-Mth (CD2 signal) is constructed with SEQ ID NO:9 and SEQ ID NO:1
  • plasmid pCD4-Fc7-Mth (CD4 signal) is constructed with SEQ ID NO:10 and SEQ ID NO:1.
  • plasmid pCD2-Fc7-Mth-DHFR is constructed with SEQ ID NO:9 and pSVeCD4DHFR
  • plasmid pCD4-Fc7-Mth-DHFR is constructed with SEQ ID NO:10 and pSVeCD4DHFR.
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and EagI and a vector fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and PspOM1.
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-CD2-Fc7-Mth (CD2 signal) is constructed with SEQ ID NO:114 and pCDNA3.1(+)
  • plasmid pCDNA3-CD4-Fc7-Mth (CD4 signal) is constructed with SEQ ID NO:115 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-CD2-Fc7-ELQLEESC (CD2 signal) is constructed with SEQ ID NO:121 and pCDNA3.1(+), and plasmid pCDNA3-CD4-Fc7-ELQLEESC (CD4 signal) is constructed with SEQ ID NO:122 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • chitin resin New England BioLabs, MA
  • buffer A 20 mM Tris-HCl, pH 7.5 containing 500 mM NaCl
  • Unbound protein is washed from the column with 10 column volumes of buffer A.
  • Thiol reagent-induced cleavage is initiated by rapidly equilibrating the chitin resin in buffer B (20 mM Tris-HCl, pH 8 containing 0.5 M NaCl and 0.1 M 2-mercaptoethane-sulfonic acid (MESNA)).
  • MESNA 2-mercaptoethane-sulfonic acid
  • Fc-thioester intermediate Starting with the purified Fc-thioester intermediate, native chemical ligation is carried out with cysteine or selenocysteine using the procedure in EXAMPLE 2.
  • the final Fc-X product is purified to remove unreacted cysteine and selenocysteine by affinity chromatography with protein A sepharose.
  • S-Fc and Fc-X proteins are useful in preparing immunosymmetroadhesins having two binding domains joined to a single Fc domain (see below). Binding domains are added to the N-terminal-S-termini (S-Fc) or C-terminal-X-termini (Fc-X). S-Fc-X domains that are useful in preparing bi-symmetroadhesins with four binding domains joined to a single Fc domain are prepared using the procedures described in EXAMPLE 1 and EXAMPLE 3.
  • host cells are transfected with expression vectors that encode pre-Fc-intein chimeric polypeptides containing the M1 domain joined at its C-terminus, ELQLEESCAEAQDGELD G , by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site ( FIG. 38 ).
  • Heterologous signal peptides are selected from proteins with N-terminal cysteines (part i).
  • cleavage by the cellular signal peptidase will provide a mature S-Fc-intein fusion protein having cys-5 at the N-terminus, C DKTHTCPPCP (part ii).
  • the sequences of the IgG1 precursor polypeptides of FIGS. 38A-38B are shown in SEQ ID NO:126, SEQ ID NO:127, and SEQ ID NO:128.
  • the sequence of the mature and modified IgG1 polypeptides of FIGS. 38A-38B is shown in SEQ ID NO:129 to SEQ ID NO:131.
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert and vector fragment prepared by digestion with EcoRI and BglII.
  • PSHH-Fc5-Mth is constructed with SEQ ID NO:11 and SEQ ID NO:1
  • pIFN-Fc5-Mth is constructed with SEQ ID NO:12 and SEQ ID NO:1
  • pCETP-Fc5-Mth is constructed with SEQ ID NO:13 and SEQ ID NO:1.
  • pSHH-Fc5-Mth-DHFR is constructed with SEQ ID NO:11 and pSVeCD4DHFR
  • pIFN-Fc5-Mth-DHFR is constructed with SEQ ID NO:12 and pSVeCD4DHFR
  • pCETP-Fc5-Mth-DHFR is constructed with SEQ ID NO:13 and pSVeCD4DHFR.
  • the S-Fc-intein fusion protein is first purified from the culture supernatant of transfected host cells using chitin affinity chromatography. After cleavage from the chitin resin, the Fc-thioester intermediate is directly applied to a protein A Sepharose column in order to prevent cyclization or polymerization side-reactions. The column bound activated S-Fc-thioester is used directly for native ligation with cysteine and/or selenocysteine. The column is then washed to remove excess amino acids, and the S-Fc-X is eluted from the protein A sepharose.
  • the X-Fc and Fc-X proteins are useful in preparing immunosymmetroadhesins having two binding domains joined to a single Fc domain (see below). Binding domains are added to the N-terminal-X-termini (X-Fc) or C-terminal-X-termini (Fc-X).
  • X-Fc-X domains that are useful in preparing bi-symmetroadhesins with four binding domains joined to a single Fc domain are prepared using the procedures described in EXAMPLE 2 and EXAMPLE 3.
  • host cells are transfected with expression vectors that encode pre-Fc-intein chimeric polypeptides containing the M1 domain joined at its C-terminus, ELQLEESCAEAQDGELD G , by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site ( FIG. 39 ).
  • Heterologous signal peptides are selected from proteins with N-terminal cysteines (part i).
  • cleavage by the cellular signal peptidase will provide a mature S-Fc-intein fusion protein having cys-11 at the N-terminus (part ii).
  • X-Fc-intein fusion proteins having cys-5 or sec-5 at the N-terminus, X DKTHTCPPCP (part iii).
  • Excision of the intein by protein splicing provides an Fc-thioester intermediate (part iv).
  • the Fc-thioester with is carried out with free cysteine and/or selenocysteine to prepare X-Fc-X proteins having a C-terminal-X-terminus ELQLEESCAEAQDGELDG X (part v).
  • part iii is carried following parts iv and v.
  • the sequences of the IgG1 precursor polypeptides of FIGS. 39A-39B are shown in SEQ ID NO:132, SEQ ID NO:133, and SEQ ID NO:134.
  • the sequence of the mature and modified IgG1 polypeptides of FIGS. 38A-38B is shown in SEQ ID NO:135 to SEQ ID NO:138.
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert and vector fragment prepared by digestion with EcoRI and BglII.
  • plasmid pSHH-Fc11-Mth is constructed with SEQ ID NO:14 and SEQ ID NO:1
  • pIFN-Fc11-Mth is constructed with SEQ ID NO:15 and SEQ ID NO:1
  • pCETP-Fc11-Mth is constructed with SEQ ID NO:16 and SEQ ID NO:1.
  • pSHH-Fc11-Mth-DHFR is constructed with SEQ ID NO:14 and pSVeCD4DHFR
  • pIFN-Fc11-Mth-DHFR is constructed with SEQ ID NO:15 and pSVeCD4DHFR
  • pCETP-Fc11-Mth-DHFR is constructed with SEQ ID NO:16 and pSVeCD4DHFR.
  • the S-Fc-intein fusion protein is first purified from the culture supernatant of transfected host cells using chitin affinity chromatography. Native chemical ligation is carried out on the chitin column with the Msc-NH-cys 5 -thr 10 - ⁇ -thioester peptide (Fc-A) or the Msc-NH-sec 5 -thr 10 - ⁇ -thioester peptide (Fc-B) as described (EXAMPLE 2). The chitin column is then washed thoroughly to remove unreacted peptide. The intein autocleavage reaction is then carried out. After cleavage, the X-Fc-thioester intermediate is directly applied to protein A Sepharose.
  • the bound activated X-Fc-thioester is used directly for native ligation with cysteine and/or selenocysteine.
  • the column is then washed to remove excess amino acids.
  • the Msc-blocked X-Fc-X is eluted from the column, treated to remove the Msc protecting group, and repurified using protein A Sepharose to yield the final X-Fc-X product.
  • CD4 immunoadhesins (Capon et al. (1989) Nature 337, 525-531) effectively block HIV-1 infectivity by binding to the gp120 envelope protein.
  • the blocking activity resides in the CD4 extracellular domain (residues 1 to 371).
  • CD4 symmetroadhesins are prepared using CD4-X protein, and analysed for their ability to bind gp120 and block HIV-1 infectively.
  • the activity of CD4 symmetroadhesins is compared with CD4 immunoadhesin prepared as described (Capon et al., ibid).
  • CD4-X protein is prepared by the procedures of EXAMPLE 3. Host cells are transfected with expression vectors that encode the pre-CD4 chimeric polypeptide containing the CD4 extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site ( FIGS. 40A-40B ).
  • CD4 signal sequence part i
  • cellular signal peptidase mature CD4-intein fusion protein
  • excision of the intein domain provides a CD4-thioester intermediate (part iii).
  • native chemical ligation of the CD4-thioester with free cysteine and/or selenocysteine is employed to prepare CD4 domains with C-terminal-X-termini (part iv).
  • sequences of these polypeptides are shown in SEQ ID NO: 140, SEQ ID NO:141, SEQ ID NO:142, and SEQ ID NO:143.
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert and vector fragment prepared by digestion with EcoRI and BglII.
  • plasmid pCD4-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:17 and SEQ ID NO:1.
  • plasmid pCD4-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:17 and pSVeCD4DHFR.
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-CD4-Mth was constructed using SEQ ID NO:139 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • FIG. 56 shows expression in human 293 kidney cells of human CD4-intein fusion proteins.
  • Lanes 1-4 show the CD4-intein fusion polypeptide of FIG. 40A (ii).
  • CD4-X is used to prepare various CD4 symmetroadhesins (Table 2). Hemi-symmetroadhesins are prepared using the CD4-X protein alone, immunosymmetroadhesins are prepared using the CD4-X protein with S-Fc, X-Fc, or Fc-X, and bi-symmetroadhesins are prepared using the CD4-X protein with S-Fc-X or X-Fc-X.
  • CD4 hemi-symmetroadhesin is prepared using CD4-X protein exposed to mildly reducing conditions that activate the X-termini, but do not denature the protein (Fleischman et al. (1962) Arch. Biochem. Biophys. 1 (Suppl.), 174-180; Edelman et al. (1963) Proc. Nat. Acad. Sci. (1963) 50, 753-761).
  • CD4-X protein 0.5 to 2.0 mgs/ml
  • reducing buffer 0.05 M Tris-HCl buffer pH 8.0, made 0.1 M in 2-mercaptoethanol
  • CD4 immunosymmetroadhesins and CD4 bi-symmetroadhesins are prepared on protein A Sepharose beads using the S-Fc, X-Fc, Fc-X, S-Fc-X, or X-Fc-X proteins as indicated (Table 2). The bound proteins are gently agitated in reducing buffer for 1 hour at room temperature, then washed with oxidation buffer. CD4-X is treated with reducing buffer, added to the beads, and the reaction allowed to proceed at room temperature for 20 hours.
  • CD4-gp120 saturation binding analysis is carried out as described (Smith et al. (1987) Science 238, 1704-1707) using radio-iodinated gp120 prepared as described (Lasky et al. (1987) Cell 50, 975-985). Reactions (0.2) contain 0.25% NP-40, 0.1% sodium deoxycholate, 0.06 M NaCl, 0.01 M Tris-HCl, pH 8.0 (1 ⁇ buffer A) with 125 I-gp120 (3 ng to 670 ng at 2.9 nCi/ng). Binding is carried out for 1 hour at 0° C. in the presence or absence of 50 micrograms of unlabeled purified gp120.
  • the bound 125 I-gp120 is then determined by immunoprecipitation. Binding reactions are preabsorbed with 5 microliters of normal rabbit serum for 1 hour at 0° C., cleared with 40 microliters of 10% w/v Pansorbin (Calbiochem) for 30 minutes at 0° C., and incubated overnight at 0° C. with 2 microliters of normal serum or 5 microliters (0.25 microgram) of OKT4 monoclonal antibody (Ortho Biotech). Immunoprecipitates are collected with 10 microliters of Pansorbin, washed twice in 2 ⁇ buffer and once in water, then eluted at 100° C. for 2 minutes in 0.12 M Tris-HCl pH 6.8, 4% SDS, 0.7 M mercaptoethanol. The fraction of bound 125 I-gp120 is determined in a gamma counter and Scatchard analysis is used to determine the apparent dissociation contant.
  • HIV-1 blocking studies are carried out as described (Robert-Guroff et al. (1985) Nature 316, 72-74). Equal volumes of inhibitor and HIV-1 (60 microliters) are incubated at 4° C. for 1 hour, then the same volume of H9 cells (Gallo et al. (1984) Science 224, 500-503) at 5 ⁇ 10 6 /ml is added and incubation continued for 1 hour at 37° C. Following absorption of virus, 2.5 ⁇ 10 5 cells in 150 microliters are transferred to 2 ml of incubation media. After 4 days at 37° C., the cultures are split 1:2 with fresh media and incubated for an additional 3 days.
  • TNF- ⁇ tumor necrosis factor ⁇
  • TNR TNF- ⁇ antibodies and receptors
  • TNR symmetroadhesins are prepared using TNR-X proteins, and analyzed for their ability to bind TNF- ⁇ and to block TNF- ⁇ biological activity.
  • the activity of TNR symmetroadhesins is compared to that of TNR immunoadhesins (Ashkenazi et al. (1991) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 88, 10535-10539).
  • TNR1A Human TNR
  • TNR1B Human TNR
  • Di62-Vk is prepared according to the method of EXAMPLE 1.
  • Di62-VH-X, TNR1A-X, and TNR1B-X are prepared according to the method of EXAMPLE 3.
  • Host cells are co-transfected with two expression vectors that encode the Di62-VH-CH-intein chimeric polypeptide and Di62-VkCk protein result in co-expression of the Di62-VH-CH-intein:Di62-Vk-Ck protein that is used to prepare the TNF Fab -X protein:
  • Host cells are transfected with expression vectors that encode the TNR1A-intein chimeric polypeptide and TNR1B-intein chimeric polypeptide to prepare the TNF 1 -X and TNF 2 -X proteins, respectively:
  • TNR-X proteins with C-terminal-X-termini (part iv) (refer to FIG. 43 , 44 A).
  • sequences of these polypeptides are shown in SEQ ID NO: 145, SEQ ID NO:146, SEQ ID NO:147, and SEQ ID NO:148 (Di62-VHCH); in SEQ ID NO: 150, and SEQ ID NO:151 (Di62-VkCk); in SEQ ID NO: 153, SEQ ID NO:154, SEQ ID NO:155, and SEQ ID NO:156 (TNR1A); in SEQ ID NO: 158, SEQ ID NO:159, SEQ ID NO:160, and SEQ ID NO:161 (TNR1B); and in SEQ ID NO: 163, and SEQ ID NO:164 (TNR1B immunoadhesin).
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert and vector fragment prepared by digestion with EcoRI and BglII.
  • plasmid pDi62-VHCH-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:18 and SEQ ID NO:1
  • plasmid pDi62-VkCk is constructed using SEQ ID NO:19 and SEQ ID NO:1
  • plasmid pTNR1A-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:20 and SEQ ID NO:1
  • plasmid pTNR1A-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:22 and SEQ ID NO:1.
  • plasmid pDi62-VHCH-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:18 and pSVeCD4DHFR
  • plasmid pDi62-VkCk-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:19 and pSVeCD4DHFR
  • plasmid pTNR1A-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:20 and pSVeCD4DHFR
  • plasmid pTNR1A-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:22 and pSVeCD4DHFR.
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and EagI and a vector fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and PspOM1.
  • Plasmid pCDA3-Di62-VHCH-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:144 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • Plasmid pCDA3-Di62-VkCk is constructed using SEQ ID NO:149 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • Plasmid pCDNA-3-TNR1A-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:152 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • Plasmid pCDNA-3-TNR1B-Mth-DHFR was constructed using SEQ ID NO:157 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • Plasmid pCDNA-3-TNR1B-immunoadhesin was constructed using SEQ ID NO:162 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • FIG. 57 shows the expression in human 293 kidney cells of human TNR1B fusion proteins.
  • Lanes 2 and 5 show the TNR1B-intein fusion protein of FIG. 44A (ii).
  • Lanes 1 and 3 show the TNR1B-immunoadhesin fusion protein of FIG. 44B (ii).
  • Lanes 3 and 6 show proteins from mock-transfected cells. Cell supernatants: lanes 1-3; cell lysates: lanes 4-7.
  • Lane 7 control TNR1B-immunoadhesin (R&D Systems).
  • FIG. 58 shows TNR1B symmetroadhesin subunits with C-terminal-S-termini.
  • Lanes 1-2 show the TNR1B polypeptide of FIG. 44A (iii) following purification by chitin affinity chromatography and cleavage/elution with MESNA.
  • Lanes 3 shows the native ligation product between the TNR1B polypeptide of FIG. 44A (iii) with a fluorescent-labeled peptide (New England Biolabs).
  • panel (ii) western blot with anti-TNR1B antibody (R&D Systems);
  • FIG. 59 shows TNR1B symmetroadhesin subunits with C-terminal-S-termini.
  • Lane 5 shows the TNR1B polypeptide of FIG. 44A (iv) following purification by chitin affinity chromatography and cleavage/elution with cysteine.
  • Lanes 1-4 show TNR1B-immunoadhesin.
  • FIG. 60 shows TNR1B symmetroadhesin.
  • Lanes 1-4 show the TNR1B symmetroadhesin of FIG. 44A (iv) before oxidation (lanes 1 and 4) and after oxidation in the presence of 10 mM CuSO4.
  • Lanes 3 and 6 show a TNR1B-immunoadhesin control. Lanes 1-3: reducing conditions; lanes 4-6: non-reducing conditions.
  • the TNR1B symmetroadhesin monomer (42 kd) and dimer (84 kd) are apparent in lanes 2 and 5, and lane 5, respectively.
  • FIGS. 61A-61C show TNF-alpha saturation binding analysis with various TNR1B polypeptides on the Biacore T-100.
  • A The TNR1B symmetroadhesin of FIG. 44A (iv) was covalently coupled to a Biacore CM-5 chip using standard Biacore amine chemistry.
  • B TNR1B immunoadhesin (R&D Systems) was covalently coupled to a Biacore CM-5 chip using standard Biacore amine chemistry.
  • C The TNR1B symmetroadhesin of FIG. 44A (iv) was covalently coupled to a Biacore CM-5 chip using standard Biacore thiol chemistry. Following coupling, saturation binding analysis was carried out using TNF-alpha (R&D Systems) at the indicated concentations.
  • FIGS. 62A-62C shows Scatchard analysis of the TNF-alpha saturation binding analysis shown in FIG. 61A-61C .
  • TNR 1 -X, TNR 2 -X, and TNR Fab -X proteins are used to prepare various VGFR symmetroadhesins (Tables 3, 4, and 5). The number of distinct configurations obtained for each combination, as well as the general structure for each, is also shown.
  • Hemi-symmetroadhesins are prepared using the TNR-X proteins alone, immunosymmetroadhesins are prepared using the TNR-X proteins with S-Fc, X-Fc, or Fc-X, and bi-symmetroadhesins are prepared using the TNR-X proteins with S-Fc-X or X-Fc-X.
  • TNR-X protein or TNR symmetroadhesin is determined by a quantitative immunoassay using subtype-specific, affinity-purified polyclonal antibodies to TNR1A, TNR1B, and Di62 (goat-anti-mouse), and immunoadhesins (TNR1A-Ig and TNR2A-Ig) as reference standards.
  • TNR antibodies, TNR-Ig immunoadhesins, and TNF- ⁇ protein are obtained from R&D Systems (MN).
  • PBS phosphate-buffered saline
  • Non-specific binding is determined by omitting the sample.
  • 125 I-TNF- ⁇ is incubated with immobilized samples in the presence of increasing concentrations of unlabeled TNF- ⁇ .
  • TNF cytotoxity is studied as described (Kawade and Watanabe (1984) J. Interferon Res. 4, 571-584).
  • Mouse L-M cells are plated in microtiter dishes (4 ⁇ 10 4 cells per well) and treated with actinomycin D (3 micrograms/ml) and TNF- ⁇ or TNF- ⁇ (1 nanogram/ml) in the presence or absence of the sample or other inhibitors. After 20 hours of incubation at 39° C., the cell survival is determined by a crystal violet dye exclusion test.
  • a mouse model for septic shock is studied by endotoxin injection of 6- to 8-week-old BALB/c mice.
  • Animals are injected intravenously (i.v.) with an LD 100 dose of Salmonella abortus -derived endotoxin (175 micrograms per mouse) in phosphate-buffered saline (PBS), and survival is followed for at least 78 hour.
  • PBS phosphate-buffered saline
  • TNR1-immunoadhesin and CD4-immunoadhesin are used as the positive and negative controls, respectively.
  • Each is diluted in PBS and injected i.v. prior to, or after, the administration of endotoxin.
  • VEGF-antibodies and VGFR-immunoadhesins are promising candidates for treatment in a number of metastatic carcinomas including colon, rectum, lung, and breast, and in age-related macular degeneration.
  • VGFR symmetroadhesins are prepared using VGFR-X proteins, and analyzed for their ability to bind VEGF and to block VEGF biological activity.
  • the activity of VGFR symmetroadhesins is compared to that of VGRF immunoadhesins (Park et al. (1994) J. Biol. Chem. 269, 25646-25654).
  • VGFR1-X, VGFR2-X, and VGFR3-X are prepared according to the method of EXAMPLE 3. Host cells are transfected with expression vectors that encode:
  • FIGS. 45A-45C 1) a pre-VGFR1-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the VGFR1 extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site ( FIGS. 45A-45C ); 2) a pre-VGFR2-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the VGFR1 extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site ( FIGS. 45A-45C ); 2) a pre-VGFR2-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the VGFR1 extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site ( FIGS. 45A-45C ); 2) a pre-VGFR2-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the
  • FIGS. 47A-47C a pre-VGFR1-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the VGFR1 extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site.
  • VGFR-intein fusion proteins part ii
  • Excision of the intein domain provides a VGFR-thioester intermediate (part iii).
  • native chemical ligation of the VGFR-thioester with free cysteine and/or selenocysteine is employed to prepare VGFR domains with C-terminal-X-termini (part iv).
  • sequences of these polypeptides are shown in SEQ ID NO: 166, SEQ ID NO:167, SEQ ID NO:168, and SEQ ID NO:169 (VGFR1); in SEQ ID NO: 171, SEQ ID NO:172, SEQ ID NO:173, and SEQ ID NO:174 (VGFR2); and in SEQ ID NO: 176, SEQ ID NO:177, SEQ ID NO:178, and SEQ ID NO:179 (VGFR3).
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert and vector fragment prepared by digestion with EcoRI and BglII.
  • plasmid pVGFR1-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:22 and SEQ ID NO:1
  • plasmid pVGR1-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:23 and SEQ ID NO:1
  • plasmid pVGR1-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:24 and SEQ ID NO:1.
  • plasmid pVGFR1-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:22 and pSVeCD4DHFR
  • plasmid pVGR1-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:23 and pSVeCD4DHFR
  • plasmid pVGR1-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:24 and pSVeCD4DHFR.
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and EagI and a vector fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and PspOM1.
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-VGFR1-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:165 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-VGFR2-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:170 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-VGFR3-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:175 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • VGFR1-X, VGFR2-X, and VEGFR3-X proteins are used to prepare various VGFR symmetroadhesins (Tables 6, 7, and 8). The number of distinct configurations obtained for each combination, as well as the general structure for each, is also shown.
  • Hemi-symmetroadhesins are prepared using the VGFR-X proteins alone, immunosymmetroadhesins are prepared using the VGFR-X proteins with S-Fc, X-Fc, or Fc-X, and bi-symmetroadhesins are prepared using the VGFR-X proteins with S-Fc-X or X-Fc-X.
  • Each VGFR-X protein or VGFR symmetroadhesin is determined by a quantitative immunoassay using subtype-specific, affinity-purified polyclonal antibodies to VGFR1, VGFR2, and VGFR3, and immunoadhesins (VGFR1-Ig, VGFR2-Ig, and VGFR3-Ig) as reference standards.
  • VGFR antibodies, VGFR-Ig immunoadhesins, and VEGF 165 protein are obtained from R&D Systems (MN).
  • VEGR symmetroadhesins Binding of VEGR symmetroadhesins to VEGF is studied using a VEGF saturation binding assay. Reactions (0.1 ml) contain 10% fetal bovine serum in PBS (buffer A) with 125 I-VEGF 165 ( ⁇ 9000 cpm/well, 5.69 ⁇ 10 7 cpm/microgram). Chloramine T is used to iodinated VEGF 165 as described (Keyt et al. (1996) J. Biol Chem. 271, 5638-5646). Binding is carried out overnight at 4° C. in the presence or absence of 50 nanograms of unlabeled purified VEGF 165 .
  • the bound 125 I-VEGF 165 is then determined by capture in 96-well breakaway immunoabsorbent assay plates (Nunc). Plates are coated overnight at 4° C. with 2 micrograms/ml affinity-purified goat anti-human Fc IgG (Organon-Teknika) in 50 mM Na 2 CO 3 , pH 9.6, and preblocked for 1 hr in buffer A. Binding reactions are then incubated in the coated wells for 4 hrs at room temperature, followed by 4 washes with buffer A. The fraction of bound 125 I-VEGF 165 is determined in a gamma counter. Data is analyzed using a 4-parameter non-linear curve fitting program (Kalidagraph, Abelbeck Software, Pa.).
  • Binding of VEGF to VEGR symmetroadhesins is also studied using a competition binding assay.
  • ELISA plates are coated with 2 micrograms/ml rabbit F(ab′) 2 to human IgG Fc (Jackson ImmunoResearch, Pa.) and blocked with buffer A.
  • KDR-IgG (3 nanograms/ml) in buffer A is added to the plate and incubated for 1 hr.
  • Serially-diluted samples are incubated with 2 nM biotinylated VEGF for 1 h in tubes. The reactions are then transferred to the ELISA plates and incubated for 1 h.
  • Bovine adrenal cortex capillary endothelial cells are cultured in the presence of low glucose Dulbecco's modified Eagle's medium (GIBCO) supplemented with 10% calf serum, and 2 mM glutamine (growth medium). Cells are seeded at a density of 6 ⁇ 10 3 cells/well in 6-well plates. Serially diluted samples are added to the cells at concentrations between 1 to 5000 nanograms/ml and incubated for 2 to 3 hr. Purified VEGF 165 is added to a final concentration of 3 nanograms/ml. Cells are then incubated for 5 to 6 days, removed from plates with trypsin, and cell number determined in a Coulter counter (Coulter Electronics, FL). Data is analyzed using 4-parameter non-linear regression curve fitting analysis.
  • mice Following tumor cell inoculation (24 hr.), animals (10 per group) are treated with serially diluted samples at dose of 0.05 mg/kg, 0.5 mg/kg, and 5 mg/kg, administered twice weekly intraperitoneally in a volume of 0.1 ml. Tumor size is determined at weekly intervals. Four weeks after tumor cell inoculation, animals are euthanized and the tumors removed and weighed. Statistical analysis is carried out by ANOVA.
  • a therapeutic strategy for treating malignant disease is based upon epidermal growth factor-like receptors (ErbB) and their ligands, including the neuregulins/heregulins (NRG/HRG), and the family of EGF-related protein ligands.
  • ErbB-antibodies and ErbB-immunoadhesins are under clinical investigation, and are well-proven in treating metastatic breast cancers overexpressing ErbB2.
  • ErbB symmetroadhesins are prepared using ErbB-X proteins, and analyzed for their ability to bind heregulins and block heregulin biological activity.
  • the activity of ErbB symmetroadhesins is compared to that of ErbB immunoadhesins (Sliwkowski et al. (1994) J. Biol. Chem. 269, 14661-14665).
  • ErbB1 Human ErbB include ErbB1 (Genbank Acc. No. NM — 005228); ErbB2 (GenBank Acc. No. NM — 004448); ErbB3 (GenBank Acc. No. NM — 001982); and ErbB4 (GenBank Acc. No. NM — 005235).
  • ErbB1-X, ErbB2-X, ErbB3-X, and ErbB4-X are prepared according to the method of EXAMPLE 3.
  • Host cells are transfected with expression vectors that encode:
  • FIGS. 48A-48B 1) a pre-ErbB1-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the ErbB1 extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site ( FIGS. 48A-48B ); 2) a pre-ErbB2-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the ErbB2 extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site ( FIGS. 48A-48B ); 2) a pre-ErbB2-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the ErbB2 extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site ( FIGS.
  • FIGS. 50A-50B a pre-ErbB3-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the ErbB3 extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site
  • FIGS. 50A-50B a pre-ErbB4-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the ErbB4 extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site
  • sequences of these polypeptides are shown in SEQ ID NO: 181, SEQ ID NO:182, SEQ ID NO:183, and SEQ ID NO:184 (ERBB1); in SEQ ID NO: 186, SEQ ID NO:187, SEQ ID NO:188, and SEQ ID NO:189 (ERBB2); in SEQ ID NO: 191, SEQ ID NO:192, SEQ ID NO:193, and SEQ ID NO:194 (ERBB3); and in SEQ ID NO: 196, SEQ ID NO:197, SEQ ID NO:198, and SEQ ID NO:199 (ERBB4).
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert and vector fragment prepared by digestion with EcoRI and BglII.
  • plasmid pErbB1-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:25 and SEQ ID NO:1
  • plasmid pErbB2-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:26 and SEQ ID NO:1
  • plasmid pErbB3-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:27 and SEQ ID NO:1
  • plamid pErbB4-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:28 and SEQ ID NO:1.
  • plasmid pErbB1-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:25 and pSVeCD4DHFR
  • plasmid pErbB2-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:26 and pSVeCD4DHFR
  • plasmid pErbB3-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:27 and pSVeCD4DHFR
  • plamid pErbB4-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:28 and pSVeCD4DHFR.
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and EagI and a vector fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and PspOM1.
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-ERBB1-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:180 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-ERBB2-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:185 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-ERBB3-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:190 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • Plasmid pCDNA3-ERBB4-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:195 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • Hemi-symmetroadhesins are prepared using the ErbB-X proteins alone, immunosymmetroadhesins are prepared using the ErbB-X proteins with S-Fc, X-Fc, or Fc-X, and bi-symmetroadhesins are prepared using the ErbB-X proteins with S-Fc-X or X-Fc-X.
  • Each ErbB-X protein or ErbB symmetroadhesin is determined by a quantitative immunoassay using subtype-specific, affinity-purified polyclonal antibodies to ErbB1, ErbB2, ErbB3, and ErbB4, and immunoadhesins (ErbB1-Ig, ErbB2-Ig, ErbB3-Ig, and ErbB4-Ig) as reference standards.
  • ErbB antibodies, ErbB-Ig immunoadhesins, NRG1- ⁇ 177-241 protein, NRG1- ⁇ 176-246 protein, NRG1- ⁇ 1-246 protein, and NRG1-SMDF 1-296 protein are obtained from R&D Systems (MN).
  • Buffer is removed and each well is incubated with 100 microliters of the sample in 1% BSA/PBS under vigorous side-to-side rotation for 1 hour. Plates are rinsed three times with wash buffer and competitive binding is carried out by adding various amounts of cold competitor gamma-HRG and 125 I-HRG ⁇ 1 and incubating at room temperature for 2 to 3 hours with vigorous side-to-side rotation. Wells are quickly rinsed three times with wash buffer, drained and individual wells are counted in a gamma-counter. Scatchard analysis is performed using a modified Ligand program (Munson, P. and Robard, D. (1980) Analytical Biochemistry 107:220-239).
  • cells are labeled with 3 H-thymidine to measure DNA synthesis (20 mL of 1/20 diluted tritiated thymidine stock: Amersham TRA 120 B363, 1 mCi/ml). Cells are then harvested onto GF/C unifilters (96 well format) using a Packard Filtermate 196 harvester. Filters are counted using a Packard Topcount apparatus.
  • This invention is particularly useful for screening compounds by using consecutive amino acid sequences/or compounds comprising such in any of a variety of drug screening techniques.
  • the compound employed in such a test may either be free in solution, affixed to a solid support, borne on a cell surface, or located intracellularly.
  • One method of drug screening utilizes eukaryotic or prokaryotic host cells which are stably transformed with recombinant nucleic acids expressing the compound. Drugs are screened against such transformed cells in competitive binding assays. Such cells, either in viable or fixed form, can be used for standard binding assays. One may measure, for example, the formation of complexes between compound or a fragment and the agent being tested. Alternatively, one can examine the diminution in complex formation between the compound and its target cell or target receptors caused by the agent being tested.
  • the present invention provides methods of screening for drugs or any other agents which can affect a disease or disorder associated with a stretch of consecutive amino acids of the compound. These methods comprise contacting such an agent with the compound or fragment thereof and assaying (I) for the presence of a complex between the agent and the compound or fragment thereof, or (ii) for the presence of a complex between the compound or fragment thereof and the cell, by methods well known in the art.
  • the compound or fragment thereof is typically labeled. After suitable incubation, free compound or fragment thereof is separated from that present in bound form, and the amount of free or uncomplexed label is a measure of the ability of the particular agent to bind to the compound or fragment thereof or to interfere with the compound/cell complex.
  • Another technique for drug screening provides high throughput screening for compounds having suitable binding affinity to a polypeptide and is described in detail in WO 84/03564, published on Sep. 13, 1984. Briefly stated, large numbers of different small peptide test compounds are synthesized on a solid substrate, such as plastic pins or some other surface. As applied to the instant compound or fragment thereof, the peptide test compounds are reacted with compound or fragment thereof and washed. Bound compound or fragment thereof is detected by methods well known in the art. Purified compound or fragment thereof can also be coated directly onto plates for use in the aforementioned drug screening techniques. In addition, non-neutralizing antibodies can be used to capture the peptide and immobilize it on the solid support.
  • This invention also contemplates the use of competitive drug screening assays in which neutralizing antibodies capable of binding compound or fragment thereof specifically compete with a test compound for binding to compound or fragment thereof.
  • the antibodies can be used to detect the presence of any peptide which shares one or more antigenic determinants with the stretch(es) of consecutive amino acids of the compound.
  • the goal of rational drug design is to produce structural analogs of biologically active polypeptide of interest (i.e., a compound of the invention, or an amino acid sequence of a compound of the invention) or of small molecules with which they interact, e.g., agonists, antagonists, or inhibitors. Any of these examples can be used to fashion drugs which are more active or stable forms of the a compound of the invention, or an amino acid sequence of a compound of the invention or which enhance or interfere with the function of the a compound of the invention, or an amino acid sequence of a compound of the invention in vivo (cf., Hodgson, Bio/Technology, 9:19-21 (1991)).
  • the three-dimensional structure of a compound of the invention, or an amino acid sequence of a compound of the invention, or of a compound-inhibitor complex is determined by x-ray crystallography, by computer modeling or, most typically, by a combination of the two approaches. Both the shape and charges of a compound of the invention, or an amino acid sequence of a compound of the invention, must be ascertained to elucidate the structure and to determine active site(s). Relevant structural information is used to then design analogous molecules or to identify efficient inhibitors.
  • Useful examples of rational drug design may include molecules which have improved activity or stability as shown by Braxton and Wells, Biochemistry, 31:7796-7801 (1992) or which act as inhibitors, agonists, or antagonists of native peptides as shown by Athauda et al., J. Biochem., 113:742-746 (1993).
  • a target-specific antibody selected by functional assay, as described above, and then to solve its crystal structure.
  • This approach in principle, yields a pharmacore upon which subsequent drug design can be based. It is possible to bypass protein crystallography altogether by generating anti-idiotypic antibodies (anti-ids) to a functional, pharmacologically active antibody. As a mirror image of a mirror image, the binding site of the anti-ids would be expected to be an analog of the original receptor. The anti-id could then be used to identify and isolate peptides from banks of chemically or biologically produced peptides. The isolated peptides would then act as the pharmacore.
  • anti-ids anti-idiotypic antibodies
  • VEGF Vascular Endothelial Growth Factor
  • bovine adrenal cortical capillary endothelial cells (from primary culture, maximum of 12-14 passages) are plated in 96-well plates at 500 cells/well per 100 microliter.
  • Assay media includes low glucose DMEM, 10% calf serum, 2 mM glutamine, and 1 ⁇ penicillin/streptomycin/fungizone.
  • Control wells include the following: (1) no ACE cells added; (2) ACE cells alone; (3) ACE cells plus 5 ng/ml FGF; (4) ACE cells plus 3 ng/ml VEGF; (5) ACE cells plus 3 ng/ml VEGF plus 1 ng/ml TGF-beta; and (6) ACE cells plus 3 ng/ml VEGF plus 5 ng/ml LIF.
  • the test samples, poly-his tagged compounds are then added to the wells (at dilutions of 1%, 0.1% and 0.01%, respectively).
  • the cell cultures are incubated for 6-7 days at 37° C./5% CO 2 After the incubation, the media in the wells is aspirated, the cells are washed 1 ⁇ with PBS. An acid phosphatase reaction mixture (100 microliter; 0.1M sodium acetate, pH 5.5, 0.1% Triton X-100, 10 mM p-nitrophenyl phosphate) is then added to each well. After a 2 hour incubation at 37° C., the reaction is stopped by addition of 10 microliters 1M NaOH. Optical density (OD) is measured on a microplate reader at 405 nm.
  • OD optical density
  • the activity of the assayed compound is calculated as the percent inhibition of VEGF (3 ng/ml) stimulated proliferation (as determined by measuring acid phosphatase activity at OD 405 nm) relative to the cells without stimulation.
  • TGF-beta can be employed as an activity reference at 1 ng/ml, since TGF-beta blocks 70-90% of VEGF-stimulated ACE cell proliferation. The results are indicative of the utility of the assayed compound in cancer therapy and specifically in inhibiting tumor angiogenesis.
  • Numerical values are determined by calculating the percent inhibition of VEGF stimulated proliferation by the assayed compound relative to cells without stimulation and then dividing that percentage into the percent inhibition obtained by TGF-beta at 1 ng/ml which is known to block 70-90% of VEGF stimulated cell proliferation. The results are considered positive if the assayed compound exhibits 30% or greater inhibition of VEGF stimulation of endothelial cell growth (relative inhibition 30% or greater).
  • This assay can demonstrate if the compound tested has efficacy in enhancing the survival of retinal neuron cells and, therefore, is useful for the therapeutic treatment of retinal disorders or injuries including, for example, treating sight loss in mammals due to retinitis pigmentosum, AMD, etc.
  • Sprague Dawley rat pups at postnatal day 7 are killed by decapitation following CO 2 anesthesia and the eyes are removed under sterile conditions.
  • the neural retina is dissected away from the pigment epithelium and other ocular tissue and then dissociated into a single cell suspension using 0.25% trypsin in Ca 2+ , Mg 2+ -free PBS.
  • the retinas are incubated at 37° C. for 7-10 minutes after which the trypsin is inactivated by adding 1 ml soybean trypsin inhibitor.
  • the cells are plated at 100,000 cells per well in 96 well plates in DMEM/F12 supplemented with N 2 and with or without the specific test compound.
  • Cells for all experiments are grown at 37° C. in a water saturated atmosphere of 5% CO 2 . After 2-3 days in culture, cells are stained with calcein AM then fixed using 4% paraformaldehyde and stained with DAPI for determination of total cell count. The total cells (fluorescent) are quantified at 20 ⁇ objective magnification using CCD camera and NIH image software for MacIntosh. Fields in the well are chosen at random.
  • percent survival is calculated by dividing the total number of calcein AM positive cells at 2-3 days in culture by the total number of DAPI-labeled cells at 2-3 days in culture. Anything above 30% survival is considered positive.
  • the results are calculated as % survival: total number of calcein-rhodopsin positive cells at 2-3 days in culture, divided by the total number of rhodopsin positive cells at time 2-3 days in culture.
  • the total cells (fluorescent) are quantified at 20 ⁇ objective magnification using a CCD camera and NIH image software for MacIntosh. Fields in the well are chosen at random.
  • the ability of the compounds disclosed herein to induce apoptosis in endothelial cells can be tested in human venous umbilical vein endothelial cells (HUVEC, Cell Systems).
  • a positive test in the assay is indicative of the usefulness of the compound in therapeutically treating tumors as well as vascular disorders where inducing apoptosis of endothelial cells would be beneficial.
  • the cells are plated on 96-well microtiter plates (Amersham Life Science, cytostar-T scintillating microplate, RPNQ160, sterile, tissue-culture treated, individually wrapped), in 10% serum (CSG-medium, Cell Systems), at a density of 2 ⁇ 10 4 cells per well in a total volume of 100 ⁇ l.
  • test samples containing the tested compound are added in triplicate at dilutions of 1%, 0.33% and 0.11%.
  • Wells without cells were used as a blank and wells with cells only are used as a negative control.
  • As a positive control 1:3 serial dilutions of 50 ⁇ l of a 3 ⁇ stock of staurosporine were used.
  • the ability of the compound to induce apoptosis is determined by processing of the 96 well plates for detection of Annexin V, a member of the calcium and phospholipid binding proteins, to detect apoptosis.
  • Percent above background represents the percentage amount of counts per minute above the negative controls. Percents greater than or equal to 30% above background are considered positive.
  • PDB12 pancreatic ductal cells are plated on fibronectin coated 96 well plates at 1.5 ⁇ 10 3 cells per well in 100 ⁇ L/180 ⁇ L of growth media. 100 ⁇ L of growth media with the compound test sample or negative control lacking the compound is then added to well, for a final volume of 200 ⁇ L. Controls contain growth medium containing a protein shown to be inactive in this assay. Cells are incubated for 4 days at 37° C. 20 ⁇ L of Alamar Blue Dye (AB) is then added to each well and the flourescent reading is measured at 4 hours post addition of AB, on a microtiter plate reader at 530 nm excitation and 590 nm emission. The standard employed is cells without Bovine Pituitary Extract (BPE) and with various concentrations of BPE. Buffer or CM controls from unknowns are run 2 times on each 96 well plate.
  • BPE Bovine Pituitary Extract
  • This assay is designed to measure the ability of the various compounds disclosed herein to stimulate hypertrophy of adult heart. A positive test in this assay indicates that the compound would be expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of various cardiac insufficiency disorders.
  • Ventricular myocytes freshly isolated from adult (250 g) Sprague Dawley rats are plated at 2000 cell/well in 180 ⁇ l volume. Cells are isolated and plated on day 1, the compound-containing test samples or growth medium only (negative control) (20 ⁇ l volume) is added on day 2 and the cells are then fixed and stained on day 5. After staining, cell size is visualized wherein cells showing no growth enhancement as compared to control cells are given a value of 0.0, cells showing small to moderate growth enhancement as compared to control cells are given a value of 1.0 and cells showing large growth enhancement as compared to control cells are given a value of 2.0. Any degree of growth enhancement as compared to the negative control cells is considered positive for the assay.
  • PDB12 pancreatic ductal cells are plated on fibronectin coated 96 well plates at 1.5 ⁇ 10 3 cells per well in 100 ⁇ L/180 ⁇ L of growth media. 100 ⁇ L of growth media with the compound test sample or negative control lacking the compound tested is then added to well, for a final volume of 200 ⁇ L. Controls contain growth medium containing a protein shown to be inactive in this assay. Cells are incubated for 4 days at 37° C. 20 ⁇ L of Alamar Blue Dye (AB) is then added to each well and the flourescent reading is measured at 4 hours post addition of AB, on a microtiter plate reader at 530 nm excitation and 590 nm emission. The standard employed is cells without Bovine Pituitary Extract (BPE) and with various concentrations of BPE. Buffer or growth medium only controls from unknowns are run 2 times on each 96 well plate.
  • BPE Bovine Pituitary Extract
  • Percent increase in protein production is calculated by comparing the Alamar Blue Dye calculated protein concentration produced by the test compound-treated cells with the Alamar Blue Dye calculated protein concentration produced by the negative control cells. A percent increase in protein production of greater than or equal to 25% as compared to the negative control cells is considered positive.
  • This assay is designed to measure the ability of the compounds disclosed herein to stimulate hypertrophy of neonatal heart. Testing positive in this assay indicates the compounds to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of various cardiac insufficiency disorders.
  • Cardiac myocytes from 1-day old Harlan Sprague Dawley rats are obtained.
  • Cells 180 ⁇ l at 7.5 ⁇ 10 4 /ml, serum ⁇ 0.1%, freshly isolated
  • Test samples containing the test compound or growth medium only (negative control) (201/well) are added directly to the wells on day 1.
  • PGF (20 ⁇ l/well) is then added on day 2 at final concentration of 10 ⁇ 6 M.
  • the cells are then stained on day 4 and visually scored on day 5, wherein cells showing no increase in size as compared to negative controls are scored 0.0, cells showing a small to moderate increase in size as compared to negative controls are scored 1.0 and cells showing a large increase in size as compared to negative controls are scored 2.0.
  • a positive result in the assay is a score of 1.0 or greater.
  • This assay is used to determine if the compounds disclosed herein are active as a stimulator of the proliferation of stimulated T-lymphocytes.
  • Compounds which stimulate proliferation of lymphocytes are useful therapeutically where enhancement of an immune response is beneficial.
  • a therapeutic agent may take the form of antagonists of the compounds of the invention, for example, murine-human chimeric, humanized or human antibodies against the compound.
  • peripheral blood mononuclear cells are isolated from mammalian individuals, for example a human volunteer, by leukopheresis (one donor will supply stimulator PBMCs, the other donor will supply responder PBMCs). If desired, the cells are frozen in fetal bovine serum and DMSO after isolation.
  • Frozen cells may be thawed overnight in assay media (37° C., 5% CO 2 ) and then washed and resuspended to 3 ⁇ 10 6 cells/ml of assay media (RPMI; 10% fetal bovine serum, 1% penicillin/streptomycin, 1% glutamine, 1% HEPES, 1% non-essential amino acids, 1% pyruvate).
  • assay media 37° C., 5% CO 2
  • the stimulator PBMCs are prepared by irradiating the cells (about 3000 Rads).
  • the assay is prepared by plating in triplicate wells a mixture of:
  • test sample diluted to 1% or to 0.1%, 50:1 of irradiated stimulator cells, and 50:1 of responder PBMC cells.
  • 100 microliters of cell culture media or 100 microliter of CD4-IgG is used as the control.
  • the wells are then incubated at 37° C., 5% CO 2 for 4 days. On day 5, each well is pulsed with tritiated thymidine (1.0 mC/well; Amersham). After 6 hours the cells are washed 3 times and then the uptake of the label is evaluated.
  • PBMCs are isolated from the spleens of Balb/c mice and C57B6 mice.
  • the cells are teased from freshly harvested spleens in assay media (RPMI; 10% fetal bovine serum, 1% penicillin/streptomycin, 1% glutamine, 1% HEPES, 1% non-essential amino acids, 1% pyruvate) and the PBMCs are isolated by overlaying these cells over Lympholyte M (Organon Teknika), centrifuging at 2000 rpm for 20 minutes, collecting and washing the mononuclear cell layer in assay media and resuspending the cells to 1 ⁇ 10 7 cells/ml of assay media. The assay is then conducted as described above.
  • assay media RPMI; 10% fetal bovine serum, 1% penicillin/streptomycin, 1% glutamine, 1% HEPES, 1% non-essential amino acids, 1% pyruvate
  • Lympholyte M Organon
  • This assay shows the ability of the compounds disclosed herein of the invention act to induce the expression of c-fos in pericyte cells and, therefore, their use not only as diagnostic markers for particular types of pericyte-associated tumors but also for giving rise to antagonists which would be expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of pericyte-associated tumors.
  • pericytes are received from VEC Technologies and all but 5 ml of media is removed from flask.
  • the pericytes are trypsinized, washed, spun and then plated onto 96 well plates.
  • the metacarphophalangeal joint of 4-6 month old pigs is aseptically dissected, and articular cartilage was removed by free hand slicing being careful to avoid the underlying bone.
  • the cartilage was minced and cultured in bulk for 24 hours in a humidified atmosphere of 95% air, 5% CO 2 in serum free (SF) media (DME/F12 1:1) with 0.1% BSA and 100 U/ml penicillin and 100 ⁇ g/ml streptomycin. After washing three times, approximately 100 mg of articular cartilage is aliquoted into micronics tubes and incubated for an additional 24 hours in the above SF media.
  • the compound is then added at 1% either alone or in combination with 18 ng/ml interleukin-1 alpha, a known stimulator of proteoglycan release from cartilage tissue.
  • the supernatant is then harvested and assayed for the amount of proteoglycans using the 1,9-dimethyl-methylene blue (DMB) calorimetric assay (Farndale and Buttle, Biochem. Biophys. Acta 883:173-177 (1985)).
  • DMB 1,9-dimethyl-methylene blue
  • This assay is used to test whether compounds of the invention stimulate an immune response and induce inflammation by inducing mononuclear cell, eosinophil and PMN infiltration at the site of injection of the animal. Compounds which stimulate an immune response are useful therapeutically where stimulation of an immune response is beneficial.
  • This skin vascular permeability assay is conducted as follows. Hairless guinea pigs weighing 350 grams or more are anesthetized with ketamine (75-80 mg/Kg) and 5 mg/Kg xylazine intramuscularly (IM). A sample of purified compound of the invention or a conditioned media test sample is injected intradermally onto the backs of the test animals with 100 ⁇ l per injection site.
  • This assay is designed to measure the ability of compounds disclosed herein to stimulate hypertrophy of neonatal heart, a positive test indicating usefulness for the therapeutic treatment of various cardiac insufficiency disorders.
  • Cardiac myocytes from 1-day old Harlan Sprague Dawley rats were obtained.
  • Cells (180 ⁇ l at 7.5 ⁇ 10 4 /ml, serum ⁇ 0.1%, freshly isolated) are added on day 1 to 96-well plates previously coated with DMEM/F12+4% FCS.
  • Test samples containing the test compound (20 ⁇ l/well) are added directly to the wells on day 1.
  • PGF (20 ⁇ l/well) is then added on day 2 at a final concentration of 10 ⁇ 6 M.
  • the cells are then stain on day 4 and visually scored on day ⁇ 5.
  • Visual scores are based on cell size, wherein cells showing no increase in size as compared to negative controls are scored 0.0, cells showing a small to moderate increase in size as compared to negative controls are scored 1.0 and cells showing a large increase in size as compared to negative controls are scored 2.0. A score of 1.0 or greater is considered positive.
  • This example shows that one or more of the compound of the invention are active as inhibitors of the proliferation of stimulated T-lymphocytes.
  • Compounds which inhibit proliferation of lymphocytes are useful therapeutically where suppression of an immune response is beneficial.
  • peripheral blood mononuclear cells are isolated from mammalian individuals, for example a human volunteer, by leukopheresis (one donor will supply stimulator PBMCs, the other donor will supply responder PBMCs). If desired, the cells are frozen in fetal bovine serum and DMSO after isolation.
  • Frozen cells may be thawed overnight in assay media (37° C., 5% CO 2 ) and then washed and resuspended to 3 ⁇ 10 6 cells/ml of assay media (RPMI; 10% fetal bovine serum, 1% penicillin/streptomycin, 1% glutamine, 1% HEPES, 1% non-essential amino acids, 1% pyruvate).
  • assay media 37° C., 5% CO 2
  • the stimulator PBMCs are prepared by irradiating the cells (about 3000 Rads).
  • the assay is prepared by plating in triplicate wells a mixture of:
  • test sample diluted to 1% or to 0.1%, 50:1 of irradiated stimulator cells, and 50:1 of responder PBMC cells.
  • 100 microliters of cell culture media or 100 microliter of CD4-IgG is used as the control.
  • the wells are then incubated at 37° C., 5% CO 2 for 4 days. On day 5, each well is pulsed with tritiated thymidine (1.0 mC/well; Amersham). After 6 hours the cells are washed 3 times and then the uptake of the label is evaluated.
  • PBMCs are isolated from the spleens of Balb/c mice and C57B6 mice.
  • the cells are teased from freshly harvested spleens in assay media (RPMI; 10% fetal bovine serum, 1% penicillin/streptomycin, 1% glutamine, 1% HEPES, 1% non-essential amino acids, 1% pyruvate) and the PBMCs are isolated by overlaying these cells over Lympholyte M (Organon Teknika), centrifuging at 2000 rpm for 20 minutes, collecting and washing the mononuclear cell layer in assay media and resuspending the cells to 1 ⁇ 10 7 cells/ml of assay media. The assay is then conducted as described above.
  • assay media RPMI; 10% fetal bovine serum, 1% penicillin/streptomycin, 1% glutamine, 1% HEPES, 1% non-essential amino acids, 1% pyruvate
  • Lympholyte M Organon
  • Any decreases below control is considered to be a positive result for an inhibitory compound, with decreases of less than or equal to 80% being preferred. However, any value less than control indicates an inhibitory effect for the test protein.
  • the ability of the compounds disclosed herein to induce apoptosis in endothelial cells can be tested in human venous umbilical vein endothelial cells (HUVEC, Cell Systems) using a 96-well format, in 0% serum media supplemented with 100 ng/ml VEGF, 0.1% BSA, 1 ⁇ pen/strep.
  • HUVEC human venous umbilical vein endothelial cells
  • a positive result in this assay indicates the usefulness of the compound for therapeutically treating any of a variety of conditions associated with undesired endothelial cell growth including, for example, the inhibition of tumor growth.
  • Coating of 96 well plates can be prepared by allowing gelatinization to occur for >30 minutes with 100 ⁇ l of 0.2% gelatin in PBS solution. The gelatin mix is aspirated thoroughly before plating HUVEC cells at a final concentration of 2 ⁇ 10 4 cells/ml in 10% serum containing medium—100 ⁇ l volume per well. The cells were grown for 24 hours before adding test samples containing the compound of interest.
  • ELISA is used to determine levels of apoptosis preparing solutions according to the Boehringer Manual [Boehringer, Cell Death Detection ELISA plus, Cat No. 1 920 685].
  • Sample preparations 96 well plates are spun down at 1 krpm for 10 minutes (200 g); the supernatant is removed by fast inversion, placing the plate upside down on a paper towel to remove residual liquid.
  • 200 ⁇ l of 1 ⁇ Lysis buffer is added and incubation allowed at room temperature for 30 minutes without shaking. The plates were spun down for 10 minutes at 1 krpm, and 20 ⁇ l of the lysate (cytoplasmic fraction) is transferred into streptavidin coated MTP.
  • This assay is designed to determine whether compounds of the present invention show the ability to stimulate calcium flux in human umbilical vein endothelial cells (HUVEC, Cell Systems).
  • Calcium influx is a well documented response upon binding of certain ligands to their receptors.
  • a test compound that results in a positive response in the present calcium influx assay can be said to bind to a specific receptor and activate a biological signaling pathway in human endothelial cells. This could ultimately lead, for example, to endothelial cell division, inhibition of endothelial cell proliferation, endothelial tube formation, cell migration, apoptosis, etc.
  • Human venous umbilical vein endothelial cells (HUVEC, Cell Systems) in growth media (50:50 without glycine, 1% glutamine, 10 mM Hepes, 10% FBS, 10 ng/ml bFGF), are plated on 96-well microtiter ViewPlates-96 (Packard Instrument Company Part #6005182) microtiter plates at a cell density of 2 ⁇ 10 4 cells/well. The day after plating, the cells are washed three times with buffer (HBSS plus 10 mM Hepes), leaving 100 ⁇ l/well. Then 100 ⁇ l/well of 8 ⁇ M Fluo-3 (2 ⁇ is added. The cells are incubated for 1.5 hours at 37° C./5% CO 2 .
  • test samples of the compound are prepared on different 96-well plates at 5 ⁇ concentration in buffer.
  • the positive control corresponded to 50 ⁇ M ionomycin (5 ⁇ ); the negative control corresponded to Protein 32.
  • Cell plate and sample plates are run on a FLIPR (Molecular Devices) machine. The FLIPR machine added 25 ⁇ l of test sample to the cells, and readings are taken every second for one minute, then every 3 seconds for the next three minutes.
  • the fluorescence change from baseline to the maximum rise of the curve ( ⁇ change) is calculated, and replicates averaged.
  • the rate of fluorescence increase is monitored, and only those samples which had a ⁇ change greater than 1000 and a rise within 60 seconds, are considered positive.
  • the assay is performed is follows. BHK-21 fibroblast cells plated in standard growth medium at 2500 cells/well in a total volume of 100 ⁇ l. The compound, beta-FGF (positive control) or nothing (negative control) are then added to the wells in the presence of 1 ⁇ g/ml of heparin for a total final volume of 200 ⁇ l. The cells are then incubated at 37° C. for 6 to 7 days. After incubation, the media is removed, the cells are washed with PBS and then an acid phosphatase substrate reaction mixture (100 ⁇ l/well) is added. The cells are then incubated at 37° C. for 2 hours. 10 ⁇ L per well of 1N NaOH is then added to stop the acid phosphatase reaction. The plates are then read at OD 405 nm. A positive in the assay is acid phosphatase activity which is at least 50% above the negative control.
  • This assay is designed to measure the inhibition of heart adult hypertrophy. Compounds testing positive in this assay may find use in the therapeutic treatment of cardiac disorders associated with cardiac hypertrophy.
  • PE phenylephrine
  • Assay media included: M199 (modified)-glutamine free, NaHCO 3 , phenol red, supplemented with 100 nM insulin, 0.2% BSA, 5 mM cretine, 2 mM L-carnitine, 5 mM taurine, 100 U/ml penicillin G, 100 ⁇ g/ml streptomycin (CCT medium). Only inner 60 wells are used in 96 well plates. Of these, 6 wells are reserved for negative and positive (PE) controls.
  • PE negative and positive
  • This assay is designed to determine whether compounds of the invention show the ability to induce c-fos in endothelial cells.
  • Compounds testing positive in this assay would be expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of conditions or disorders where angiogenesis would be beneficial including, for example, wound healing, and the like (is would agonists of these compounds).
  • Antagonists of the compounds testing positive in this assay would be expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of cancerous tumors.
  • Human venous umbilical vein endothelial cells (HUVEC, Cell Systems) in growth media (50% Ham's F12 w/o GHT: low glucose, and 50% DMEM without glycine: with NaHCO 3 , 1% glutamine, 10 mM HEPES, 10% FBS, 10 ng/ml bFGF) are plated on 96-well microtiter plates at a cell density of 1 ⁇ 10 4 cells/well.
  • positive control growth media
  • the cells are incubated for 30 minutes at 37° C., in 5% CO 2 .
  • the samples are removed, and the first part of the bDNA kit protocol (Chiron Diagnostics, cat. #6005-037) is followed, where each capitalized reagent/buffer listed below is available from the kit.
  • the amounts of the TM Lysis Buffer and Probes needed for the tests are calculated based on information provided by the manufacturer.
  • the appropriate amounts of thawed Probes are added to the TM Lysis Buffer.
  • the Capture Hybridization Buffer is warmed to room temperature.
  • the bDNA strips are set up in the metal strip holders, and 100 ⁇ l of Capture Hybridization Buffer is added to each b-DNA well needed, followed by incubation for at least 30 minutes.
  • the test plates with the cells are removed from the incubator, and the media is gently removed using the vacuum manifold.
  • 100 ⁇ l of Lysis Hybridization Buffer with Probes are quickly pipetted into each well of the microtiter plates. The plates are then incubated at 55° C.
  • the plates are placed on the vortex mixer with the microtiter adapter head and vortexed on the #2 setting for one minute. 80 ⁇ l of the lysate is removed and added to the bDNA wells containing the Capture Hybridization Buffer, and pipetted up and down to mix. The plates are incubated at 53° C. for at least 16 hours.
  • the second part of the bDNA kit protocol is followed. Specifically, the plates are removed from the incubator and placed on the bench to cool for 10 minutes. The volumes of additions needed are calculated based upon information provided by the manufacturer.
  • An Amplifier Working Solution is prepared by making a 1:100 dilution of the Amplifier Concentrate (20 fm/ ⁇ l) in AL Hybridization Buffer. The hybridization mixture is removed from the plates and washed twice with Wash A. 50 ⁇ l of Amplifier Working Solution is added to each well and the wells are incubated at 53° C. for 30 minutes. The plates are then removed from the incubator and allowed to cool for 10 minutes.
  • the Label Probe Working Solution is prepared by making a 1:100 dilution of Label Concentrate (40 pmoles/ ⁇ l) in AL Hybridization Buffer. After the 10-minute cool-down period, the amplifier hybridization mixture is removed and the plates are washed twice with Wash A. 50 ⁇ l of Label Probe Working Solution is added to each well and the wells are incubated at 53° C. for 15 minutes. After cooling for 10 minutes, the Substrate is warmed to room temperature. Upon addition of 3 ⁇ l of Substrate Enhancer to each ml of Substrate needed for the assay, the plates are allowed to cool for 10 minutes, the label hybridization mixture is removed, and the plates are washed twice with Wash A and three times with Wash D. 50 ⁇ l of the Substrate Solution with Enhancer is added to each well. The plates are incubated for 30 minutes at 37° C. and RLU is read in an appropriate luminometer.
  • the replicates are averaged and the coefficient of variation is determined.
  • the measure of activity of the fold increase over the negative control (Protein 32/HEPES buffer described above) value is indicated by chemiluminescence units (RLU).
  • RLU chemiluminescence units
  • This assay is designed to determine whether the compounds of the present invention show the ability to induce vascular permeability.
  • Compounds testing positive in this assay are expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of conditions which would benefit from enhanced vascular permeability including, for example, conditions which may benefit from enhanced local immune system cell infiltration.
  • Hairless guinea pigs weighing 350 grams or more are anesthetized with Ketamine (75-80 mg/kg) and 5 mg/kg Xylazine intramuscularly.
  • Test samples containing the tested compound or a physiological buffer without the test compound are injected into skin on the back of the test animals with 100 ⁇ l per injection site intradermally. There are approximately 16-24 injection sites per animal.
  • One ml of Evans blue dye (1% in PBS) is then injected intracardially. Skin vascular permeability responses to the compounds (i.e., blemishes at the injection sites of injection) are visually scored by measuring the diameter (in mm) of blue-colored leaks from the site of injection at 1 and 6 hours post administration of the test materials.
  • the mm diameter of blueness at the site of injection is observed and recorded is well is the severity of the vascular leakage. Blemishes of at least 5 mm in diameter are considered positive for the assay when testing purified proteins, being indicative of the ability to induce vascular leakage or permeability. A response greater than 7 mm diameter is considered positive for conditioned media samples.
  • Human VEGF at 0.1 ⁇ g/100 ⁇ l is used is a positive control, inducing a response of 15-23 mm diameter.
  • the cells are split [420,000 cells per gelatinized 6 cm dishes (11 ⁇ 10 3 cells/cm 2 Falcon, Primaria)] and grown in media containing serum (CS-C, Cell System) overnight or for 16 hours to 24 hours.
  • CS-C Cell System
  • the cells are washed 1 ⁇ with 5 ml PBS; 3 ml of 0% serum medium is added with VEGF (100 ng/ml); and 30 ⁇ l of the PRO test compound (final dilution 1%) or 0% serum medium (negative control) is added. The mixtures are incubated for 48 hours before harvesting.
  • the cells are then harvested for FACS analysis.
  • the medium is aspirated and the cells washed once with PBS.
  • 5 ml of 1 ⁇ trypsin is added to the cells in a T-175 flask, and the cells are allowed to stand until they are released from the plate (about 5-10 minutes). Trypsinization is stopped by adding 5 ml of growth media.
  • the cells are spun at 1000 rpm for 5 minutes at 4° C.
  • the media is aspirated and the cells are resuspended in 10 ml of 10% serum complemented medium (Cell Systems), 5 ⁇ l of Annexin-FITC (BioVison) added and chilled tubes are submitted for FACS.
  • a positive result is determined to be enhanced apoptosis in the compound treated samples is compared to the negative control.
  • This assay is designed to determine whether the compounds tested show the ability to induce c-fos in cortical neurons. Compounds testing positive in this assay would be expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of nervous system disorders and injuries where neuronal proliferation would be beneficial.
  • Cortical neurons are dissociated and plated in growth medium at 10,000 cells per well in 96 well plates. After approximately 2 cellular divisions, the cells are treated for 30 minutes with the compound or nothing (negative control). The cells are then fixed for 5 minutes with cold methanol and stained with an antibody directed against phosphorylated CREB. mRNA levels are then calculated using chemiluminescence. A positive in the assay is any factor that results in at least a 2-fold increase in c-fos message is compared to the negative controls.
  • This assay is designed to determine whether the compounds of the invention show the ability to promote endothelial vacuole and lumen formation in the absence of exogenous growth factors.
  • Compounds testing positive in this assay would be expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of disorders where endothelial vacuole and/or lumen formation would be beneficial including, for example, where the stimulation of pinocytosis, ion pumping, vascular permeability and/or junctional formation would be beneficial.
  • HUVEC cells (passage ⁇ 8 from primary) are mixed with type I rat tail collagen (final concentration 2.6 mg/ml) at a density of 6 ⁇ 10 5 cells per ml and plated at 50 ⁇ l per well of M199 culture media supplement with 1% FBS and 1 ⁇ M 6-FAM-FITC dye to stain the vacuoles while they are forming and in the presence of the test compound.
  • the cells are then incubated at 37° C./5% CO 2 for 48 hours, fixed with 3.7% formalin room temperature for 10 minutes, washed 5 times with M199 medium and then stained with Rh-Phalloidin at 4° C. overnight followed by nuclear staining with 4 ⁇ M DAPI.
  • a positive result in the assay is when vacuoles are present in greater than 50% of the cells.
  • This assay is designed to determine whether compounds of the invention show the ability to affect glucose or FFA uptake by skeletal muscle cells. Compounds testing positive in this assay would be expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of disorders where either the stimulation or inhibition of glucose uptake by skeletal muscle would be beneficial including, for example, diabetes or hyper- or hypo-insulinemia.
  • a compound to be assayed is added to primary rat differentiated skeletal muscle, and allowed to incubate overnight. Then fresh media with the compound and +/ ⁇ insulin are added to the wells. The sample media is then monitored to determine glucose and FFA uptake by the skeletal muscle cells. The insulin will stimulate glucose and FFA uptake by the skeletal muscle, and insulin in media without the compound is used is a positive control, and a limit for scoring. As the compound being tested may either stimulate or inhibit glucose and FFA uptake, results are scored is positive in the assay if greater than 1.5 times or less than 0.5 times the insulin control.
  • This assay tests the ability of the compounds of this invention act to enhance the survival/proliferation of rod photoreceptor cells and, therefore, are useful for the therapeutic treatment of retinal disorders or injuries including, for example, treating sight loss in mammals due to retinitis pigmentosum, AMD, etc.
  • Sprague Dawley rat pups (postnatal day 7, mixed population: glia and netinal neural cell types) are killed by decapitation following CO 2 anesthesia and the eyes removed under sterile conditions.
  • the neural retina is dissected away from the pigment epithelium and other ocular tissue and then dissociated into a single cell suspension using 0.25% trypsin in Ca 2+ , Mg 2+ -free PBS.
  • the retinas are incubated at 37° C. in this solution for 7-10 minutes after which the trypsin is inactivated by adding 1 ml soybean trypsin inhibitor.
  • the cells are plated at a density of approximately 10,000 cells/ml into 96 well plates in DMEM/F12 supplemented with N 2 .
  • Rho 4D2 ascities or IgG 1:100
  • the results are calculated is % survival: total number of calcein—rhodopsin positive cells at 7-10 days in culture, divided by the total number of rhodopsin positive cells at time 7-10 days in culture.
  • the total cells (fluorescent) are quantified at 20 ⁇ objective magnification using a CCD camera and NIH image software for MacIntosh. Fields in the well are chosen at random.
  • the antiproliferative activity of the compounds disclosed herein can be determined in the investigational, disease-oriented in vitro anti-cancer drug discovery assay of the National Cancer Institute (NCl), using a sulforhodamine B (SRB) dye binding assay essentially is described by Skehan et al., J. Natl. Cancer Inst. 82:1107-1112 (1990).
  • NCl panel The 60 tumor cell lines employed in this study (“the NCl panel”), as well as conditions for their maintenance and culture in vitro, have been described by Monks et al., J. Natl. Cancer Inst. 83:757-766 (1991).
  • This screen is to initially evaluate the cytotoxic and/or cytostatic activity of the test compounds against different types of tumors (Monks et al., supra; Boyd, Cancer: Princ. Pract. Oncol. Update 3(10):1-12 [1989]).
  • Cells from approximately 60 human tumor cell lines are harvested with trypsin/EDTA (Gibco), washed once, resuspended in IMEM and their viability is determined.
  • the cell suspensions are added by pipet (100 ⁇ L volume) into separate 96-well microtiter plates. The cell density for the 6-day incubation is less than for the 2-day incubation to prevent overgrowth. Inoculates are allowed a preincubation period of 24 hours at 37° C. for stabilization. Dilutions at twice the intended test concentration are added at time zero in 100 ⁇ L aliquots to the microtiter plate wells (1:2 dilution). Test compounds are evaluated at five half-log dilutions (1000 to 100.000-fold). Incubations took place for two days and six days in a 5% CO 2 atmosphere and 100% humidity.
  • sulforhodamine B (Sigma) dissolved in 1% acetic acid, rinsed four times with 1% acetic acid to remove unbound dye, dried, and the stain is extracted for five minutes with 0.1 ml of 10 mM Tris base [tris(hydroxymethyl)aminomethane], pH 10.5.
  • the absorbance (OD) of sulforhodamine B at 492 nm is measured using a computer-interfaced, 96-well microtiter plate reader.
  • test sample is considered positive if it shows at least 50% growth inhibitory effect at one or more concentrations.
  • This assay is designed to determine whether the compounds of this invention show the ability to affect glucose or FFA uptake by adipocyte cells.
  • Compounds testing positive in this assay would be expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of disorders where either the stimulation or inhibition of glucose uptake by adipocytes would be beneficial including, for example, obesity, diabetes or hyper- or hypo-insulinemia.
  • compounds to be assayed are added to primary rat adipocytes, and allowed to incubate overnight. Samples are taken at 4 and 16 hours and assayed for glycerol, glucose and FFA uptake. After the 16 hour incubation, insulin is added to the media and allowed to incubate for 4 hours. At this time, a sample is taken and glycerol, glucose and FFA uptake is measured. Media containing insulin without the compound is used as a positive reference control. As the compound being tested may either stimulate or inhibit glucose and FFA uptake, results are scored as positive in the assay if greater than 1.5 times or less than 0.5 times the insulin control.
  • This assay shows whether the compounds of the invention act to induce redifferentiation of chondrocytes, and therefore are expected to be useful for the treatment of various bone and/or cartilage disorders such as, for example, sports injuries and arthritis.
  • the assay is performed as follows. Porcine chondrocytes are isolated by overnight collagenase digestion of articulary cartilage of metacarpophalangeal joints of 4-6 month old female pigs. The isolated cells are then seeded at 25,000 cells/cm 2 in Ham F-12 containing 10% FBS and 4 ⁇ g/ml gentamycin.
  • the culture media is changed every third day and the cells are then seeded in 96 well plates at 5,000 cells/well in 100 ⁇ l of the same media without serum and 100 ⁇ l of the test compound, 5 nM staurosporin (positive control) or medium alone (negative control) is added to give a final volume of 200 ⁇ l/well. After 5 days of incubation at 37° C., a picture of each well is taken and the differentiation state of the chondrocytes is determined. A positive result in the assay occurs when the redifferentiation of the chondrocytes is determined to be more similar to the positive control than the negative control.
  • This assay is useful for screening compounds for the ability to induce the switch from adult hemoglobin to fetal hemoglobin in an erythroblastic cell line.
  • Compounds testing positive in this assay are expected to be useful for therapeutically treating various mammalian hemoglobin-associated disorders such as the various thalassemias.
  • the assay is performed as follows. Erythroblastic cells are plated in standard growth medium at 1000 cells/well in a 96 well format. The tested compound is added to the growth medium at a concentration of 0.2% or 2% and the cells are incubated for 5 days at 37° C. As a positive control, cells are treated with 100 ⁇ M hemin and as a negative control, the cells are untreated. After 5 days, cell lysates are prepared and analyzed for the expression of gamma globin (a fetal marker). A positive in the assay is a gamma globin level at least 2-fold above the negative control.
  • This assay shows whether compounds of the invention act to induce proliferation of mammalian kidney mesangial cells and therefore are useful for treating kidney disorders associated with decreased mesangial cell function such as Berger disease or other nephropathies associated with Schonlein-Henoch purpura, celiac disease, dermatitis herpetiformis or Crohn disease.
  • the assay is performed as follows. On day one, mouse kidney mesangial cells are plated on a 96 well plate in growth media (3:1 mixture of Dulbecco's modified Eagle's medium and Ham's F12 medium, 95% fetal bovine serum, 5% supplemented with 14 mM HEPES) and grown overnight.
  • test compound On day 2, the test compound is diluted at 2 concentrations (1% and 0.1%) in serum-free medium and added to the cells. Control samples are serum-free medium alone. On day 4, 20 ⁇ l of the Cell Titer 96 Aqueous one solution reagent (Progema) was added to each well and the colormetric reaction was allowed to proceed for 2 hours. The absorbance (OD) is then measured at 490 nm. A positive in the assay is an absorbance reading which is at least 15% above the control reading.
  • This assay is used to determine of compounds of the invention act as potent mitogens for inner ear supporting cells which are auditory hair cell progenitors and, therefore, are useful for inducing the regeneration of auditory hair cells and treating hearing loss in mammals.
  • the assay is performed as follows. Rat UEC-4 utricular epithelial cells are aliquoted into 96 well plates with a density of 3000 cells/well in 200 ⁇ l of serum-containing medium at 33° C. The cells are cultured overnight and are then switched to serum-free medium at 37° C. Various dilutions of the compounds (or nothing for a control) are then added to the cultures and the cells are incubated for 24 hours.
  • This assay is designed to determine whether compounds of the present invention show the ability to induce the proliferation and/or redifferentiation of chondrocytes in culture. Compounds testing positive in this assay would be expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of various bone and/or cartilage disorders such as, for example, sports injuries and arthritis.
  • Porcine chondrocytes are isolated by overnight collagenase digestion of articular cartilage of the metacarpophalangeal joint of 4-6 month old female pigs. The isolated cells are then seeded at 25,000 cells/cm 2 in Ham F-12 containing 10% FBS and 4 ⁇ g/ml gentamycin. The culture media is changed every third day and the cells are reseeded to 25,000 cells/cm 2 every five days. On day 12, the cells are seeded in 96 well plates at 5,000 cells/well in 100 ⁇ l of the same media without serum and 100 ⁇ l of either serum-free medium (negative control), staurosporin (final concentration of 5 nM; positive control) or the test compound are added to give a final volume of 200 ⁇ l/well.
  • This assay is designed to determine whether the compounds of the present invention show the ability to inhibit neonatal heart hypertrophy induced by LIF and endothelin-1 (ET-1).
  • a test compound that provides a positive response in the present assay would be useful for the therapeutic treatment of cardiac insufficiency diseases or disorders characterized or associated with an undesired hypertrophy of the cardiac muscle.
  • Cardiac myocytes from 1-day old Harlan Sprague Dawley rats (180 ⁇ l at 7.5 ⁇ 10 4 /ml, serum ⁇ 0.1, freshly isolated) are introduced on day 1 to 96-well plates previously coated with DMEM/F12+4% FCS.
  • Test compound samples or growth medium alone (negative control) are then added directly to the wells on day 2 in 20 ⁇ l volume.
  • LIF+ET-1 are then added to the wells on day 3. The cells are stained after an additional 2 days in culture and are then scored visually the next day. A positive in the assay occurs when the compound treated myocytes are visually smaller on the average or less numerous than the untreated myocytes.

Abstract

Hybrid immunoglobulins containing moving parts are provided as well as related compositions and methods of use and methods of production. In addition, analogous genetic devices are provided as well as related compositions and methods of use and methods of production.

Description

  • This application claims benefit of U.S. Provisional Application No. 60/856,864, filed Nov. 2, 2006, the contents of which are hereby incorporated by reference into this application.
  • Throughout this application, various publications are referenced. The disclosures of these publications in their entireties are hereby incorporated by reference into this application in order to more fully describe the state of the art as known to those skilled therein as of the date of the invention described and claimed herein.
  • BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
  • All machines and devices have moving parts. The function of the moving parts is to perform work, by transforming a source of energy, in order to carry out a useful task. Moving parts cover a spectrum of sizes and shapes. At one end of the spectrum is a visible world evident in machines that perform mechanical tasks. At the other end of the spectrum is an invisible world of charge carriers utilized by devices that carry out electrical work.
  • This spectrum is so vast that certain of its regions have only begun to be technologically exploited. Among these are devices with moving parts of several nano-meters to several hundred nano-meters. This size range holds considerable interest to many scientists and engineers because it is comparable to the very size of molecules, the fundamental units of chemical matter. Nano-machines have the potential to exploit the unique properties of molecules, such as intermolecular binding or catalysis.
  • The ability to make molecules of any imaginable size and shape is one activity crucial in building nano-machines. As such it has been widely anticipated in medicine, electronics, optics, and many other fields. Tremendous commercial activity has been focused on the synthesis very large numbers of chemically distinct molecules. However, molecular configuration (differences in bonding) is just one practical means of generating diversity. Molecular conformation (differences in bond rotation) offers another important avenue for generating a universe of continuous size and shape.
  • Molecular conformation has certain unique advantages in strategies for creating molecules with moving parts. While atoms and chemical bonds have precise linear and angular dimensions, conformational change can provide limitless variation in the size and shape of molecules. Covalent and non-covalent chemical bonds both afford rotational degrees of freedom. Dihedral rotation around each of a series of bonds connecting distinct parts (domains) of a molecule is capable of providing the essential dynamic ingredient of nano-machines.
  • In general, any two given atoms interconnected by a single bond (i.e., a single electron pair) can rotate fully 360 degrees with respect to each other and with respect to the other atoms that each is bonded to. A series of consecutive single bonds is like a series of interconnected ball joints. Although limited to rotary motions, a series of consecutive single bonds, like a series of consecutive ball joints, can recapitulate the movement of other types of interconnected moving parts (e.g., a series of consecutive hinges).
  • One challenging aspect of creating useful nano-machines is striking a balance in the number of moving parts and the number of interconnections. Above a certain threshold, increasing the number of parts or connections in any machine is counterproductive. Thus automobile engines employ an optimal number of pistons, valves, camshafts, pulleys, and so forth.
  • The analogous challenge in the chemical field is illustrated by two related, but very different types of molecules, namely organic and biological polymers. A good comparison is provided by polyethylene and proteins. Polyethylenes are stretches of consecutive ethylenes, (CH2)n, interconnected by consecutive single bonds (—C—)n, while proteins are stretches of consecutive amino acids, (NHCHRCO)n, interconnected by consecutive peptide bonds (═N—C—C═)n. Unbranched polyethylenes are repeating chains of single bonds, while proteins are repeating chains of one double bond followed by two single bonds. The most important difference between these two types of chains is that polyethylene can adopt almost any conformation and thus has no definite size or shape (only a statistically averaged one), while proteins are extremely rigid and thus have very definite (and unchanging) size and shape.
  • A simple but reasonable comparison to a mechanical device would represent polyethylene as a machine with a high ratio of moving parts to connections, and a protein as a machine with an low ratio of moving parts to connections. Neither molecule is very suited to a machine-like task unless one takes advantage of higher order structures that each can form. For example, polyethylene is useful when its ability to form intermolecular fibers is exploited. Interesting, the ability of polyethylene to display such tertiary structure depends upon its inherent flexibility. Although some proteins can form fibers of commercial value (e.g., silk, wool and collagen), most proteins are globular and do not.
  • Globular proteins are, for nearly all practical purposes, machines with few if any moving parts, like a crowbar that must exert its leverage in combination with other objects, such as the human that wields it and the objects against which it is wedged. Notwithstanding, there are many instances in which there would be great value to protein-like molecules having distinct regions (e.g., binding domains) that are joined together in some manner permitting relative, yet coordinated movement. One example would be protein-like molecules capable of cooperatively binding a disease target having two or more identical binding sites. This would take full advantage of the unique properties of globular protein binding domains, namely their great specificity for targets, particularly other proteins associated with disease.
  • The potential commercial value of protein-like molecules that are able to cooperatively bind a disease target may be estimated quantitatively. A starting assumption is that most therapeutics in current use, whether small molecules or biopharmaceuticals, typically bind their targets non-cooperatively with affinity constants on the order of nano-molar (10−9 M). Remarkably, a cooperative therapeutic could conceivably bind the same target, with an affinity of nano-molar×nano-molar (10−9 M×10−9 M) [i.e., atto-molar (10−18 M)].
  • Because therapeutics are typically required in great molar excess over their targets (about one million-fold), a cooperative therapeutic would thus be equivalent to a non-cooperative therapeutic at a 10−6 smaller dose. For many current biopharmaceuticals (e.g. antibodies and immunoadhesins) this difference amounts to 1 microgram per single dose instead of 1 gram per single dose. With patient costs exceeding $1,000 per gram, this factor has great significance in new drug discovery and development as well as for existing biopharmaceuticals.
  • One irony associated with antibodies and immunoadhesins is that while they are symmetric proteins having two identical binding domains, they do not generally bind symmetrically to symmetric targets. The inflexible connections between the two binding domains do not provide the machine-like motion that would permit cooperative binding. Numerous attempts to engineer antibodies and immunoadhesins that bind symmetrically have failed because of the difficulty in achieving the precise geometry needed for complementary symmetries between the binding sites and target sites. Unlike materials used to make conventional machines, such as wood, metals, plastics, ceramics, and the like, molecules cannot simply be cut, wrought, cast, machined or joined to an exact size and shape.
  • While cooperative binding is thus not readily achieved with any single fixed size and shape, conformational flexibility between binding domains does provides a potential solution. A “one size fits all” strategy is based upon the proposition that a protein-like molecule with binding domains that move symmetrically will also be capable of binding symmetrically (i.e., cooperativity) The binding domains are driven thermodynamically into a conformation most compatible with simultaneous binding of both target sites because it represents the energetically favored conformational minima.
  • SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
  • In an embodiment this invention provides a compound comprising a first stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which comprises a binding site for a target; and a second stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which is identical to the sequence of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and which comprises an identical binding site for the target; wherein each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids has at a predefined end thereof a cysteine residue or a selenocysteine residue and such cysteine residues or such selenocysteine residues are joined by a bond having the structure:
  • Figure US20080254512A1-20081016-C00001
  • wherein each X is the same and represents a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and each C represents a beta-carbon of one of such cysteine or selenocysteine residues.
  • In an embodiment this invention also provides a compound comprising a first stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which comprises a binding site for a target; and a second stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which is different from the sequence of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and which comprises a binding site for a different moiety; wherein each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids has at a predefined end thereof a cysteine residue or a selenocysteine residue and such residues are joined by a bond having the structure:
  • Figure US20080254512A1-20081016-C00002
  • wherein each X may be the same or different and represents a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and each C represents a beta-carbon of one of such cysteine or selenocysteine residues.
  • Genetic devices disclosed herein comprise two or more stretches of consecutive amino acids that are connected at a predefined terminus by a non-peptide bond. Such genetic devices are both symmetric and symmetrically binding with respect to one or more important targets (i.e., cooperative). The genetic devices herein are protein-like molecules may be described by a number of related terms that include symmetroadhesins, immuno-symmetroadhesins, hemi-symmetroadhesins, and bi-symmetroadhesins [meaning “stick to proportionately,” from the Gk. symmetros “having a common measure, even, proportionate,” and the L. adhaerentem, prp. of adhaerere “stick to”].
  • Disclosed herein is a compound comprising two or more independently-folding protein domains linked to one another through one or more non-peptide bonds, around which bond(s) dihedral rotation may occur.
  • BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE FIGURES
  • FIG. 1: Stretches of consecutive amino acids, with one X-terminus, depicting positions of N-, C-, S-, and Se-termini. N-terminal and C-terminal amino acid residues, drawn as a Newman-style projection, are shown above and below the projection plane, respectively: (i) A stretch of consecutive amino acids (generalized structure), having, an N-terminal amino acid residue (sidechain=R1) having a free α-amino (NH2) group, and a C-terminal amino acid residue (sidechain=Rn) having a free α-carboxyl (COOH) group. (ii) A stretch of consecutive amino acids, with N-terminal S-terminus, having, an N-terminal cysteine having free α-amino (NH2) and β-sulfhydryl (SH) groups, and a C-terminal amino acid residue having a free α-carboxyl (COOH) group. (iii) A stretch of consecutive amino acids, with C-terminal S-terminus, having, an N-terminal amino acid residue having a free α-amino (NH2) group, and a C-terminal cysteine having free α-carboxyl (COOH) and β-sulfhydryl (SH) groups. (iv) A stretch of consecutive amino acids, with N-terminal Se-terminus, having, an N-terminal selenocysteine having free α-amino (NH2) and β-selenohydryl (SeH) groups, and a C-terminal amino acid residue having a free α-carboxyl (COOH) group. (v) A stretch of consecutive amino acids, with C-terminal Se-terminus, having, a N-terminal amino acid residue having a free α-amino (NH2) group, and a C-terminal selenocysteine having free α-carboxyl (COOH) and β-selenohydryl (SeH) groups.
  • FIG. 2: Stretches of consecutive amino acids, with two X-termini, depicting positions of N-, C-, S-, and Se-termini. N-terminal and C-terminal amino acid residues, drawn as a Newman-style projection, are shown above and below the projection plane, respectively. (i) A stretch of consecutive amino acids, with two X-termini (generalized structure), having, an N-terminal amino acid residue (sidechain=X1) having a free α-amino (NH2) group, and a C-terminal amino acid residue (sidechain=Xn) having a free α-carboxyl (COOH) group. (ii) A stretch of consecutive amino acids, with N-terminal S-terminus and C-terminal S-terminus, having, an N-terminal cysteine having free α-amino (NH2) and β-sulfhydryl (SH) groups, and a C-terminal cysteine having free α-carboxyl (COOH) and β-sulfhydryl (SH) groups. (iii) A stretch of consecutive amino acids, with N-terminal S-terminus and C-terminal Se-terminus, having, an N-terminal cysteine having free α-amino (NH2) and β-sulfhydryl (SH) groups, and a C-terminal selenocysteine having free α-carboxyl (COOH) and β-selenohydryl (SeH) groups. (iv) A stretch of consecutive amino acids, with N-terminal Se-terminus and C-terminal S-terminus, having, an N-terminal selenocysteine having free α-amino (NH2) and β-selenohydryl (SeH) groups, and a C-terminal cysteine having free α-carboxyl (COOH) and β-sulfhydryl (SH) groups. (v) A stretch of consecutive amino acids, with N-terminal Se-terminus and C-terminal Se-terminus, having, an N-terminal selenocysteine having free α-amino (NH2) and β-selenohydryl (SeH) groups, and a C-terminal selenocysteine having free α-carboxyl (COOH) and β-selenohydryl (SeH) groups.
  • FIG. 3: General structure of a chimeric polypeptide consisting of a first stretch of consecutive amino acids joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a second stretch of consecutive amino acids. Chimeric polypeptides, like proteins found in nature, are continuous stretches of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond. Like other proteins, chimeric polypeptides have limited conformational flexibility because the peptide bond by itself provides no more than two consecutive single bonds capable of dihedral rotation along the polypeptide chain. Amino acid residues in the figure are numbered as follows: The first stretch of consecutive amino acids has length=n residues, and numbering=1, 2, 3, . . . , (n−2), (n−1), n. The second stretch of consecutive amino acids has length=p residues, and numbering=1′, 2′, 3′, . . . , (p−a2), (p−a1), p. The chimeric polypeptide has length=(n+p) residues, and numbering=1, 2, 3, . . . , (n−2), (n−1), n, (n+1), (n+2), (n+3), (n+p−2), (n+p−1), (n+p). The major and minor tautomeric forms and the resonance structure are shown on the left, center and right, respectively.
  • FIG. 4A: General structure of a “symmetroadhesin” with a head-to-tail configuration consisting of a first stretch of consecutive amino acids joined at its C-terminal-X-terminus by an -X-X- bond to the N-terminal-X-terminus of a second stretch of consecutive amino acids. The -X-X- bond is not a peptide bond. Non-limiting examples of the bonds envisaged here include any combination wherein each X is a S or a Se atom. The overall polarity of head-to-tail symmetroadhesins is N- to C-terminal. Symmetroadhesins, like proteins, are stretches of consecutive amino acids each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid, but differ from proteins by substituting one or more -X-X- bonds for peptide bonds. Symmetroadhesins have greater conformational flexibility than polypeptides because each -X-X- bond provides seven adjacent single bonds capable of dihedral rotation. Amino acid residues are numbered as follows: The first stretch of consecutive amino acids has length=n residues, and numbering=1, 2, 3, . . . , (n−2), (n−1), n. The second stretch of consecutive amino acids has length=p residues, and numbering=1′, 2′, 3′, (p−a2), (p−a1), p. The head-to-tail symmetroadhesin has length=(n+p) residues, and numbering=1, 2, 3, . . . , (n−2), (n−1), n, (n+1), (n+2), (n+3), . . . , (n+p−2), (n+p−1), (n+p). The major and minor tautomeric forms and the resonance structure are shown on the left, center and right, respectively.
  • FIG. 4B: The symmetroadhesin of FIG. 4A (left) compared with a symmetroadhesin (right) consisting of a first stretch of consecutive amino acids joined at the X-terminus of its penultimate C-terminal residue by an -X-X- bond to the X-terminus of the penultimate N-terminal residue of a second stretch of consecutive amino acids. Resonance structures are shown for each.
  • FIG. 4C: The symmetroadhesin of FIG. 4A (left) compared with a symmetroadhesin (right) consisting of a first stretch of consecutive amino acids joined at the X-terminus of its antepenultimate C-terminal residue by an -X-X- bond to the X-terminus of the antepenultimate N-terminal residue of a second stretch of consecutive amino acids. Resonance structures are shown for each.
  • FIG. 4D: The symmetroadhesin of FIG. 4A (left) compared with a symmetroadhesin (right) consisting of a first stretch of consecutive amino acids joined at the X-terminus of its preantepenultimate C-terminal residue by an -X-X- bond to the X-terminus of the preantepenultimate N-terminal residue of a second stretch of consecutive amino acids. Resonance structures are shown for each.
  • FIG. 5: General structure of a symmetroadhesin with a head-to-head configuration consisting of a first stretch of consecutive amino acids, joined at its N-terminal-X-terminus by an -X-X- bond to the N-terminal-X-terminus of a second stretch of consecutive amino acids. The overall polarity of head-to-head symmetroadhesins changes at the position of the -X-X- bond, going from C- to N-terminal to N- to C-terminal. Amino acid residues are numbered as follows: The first stretch of consecutive amino acids has length=n residues, and numbering=1, 2, 3, . . . , (n−2), (n−1), n. The second stretch of consecutive amino acids has length=p residues, and numbering=1′, 2′, 3′, (p−a2), (p−a1), p. The head-to-head symmetroadhesin has length=(n+p) residues, and numbering=n, (n−1), (n−2), . . . , 3, 2, 1, (inversion), 1′, 2′, 3′, . . . , (p−a2), (p−a1), p. The major and minor tautomeric forms and the resonance structure are shown on the left, center and right, respectively.
  • FIG. 6: General structure of a symmetroadhesin with a tail-to-tail configuration consisting of a first stretch of consecutive amino acids joined at its C-terminal-X-terminus by an -X-X- bond to the C-terminal-X-terminus of a second stretch of consecutive amino acids. The overall polarity of tail-to-tail symmetroadhesins changes at the position of the -X-X- bond, going from N- to C-terminal to C- to N-terminal. Amino acid residues are numbered as follows: The first stretch of consecutive amino acids has length=n residues, and numbering=1, 2, 3, . . . , (n−2), (n−1), n. The second stretch of consecutive amino acids has length=p residues, and numbering=1′, 2′, 3′, (p−a2), (p−a1), p. The tail-to-tail symmetroadhesin has length=n+p residues, and numbering=1, 2, 3, . . . , (n−2), (n−1), n, (inversion), p, (p−a1), (p−a2), . . . , 3′, 2′, 1′. The major and minor tautomeric forms and the resonance structure are shown on the left, center and right, respectively.
  • FIG. 7: A schematic representation of a head-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesin showing the all-trans conformation. All of the seven consecutive single bonds joining the C-terminal-X-terminus with the N-terminal-X-terminus are trans (N—C—C—X—X—C—C—C). The two binding domains are pointed away from one another in this conformation; a rotation of 180 degrees around any one of the seven consecutive single bonds will point the two binding domains towards one another. Hemi-symmetroadhesins with the head-to-tail configuration are asymmetric molecules regardless of conformation (compare FIGS. 7 and 8); however, two or more head-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesins can together form a symmetric molecule.
  • FIG. 8: A schematic representation of a head-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesin showing the X-cis-X conformation. All but one of seven consecutive single bonds joining the C-terminal-X-terminus with the N-terminal-X-terminus are trans (N—C—C—X-cis-X—C—C—C). The two binding domains are pointed towards one another in this conformation; further rotations of 180 degrees around any one of the seven consecutive single bonds will point the two binding domains away from one another. Hemi-symmetroadhesins with the head-to-tail configuration are asymmetric molecules regardless of conformation (compare FIGS. 7 and 8); however, two or more head-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesins can together form a symmetric molecule.
  • FIG. 9: A schematic representation of a head-to-head hemi-symmetroadhesin showing the all-trans conformation. All of the seven consecutive single bonds joining the 1st N-terminal-X-terminus and 2nd N-terminal-X-terminus are trans (C—C—C—X—X—C—C—C). The two binding domains are pointed away from one another in this conformation; a rotation of 180 degrees around any one of the seven consecutive single bonds will point the two binding domains towards one another. Hemi-symmetroadhesins with the head-to-head configuration are symmetric molecules in only two of their possible conformations: the all-trans and the X-cis-X (compare FIGS. 9 and 10); however, two or more head-to-head hemi-symmetroadhesins subunits can form a molecule that has an unlimited number of symmetric conformations.
  • FIG. 10: A schematic representation of a head-to-head hemi-symmetroadhesin showing the X-cis-X conformation. All but one of the seven consecutive single bonds joining the 1st N-terminal-X-terminus and 2nd N-terminal-X-terminus are trans (C—C—C—X-cis-X—C—C—C). The two binding domains are pointed towards one another in this conformation; further rotations of 180 degrees around any one of the seven consecutive single bonds will point the two binding domains away from one another. Hemi-symmetroadhesins with the head-to-head configuration are symmetric molecules in only two of their possible conformations: the all-trans and the X-cis-X (compare FIGS. 9 and 10); however, two or more head-to-head hemi-symmetroadhesins subunits can form a molecule that has an unlimited number of symmetric conformations.
  • FIG. 11: A schematic representation of a tail-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesin showing the all-trans conformation. All of the seven consecutive single bonds joining the 1st C-terminal-X-terminus and 2nd C-terminal-X-terminus are trans (N—C—C—X—X—C—C—N). The two binding domains are pointed away from one another in this conformation; a rotation of 180 degrees around any one of the seven consecutive single bonds will point the two binding domains towards one another. Hemi-symmetroadhesins with the tail-to-tail configuration are symmetric molecules in only two of their possible conformations: the all-trans and the X-cis-X (compare FIGS. 11 and 12); however, two or more tail-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesins subunits can form a molecule that has an unlimited number of symmetric conformations.
  • FIG. 12: A schematic representation of a tail-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesin showing the X-cis-X conformation. All but one of the seven consecutive single bonds joining the 1st C-terminal-X-terminus and 2nd C-terminal-X-terminus are trans (N—C—C—X-cis-X—C—C—N). The two binding domains are pointed towards one another in this conformation; further rotations of 180 degrees around any one of the seven consecutive single bonds will point the two binding domains away from one another. Hemi-symmetroadhesins with the tail-to-tail configuration are symmetric molecules in only two of their possible conformations: the all-trans and the X-cis-X (compare FIGS. 9 and 10); however, two or more tail-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesins subunits can form a molecule that has an unlimited number of symmetric conformations.
  • FIG. 13: A schematic representation of a tail-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesin consisting of two immunoglobulin Fab binding domains. The all-trans conformation is shown here. All of the seven consecutive single bonds joining the 1st C-terminal-X-terminus and 2nd C-terminal-X-terminus are trans (N—C—C—X—X—C—C—N). The two Fab binding domains are pointed away from one another in this conformation; a rotation of 180 degrees around any one of the seven consecutive single bonds will point the Fab binding domains towards one another (compare FIGS. 13 and 14). The heavy chain regions are joined together by the X-X bond; the light chain regions are joined to the heavy chain regions by internal disulfide bonds. Abbreviations: VL, light chain variable region; CL, light chain constant region; VH, heavy chain variable region; CH1, heavy chain constant region 1.
  • FIG. 14: A schematic representation of a tail-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesin consisting of two immunoglobulin Fab binding domains. The X-cis-X conformation is shown here. All but one of seven consecutive single bonds joining the 1st C-terminal-X-terminus and 2nd C-terminal-X-terminus are trans (N—C—C—X-cis-X—C—C—N). The two Fab binding domains are pointed towards one another in this conformation; further rotation of 180 degrees around any one of the seven consecutive single bonds will point the Fab binding domains away from one another (compare FIGS. 13 and 14). The heavy chain regions are joined together by the X-X bond; the light chain regions are joined to the heavy chain regions by internal disulfide bonds. Abbreviations: VL, light chain variable region; CL, light chain constant region; VH, heavy chain variable region; CH1, heavy chain constant region 1.
  • FIG. 15: Schematic representation of the immunoadhesin molecule (Capon et al. (1989) Nature 337, 525-530). Immunoadhesins are chimeric polypeptides that form disulfide-linked dimers. Each chimeric polypeptide consists of a binding domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of an immunoglobulin Fc domain. Although immunoadhesins are structurally symmetric, they do not generally bind cooperatively to dimeric or multimeric target molecules. Abbreviations: CH2, heavy chain constant region 2; CH3, heavy chain constant region 3.
  • FIG. 16: Schematic representation of the immunoglobulin (antibody) molecule. Immunoglobulins are heterotetramers consisting of two heavy chains and two light chains. Although immunoglobulins are structurally symmetric, they do not generally bind cooperatively to dimeric or multimeric target molecules. Abbreviations: VL, light chain variable region; CL, light chain constant region; VH, heavy chain variable region; CH1, heavy chain constant region 1; CH2, heavy chain constant region 2; CH3, heavy chain constant region 3.
  • FIG. 17: A schematic representation of a head-to-tail immunosymmetroadhesin showing the all-trans conformation. Head-to-tail immunosymmetroadhesins are head-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesins that form disulfide-linked dimers. Each hemi-symmetroadhesin consists of an immunoglobulin Fab binding domain having a C-terminal-X-terminus joined by an -X-X- bond to a immunoglobulin Fc subunit having an N-terminal-X-terminus. The dimer contains two functional Fab binding domains and one functional Fc binding domain. The seven consecutive single bonds which join each Fab domain to an Fc subunit are all trans (N—C—C—X—X—C—C—C). Symmetric rotations of 180 degrees around the first (N—C), third (C—X), fifth (X—C), or seventh (C—C) pairs of consecutive single bonds will move the two Fab domains in a first general direction (compare FIGS. 17 and 18). Symmetric rotations of 180 degrees around the second (C—C), fourth (X—X), or sixth (C—C) single bond pairs will move the two Fab domains in a second general direction (compare FIGS. 17 and 19).
  • FIG. 18: A schematic representation of a head-to-tail immunosymmetroadhesin showing the X-cis-C conformation. The X-cis-C conformation is obtained from the all-trans conformation by the symmetric rotation of the fifth pair of seven consecutive single bonds (N—C—C—X—X-cis-C—C—C) (compare FIGS. 17 and 18). Other conformations that are similar to the X-cis-C conformation shown here are obtained from the all-trans conformation following the symmetric rotation of the first (N-cis-C—C—X—X—C—C—C), the third (N—C—C-cis-X—X—C—C—C), or the seventh pairs (N—C—C—X—X—C—C-cis-C) of consecutive single bonds.
  • FIG. 19: A schematic representation of a head-to-tail immunosymmetroadhesin showing the X-cis-X conformation. The X-cis-X conformation is obtained from the all-trans conformation by the symmetric rotation of the fourth pair of seven consecutive single bonds (N—C—C—X-cis-X—C—C—C) (compare FIGS. 17 and 19). Other conformations that are similar to the X-cis-X conformation shown here are obtained from the all-trans conformation following the symmetric rotation of the second (N—C-cis-C—X—X—C-C—C), or the sixth pairs (N—C-C—X—X—C-cis-C—C) of consecutive single bonds.
  • FIG. 20: A schematic representation of a tail-to-tail immunosymmetroadhesin showing the all-trans conformation. Tail-to-tail immunosymmetroadhesins are tail-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesins that form disulfide-linked dimers. Each hemi-symmetroadhesin consists of an immunoglobulin Fab binding domain having a C-terminal-X-terminus joined by an X-X bond to an immunoglobulin Fc subunit having a C-terminal-X-terminus. The dimer contains two functional Fab binding domains and one functional Fc binding domain. The seven consecutive single bonds which join each Fab domain to an Fc subunit are all trans (N—C—C—X—X—C—C—N). Symmetric rotations of 180 degrees around the first (N—C), third (C—X), fifth (X—C), or seventh (C—N) pairs of consecutive single bonds will move the two Fab domains in a first general direction (compare FIGS. 20 and 21). Symmetric rotations of 180 degrees around the second (C—C), fourth (X—X), or sixth (C—C) single bond pairs will move the two Fab domains in a second general direction (compare FIGS. 20 and 22).
  • FIG. 21: A schematic representation of a tail-to-tail immunosymmetroadhesin showing the X-cis-C conformation. The X-cis-C conformation is obtained from the all-trans conformation by the symmetric rotation of the fifth pair of seven consecutive single bonds (N—C—C—X—X-cis-C—C—N) (compare FIGS. 20 and 21). Other conformations that are similar to the X-cis-C conformation shown here are obtained from the all-trans conformation following the symmetric rotation of the first (N-cis-C—C—X—X—C—C—N), the third (N—C—C-cis-X—X—C—C—N), or the seventh pairs (N—C—C—X—X—C—C-cis-N) of consecutive single bonds.
  • FIG. 22: A schematic representation of a tail-to-tail immunosymmetroadhesin showing the X-cis-X conformation. The X-cis-X conformation is obtained from the all-trans conformation by the symmetric rotation of the fourth pair of seven consecutive single bonds (N—C—C—X-cis-X—C—C—N) (compare FIGS. 20 and 22). Other conformations that are similar to the X-cis-X conformation shown here are obtained from the all-trans conformation following the symmetric rotation of the second (N—C-cis-C—X—X—C—C—N), or the sixth pairs (N—C—C—X—X—C-cis-C—N) of consecutive single bonds.
  • FIG. 23: Schematic representation of bi-symmetroadhesin with four Fab binding domains, showing the all-trans conformation. The molecule is a dimer of two hemi-symmetroadhesins each consisting of three stretches of consecutive amino acids. The bi-symmetroadhesin shown here is a head-to-tail, tail-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesin that forms disulfide-linked dimers. Each hemi-symmetroadhesin consists of two immunoglobulin Fab domains having a C-terminal-X-terminus that is joined by an -X-X- bond to a immunoglobulin Fc subunit; the first Fab domain is joined to the Fc N-terminal-X-terminus, and the second Fab is joined to the Fc C-terminal-X-terminus. The dimer has four functional Fab binding domains, and one functional Fc binding domain. The seven consecutive single bonds which join all four Fab domains to an Fc subunit are all trans (N—C—C—X—X—C—C—C/N). Symmetric rotations of 180 degrees around the first (N—C), third (C—X), fifth (X—C), or seventh (C—C/N) pairs of consecutive single bonds will move the four Fab domains in a first general direction (compare FIGS. 23 and 24). Symmetric rotations of 180 degrees around the second (C—C), fourth (X—X), or sixth (C—C) single bond pairs will move the four Fab domains in a second general direction (compare FIGS. 23 and 25).
  • FIG. 24: Schematic representation of the X-cis-C conformation of a bi-immunosymmetroadhesin consisting of four Fab binding domains and one Fc domain. The molecule is a dimer of two hemi-symmetroadhesins each consisting of three stretches of consecutive amino acids.
  • FIG. 25: Schematic representation of the X-cis-X conformation of a bi-immunosymmetroadhesin consisting of four Fab binding domains and one Fc domain. The molecule is a dimer of two hemi-symmetroadhesins each consisting of three stretches of consecutive amino acids.
  • FIG. 26: Schematic representation of the all-trans conformation of a bi-immunosymmetroadhesin consisting of two Fab binding domains, one Fc domain, and two non-Fab binding domains. The molecule is a dimer of two hemi-symmetroadhesins each consisting of three stretches of consecutive amino acids. The bi-symmetroadhesin shown here is a head-to-tail, tail-to-tail hemi-symmetroadhesin that forms disulfide-linked dimers. Each hemi-symmetroadhesin consists of one immunoglobulin Fab domain having a C-terminal-X-terminus that is joined by an -X-X- bond to the N-terminal-X-terminus of an immunoglobulin Fc subunit, and one non-immunoglobulin binding domain having a C-terminal-X-terminus that is joined by an -X-X- bond to the C-terminal-X-terminus of an immunoglobulin Fc subunit. The dimer has two functional Fab binding domains, two functional non-immunoglobulin binding domains, and one functional Fc binding domain. The seven consecutive single bonds which join all four binding domain to an Fc subunit are all trans (N—C—C—X—X—C—C—C/N). Symmetric rotations of 180 degrees around the first (N—C), third (C—X), fifth (X—C), or seventh (C—C/N) pairs of consecutive single bonds will move the four binding domains in a first general direction (compare FIGS. 26 and 27). Symmetric rotations of 180 degrees around the second (C—C), fourth (X—X), or sixth (C—C) single bond pairs will move the four binding domains in a second general direction (compare FIGS. 26 and 28).
  • FIG. 27: Schematic representation of the X-cis-C conformation of a bi-immunosymmetroadhesin consisting of two Fab binding domains, one Fc domain, and two non-Fab binding domains. The molecule is a dimer of two hemi-symmetroadhesins each consisting of three stretches of consecutive amino acids.
  • FIG. 28: Schematic representation of the X-cis-X conformation of a bi-immunosymmetroadhesin consisting of two Fab binding domains, one Fc domain, and two non-Fab binding domains. The molecule is a dimer of two hemi-symmetroadhesins each consisting of three stretches of consecutive amino acids.
  • FIG. 29: Schematic representation of an immunoglobulin binding to a first symmetric target. The interaction is symmetric and cooperative. Both targets are bound by both immunoglobulins.
  • FIG. 30: Schematic representation of a symmetroadhesin binding to a first symmetric target. The interaction is symmetric and cooperative. Both targets are bound by both symmetroadhesins in a first conformation (all-trans).
  • FIG. 31: Schematic representation of an immunoglobulin binding to a second symmetric target. The interaction is neither symmetric and nor cooperative. Only one target is bound by each immunoglobulin.
  • FIG. 32: Schematic representation of a symmetroadhesin binding to a second symmetric target. The interaction is symmetric and cooperative. Both targets are bound by both symmetroadhesins in a second conformation (X-cis-C).
  • FIG. 33: Schematic representation of an immunoglobulin binding to a third symmetric target. The interaction is neither symmetric and nor cooperative. Only one target is bound by each immunoglobulin.
  • FIG. 34: Schematic representation of a symmetroadhesin binding to a third symmetric target. The interaction is symmetric and cooperative. Both targets are bound by both symmetroadhesins in a third conformation (X-cis-X).
  • FIG. 35A: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide synthetic intermediates of a human IgG1 Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with an N-terminal-S-terminus. Part (i) shows three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human sonic hedgehog (SHH), human interferon alpha-2 (IFN), or human cholesterol ester transferase (CETP) signal sequences (residues −23 to −1, −23 to −1, or −17 to −1, respectively), and the human IGHG1 Fc domain (residues 1 to 228) beginning at the fifth amino acid encoded by the hinge exon, CDKTHTCPPCP (Ellison et al. (1982) Nuc. Acids Res. 10, 4071-4079). The three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides have lengths of 251, 251 and 245 residues, respectively. Part (ii) shows the mature Fc domain (length=228) with an N-terminal-S-terminus. The N-terminal cysteine residue is underlined. (IGHG1, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P01857, Ig gamma-1 chain C region, Homo sapiens).
  • FIG. 35B: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide synthetic intermediates of a human IgG2 Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with an N-terminal-S-terminus. Part (i) shows three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human sonic hedgehog (SHH), human interferon alpha-2 (IFN), or human cholesterol ester transferase (CETP) signal sequences (residues −23 to −1, −23 to −1, or −17 to −1, respectively), and the human IGHG2 Fc domain (residues 1 to 225) beginning at the fourth amino acid encoded by the hinge exon, CCVECPPCP (Ellison et al. (1982) Nuc. Acids Res. 10, 4071-4079). The three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides have lengths of 248, 248 and 242 residues, respectively. Part (ii) shows the mature Fc domain (length=225) with an N-terminal-S-terminus. The N-terminal cysteine residue is underlined. (IGHG2, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P01859, Ig gamma-2 chain C region, Homo sapiens).
  • FIG. 35C: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide synthetic intermediates of a human IgG3 Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with an N-terminal-S-terminus. Part (i) shows three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human sonic hedgehog (SHH), human interferon alpha-2 (IFN), or human cholesterol ester transferase (CETP) signal sequences (residues −23 to −1, −23 to −1, or −17 to −1, respectively), and the human IGHG3 Fc domain (residues 1 to 267) beginning at the thirteenth amino acid encoded by the first hinge exon, CPRCP (Strausberg et al. (2002) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 99, 16899-1690). The three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides have lengths of 290, 290 and 284 residues, respectively. Part (ii) shows the mature Fc domain (length=267) with an N-terminal-S-terminus. The N-terminal cysteine residue is underlined. (IGHG3, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry Q8N4Y9, Ig gamma-3 chain C region, Homo sapiens).
  • FIG. 35D: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide synthetic intermediates of a human IgG4 Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with an N-terminal-S-terminus. Part (i) shows three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human sonic hedgehog (SHH), human interferon alpha-2 (IFN), or human cholesterol ester transferase (CETP) signal sequences (residues −23 to −1, −23 to −1, or −17 to −1, respectively), and the human IGHG4 Fc domain (residues 1 to 222) beginning at the eighth amino acid encoded by the hinge exon, CPSCP (Strausberg et al. (2002) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 99, 16899-1690). The three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides have lengths of 245, 245 and 239 residues, respectively. Part (ii) shows the mature Fc domain (length=222) with an N-terminal-S-terminus. The N-terminal cysteine residue is underlined. (IGHG4, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry Q8TC63, Ig gamma-4 chain C region, Homo sapiens).
  • FIG. 36A: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide synthetic intermediates of a human Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with an N-terminal-X-terminus. Part (i) shows three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human sonic hedgehog (SHH), human interferon alpha-2 (IFN), or human cholesterol ester transferase (CETP) signal sequences (residues −23 to −1, −23 to −1, or −17 to −1, respectively), and the human IGHG1 Fc domain (residues 1 to 222) beginning at the eleventh amino acid encoded by the hinge exon, CPPCP (Ellison et al. (1982) Nuc. Acids Res. 10, 4071-4079). The three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides have lengths of 245, 245 and 239 residues, respectively. Part (ii) shows the mature Fc domain (length=222) having an N-terminal-S-terminus. The N-terminal cysteine residue is underlined. Part (iii) shows the mature Fc domain extended by native chemical ligation (length=226) to have an N-terminal-X-terminus. The N-terminal X amino acid (e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine) is underlined; it is followed by the sixth amino acid encoded by the hinge exon, XDKTHTCPPCP. (IGHG1, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P01857, Ig gamma-1 chain C region, Homo sapiens).
  • FIG. 36B: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide synthetic intermediates of a human Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with an N-terminal-X-terminus. Part (i) shows three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human sonic hedgehog (SHH), human interferon alpha-2 (IFN), or human cholesterol ester transferase (CETP) signal sequences (residues −23 to −1, −23 to −1, or −17 to −1, respectively), and the human IGHG1 Fc domain (residues 1 to 219) beginning at the fourteenth amino acid encoded by the hinge exon, CP (Ellison et al. (1982) Nuc. Acids Res. 10, 4071-4079). The three distinct pre-Fc polypeptides have lengths of 242, 242 and 236 residues, respectively. Part (ii) shows the mature Fc domain (length=219) having an N-terminal-S-terminus. The N-terminal cysteine residue is underlined. Part (iii) shows the mature Fc domain extended by native chemical ligation (length=222) to have an N-terminal-X-terminus. The N-terminal X amino acid (e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine) is underlined; it is followed by the twelfth amino acid encoded by the hinge exon, XPPCP. (IGHG1, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P01857, Ig gamma-1 chain C region, Homo sapiens).
  • FIG. 37A: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus. Part (i) shows two distinct pre-Fc-intein polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human CD2 or CD4 signal sequences (residues −24 to −1, or −25 to −1, respectively), the human IGHG1 Fc domain (residues 1 to 224) beginning at the seventh amino acid encoded by the hinge exon (KTHTCPPCP), the human IGHG3 M1 domain (residues 225 to 241), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 242 to 441). The two distinct pre-Fc-intein chimeric polypeptides have lengths of 465 and 466 residues, respectively. Part (ii) shows the mature Fc-intein chimeric polypeptide (length=441) comprising the human Fc/M1 domain and the Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain. The intein autocleavage site is underlined. Part (iii) shows the thioester-terminated human Fc/M1 domain (length=242). The C-terminal thio-glycine residue (Z) is underlined. Part (iv) shows the human Fc/M1 domain (length=243) with a C-terminal-X-terminus. The C-terminal X amino acid residue (e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine) is underlined. (IGHG1, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P01857, Ig gamma-1 chain C region, Homo sapiens; IGHG3, NCBI/GenBank accession BAA11363, membrane-bound-type Ig gamma-chain, Homo sapiens).
  • FIG. 37B: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide synthetic intermediates of a human Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with an C-terminal-S-terminus. Part (i) shows two distinct pre-Fc polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human CD2 or CD4 signal sequences (residues −24 to −1, or −25 to −1, respectively), the human IGHG1 Fc domain (residues 1 to 224) beginning at the seventh amino acid encoded by the hinge exon (KTHTCPPCP), and a portion of the human IGHG3 M1 domain (residues 225 to 232). The two distinct pre-Fc polypeptides have lengths of 256 and 257 residues, respectively. Part (ii) shows the mature Fc domain (length=232) with an N-terminal-S-terminus. The N-terminal cysteine residue is underlined. (IGHG1, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P01857, Ig gamma-1 chain C region, Homo sapiens).
  • FIGS. 38A-38B: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit, with an N-terminal-S-terminus and a C-terminal-X-terminus. (A) Part (i) shows three distinct pre-Fc-intein polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human sonic hedgehog (SHH), human interferon alpha-2 (IFN), or human cholesterol ester transferase (CETP) signal sequences (residues −23 to −1, −23 to −1, or −17 to −1, respectively), the human IGHG1 Fc domain (residues 1 to 226) beginning at the fifth amino acid encoded by the hinge exon (CDKTHTCPPCP), the human IGHG3 M1 domain (residues 227 to 243), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 244 to 443). The three distinct pre-Fc-intein chimeric polypeptides have lengths of 466, 466 and 460 residues, respectively. Part (ii) shows the mature Fc-intein chimeric polypeptide (length=443) comprising the human Fc/M1 domain and the Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain with an N-terminal-S-terminus. The N-terminal cysteine residue and intein autocleavage site are underlined. (B) Part (iii) shows the thioester-terminated human Fc/M1 domain (length=244). The N-terminal cysteine residue and C-terminal thio-glycine residue (Z) are underlined. Part (iv) shows the Fc/M1 domain (length=245) with an N-terminal-S-terminus and a C-terminal-X-terminus. The N-terminal cysteine residue and C-terminal X amino acid residue (e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine) are underlined. (IGHG1, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P01857, Ig gamma-1 chain C region, Homo sapiens; IGHG3, NCBI/GenBank accession BAA11363, membrane-bound-type Ig gamma-chain, Homo sapiens).
  • FIGS. 39A-39B: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human Fc symmetroadhesin precursor subunit, with an N-terminal-X-terminus and a C-terminal-X-terminus. (A) Part (i) shows three distinct pre-Fc-intein polypeptides comprising, alternatively, the human sonic hedgehog (SHH), human interferon alpha-2 (IFN), or human cholesterol ester transferase (CETP) signal sequences (residues −23 to −1, −23 to −1, or −17 to −1, respectively), the human IGHG1 Fc domain (residues 1 to 220) beginning at the eleventh amino acid encoded by the hinge exon (CPPCP), the human IGHG3 M1 domain (residues 221 to 237), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 238 to 437). The three distinct pre-Fc-intein chimeric polypeptides have lengths of 460, 460 and 454 residues, respectively. Part (ii) shows the mature Fc-intein chimeric polypeptide (length=437) comprising the human Fc/M1 domain and the Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain with an N-terminal-S-terminus. The N-terminal cysteine residue and intein autocleavage site are underlined. (B) Part (iii) shows the mature Fc-intein chimeric polypeptide extended by native chemical ligation (length=443) to have an N-terminal-X-terminus. The N-terminal X amino acid (e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine) is underlined. Part (iv) shows the thioester-terminated human Fc/M1 domain (length=244). The N-terminal X amino acid residue and C-terminal thio-glycine residue (Z) are underlined. Part (v) shows the Fc/M1 domain (length=245) with an N-terminal-X-terminus and a C-terminal-X-terminus. The N-terminal X amino acid residue and C-terminal X amino acid residue are underlined. (IGHG1, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P01857, Ig gamma-1 chain C region, Homo sapiens; IGHG3, NCBI/GenBank accession BAA11363, membrane-bound-type Ig gamma-chain, Homo sapiens).
  • FIGS. 40A-40B: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human CD4 symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus. (A) Part (i) shows the pre-CD4-intein polypeptide (length=596) comprising the human CD4 signal sequence (residues −25 to −1) and extracellular domain (residues 1 to 371), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 372 to 571). Part (ii) shows the mature CD4-intein chimeric polypeptide (length=571) comprising the human CD4 extracellular domain and the Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain. The position of the intein autocleavage site is underlined. (B) Part (iii) shows the thioester-terminated human CD4 extracellular domain (length=372). The C-terminal thio-glycine residue (Z) is underlined. Part (iv) shows the human CD4 extracellular domain (length=373) with a C-terminal-X-terminus. The C-terminal X amino acid residue (e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine) is underlined. (CD4, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P01730, T-cell surface glycoprotein CD4).
  • FIGS. 41A-41B: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a Di62-VH symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus. (A) Part (i) shows the pre-Di62-VH-intein polypeptide (length=444) comprising the mouse Di62-VH signal sequence (residues −19 to −1) and variable domain (residues 1 to 117), the human CH1 contant domain (residues 118 to 225), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 226 to 425). Part (ii) shows the mature Di62-VH-intein chimeric polypeptide (length=425) comprising the mouse Di62-VH variable domain, the human CH1 contant domain, and the Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain. The position of the intein autocleavage site is underlined. (B) Part (iii) shows the thioester-terminated mouse Di62-VH variable domain/human CH1 contant domain (length=226). The C-terminal thio-glycine residue (Z) is underlined. Part (iv) shows the mouse Di62-VH variable domain/human CH1 contant domain (length=227) with a C-terminal-X-terminus. The C-terminal X amino acid residue (e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine) is underlined. (Di62-VH, NCBI/GenBank accession CAA05416, IgG heavy chain, antigen binding of human TNF alpha subunit, Mus musculus).
  • FIG. 42: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide synthetic intermediates of a Di62-Vk symmetroadhesin precursor subunit. Part (i) shows the pre-Di62-Vk polypeptide (length=234) comprising the mouse Di62-Vk signal sequence (residues −20 to −1) and variable domain (residues 1 to 107), and the human Ck contant domain (residues 108 to 214). Part (ii) shows the mature Di62-Vk chimeric polypeptide (length=214) comprising the mouse Di62-Vk variable domain, and the human Ck contant domain. (Di62-Vk, NCBI/GenBank accession CAA05417, IgG light chain, antigen binding of human TNF alpha subunit, Mus musculus).
  • FIG. 43: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human TNR1A symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus. Part (i) shows the pre-TNR1A-intein polypeptide (length=411) comprising the human TNR1A signal sequence (residues −21 to −1) and extracellular domain (residues 1 to 190), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 191 to 390). Part (ii) shows the mature TNR1A-intein chimeric polypeptide (length=390) comprising the human TNR1A extracellular domain and the Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain. The position of the intein autocleavage site is underlined. Part (iii) shows the thioester-terminated human TNR1A extracellular domain (length=191). The C-terminal thio-glycine residue (Z) is underlined. Part (iv) shows the human TNR1A extracellular domain (length=192) with a C-terminal-X-terminus. The C-terminal X amino acid residue (e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine) is underlined. (TNR1A, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P19438, Tumor necrosis factor receptor superfamily member 1A).
  • FIG. 44A: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human TNR1B symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus. Part (i) shows the pre-TNR1B-intein polypeptide (length=457) comprising the human TNR1B signal sequence (residues −22 to −1) and extracellular domain (residues 1 to 235), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 236 to 435). Part (ii) shows the mature TNR1B-intein chimeric polypeptide (length=435) comprising the human TNR1B extracellular domain and the Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain. The position of the intein autocleavage site is underlined. Part (iii) shows the thioester-terminated human TNR1B extracellular domain (length=236). The C-terminal thio-glycine residue (Z) is underlined. Part (iv) shows the human TNR1B extracellular domain (length=237) with a C-terminal-X-terminus. The C-terminal X amino acid residue (e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine) is underlined. (TNR1B, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry 20333, Tumor necrosis factor receptor superfamily member 1B).
  • FIG. 44B: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide synthetic intermediates of a TNR1B immunoadhesin precursor subunit. Part (i) shows the pre-TNR1B-immunoadhesin polypeptide (length=489) comprising the TNR1B signal sequence (residues −22 to −1) and extracellular domain (residues 1 to 235), and the human heavy contant domain (residues 236 to 467). Part (ii) shows the mature TNR1B-immunoadhesin (length=467).
  • FIGS. 45A-45C: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human VGFR1 symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus. (A) Part (i) shows the pre-VGFR1-intein polypeptide (length=958) comprising the human VGFR1 signal sequence (residues −26 to −1) and extracellular domain (residues 1 to 732), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 733 to 932). (B) Part (ii) shows the mature VGFR1-intein chimeric polypeptide (length=932) comprising the human VGFR1 extracellular domain and the Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain. The position of the intein autocleavage site is underlined. (C) Part (iii) shows the thioester-terminated human VGFR1 extracellular domain (length=733). The C-terminal thio-glycine residue (Z) is underlined. Part (iv) shows the human VGFR1 extracellular domain (length=734) with a C-terminal-X-terminus. The C-terminal X amino acid residue (e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine) is underlined. (VGFR1, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P17948, Vascular endothelial growth factor receptor 1).
  • FIGS. 46A-46C: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human VGFR2 symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus. (A) Part (i) shows the pre-VGFR2-intein polypeptide (length=964) comprising the human VGFR2 signal sequence (residues −19 to −1) and extracellular domain (residues 1 to 745), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 746 to 945). (B) Part (ii) shows the mature VGFR2-intein chimeric polypeptide (length=945) comprising the human VGFR2 extracellular domain and the Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain. The position of the intein autocleavage site is underlined. (C) Part (iii) shows the thioester-terminated human VGFR2 extracellular domain (length=746). The C-terminal thio-glycine residue (Z) is underlined. Part (iv) shows the human VGFR2 extracellular domain (length=747) with a C-terminal-X-terminus. The C-terminal X amino acid residue (e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine) is underlined. (VGFR2, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P35968, Vascular endothelial growth factor receptor 2).
  • FIGS. 47A-47C: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human VGFR3 symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus. (A) Part (i) shows the pre-VGFR3-intein polypeptide (length=975) comprising the human VGFR3 signal sequence (residues −24 to −1) and extracellular domain (residues 1 to 751), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 752 to 951). (B) Part (ii) shows the mature VGFR3-intein chimeric polypeptide (length=951) comprising the human VGFR3 extracellular domain and the Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain. The position of the intein autocleavage site is underlined. (C) Part (iii) shows the thioester-terminated human VGFR3 extracellular domain (length=752). The C-terminal thio-glycine residue (Z) is underlined. Part (iv) shows the human VGFR3 extracellular domain (length=753) with a C-terminal-X-terminus. The C-terminal X amino acid residue (e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine) is underlined. (VGFR3, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P35916, Vascular endothelial growth factor receptor 3).
  • FIGS. 48A-48B: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human ERBB1 symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus. (A) Part (i) shows the pre-ERBB1-intein polypeptide (length=845) comprising the human ERBB1 signal sequence (residues −24 to −1) and extracellular domain (residues 1 to 621), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 622 to 821). Part (ii) shows the mature ERBB1-intein chimeric polypeptide (length=821) comprising the human ERBB1 extracellular domain and the Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain. The position of the intein autocleavage site is underlined. (B) Part (iii) shows the thioester-terminated human ERBB1 extracellular domain (length=622). The C-terminal thio-glycine residue (Z) is underlined. Part (iv) shows the human ERBB1 extracellular domain (length=623) with a C-terminal-X-terminus. The C-terminal X amino acid residue (e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine) is underlined. (ERBB1, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P00533, Epidermal growth factor receptor).
  • FIGS. 49A-49B: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human ERBB2 symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus. (A) Part (i) shows the pre-ERBB2-intein polypeptide (length=852) comprising the human ERBB2 signal sequence (residues −22 to −1) and extracellular domain (residues 1 to 630), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 631 to 830). Part (ii) shows the mature ERBB2-intein chimeric polypeptide (length=830) comprising the human ERBB2 extracellular domain and the Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain. The position of the intein autocleavage site is underlined. (B) Part (iii) shows the thioester-terminated human ERBB2 extracellular domain (length=631). The C-terminal thio-glycine residue (Z) is underlined. Part (iv) shows the human ERBB2 extracellular domain (length=632) with a C-terminal-X-terminus. The C-terminal X amino acid residue (e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine) is underlined. (ERBB2, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P04626, Receptor tyrosine-protein kinase erbB-2).
  • FIGS. 50A-50B: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human ERBB3 symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus. (A) Part (i) shows the pre-ERBB3-intein polypeptide (length=843) comprising the human ERBB3 signal sequence (residues −19 to −1) and extracellular domain (residues 1 to 624), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 625 to 824). Part (ii) shows the mature ERBB3-intein chimeric polypeptide (length=824) comprising the human ERBB3 extracellular domain and the Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain. The position of the intein autocleavage site is underlined. (B) Part (iii) shows the thioester-terminated human ERBB3 extracellular domain (length=625). The C-terminal thio-glycine residue (Z) is underlined. Part (iv) shows the human ERBB3 extracellular domain (length=626) with a C-terminal-X-terminus. The C-terminal X amino acid residue (e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine) is underlined. (ERBB3, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry P21860, Receptor tyrosine-protein kinase erbB-3).
  • FIGS. 51A-51B: Amino acid sequences of various polypeptide intermediates in an intein-based synthesis of a human ERBB4 symmetroadhesin precursor subunit with a C-terminal-X-terminus. (A) Part (i) shows the pre-ERBB4-intein polypeptide (length=851) comprising the human ERBB4 signal sequence (residues −25 to −1) and extracellular domain (residues 1 to 626), and an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain (residues 627 to 826). Part (ii) shows the mature ERBB4-intein chimeric polypeptide (length=826) comprising the human ERBB4 extracellular domain and the Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain. The position of the intein autocleavage site is underlined. (B) Part (iii) shows the thioester-terminated human ERBB4 extracellular domain (length=627). The C-terminal thio-glycine residue (Z) is underlined. Part (iv) shows the human ERBB4 extracellular domain (length=628) with a C-terminal-X-terminus. The C-terminal X amino acid residue (e.g., cysteine, selenocysteine) is underlined. (ERBB4, UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot entry Q15303, Receptor tyrosine-protein kinase erbB-4).
  • FIG. 52: Expression in 293 kidney cells of human IgG1 Fc symmetroadhesin subunits with N-terminal-S-termini. Lanes 1-6 and lanes 7-12 show the IgG1 Fc polypeptides of FIG. 35A (ii) and FIG. 36A (ii), respectively. Cell supernatants: lanes 1, 3, 5, 7, 9 and 11; cell lysates: lanes 2, 4, 6, 8, 10 and 12. Signal sequences used: SHH ( lanes 1, 2, 7 and 8); IFNα ( lanes 3, 4, 9, 10); CETP ( lanes 5, 6, 11 and 12).
  • FIG. 53: Expression in 293 kidney cells of human IgG1 Fc symmetroadhesin subunits. Lanes 1-2, 3-4 and 5-6 show the IgG1 Fc polypeptides of FIG. 35A (ii), FIG. 36A (ii) and FIG. 37B (ii), respectively. Cell supernatants: (lanes 1-6). Signal sequences used: SHH (lanes 1-6).
  • FIG. 54: Protein A purification of human IgG1 Fc symmetroadhesin subunits expressed in 293 kidney cells. Lane 2 and 8 show the IgG1 Fc polypeptides of FIG. 36A and FIG. 35A, respectively. Lanes 1-7: proteinA-sepharose column fractions for the IgG1 Fc polypeptide of FIG. 36A.
  • FIG. 55: Thiol-sepharose binding of proteinA-purified human IgG1 Fc symmetroadhesin subunits shown in FIG. 54. Lanes 1-3 and lanes 4-6 show the human IgG1 Fc polypeptides of FIG. 35A and FIG. 36A, respectively. Lanes 1 and 4: starting material; lanes 2 and 5: thiol-sepharose flow-thru fraction; lanes 3 and 6: thiol-sepharose bound fraction.
  • FIG. 56: Expression in human 293 kidney cells of human CD4-intein fusion proteins. Lanes 1-4 show the CD4-intein fusion polypeptide of FIG. 40A (ii). Cell supernatants: lanes 1 and 3; cell lysates: lanes 2 and 4.
  • FIG. 57: Expression in human 293 kidney cells of human TNR1B fusion proteins. Lanes 2 and 5 show the TNR1B-intein fusion protein of FIG. 44A (ii). Lanes 1 and 3 show the TNR1B-immunoadhesin fusion protein of FIG. 44B (ii). Lanes 3 and 6 show proteins from mock-transfected cells. Cell supernatants: lanes 1-3; cell lysates: lanes 4-7. Lane 7: control TNR1B-immunoadhesin (R&D Systems).
  • FIG. 58: TNR1B symmetroadhesin subunits with C-terminal-S-termini. Lanes 1-2 show the TNR1B polypeptide of FIG. 44A (iii) following purification by chitin affinity chromatography and cleavage/elution with MESNA. Lanes 3 shows the native ligation product between the TNR1B polypeptide of FIG. 44A (iii) with a fluorescent-labeled peptide (New England Biolabs). Panel (i): direct fluorescence; panel (ii): western blot with anti-TNR1B antibody (R&D Systems); panel (iii): SYPRO Ruby staining (Sigma-Aldrich).
  • FIG. 59: TNR1B symmetroadhesin subunits with C-terminal-S-termini. Lane 5 shows the TNR1B polypeptide of FIG. 44A (iv) following purification by chitin affinity chromatography and cleavage/elution with cysteine. Lanes 1-4 show TNR1B-immunoadhesin.
  • FIG. 60: TNR1B symmetroadhesin. Lanes 1-4 show the TNR1B symmetroadhesin of FIG. 44A (iv) before oxidation (lanes 1 and 4) and after oxidation in the presence of 10 mM CuSO4. Lanes 3 and 6 show a TNR1B-immunoadhesin control. Lanes 1-3: reducing conditions; lanes 4-6: non-reducing conditions. The TNR1B symmetroadhesin monomer (42 kd) and dimer (84 kd) are apparent in lanes 2 and 5, and lane 5, respectively.
  • FIG. 61A-61C: TNF-alpha saturation binding analysis with various TNR1B polypeptides on the Biacore T-100. (A) The TNR1B symmetroadhesin of FIG. 44A (iv) was covalently coupled to a Biacore CM-5 chip using standard Biacore amine chemistry. (B) TNR1B immunoadhesin (R&D Systems) was covalently coupled to a Biacore CM-5 chip using standard Biacore amine chemistry. (C) The TNR1B symmetroadhesin of FIG. 44A (iv) was covalently coupled to a Biacore CM-5 chip using standard Biacore thiol chemistry. Following coupling, saturation binding analysis was carried out using TNF-alpha (R&D Systems) at the indicated concentations.
  • FIG. 62A-62C: Scatchard analysis of the TNF-alpha saturation binding analysis shown in FIG. 61A-61C. (A) TNR1B symmetroadhesin of FIG. 44A (iv) covalently coupled using amine chemistry; Kd=Kd=4.697×10−9 M. (B) TNR1B-immunoadhesin (R&D Systems) covalently coupled using amine chemistry; Kd=4.089×10−9 M. (C) TNR1B symmetroadhesin of FIG. 44A (iv) covalently coupled using thiol chemistry; Kd=0.8476×10−9 M.
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION
  • This invention provides a compound comprising a first stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which comprises a binding site for a target; and a second stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which is identical to the sequence of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and which comprises an identical binding site for the target; wherein each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids has at a predefined end thereof a cysteine residue or a selenocysteine residue and such cysteine residues or such selenocysteine residues are joined by a bond having the structure:
  • Figure US20080254512A1-20081016-C00003
  • wherein each X is the same and represents a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and each C represents a beta-carbon of one of such cysteine or selenocysteine residues.
  • In an embodiment, the bond has the structure:
  • Figure US20080254512A1-20081016-C00004
  • In an embodiment, the residue at the predefined end of each of the first stretch and the second stretch of consecutive amino acids is a cysteine residue. In an embodiment the residue at the predefined end of each of the first stretch and the second stretch of consecutive amino acids is a selenocysteine residue.
  • This invention also provides a compound comprising a first stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which comprises a binding site for a target; and a second stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which is different from the sequence of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and which comprises a binding site for a different moiety; wherein each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids has at a predefined end thereof a cysteine residue or a selenocysteine residue and such residues are joined by a bond having the structure:
  • Figure US20080254512A1-20081016-C00005
  • wherein each X may be the same or different and represents a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and each C represents a beta-carbon of one of such cysteine or selenocysteine residues.
  • In an embodiment the bond has the structure:
  • Figure US20080254512A1-20081016-C00006
  • In an embodiment both of the residues at the predefined ends of each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids are cysteine residues. In an embodiment both of the residues at the predefined ends of each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids are selenocysteine residues. In an embodiment the residue at one predefined end of one of the first stretch or second stretch of consecutive amino acids is a cysteine residue and the residue at the other predefined end is a selenocysteine residue.
  • This invention provides a multimer comprising two or more identical instant compounds joined together by at least one bond. In an embodiment the multimer is a dimer. In an embodiment the multimer is a trimer. In an embodiment the multimer is a tetramer. In an embodiment of the multimer, the one or more bonds comprises a disulfide bond.
  • In an embodiment of the compounds the predefined end of both the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids is a N-terminal end thereof. In an embodiment the predefined end of both the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids is a C-terminal end thereof. In an embodiment the predefined end of one of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids is a C-terminal end and the other predefined end is a N-terminal end.
  • In an embodiment of the compounds, the first stretch of amino acids comprises L-amino acids. In an embodiment, the first stretch of amino acids comprises D-amino acids. In an embodiment, the first stretch of amino acids comprises L-amino acids and D-amino acids
  • In an embodiment, the second stretch of amino acids comprises L-amino acids. In an embodiment, the second stretch of amino acids comprises D-amino acids. In an embodiment, the second stretch of amino acids comprises L-amino acids and D-amino acids.
  • In an embodiment, the first stretch of amino acids comprises at least 50 consecutive amino acids. In an embodiment the second stretch of amino acids comprises at least 50 consecutive amino acids. In an embodiment, the first and/or second stretch of amino acids is between 1 and 100, 100 and 200 or 200 and 300 amino acids in length. In an embodiment the first stretch or second stretch of amino acids comprises at least 20, 25, 30, 35, 40, or 45 consecutive amino acids.
  • In an embodiment, the first stretch of amino acids comprises more than one type of amino acid. In an embodiment, the second stretch of amino acids comprises more than one type of amino acid.
  • In an embodiment of the instant compounds, the sequence of the first and/or second stretch of amino acids corresponds to the sequence of a constant region of an immunoglobulin. In an embodiment, the immunoglobulin is a human immunoglobulin. In an embodiment, the constant region of the immunoglobulin is a constant region of an IgG, an IgA, an IgE, an IgD, or an IgM immunoglobulin. In an embodiment, the constant region of the immunoglobulin is a constant region of an IgG-1, IgG-2, IgG-3 or IgG-4 immunoglobulin. In an embodiment, the constant region of the immunoglobulin which is a constant region of an IgG-1, IgG-2, IgG-3 or IgG-4 immunoglobulin has one of the sequences set forth herein. In an embodiment, the constant region of the immunoglobulin is a constant region of an IgG immunoglobulin and comprises a hinge region, a CH6 region and a CH3 region. In an embodiment, the different moiety is an immunoeffector or immunoregulator.
  • In an embodiment, the target is protein. In an embodiment, the target is an EGF receptor, a HER2, a VEGF receptor, a CD20 antigen, a CD11a, an IgE immunoglobulin, a glycoprotein IIa receptor, a glycoprotein IIIa receptor, a TNF alpha, or a TNF receptor, a gp120. In an embodiment, each of the first and second stretch of consecutive amino acids comprises the amino acid sequence of any one of TNFRSF1a, TNFRSF1b, VEGFR1, VEGFR6, VEGFR3, human Erb1, human Erb2, human Erb6, human Erb3, or human Erb4. In an embodiment, the first or second stretch of consecutive amino acids comprises the amino acid sequence set forth of any one of TNFRSF1a, TNFRSF1b, VEGFR1, VEGFR6, VEGFR3, human Erb1, human Erb2, human Erb6, human Erb3, or human Erb4).
  • This invention provides a composition comprising any of the instant compounds in an amount effective to bind the target, and a carrier. In an embodiment, the compound is in an amount effective to bind the target, and a carrier. In an embodiment, the compound is a multimer and is in an amount effective to bind the target, and a carrier. In an embodiment, the multimer is also present in an amount effective to bind the different moiety. In an embodiment, the carrier is a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. In an embodiment the carrier is a phosphate-buffered saline. Such a composition may be lyophilized.
  • This invention provides a method of affecting the activity of a target comprising contacting the target with the composition of one or more of the instant compounds, under conditions such that the compound binds to and affects the activity of the target. In one embodiment, the binding of the composition to the target increases the activity of the target. In one embodiment, the binding of the composition to the target decreases the activity of the target. In one embodiment, the target is an EGF receptor, a HER2 protein, a VEGF receptor, a CD20 antigen, a CD11a, an IgE immunoglobulin, a glycoprotein IIa receptor, a glycoprotein IIIa receptor, a gp40, a gp120, a TNF alpha, or a TNF receptor.
  • This invention provides a complex comprising the composition of any of the instant compounds and a third stretch of consecutive amino acids, wherein the third stretch of consecutive amino acids is bound to the one of the first or second stretch of consecutive amino acids by one or more bonds. In an embodiment the one or more bonds comprise van der Waals forces. In one embodiment the one or more bonds comprise a hydrogen bond. In one embodiment the one or bonds comprise a covalent bond. In one embodiment the one or bonds comprise a disulfide bond. In an embodiment the at least one bond is a disulfide bond. In an embodiment the disulfide bond is between two non-terminal amino acid residues. In an embodiment the disulfide bond is between two amino acid residues, at least one of which is a non-terminal amino acid residue.
  • This invention provides a process of making one of the instant compounds comprising:
      • (a) transfecting a cell with a recombinant nucleic acid which comprises (i) a first portion, the sequence of which is a N-terminal signal sequence, contiguous with (ii) a second portion, the sequence of which encodes a stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous with (iii) a third portion, the sequence of which encodes a C-terminal intein-containing binding domain, under conditions permitting synthesis of a chimeric polypeptide comprising the stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous with the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain;
      • (b) isolating the chimeric polypeptide produced in step (a);
      • (c) treating the chimeric polypeptide so as to cause thio-mediated cleavage of the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain from the stretch of consecutive amino acids and its replacement with a C-terminal thioester;
      • (d) treating the product of step (c) to permit the attachment of a cysteine residue to the product so as to form product with a C-terminal cysteine; and
      • (e) oxidizing the product of step (e) in the presence of another product of step (e) under conditions permitting formation of the compound.
  • In one embodiment, the recombinant nucleic acid has the sequence set forth in any one of SEQ ID NOs. 1-8. In one embodiment, the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is an intein-chitin binding domain. In one embodiment, the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain. In one embodiment, the chimeric polypeptide is isolated in step b) by affinity chromatography. In one embodiment, the chimeric polypeptide is isolated in step b) by exposure of the product to a chitin-derivatized resin. In one embodiment, the oxidizing conditions permit formation of a disulfide bond between the C-terminal cysteine of each of the products.
  • This invention provides a compound comprising an independently folding protein domain fused to a second independently folding protein domain by non-peptide bond. This invention provides a compound comprising a first polypeptide chain, comprising a terminal cysteine residue, fused at its S-terminus to a S-terminus of a second polypeptide chain comprising a terminal cysteine residue. This invention provides a compound comprising a first polypeptide chain, comprising a terminal selenocysteine residue, fused at its Se-terminus to a S-terminus of a second polypeptide chain comprising a terminal cysteine residue. This invention provides a compound comprising a first polypeptide chain, comprising a terminal selenocysteine residue, fused at its Se-terminus to a Se-terminus of a second polypeptide chain comprising a terminal selenocysteine residue. This invention provides a multimer comprising two or more identical compounds according to any one of claims 66-69 joined together by at least one bond.
  • This invention provides a method of making a stretch of consecutive amino acids comprising an N-terminal cysteine comprising:
      • (a) transfecting a cell with a recombinant nucleic acid which comprises (i) a first portion, the sequence of which encodes a N-terminal signal sequence contiguous with (ii) a second portion, the sequence of which encodes a stretch of consecutive amino acids comprising a N-terminal cysteine residue, under conditions permitting (i) synthesis of a chimeric polypeptide which comprises the N-terminal signal sequence joined by a peptide bond at its C-terminus to the N-terminal cysteine of the stretch of consecutive amino acids and (ii) cleavage of the N-terminal signal sequence from the chimeric polypeptide within the cell so as to produce a stretch of consecutive amino acids comprising an N-terminal cysteine;
      • (b) recovering the stretch of consecutive amino acids produced in step (a).
  • In one embodiment of the methods disclosed herein, the stretch of consecutive amino acids is isolated in step (b).
  • In one embodiment, the stretch of consecutive amino acids comprises an immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide. In one embodiment, the immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide is a human immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide. In one embodiment, the N-terminal cysteine residue is a cys-5 residue of the human immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide. In one embodiment, the cell is a 293 human embryonic cell or a CHO-K1 hamster ovary cell. In one embodiment, the transfection is performed with a plasmid pSA. In one embodiment, N-terminal signal sequence is selected from a protein having a N-terminal cysteine. In one embodiment, the signal peptide is sonic hedgehog, interferon alpha-2 or cholesterol ester transferase. In one embodiment, the stretch of consecutive amino acids is recovered by affinity chromatography. In one embodiment, the cleavage of the chimeric polypeptide within the cell is effected by a cellular signal peptidase.
  • This invention provides a method of making a stretch of consecutive amino acids comprising an N-terminal cysteine or selenocysteine comprising:
    • (a) transfecting a cell with a recombinant nucleic acid which comprises (i) a first portion, the sequence of which encodes a N-terminal signal sequence contiguous with (ii) a second portion, the sequence of which encodes a stretch of consecutive amino acids comprising a N-terminal cysteine residue, under conditions permitting (i) synthesis of a chimeric polypeptide comprising the N-terminal signal sequence joined at its C-terminus to the N-terminal cysteine of the Fc polypeptide and (ii) cleavage of the N-terminal signal sequence from the chimeric polypeptide within the cell so as to produce a stretch of consecutive amino acids comprising an N-terminal cysteine;
    • (b) ligating the N-terminal of the stretch of consecutive amino acids produced in step (a) with a C-terminal of a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence cys-asp-lys-thr-his-thr or with a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence sec-asp-lys-thr-his-thr so as to thereby produce the stretch of consecutive amino acids comprising an N-terminal cysteine or selenocysteine; and
    • (c) recovering the stretch of consecutive amino acids produced in step (b).
  • In an embodiment, the stretch of consecutive amino acids comprises an immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide. In an embodiment, the immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide is a human immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide. In an embodiment, the N-terminal cysteine residue is a cys-5 residue of the human immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide. In one embodiment, the N-terminal cysteine residue is a cys-11 residue of the human immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide. In an embodiment, the peptide in step (b) comprises the amino acid sequence cys-asp-lys-thr-his-thr and the stretch of consecutive amino acids produced comprises an N-terminal cysteine. In an embodiment, peptide in step (b) comprises the amino acid sequence sec-asp-lys-thr-his-thr and the stretch of consecutive amino acids produced comprises an N-terminal selenocysteine. In an embodiment, the peptide in step (b) is protected with a N-terminal Msc protecting group prior to ligation. In an embodiment, the cell is a 293 human embryonic cell or a CHO-K1 hamster ovary cell. In an embodiment, the transfection is performed with a plasmid pSA. In an embodiment, the N-terminal signal sequence is selected from a protein having a N-terminal cysteine. In an embodiment, the signal peptide is sonic hedgehog, interferon alpha-2 or cholesterol ester transferase. In an embodiment, the stretch of consecutive amino acids is recovered by affinity chromatography. In an embodiment, the cleavage of the chimeric polypeptide within the cell is effected by a cellular signal peptidase. In embodiments other short peptide sequences with a N-terminal cysteine or selenocysteine are employed in place of those set forth above.
  • This invention provides process of making a stretch of consecutive amino acids comprising a C-terminal cysteine or a C-terminal selenocysteine, comprising:
      • (a) transfecting a cell with a recombinant nucleic acid which comprises (i) a first portion, the sequence of which encodes a N-terminal signal sequence, contiguous with (ii) a second portion, the sequence of which encodes a stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous with (iii) a third portion, the sequence of which encodes a C-terminal intein-containing binding domain, under conditions permitting (i) synthesis of a chimeric polypeptide comprising the N-terminal signal sequence contiguous with the stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous with the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain and (ii) cleavage of the N-terminal signal sequence from the chimeric polypeptide so as to produce a second chimeric polypeptide having a N-terminal lysine residue and comprising the stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous with the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain;
      • (b) isolating the second chimeric polypeptide produced in step (a);
      • (c) treating the second chimeric polypeptide so as to cause thio-mediated cleavage of the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain from the stretch of consecutive amino acids so as to form a C-terminal thioester;
      • (d) ligating the product of step (c) with a cysteine residue or selenocysteine residue at its C-terminal so as to form product with a C-terminal cysteine or a C-terminal selenocysteine; and
      • (e) recovering the product of step (d).
  • In an embodiment, the stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous comprises an IgG immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide and an IgG M1 exon. In an embodiment, the IgG immunoglobulin is a human IgG immunoglobulin. In an embodiment, the stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous comprises a CD4 extracellular domain. In an embodiment, the N-terminal signal sequence is selected from a protein having a N-terminal lysine. In an embodiment, the N-terminal signal sequence is a CD2 T-cell surface glycoprotein or a CD4 T-cell surface glycoprotein. In an embodiment, the cell is a 293 human embryonic cell or a CHO-K1 hamster ovary cell. In an embodiment, the transfection is performed with a plasmid pSA. In an embodiment, the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is an intein-chitin binding domain. In an embodiment, the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain. In an embodiment, the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is a self-splicing intein-containing binding domain. In an embodiment, the chimeric polypeptide is isolated in step b) by exposure of the product to a chitin-derivatized resin. In an embodiment, the cleavage of the second chimeric polypeptide within the cell is effected by a cellular signal peptidase. In an embodiment, the product of step (c) is ligated with a cysteine residue. In an embodiment, the product of step (c) is ligated with a selenocysteine residue.
  • This invention provides a process of making a stretch of consecutive amino acids comprising a N-terminal cysteine and a C-terminal cysteine or selenocysteine comprising:
      • (a) transfecting a cell with a recombinant nucleic acid which comprises (i) a first portion, the sequence of which encodes a N-terminal signal sequence, contiguous with (ii) a second portion, the sequence of which encodes a stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous with (iii) a third portion, the sequence of which encodes a C-terminal intein-containing binding domain, under conditions permitting (i) synthesis of a chimeric polypeptide comprising the N-terminal signal sequence contiguous with the stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous with the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain and (ii) cleavage of the N-terminal signal sequence from the chimeric polypeptide so as to produce a second chimeric polypeptide having a N-terminal cysteine residue and comprising the stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous with the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain;
      • (b) isolating the second chimeric polypeptide produced in step (a);
      • (c) treating the second chimeric polypeptide so as to cause thio-mediated cleavage of the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain from the stretch of consecutive amino acids so as to form a C-terminal thioester;
      • (d) ligating the product of step (c) with a cysteine residue or selenocysteine residue at its C-terminal so as to form product with a C-terminal cysteine or a C-terminal selenocysteine; and
      • (e) recovering the product of step (d).
  • In an embodiment, the stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous comprises an IgG immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide and an IgG M1 exon. In an embodiment, the IgG immunoglobulin is a human IgG immunoglobulin. In an embodiment, the N-terminal signal sequence is selected from a protein having a N-terminal cysteine. In an embodiment, the N-terminal cysteine residue is a cys-5 residue of the human immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide. In an embodiment, the N-terminal cysteine residue is a cys-11 residue of the human immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide. In an embodiment, the N-terminal signal is a sonic hedgehog, interferon alpha-2 or cholesterol ester transferase. In an embodiment, the cell is a 293 human embryonic cell or a CHO-K1 hamster ovary cell. In an embodiment, the transfection is performed with a plasmid pSA. In an embodiment, the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is an intein-chitin binding domain. In an embodiment, the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain. In an embodiment, the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is a self-splicing intein-containing binding domain In an embodiment, the second chimeric polypeptide is isolated in step b) by exposure of the product to a chitin-derivatized resin. In an embodiment, the product is recovered in step e) by affinity chromatography. In an embodiment, the cleavage of the chimeric polypeptide within the cell is effected by a cellular signal peptidase. In an embodiment, the product of step (c) is ligated with a cysteine residue. In an embodiment, the product of step (c) is ligated with a selenocysteine residue.
  • This invention provides a process of making a stretch of consecutive amino acids comprising a N-terminal cysteine or selenocysteine and a C-terminal cysteine or selenocysteine comprising:
      • (a) transfecting a cell with a recombinant nucleic acid which comprises (i) a first portion, the sequence of which encodes a N-terminal signal sequence, contiguous with (ii) a second portion, the sequence of which encodes a stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous with (iii) a third portion, the sequence of which encodes a C-terminal intein-containing binding domain, under conditions permitting (i) synthesis of a chimeric polypeptide comprising the N-terminal signal sequence contiguous with the stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous with the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain and (ii) cleavage of the N-terminal signal sequence from the chimeric polypeptide so as to produce a second chimeric polypeptide having a N-terminal cysteine residue and comprising the stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous with the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain;
      • (b) isolating the second chimeric polypeptide produced in step (a);
      • (c) (i) ligating the N-terminal of the stretch of consecutive amino acids produced in step (a) with a C-terminal of a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence cys-asp-lys-thr-his-thr or with a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence sec-asp-lys-thr-his-thr so as to thereby produce the stretch of consecutive amino acids comprising a N-terminal cysteine or a N-terminal selenocysteine, respectively;
        • (ii) treating the chimeric polypeptide so as to cause thio-mediated cleavage of the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain from the stretch of consecutive amino acids and its replacement with a C-terminal thioester;
        • (iii) ligating the product of step (c) with a cysteine residue or selenocysteine residue at its C-terminal so as to form product with a C-terminal cysteine pr with a C-terminal selenocysteine; and
      • (d) recovering the product of step (c)(iii).
  • In an embodiment, the stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous comprises an IgG immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide and an IgG M1 exon. In an embodiment, the IgG immunoglobulin is a human IgG immunoglobulin. In an embodiment, the N-terminal signal sequence is selected from a protein having a N-terminal cysteine. In an embodiment, the N-terminal cysteine residue is a cys-11 residue of the human immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide. In an embodiment, N-terminal signal sequence is selected from a protein having a N-terminal cysteine. In an embodiment, the N-terminal signal is a sonic hedgehog, interferon alpha-2 or cholesterol ester transferase. In an embodiment, the cell is a 293 human embryonic cell or a CHO-K1 hamster ovary cell. In an embodiment, the transfection is performed with a plasmid pSA. In an embodiment, the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is an intein-chitin binding domain. In an embodiment, the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain is an Mth RIR1 intein-chitin binding domain. In an embodiment, the chimeric polypeptide is isolated in step (b) by exposure of the product to a chitin-derivatized resin.
  • In an embodiment, the immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide is a human immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide. In an embodiment, the N-terminal cysteine residue of the Fc polypeptide is a cys-11 residue. In an embodiment, the peptide in step (c) (i) comprises the amino acid sequence cys-asp-lys-thr-his-thr and the stretch of consecutive amino In an embodiment, the peptide in step (c) (i) comprises the amino acid sequence sec-asp-lys-thr-his-thr and the stretch of consecutive amino acids produced comprises an N-terminal selenocysteine. In an embodiment, the peptide in step (c) is protected with a N-terminal Msc protecting group prior to ligation. In an embodiment, in the cell is a 293 human embryonic cell or a CHO-K1 hamster ovary cell. In an embodiment, the transfection is performed with a plasmid pSA. In an embodiment, the N-terminal signal sequence is selected from a protein having a N-terminal cysteine. In an embodiment, the signal peptide is sonic hedgehog, interferon alpha-2 or cholesterol ester transferase. In an embodiment, in the stretch of consecutive amino acids is recovered by affinity chromatography.
  • In an embodiment, step (c) of this instant method is performed in the order step (c) (i); step (c) (ii); step (c) (iii). In an embodiment, step (c) is performed in the order step (c)(ii); step (c)(iii); step (c)(i).
  • This invention provides a process for making a compound comprising contacting a stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which comprises a binding site for a target with a second stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which is identical to the sequence of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and which comprises an identical binding site for the target, wherein each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids has at a predefined end thereof a cysteine residue or a selenocysteine residue, under reducing conditions so as to make the compound.
  • This invention provides a process for making a compound comprising contacting a stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which comprises a binding site for a target with a second stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which is different to the sequence of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and which comprises an identical binding site for the target, wherein each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids has at a predefined end thereof a cysteine residue or a selenocysteine residue, under reducing conditions so as to make the compound.
  • In an embodiment of the instant processes, the reducing conditions do not denature the stretches of consecutive amino acids. In an embodiment, the reducing conditions comprise exposing the stretches of consecutive amino acids to a buffer comprising Tris-HCL and mercaptoethanol. In an embodiment, the buffer is between pH 7.6 and 8.4. In an embodiment, the buffer is pH 8. In an embodiment, the method further comprises exchanging the product into oxidation buffer. In an embodiment, the stretches of consecutive amino acids comprises a CD4 extracellular domain. In an embodiment, the stretches of consecutive amino acids comprises a sequence of an immunoglobulin Fc polypeptide. In an embodiment, the immunoglobulin is a human immunoglobulin.
  • In embodiments, the transfected cells of the instant methods are grown under conditions suitable to permit expression of the polypeptide.
  • In an embodiment a compound is provided comprising a first stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which comprises a binding site for a target; and
  • a second stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which is identical to the sequence of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and which comprises an identical binding site for the target;
    wherein each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids has at a predefined end thereof, independently, a natural amino acid or non-natural amino having a linear aliphatic side-chain acid comprising a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and wherein such sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) are joined by a bond having the structure:
  • Figure US20080254512A1-20081016-C00007
  • wherein each X is a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and each (C) represents a carbon of the linear aliphatic side-chain of one of such natural or non-natural amino acid and wherein n and m are, independently, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10.
  • In an embodiment, the natural amino acid is homocysteine of homoselenocysteine. In an embodiment, the first stretch and second stretch of amino acids have a homocysteine at the predefined end thereof. In an embodiment, the first stretch and second stretch of amino acids have a homoselenocysteine at the predefined end thereof. In an embodiment, the first stretch and second stretch of amino acids have a homocysteine at the predefined end thereof. In an embodiment, the predefined end is a C-terminus.
  • A compound is provided which comprises a first stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which comprises a binding site for a target; and
  • a second stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which is different from the sequence of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and which comprises a binding site for a different moiety;
    wherein each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids has at a predefined end thereof, independently, a natural amino acid or non-natural amino having a linear aliphatic side-chain acid comprising a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and wherein such sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) are joined by a bond having the structure:
  • Figure US20080254512A1-20081016-C00008
  • wherein each X may be the same or different and represents a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and each (C) represents a carbon of the linear aliphatic side-chain of one of such natural or non-natural amino acid and wherein n and m are, independently, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10.
  • In an embodiment, the natural amino acid is homocysteine of homoselenocysteine. In an embodiment, the first stretch and second stretch of amino acids have a homocysteine at the predefined end thereof. In an embodiment, the first stretch and second stretch of amino acids have a homoselenocysteine at the predefined end thereof. In an embodiment, the first stretch and second stretch of amino acids have a homocysteine at the predefined end thereof. In an embodiment, the predefined end is a C-terminus.
  • A method is provided of producing a protein which comprises a first polypeptide contiguous with an intein, which intein is contiguous with a second polypeptide comprising a binding domain, the method comprising transfecting an animal cell with a nucleic acid, which nucleic acid comprises (i) a first portion which encodes the polypeptide contiguous with (ii) a second portion which encodes the intein, contiguous with a and the third portion of which encodes the binding domain, under conditions such that the animal cell expresses and secretes the protein. In an embodiment, the animal cell is a derived from mammal. In an embodiment, the binding domain is a chitin-binding domain.
  • A composition is provided comprising a polypeptide attached to a solid surface through a terminal disulfide bond. In an embodiment, the solid surface is a chip or a bead.
  • A compound is provided comprising:
  • a first stretch of consecutive amino acids each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and which first stretch of consecutive amino acids comprises an amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain; and
    a second stretch of consecutive amino acids, comprising at least 100 amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond, wherein at least 90 consecutive amino acids of the second stretch of consecutive amino acids have a sequence identical to portion of a human immunoglobulin constant region polypeptide, and wherein the second stretch of consecutive amino acids comprises an amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain at a predefined terminus thereof,
    wherein said amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and said amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain of the second stretch of consecutive amino acids are joined by a bond having the structure:
  • Figure US20080254512A1-20081016-C00009
  • wherein each X represents, independently, a chalcogen, and wherein C1 represents a side chain carbon of the amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and C2 represents a side chain carbon of the second stretch of consecutive amino acids.
  • In embodiments at least wherein at least 91, 92, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 99 or 100 consecutive amino acids of the second stretch of consecutive amino acids have a sequence identical to portion of a human immunoglobulin constant region polypeptide.
  • In an embodiment of the compound, at least one of C1 and C2 is a beta carbon of amino acid. In an embodiment of the compound the bond has the structure:
  • Figure US20080254512A1-20081016-C00010
  • wherein S is sulfur. In an embodiment of the compound the bond has the structure:
  • Figure US20080254512A1-20081016-C00011
      • wherein S is sulfur and Se is selenium.
  • In an embodiment of the compound the amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain at the predefined terminus of the second stretch of amino acids is a cysteine. In an embodiment of the compound the amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain at the predefined terminus of the second stretch of amino acids is a selenocysteine, homocysteine or homoseleneocysteine. In an embodiment of the compound the amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids is a cysteine. In an embodiment of the compound the amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain of the first stretch of amino acids is a selenocysteine, homocysteine or homoseleneocysteine. In an embodiment of the compound the amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids is a terminal residue.
  • In an embodiment, the amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids is a penultimate, antepenultimate, or pre-antepenultimate terminal residue.
  • In an embodiment, the second stretch of consecutive amino acids has a sequence identical to a human immunoglobulin constant region. In an embodiment, the second stretch of consecutive amino acids is a portion of a human immunoglobulin constant region. In an embodiment, the first stretch of consecutive amino acids has a sequence identical to a human immunoglobulin constant region.
  • In an embodiment, the human immunoglobulin constant region polypeptide is a human IgG1, human IgG2, human IgG3, or human IgG4. A compound is provided wherein the side chain of at least one of amino acid residues having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain comprises a C1-C10 alkylene.
  • A composition is provided comprising two of the instant compounds bonded together via at least one disulfide bond between the second stretch of consecutive amino acids of each of the compounds.
  • A composition comprising a polypeptide is provided comprising consecutive amino acids having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:35 through 46, or having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:53 through 67, or having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:74 through 82, or having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:89 through 97, wherein the polypeptide does not consist of a naturally-occurring immunoglobulin polypeptide, including enzyme-cleaved fragments thereof.
  • A composition comprising a polypeptide is provided consisting of consecutive amino acids having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:35 through 46, or having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:53 through 67, or having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:74 through 82, or having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:89 through 97.
  • A composition comprising the instant polypeptide is provided and a carrier. In an embodiment of the compound, the carrier is phosphate-buffered saline.
  • A composition is provided comprising two of the instant independently chosen polypeptides, joined by a non-peptide bond. In one embodiment the bond is a di-chalcogenide bond. In one embodiment the bond is a disulfide bond.
  • A composition comprising two of the instant polypeptides bonded together via at least one disulfide bond between the two polypeptides is provided.
  • A composition is provided comprising a polypeptide is provided consisting of consecutive amino acids having a sequence identical to a portion of the sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO:44, SEQ ID NO:64, SEQ ID NO:81 or SEQ ID NO:96, wherein at least one of the terminal residues of the polypeptide has a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain.
  • In an embodiment of the compound the terminal residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain is a cysteine or analog thereof.
  • The various N-terminal signal sequences, plasmids, expression vecots, recombinant nucleic acids, stretches of consecutive amino acids, intein binding domains, cell types, recovery/isolation methods, etc set forth hereinabove are non-limiting examples, further of which are set forth in the Examples below.
  • DEFINITION OF TERMS
  • Stretch of consecutive amino acids: a plurality of amino acids arranged in a chain, each of which is joined to a preceding amino acid by a peptide bond, excepting that the first amino acid in the chain is not joined to a preceding amino acid. The amino acids of the chain may be naturally or non-naturally occurring, or may comprise a mixture thereof. The amino acids, unless otherwise indicated, may be genetically encoded, naturally-occurring but not genetically encoded, or non-naturally occurring, and any selection thereof.
  • In an embodiment, a stretch of consecutive amino acids has biological activity, including, but not limited to, target-binding activity or an immunoeffector activity, which biological activity is retained on the bonding of the stretch of consecutive amino acids to another stretch of consecutive amino acids by an —X—X— bond (e.g. —S—S—, —S—Se—, —Se—Se—, or —Se—S— bond). A “segment of consecutive amino acids” is an alternative description of “a stretch of amino acids”.
  • N-terminal amino acid residue: the terminal residue of a stretch of two or more consecutive amino acids having a free α-amino (NH2) functional group, or a derivative of an α-amino (NH2) functional group.
  • N-terminus: the free α-amino (NH2) group (or derivative thereof) of a N-terminal amino acid residue.
  • C-terminal amino acid residue: the terminal residue of a stretch of two or more consecutive amino acids having a free α-carboxyl (COOH) functional group, or a derivative of a α-carboxyl (COOH) functional group.
  • C-terminus: the free α-carboxyl (COOH) group (or derivative thereof) of a C-terminal amino acid residue.
  • S-terminal cysteine residue: a cysteine which is the N- and/or C-terminal residue(s) of a stretch of consecutive amino acids, and which has a free β-sulfhydryl (SH) functional group, or a derivative of a β-sulfhydryl (SH) functional group.
  • S-terminus: the free β-sulfhydryl (SH) group (or derivative thereof) of a S-terminal cysteine residue.
  • Se-terminal selenocysteine residue: a selenocysteine which is the N- and/or C-terminal residue(s) of a stretch of consecutive amino acids, and which has a free β-selenohydryl (SeH) functional group, or a derivative of a β-selenohydryl (SeH) functional group.
  • Se-terminus: the free β-selenohydryl (SeH) group (or derivative thereof) of a Se-terminal selenocysteine residue.
  • X-terminal amino acid residue: a cysteine (or cysteine derivative) or homocysteine (or homocysteine derivative), selenocysteine (or selenocysteine derivative) or homoselenocysteine (or homoselenocysteine derivative), which is the N- and/or C-terminal residue(s) of a stretch of consecutive amino acids, and which has a free β-sulfhydryl (SH) or β-selenohydryl (SeH) functional group, respectively, or a sulfur-containing or selenium-containing derivative thereof.
  • X-terminus: the free β-sulfhydryl (SH) or β-selenohydryl (SeH) group of a S-terminal cysteine/cysteine derivative residue or of a Se-terminal selenocysteine/selenocysteine derivative residue, respectively. In addition, an X-terminus can be the free β-sulfhydryl (SH) or β-selenohydryl (SeH) group of a S-terminal homocysteine residue or Se-terminal homoselenocysteine residue.
  • Target: an entity which binds to a discrete selection of a stretch of consecutive amino acids or a portion of a tertiary structure thereof and includes, but is not limited to, receptors, carrier proteins, hormones, cellular adhesive proteins, tissue-specific adhesion factors, growth factors, and enzymes. Specific examples of targets include a human EGF receptor, a HER2 protein, a VEGF receptor, a human CD20 antigen, a human CD11a, a human IgE immunoglobulin, a human glycoprotein IIa receptor, a human glycoprotein IIIa receptor, a human TNF alpha, and a TNF receptor.
  • A “bond”, unless otherwise specified, or contrary to context, is understood to include a covalent bond, a dipole-dipole interaction such as a hydrogen bond, and intermolecular interactions such as van der Waals forces.
  • A “Signal Sequence” is a short (3-60 amino acids long) peptide chain that directs the post-translational transport of a polypeptide.
  • “Amino acid” as used herein, in one embodiment, means a L or D isomer of the genetically encoded amino acids, i.e. isoleucine, alanine, leucine, asparagine, lysine, aspartate, methionine, cysteine, phenylalanine, glutamate, threonine, glutamine, tryptophan, glycine, valine, proline, arginine, serine, histidine, tyrosine, selenocysteine, pyrolysine and also includes homocysteine and homoselenocysteine.
  • Other examples of amino acids include an L or D isomer of taurine, gaba, dopamine, lanthionine, 2-aminoisobutyric acid, dehydroalanine, ornithine and citrulline, as well as non-natural homologues and synthetically modified forms thereof including amino acids having alkylene chains shortened or lengthened by up to two carbon atoms, amino acids comprising optionally substituted aryl groups, and amino acids comprising halogenated groups, including halogenated alkyl and aryl groups as well as beta or gamma amino acids, and cyclic analogs.
  • Due to the presence of ionizable amino and carboxyl groups, the amino acids in these embodiments may be in the form of acidic or basic salts, or may be in neutral forms. Individual amino acid residues may also be modified by oxidation or reduction. Other contemplated modifications include hydroxylation of proline and lysine, phosphorylation of hydroxyl groups of seryl or threonyl residues, and methylation of the alpha-amino groups of lysine, arginine, and histidine side chains.
  • Covalent derivatives may be prepared by linking particular functional groups to the amino acid side chains or at the N- or C-termini.
  • “Chalcogen” as used herein is limited to sulfur, selenium, tellurium and polonium only, i.e. as used herein, “chalcogen” excludes oxygen and ununhexium.
  • “Chalcogen functional group containing side chain” as used herein is an amino acid residue side chain containing a terminally reactive non-oxygen, non-ununhexium chalcogen atom. By way of non-limiting example, an amino acid having a chalcogen functional group containing side chain would be cysteine, selenocysteine, homocysteine etc., but would not include methionine, for example, which contains a chalcogen atom (S), but not a terminally reactive chalcogen atom.
  • Compounds comprising amino acids with R-group substitutions are within the scope of the invention. It is understood that substituents and substitution patterns on the compounds of the instant invention can be selected by one of ordinary skill in the art to provide compounds that are chemically stable from readily available starting materials.
  • “Natural amino acid” as used herein means a L or D isomer of the genetically encoded amino acids, i.e. isoleucine, alanine, leucine, asparagine, lysine, aspartate, methionine, cysteine, phenylalanine, glutamate, threonine, glutamine, tryptophan, glycine, valine, proline, arginine, serine, histidine, tyrosine, selenocysteine, pyrolysine and homocysteine and homoselenocysteine.
  • “Non-natural amino acid” as used herein means a chemically modified L or D isomer of isoleucine, alanine, leucine, asparagine, lysine, aspartate, methionine, cysteine, phenylalanine, glutamate, threonine, glutamine, tryptophan, glycine, valine, proline, arginine, serine, histidine, tyrosine, selenocysteine, pyrolysine, homocysteine, homoselenocysteine, taurine, gaba, dopamine, lanthionine, 2-aminoisobutyric acid, dehydroalanine, ornithine or citrulline, including cysteine and selenocysteine derivatives having C3-C10 aliphatic side chains between the alpha carbon and the S or Se. In one embodiment the aliphatic side chain is an alkylene. In another embodiment, the aliphatic side chain is an alkenylene or alkynylene.
  • In addition to the stretches of consecutive amino acid sequences described herein, it is contemplated that variants thereof can be prepared by introducing appropriate nucleotide changes into the encoding DNA, and/or by synthesis of the desired consecutive amino acid sequences. Those skilled in the art will appreciate that amino acid changes may alter post-translational processes of the stretches of consecutive amino acids described herein when expression is the chosen method of synthesis (rather than chemical synthesis for example), such as changing the number or position of glycosylation sites or altering the membrane anchoring characteristics.
  • Variations in the sequences described herein, can be made, for example, using any of the techniques and guidelines for conservative and non-conservative mutations set forth, for instance, in U.S. Pat. No. 5,364,934. Variations may be a substitution, deletion or insertion of one or more codons encoding the consecutive amino acid sequence of interest that results in a change in the amino acid sequence as compared with the native sequence. Optionally the variation is by substitution of at least one amino acid with any other amino acid in one or more of the domains. Guidance in determining which amino acid residue may be inserted, substituted or deleted without adversely affecting the desired activity may be found by comparing the sequence with that of homologous known protein molecules and minimizing the number of amino acid sequence changes made in regions of high homology. Amino acid substitutions can be the result of replacing one amino acid with another amino acid having similar structural and/or chemical properties, such as the replacement of a leucine with a serine, i.e., conservative amino acid replacements. Insertions or deletions may optionally be in the range of about 1 to 5 amino acids. The variation allowed may be determined by systematically making insertions, deletions or substitutions of amino acids in the sequence and testing the resulting variants for activity exhibited by the full-length or mature native sequence. It is understood that any terminal variations are made within the context of the invention disclosed herein.
  • Amino acid sequence variants of the binding partner are prepared with various objectives in mind, including increasing the affinity of the binding partner for its ligand, facilitating the stability, purification and preparation of the binding partner, modifying its plasma half life, improving therapeutic efficacy, and lessening the severity or occurrence of side effects during therapeutic use of the binding partner.
  • Amino acid sequence variants of these sequences are also contemplated herein including insertional, substitutional, or deletional variants. Such variants ordinarily can prepared by site-specific mutagenesis of nucleotides in the DNA encoding the target-binding monomer, by which DNA encoding the variant is obtained, and thereafter expressing the DNA in recombinant cell culture. Fragments having up to about 100-150 amino acid residues can also be prepared conveniently by in vitro synthesis. Such amino acid sequence variants are predetermined variants and are not found in nature. The variants exhibit the qualitative biological activity (including target-binding) of the nonvariant form, though not necessarily of the same quantative value. While the site for introducing an amino acid sequence variation is predetermined, the mutation per se need not be predetermined. For example, in order to optimize the performance of a mutation at a given site, random or saturation mutagenesis (where all 20 possible residues are inserted) is conducted at the target codon and the expressed variant is screened for the optimal combination of desired activities. Such screening is within the ordinary skill in the art.
  • Amino acid insertions usually will be on the order of about from 1 to 10 amino acid residues; substitutions are typically introduced for single residues; and deletions will range about from 1 to 30 residues. Deletions or insertions preferably are made in adjacent pairs, i.e. a deletion of 2 residues or insertion of 2 residues. It will be amply apparent from the following discussion that substitutions, deletions, insertions or any combination thereof are introduced or combined to arrive at a final construct.
  • In an aspect, the invention concerns a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids having at least about 80% sequence identity, preferably at least about 81% sequence identity, more preferably at least about 82% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 83% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 84% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 85% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 86% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 87% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 88% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 89% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 90% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 91% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 92% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 93% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 94% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 95% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 96% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 97% sequence identity, yet more preferably at least about 98% sequence identity and yet more preferably at least about 99% sequence identity to an amino acid sequence disclosed in the specification, a figure, a SEQ ID NO. or a sequence listing of the present application.
  • The % amino acid sequence identity values can be readily obtained using, for example, the WU-BLAST-2 computer program (Altschul et al., Methods in Enzymology 266:460-480 (1996)).
  • Fragments of native sequences are provided herein. Such fragments may be truncated at the N-terminus or C-terminus, or may lack internal residues, for example, when compared with a full length native protein. Again, it is understood that any terminal variations are made within the context of the invention disclosed herein. Certain fragments lack amino acid residues that are not essential for a desired biological activity of the sequence of interest.
  • Any of a number of conventional techniques may be used. Desired peptide fragments or fragments of stretches of consecutive amino acids may be chemically synthesized. An alternative approach involves generating fragments by enzymatic digestion, e.g. by treating the protein with an enzyme known to cleave proteins at sites defined by particular amino acid residues, or by digesting the DNA with suitable restriction enzymes and isolating the desired fragment. Yet another suitable technique involves isolating and amplifying a DNA fragment encoding a desired polypeptide/sequence fragment, by polymerase chain reaction (PCR). Oligonucleotides that define the desired termini of the DNA fragment are employed at the 5′ and 3′ primers in the PCR.
  • In particular embodiments, conservative substitutions of interest are shown in Table 1 under the heading of preferred substitutions. If such substitutions result in a change in biological activity, then more substantial changes, denominated exemplary substitutions in Table 1, or as further described below in reference to amino acid classes, are introduced and the products screened.
  • TABLE 1
    Original Exemplary Preferred
    Ala (A) val; leu; ile val
    Arg (R) lys; gln; asn lys
    Asn (N) gln; his; lys; arg gln
    Asp (D) glu glu
    Cys (C) ser ser
    Gln (Q) asn asn
    Glu (E) asp asp
    Gly (G) pro; ala ala
    His (H) asn; gln; lys; arg arg
    Ile (I) leu; val; met; ala; phe; norleucine leu
    Leu (L) norleucine; ile; val; met; ala; phe ile
    Lys (K) arg; gln; asn arg
    Met (M) leu; phe; ile leu
    Phe (F) leu; val; ile; ala; tyr leu
    Pro (P) ala ala
    Ser (S) thr thr
    Thr (T) ser ser
    Trp (W) tyr; phe tyr
    Tyr (Y) trp; phe; thr; ser phe
    Val (V) ile; leu; met; phe; ala; norleucine leu
  • Substantial modifications in function or immunological identity of the sequence are accomplished by selecting substitutions that differ significantly in their effect on maintaining (a) the structure of the polypeptide backbone in the area of the substitution, for example, as a sheet or helical conformation, (b) the charge or hydrophobicity of the molecule at the target site, or (c) the bulk of the side chain. Naturally occurring residues are divided into groups based on common side-chain properties:
  • (1) hydrophobic: norleucine, met, ala, val, leu, ile;
    (2) neutral hydrophilic: cys, ser, thr;
    (3) acidic: asp, glu;
    (4) basic: asn, gln, his, lys, arg;
    (5) residues that influence chain orientation: gly, pro;
    (6) aromatic: trp, tyr, phe.
  • Non-conservative substitutions will entail exchanging a member of one of these classes for another class. Such substituted residues also may be introduced into the conservative substitution sites or, more preferably, into the remaining (non-conserved) sites.
  • The variations can be made using methods known in the art such as oligonucleotide-mediated (site-directed) mutagenesis, alanine scanning, and PCR mutagenesis. Site-directed mutagenesis (Carter et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 13:4331 (1986); Zoller et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 10:6487 (1987)), cassette mutagenesis (Wells et al., Gene, 34:315 (1985)), restriction selection mutagenesis (Wells et al., Philos. Trans. R. Soc. London SerA, 317:415 (1986)) or other known techniques can be performed on the cloned DNA to produce the variant DNA.
  • Scanning amino acid analysis can also be employed to identify one or more amino acids along a contiguous sequence. Among the preferred scanning amino acids are relatively small, neutral amino acids. Such amino acids include alanine, glycine, serine, and cysteine. Alanine is typically a preferred scanning amino acid among this group because it eliminates the side-chain beyond the beta-carbon and is less likely to alter the main-chain conformation of the variant (Cunningham and Wells, Science, 244:1081-1085 (1989)). Alanine is also typically preferred because it is the most common amino acid. Further, it is frequently found in both buried and exposed positions (Creighton, The Proteins, (W.H. Freeman & Co., N.Y.); Chothia, J. Mol. Biol., 150:1 (1976)). If alanine substitution does not yield adequate amounts of variant, an isoteric amino acid can be used.
  • Covalent modifications: The stretches of consecutive amino acids may be covalently modified. One type of covalent modification includes reacting targeted amino acid residues with an organic derivatizing agent that is capable of reacting with selected side chains or the N- or C-terminal residues that are not involved in an -x-x- bond. Derivatization with bifunctional agents is useful, for instance, for crosslinking to a water-insoluble support matrix or surface for use in the method for purifying anti-sequence of interest antibodies, and vice-versa. Commonly used crosslinking agents include, e.g., 1,1-bis(diazoacetyl)-2-phenylethane, glutaraldehyde, N-hydroxysuccinimide esters, for example, esters with 4-azidosalicylic acid, homobifunctional imidoesters, including disuccinimidyl esters such as 3,3′-dithiobis(succinimidylpropionate), bifunctional maleimides such as bis-N-maleimido-1,8-octane and agents such as methyl-3-((p-azidophenyl)dithio)propioimidate.
  • Other modifications include deamidation of glutaminyl and asparaginyl residues to the corresponding glutamyl and aspartyl residues, respectively, hydroxylation of proline and lysine, phosphorylation of hydroxyl groups of seryl or threonyl residues, methylation of the .alpha.-amino groups of lysine, arginine, and histidine side chains (T. E. Creighton, Proteins: Structure and Molecular Properties, W.H. Freeman & Co., San Francisco, pp. 79-86 (1983)), acetylation of the N-terminal amine, and amidation of any C-terminal carboxyl group.
  • Another type of covalent modification comprises altering the native glycosylation pattern of the consecutive stretch of amino acids or of a polypeptide. “Altering the native glycosylation pattern” is intended for purposes herein to mean deleting one or more carbohydrate moieties found in amino acid sequences (either by removing the underlying glycosylation site or by deleting the glycosylation by chemical and/or enzymatic means), and/or adding one or more glycosylation sites that are not present in the native sequence. In addition, the phrase includes qualitative changes in the glycosylation of the native proteins, involving a change in the nature and proportions of the various carbohydrate moieties present.
  • Addition of glycosylation sites to the amino acid sequence may be accomplished by altering the amino acid sequence. The alteration may be made, for example, by the addition of, or substitution by, one or more serine or threonine residues to the native sequence (for O-linked glycosylation sites). The amino acid sequence may optionally be altered through changes at the DNA level, particularly by mutating the DNA encoding the amino acid sequence at preselected bases such that codons are generated that will translate into the desired amino acids.
  • Another means of increasing the number of carbohydrate moieties on the amino acid sequence is by chemical or enzymatic coupling of glycosides to the polypeptide. Such methods are described in the art, e.g., in WO 87/05330 published Sep. 11, 1987, and in Aplin and Wriston, CRC Crit. Rev. Biochem., pp. 259-306 (1981).
  • Removal of carbohydrate moieties present on the amino acid sequence may be accomplished chemically or enzymatically or by mutational substitution of codons encoding for amino acid residues that serve as targets for glycosylation. Chemical deglycosylation techniques are known in the art and described, for instance, by Hakimuddin, et al., Arch. Biochem. Biophys., 259:52 (1987) and by Edge et al., Anal. Biochem., 118:131 (1981). Enzymatic cleavage of carbohydrate moieties on polypeptides can be achieved by the use of a variety of endo- and exo-glycosidases as described by Thotakura et al., Meth. Enzymol., 138:350 (1987).
  • Another type of covalent modification comprises linking the amino acid sequence to one of a variety of nonproteinaceous polymers, e.g., polyethylene glycol (PEG), polypropylene glycol, or polyoxyalkylenes, in the manner set forth in U.S. Pat. No. 4,640,835; 4,496,689; 4,301,144; 4,670,417; 4,791,192 or 4,179,337, or to a tag polypeptide which provides an epitope to which an anti-tag antibody can selectively bind. Various tag polypeptides and their respective antibodies are well known in the art. Examples include poly-histidine (poly-his) or poly-histidine-glycine (poly-his-gly) tags; the flu HA tag polypeptide and its antibody 12CA5 (Field et al., Mol. Cell. Biol., 8:2159-2165 (1988)); the c-myc tag and the 8F9, 3C7, 6E10, G4, B7 and 9E10 antibodies thereto (Evan et al., Molecular and Cellular Biology, 5:3610-3616 (1985); and the Herpes Simplex virus glycoprotein D (gD) tag and its antibody (Paborsky et al., Protein Engineering, 3(6):547-553 (1990)). Other tag polypeptides include the Flag-peptide (Hopp et al., BioTechnology, 6:1204-1210 (1988)); the KT3 epitope peptide (Martin et al., Science, 255:192-194 (1992)); an alpha-tubulin epitope peptide (Skinner et al., J. Biol. Chem., 266:15163-15166 (1991)); and the T7 gene 10 protein peptide tag (Lutz-Freyermuth et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 87:6393-6397 (1990)).
  • Salts
  • Salts of the compounds disclosed herein are within the scope of the invention. As used herein, a “salt” is salt of the instant compounds which has been modified by making acid or base salts of the compounds.
  • Pharmaceuticals
  • The salt can be pharmaceutically acceptable. Examples of pharmaceutically acceptable salts include, but are not limited to, mineral or organic acid salts of basic residues such as amines; alkali or organic salts of acidic residues such as carboxcylic acids. The salts can be made using an organic or inorganic acid. Such acid salts are chlorides, bromides, sulfates, nitrates, phosphates, sulfonates, formates, tartrates, maleates, malates, citrates, benzoates, salicylates, ascorbates, and the like. Carboxylate salts are the alkaline earth metal salts, sodium, potassium or lithium.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the compounds disclosed here can be prepared in any conventional manner, for example by treating a solution or suspension of the corresponding free base or acid with one chemical equivalent of a pharmaceutically acceptable acid or base. Conventional concentration or crystallization techniques can be employed to isolate the salts. Illustrative of suitable acids are acetic, lactic, succinic, maleic, tartaric, citric, gluconic, ascorbic, benzoic, cinnamic, fumaric, sulfuric, phosphoric, hydrochloric, hydrobromic, hydroiodic, sulfamic, sulfonic acids such as methanesulfonic, benzene sulfonic, p-toluenesulfonic, and related acids. Illustrative bases are sodium, potassium, and calcium.
  • The term “pharmaceutically acceptable carrier” is understood to include excipients, carriers or diluents. The particular carrier, diluent or excipient used will depend upon the means and purpose for which the active ingredient is being applied.
  • The compounds of this invention may be administered alone or in combination with one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, in either single or multiple doses. Suitable pharmaceutical carriers include inert solid diluents or fillers, sterile aqueous solutions and various organic solvents. The pharmaceutical compositions disclosed herein can be readily administered in a variety of dosage forms such as injectable solutions, tablets, powders, lozenges, syrups, and the like. These pharmaceutical compositions can, if desired, contain additional ingredients such as flavorings, binders, excipients and the like. Additionally, lubricating agents such as magnesium stearate, sodium lauryl sulfate and talc may be used for tabletting purposes. Solid compositions of a similar type may also be employed as fillers in soft and hard filled gelatin capsules. Preferred materials for this include lactose or milk sugar and high molecular weight polyethylene glycols. When aqueous suspensions or elixirs are desired for oral administration, the essential active ingredient therein may be combined with various sweetening or flavoring agents, coloring matter or dyes and, if desired, emulsifying or suspending agents, together with diluents such as water, ethanol, propylene glycol, glycerin and combinations thereof.
  • For parenteral administration, solutions containing a compound of this invention or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof in sterile aqueous solution may be employed. Such aqueous solutions should be suitably buffered if necessary and the liquid diluent first rendered isotonic with sufficient saline or glucose. These particular aqueous solutions are especially suitable for intravenous, intramuscular, subcutaneous and intraperitoneal administration. The sterile aqueous media employed are all readily available by standard techniques known to those skilled in the art.
  • The final pharmaceutical composition can be processed into a unit dosage form (e.g., powdered or lyophilized in a vial, a solution in a vial, tablet, capsule or sachet) and then packaged for distribution. The processing step will vary depending upon the particular unit dosage form. For example, a tablet is generally compressed under pressure into a desired shape and a capsule or sachet employs a simple fill operation. Those skilled in the art are well aware of the procedures used for manufacturing the various unit dosage forms.
  • The compositions of this invention may be in a variety of forms. These include, for example, liquid, semi-solid and solid dosage forms, such as liquid solutions (e.g., injectable and infusible solutions), dispersions or suspensions, tablets, pills, powders, liposomes and suppositories. The preferred form depends on the intended mode of administration and therapeutic application. Some compositions are in the form of injectable or infusible solutions. A mode of administration is parenteral (e.g., intravenous, subcutaneous, intraperitoneal, intramuscular). In an embodiment, the compound is administered by intravenous infusion or injection. In another embodiment, the compound is administered by intramuscular or subcutaneous injection.
  • Therapeutic compositions as contemplated herein typically must be sterile and stable under the conditions of manufacture and storage. The composition can be formulated as a solution, microemulsion, dispersion, liposome, or other ordered structure suitable to high drug concentration. Sterile injectable solutions can be prepared by incorporating the compound in the required amount in an appropriate solvent with one or a combination of ingredients as required, followed by filtered sterilization. Generally, dispersions are prepared by incorporating the active compound into a sterile vehicle that contains a basic dispersion medium and the required other ingredients from those enumerated above. In the case of sterile powders for the preparation of sterile injectable solutions, the preferred methods of preparation are vacuum drying and freeze-drying that yields a powder of the active ingredient plus any additional desired ingredient from a previously sterile-filtered solution thereof. The proper fluidity of a solution can be maintained, for example, by the use of a coating such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersion and by the use of surfactants. Prolonged absorption of injectable compositions can be brought about by including in the composition an agent that delays absorption, for example, monostearate salts and gelatin.
  • In certain embodiments, the active compound may be prepared with a carrier that will protect the compound against rapid release, such as a controlled release formulation, including implants, transdermal patches, and microencapsulated delivery systems. Biodegradable, biocompatible polymers can be used, such as ethylene vinyl acetate, polyanhydrides, polyglycolic acid, collagen, polyorthoesters, and polylactic acid. Many methods for the preparation of such formulations are patented or generally known to those skilled in the art. See, e.g., Sustained and Controlled Release Drug Delivery Systems, J. R. Robinson, ed., Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, 1978. In certain embodiments, the compounds of the invention may be orally administered, for example, with an inert diluent or an assimilable edible carrier. The compound (and other ingredients, if desired) may also be enclosed in a hard or soft shell gelatin capsule, compressed into tablets, or incorporated directly into the subject's diet. For oral therapeutic administration, the compounds may be incorporated with excipients and used in the form of ingestible tablets, buccal tablets, troches, capsules, elixirs, suspensions, syrups, wafers, and the like. In administering a compound of the invention by other than parenteral administration the compound may be coated with, or co-administered with, a material to prevent its inactivation.
  • Supplementary active compounds can also be incorporated into the compositions, for example a chemotherapeutic agent, an antineoplastic agent or an anti-tumor agent. IN addition, the compounds of the invention may be coformulated and/or coadministered with one or more additional therapeutic agents. These agents include, without limitation, antibodies that bind other targets (e.g., antibodies that bind one or more growth factors or cytokines, their cell surface receptors), binding proteins, antineoplastic agents, chemotherapeutic agents, anti-tumor agents, antisense oligonucleotides, growth factors. In one embodiment, a pharmaceutical composition of the compounds disclosed herein may comprise one or more additional therapeutic agent.
  • For therapeutic use, the compositions disclosed here can be administered in various manners, including soluble form by bolus injection, continuous infusion, sustained release from implants, oral ingestion, local injection (e.g. intracrdiac, intramuscular), systemic injection, or other suitable techniques well known in the pharmaceutical arts. Other methods of pharmaceutical administration include, but are not limited to oral, subcutaneously, transdermal, intravenous, intramuscular and parenteral methods of administration. Typically, a soluble composition will comprise a purified compound in conjunction with physiologically acceptable carriers, excipients or diluents. Such carriers will be nontoxic to recipients at the dosages and concentrations employed. The preparation of such compositions can entail combining a compound with buffers, antioxidants, carbohydrates including glucose, sucrose or dextrins, chelating agents such as EDTA, glutathione and other stabilizers and excipients. Neutral buffered saline or saline mixed with conspecific serum albumin are exemplary appropriate diluents. The product can be formulated as a lyophilizate using appropriate excipient solutions (e.g., sucrose) as diluents.
  • Other derivatives comprise the compounds/compositions of this invention covalently bonded to a nonproteinaceous polymer. The bonding to the polymer is generally conducted so as not to interfere with the preferred biological activity of the compound, e.g. the binding activity of the compound to a target. The nonproteinaceous polymer ordinarily is a hydrophilic synthetic polymer, i.e., a polymer not otherwise found in nature. However, polymers which exist in nature and are produced by recombinant or in vitro methods are useful, as are polymers which are isolated from nature. Hydrophilic polyvinyl polymers fall within the scope of this invention, e.g. polyvinylalcohol and polyvinylpyrrolidone. Particularly useful are polyalkylene ethers such as polyethylene glycol, polypropylene glycol, polyoxyethylene esters or methoxy polyethylene glycol; polyoxyalkylenes such as polyoxyethylene, polyoxypropylene, and block copolymers of polyoxyethylene and polyoxypropylene (Pluronics); polymethacrylates; carbomers; branched or unbranched polysaccharides which comprise the saccharide monomers D-mannose, D- and L-galactose, fucose, fructose, D-xylose, L-arabinose, D-glucuronic acid, sialic acid, D-galacturontc acid, D-mannuronic acid (e.g. polymannuronic acid, or alginic acid), D-glucosamine, D-galactosamine, D-glucose and neuraminic acid including homopolysaccharides and heteropolysaccharides such as lactose, amylopectin, starch, hydroxyethyl starch, amylose, dextran sulfate, dextran, dextrins, glycogen, or the polysaccharide subunit of acid mucopolysaccharides, e.g. hyaluronic acid; polymers of sugar alcohols such as polysorbitol and polymannitol; as well as heparin or heparon.
  • The pharmaceutical compositions of the invention may include a “therapeutically effective amount” or a “prophylactically effective amount” of a compound of the invention. A “therapeutically effective amount” refers to an amount effective, at dosages and for periods of time necessary, to achieve the desired therapeutic result. A therapeutically effective amount of the compound may vary according to factors such as the disease state, age, sex, and weight of the individual. A therapeutically effective amount is also one in which any toxic or detrimental effects of the compound are outweighed by the therapeutically beneficial effects. A “prophylactically effective amount” refers to an amount effective, at dosages and for periods of time necessary, to achieve the desired prophylactic result. Typically, since a prophylactic dose is used in subjects prior to or at an earlier stage of disease, the prophylactically effective amount will be less than the therapeutically effective amount.
  • Examples of Pharmaceutical Compositions
  • Non-limiting examples of such compositions and dosages are set forth as follows:
  • Compositions comprising a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids which comprises consecutive amino acids having the sequence of bevacizumab (e.g. Avastin) may comprise trehalose dihydrate, sodium phosphate (monobasic, monohydrate), sodium phosphate (dibasic, anhydrous), polysorbate 20, and Water for Injection, USP. The composition may also be lyophilized, to which the water can be added for reconstitution. In an embodiment the composition has a pH of 6.2 or about 6.2. In one embodiment the compound can be administered combination with a chemotherapeutic such as intravenous 5-fluorouracil for treatment of patients with metastatic carcinoma of the colon or rectum. In one embodiment the compound is administered in a dose of between 0.1 and 10 mg/kg given once every 14 days as an IV infusion. In a further embodiment the dose is 5 mg/kg given once every 14 days. In an embodiment the dose is between 1.0 and 2.0 mg/kg given once every 14 days. In an embodiment the dose is between 0.01 and 1.5 mg/kg given once every 14 days. In an embodiment the dose is between 0.001 and 10 mg/kg given once every 1-21 days.
  • Compositions comprising a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids which comprises consecutive amino acids having the sequence of trastuzumab (e.g. Herceptin) may comprise trehalose dihydrate, L-histidine HCl, L-histidine, and polysorbate 20, USP. This can be reconstituted with Bacteriostatic Water for Injection (BWFI), USP, or equivalents thereof, containing 1.1% benzyl alcohol as a preservative or equivalents thereof. In an embodiment the composition has a pH of about 6.0. The composition may also be lyophilized, to which the water can be added for reconstitution. In one embodiment the compound can be administered to subjects with metatastic breast cancer whose tumor overexpresses HER2 protein. In an embodiment the subject has received/is receiving chemotherapy. In another embodiment the compound is administered in combination with paclitaxel to subjects with metastatic breast cancer whose tumors overexpress the HER2 protein and who have not received chemotherapy for their metastatic disease. In one embodiment the compound is administered in an initial dose of between 0.1 and 10 mg/kg in a continuous 45-120 minute infusion IV infusion. In a further embodiment the compound is administered in a dose of 4 mg/kg in a 90 minute infusion. In an embodiment a weekly maintenance dose is administered to the subject at a dose of 2 mg/kg in a 30 minute infusion. In an embodiment the compound is administered in a dose of 0.5 to 1.5 mg/kg in a 90 minute infusion. In an embodiment a weekly maintenance dose is administered to the subject at a dose of 0.5-1.0 mg/kg in a 30 minute infusion. In an embodiment the compound is administered in a dose of 0.04 to 0.5 mg/kg in a 90 minute infusion. In an embodiment the compound is administered in a dose of between 0.001 to 10 mg/kg in a 90 minute infusion.
  • Compositions comprising a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids which comprises consecutive amino acids having the sequence of rituximab (e.g. Rituxin) may comprise sodium chloride, sodium citrate dihydrate, polysorbate 80, and Water for Injection (USP), or equivalents thereof. In an embodiment the pH of the composition is adjusted to 6.5. The composition may also be lyophilized, to which the water can be added for reconstitution. In one embodiment the compound is administered to a subject for the treatment of relapsed or refractory, low-grade or follicular, CD20-positive, B-cell non-Hodgkin's lymphoma. In one embodiment the compound is administered at a dose of 250-500 mg/m2 IV infusion once weekly for 4 or 8 doses. In a further embodiment the compound is administered at 375 mg/m2 IV infusion once weekly for 4 or 8 doses. In one embodiment the compound is administered at a dose of 150-250 mg/m2 IV infusion once weekly for 4 or 8 doses. In one embodiment the compound is administered at a dose of 1.5 to 5 mg/m2 IV infusion once weekly for 4 or 8 doses. In one embodiment the compound is administered at a dose of between 1.0 and 500 mg/m2 IV infusion once weekly for 4 or 8 doses
  • Compositions comprising a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids which comprises consecutive amino acids having the sequence of efalizumab (e.g. Raptiva) may comprise sucrose, L-histidine hydrochloride monohydrate, L-histidine and polysorbate 20. Such a composition may be diluted to an approporiate dosage form with sterile non-USP water, or Sterile Water for Injection, USP, or equivalents thereof. The composition may also be lyophilized, to which the water can be added for reconstitution. In one embodiment the compound is administered to a subject for the treatment of chronic moderate to severe plaque psoriasis. Such a subject may be a candidate for systemic therapy or phototherapy. In an embodiment the compound is administered in a single 0.1-1.1 mg/kg subcutaneous (SC) conditioning dose followed by weekly SC doses of 0.8-1.5 mg/kg (maximum single dose not to exceed a total of 250 mg). In a further embodiment the compound is administered in a single 0.7 mg/kg SC conditioning dose followed by weekly SC doses of 1 mg/kg (maximum single dose not to exceed a total of 200 mg). In an embodiment the compound is administered in a single 0.001-1.0 mg/kg subcutaneous (SC) conditioning dose followed by weekly SC doses of 0.008-0.015 mg/kg.
  • Compositions comprising a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids which comprises consecutive amino acids having the sequence of omalizumab (e.g. Xolair) may comprise sucrose, L-histidine hydrochloride monohydrate, L-histidine, and polysorbate 20. Such a composition may lyophilized. In an embodiment the composition is diluted to an appropriate dosage form with Sterile Water for Injection, USP, or equivalents thereof. In one embodiment the compound is administered to a subject for the treatment of moderate to severe persistent asthma. In another embodiment the compound is administered to a subject who has a positive skin test or in vitro reactivity to a perennial aeroallergen and whose symptoms are inadequately controlled with inhaled corticosteroids in order to decrease the incidence of asthma exacerbations. In an embodiment the compound is administered at a dose of 100 to 400 mg subcutaneously every 2 or 4 weeks. In a further embodiment the compound is administered at a dose of 150 to 375 mg SC every 2 or 4 weeks. In an embodiment the compound is administered at a dose of 25 to 150 mg subcutaneously every 2 or 4 weeks. In an embodiment the compound is administered at a dose of 1 to 4 mg subcutaneously every 2 or 4 weeks.
  • Compositions comprising a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids which comprises consecutive amino acids having the sequence of etanercept (e.g. Enbrel) may comprise mannitol, sucrose, and tromethamine. In an embodiment, the composition is in the form of a lyophilizate. In an embodiment, the composition is reconstituted with, for example, Sterile Bacteriostatic Water for Injection (BWFI), USP (containing 0.9% benzyl alcohol). In an embodiment the compound is administered to a subject for reducing signs and symptoms, inducing major clinical response, inhibiting the progression of structural damage, and improving physical function in subjects with moderately to severely active rheumatoid arthritis. The compound may be initiated in combination with methotrexate (MTX) or used alone. In an embodiment the compound is administered to a subject for reducing signs and symptoms of moderately to severely active polyarticular-course juvenile rheumatoid arthritis in subjects who have had an inadequate response to one or more DMARDs. In an embodiment the compound is administered to a subject for reducing signs and symptoms, inhibiting the progression of structural damage of active arthritis, and improving physical function in subjects with psoriatic arthritis. In an embodiment the compound is administered to a subject for reducing signs and symptoms in subjects with active ankylosing spondylitis. In an embodiment the compound is administered to a subject for the treatment of chronic moderate to severe plaque psoriasis. In an embodiment wherein the subject has rheumatoid arthritis, psoriatic arthritis, or ankylosing spondylitis the compound is administered at 25-75 mg per week given as one or more subcutaneous (SC) injections. In a further embodiment the compound is administered at 50 mg per week in a single SC injection. In an embodiment wherein the subject has plaque psoriasis the compound is administered at 25-75 mg twice weekly or 4 days apart for 3 months followed by a reduction to a maintenance dose of 25-75 mg per week. In a further embodiment the compound is administered at a dose of at 50 mg twice weekly or 4 days apart for 3 months followed by a reduction to a maintenance dose of 50 mg per week. In an embodiment the dose is between 2× and 10× less than the doses set forth herein. In an embodiment wherein the subject has active polyarticular-course JRA the compound may be administered at a dose of 0.2-1.2 mg/kg per week (up to a maximum of 75 mg per week). In a further embodiment the compound is administered at a dose of 0.8 mg/kg per week (up to a maximum of 50 mg per week). In some embodiments the dose is between 2× and 100× less than the doses set forth hereinabove.
  • Compositions comprising a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids which comprises consecutive amino acids having the sequence of infliximab (e.g. Remicade) may comprise sucrose, polysorbate 80, monobasic sodium phosphate, monohydrate, and dibasic sodium phosphate, dihydrate. Preservatives are not present in one embodiment. In an embodiment, the composition is in the form of a lyophilizate. In an embodiment, the composition is reconstituted with, for example, Water for Injection (BWFI), USP. In an embodiment the pH of the composition is 7.2 or is about 7.2. In one embodiment the compound is administered is administered to a subject with rheumatoid arthritis in a dose of 2-4 mg/kg given as an intravenous infusion followed with additional similar doses at 2 and 6 weeks after the first infusion then every 8 weeks thereafter. In a further embodiment the compound is administered in a dose of 3 mg/kg given as an intravenous infusion followed with additional similar doses at 2 and 6 weeks after the first infusion then every 8 weeks thereafter. In an embodiment the dose is adjusted up to 10 mg/kg or treating as often as every 4 weeks. In an embodiment the compound is administered in combination with methotrexate. In one embodiment the compound is administered is administered to a subject with Crohn's disease or fistulizing Crohn's disease at dose of 2-7 mg/kg given as an induction regimen at 0, 2 and 6 weeks followed by a maintenance regimen of 4-6 mg/kg every 8 weeks thereafter for the treatment of moderately to severely active Crohn's disease or fistulizing disease. In a further embodiment the compound is administered at a dose of 5 mg/kg given as an induction regimen at 0, 2 and 6 weeks followed by a maintenance regimen of 5 mg/kg every 8 weeks thereafter for the treatment of moderately to severely active Crohn's disease or fistulizing disease. In an embodiment the dose is adjusted up to 10 mg/kg. In one embodiment the compound is administered to a subject with ankylosing spondylitis at a dose of 2-7 mg/kg given as an intravenous infusion followed with additional similar doses at 2 and 6 weeks after the first infusion, then every 6 weeks thereafter. In a further embodiment the compound is administered at a dose of 5 mg/kg given as an intravenous infusion followed with additional similar doses at 2 and 6 weeks after the first infusion, then every 6 weeks thereafter. In one embodiment the compound is administered to a subject with psoriatic arthritis at a dose of 2-7 mg/kg given as an intravenous infusion followed with additional similar doses at 2 and 6 weeks after the first infusion then every 8 weeks thereafter. In a further embodiment the compound is administered at a dose of 5 mg/kg given as an intravenous infusion followed with additional similar doses at 2 and 6 weeks after the first infusion then every 8 weeks thereafter. In an embodiment the compound is administered with methotrexate. In one embodiment the compound is administered to a subject with ulcerative colitis at a dose of 2-7 mg/kg given as an induction regimen at 0, 2 and 6 weeks followed by a maintenance regimen of 2-7 mg/kg every 8 weeks thereafter for the treatment of moderately to severely active ulcerative colitis. In a further embodiment the compound is administered to a subject with ulcerative colitis at a dose of 5 mg/kg given as an induction regimen at 0, 2 and 6 weeks followed by a maintenance regimen of 5 mg/kg every 8 weeks thereafter. In some embodiments the dose is between 2× and 100× less than the doses set forth hereinabove for treating the indivisual diseases.
  • Compositions comprising a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids which comprises consecutive amino acids having the sequence of cetuximab (e.g. Erbitux) may comprise a preservative-free composition including sodium chloride, sodium phosphate dibasic heptahydrate, sodium phosphate monobasic monohydrate. In an embodiment, the composition is in the form of a lyophilizate. In an embodiment, the composition is reconstituted with, for example, Water for Injection, USP. In an embodiment the pH of the composition is in the range of about 7.0 to about 7.4. In one embodiment the compound is administered to a subject for the treatment of EGFR-expressing, metastatic colorectal carcinoma. In another embodiment the compound is used in combination with irinotecan for the treatment in patients who are refractory to irinotecan-based chemotherapy. In an embodiment the compound is administered at a dose of 300-500 mg/m2 as an initial loading dose (first infusion) administered as a 120-minute IV infusion (maximum infusion rate 5 mL/min). In a further embodiment the compound is administered at a dose of 400 mg/m2 as an initial loading dose (first infusion) administered as a 120-minute IV infusion (maximum infusion rate 5 mL/min). In an embodiment the weekly maintenance dose (all other infusions) is 200-300 mg/m2 infused over 60 minutes (maximum infusion rate 5 mL/min). In a further embodiment the weekly maintenance dose (all other infusions) is 250 mg/m2 infused over 60 minutes (maximum infusion rate 5 mL/min). In some embodiments the dose is between 2× and 100× less than the doses set forth hereinabove.
  • Compositions comprising a compound comprising a stretch of consecutive amino acids which comprises consecutive amino acids having the sequence of abciximab (e.g. Reopro) may comprise, a preservative-free composition including sodium phosphate, sodium chloride and polysorbate 80. In an embodiment, the composition is in the form of a lyophilizate. In an embodiment, the composition is diluted in, or reconstituted with, for example, Water for Injection, USP. In an embodiment the pH of the composition is 7.2 or is about 7.2. In one embodiment, the composition is used as an adjunct to percutaneous coronary intervention (PCI). In such a use the compositions may be administered as an intravenous bolus of 0.15 to 0.35 mg/kg at 10-60 minutes before the start of PCI. In a further embodiment the dose is 0.2 mg/kg. In an embodiment, the bolus is followed by continuous intravenous infusion of 0.1 to 0.15 g/kg/min for up to 12 hours. In a further embodiment the dose is 0.125 g/kg/min for up to 12 hours. In one embodiment, the composition is used as an adjunct to percutaneous coronary intervention (PCI) in subjects suffering from unstable angina. In one embodiment of such a use the compositions may be administered as an intravenous bolus at 0.1 to 0.4 mg/kg before the start of PCI followed by continuous intravenous infusion of 5-15 g/min for up to 24 hours, concluding 1 hour after the PCI. In a further embodiment the composition is administered as an intravenous bolus at 0.25 mg/kg before the start of PCI followed by continuous intravenous infusion of 10 g/min for up to 24 hours, concluding 1 hour after the PCI. In some embodiments the dose is between 2× and 100× less than the doses set forth hereinabove.
  • In each of the embodiments of the compositions described herein, the compositions, when in the form of a lyophilizate, may be reconstituted with, for example, sterile aqueous solutions, sterile water, Sterile Water for Injections (USP), Sterile Bacteriostatic Water for Injections (USP), and equivalents thereof known to those skilled in the art.
  • It is understood that in administration of any of the instant compounds, the compound may be administered in isolation, in a carrier, as part of a pharmaceutical composition, or in any appropriate vehicle.
  • Dosage
  • It is understood that where a dosage range is stated herein, e.g. 1-10 mg/kg per week, the invention disclosed herein also contemplates each integer dose, and tenth thereof, between the upper and lower limits. In the case of the example given, therefore, the invention contemplates 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7, 1.8, 1.9, 2.0, 2.1, 2.2, 2.3, 2.4 etc. mg/kg up to 10 mg/kg.
  • In embodiments, the compounds of the present invention can be administered as a single dose or may be administered as multiple doses.
  • In general, the daily dosage for treating a disorder or condition according to the methods described above will generally range from about 0.01 to about 10.0 mg/kg body weight of the subject to be treated.
  • Variations based on the aforementioned dosage ranges may be made by a physician of ordinary skill taking into account known considerations such as the weight, age, and condition of the person being treated, the severity of the affliction, and the particular route of administration chosen.
  • It is also expected that the compounds disclosed will effect cooperative binding with attendant consequences on effective dosages required.
  • Kits
  • Another aspect of the present invention provides kits comprising the compounds disclosed herein and the pharmaceutical compositions comprising these compounds. A kit may include, in addition to the compound or pharmaceutical composition, diagnostic or therapeutic agents. A kit may also include instructions for use in a diagnostic or therapeutic method. In a diagnostic embodiment, the kit includes the compound or a pharmaceutical composition thereof and a diagnostic agent. In a therapeutic embodiment, the kit includes the antibody or a pharmaceutical composition thereof and one or more therapeutic agents, such as an additional antineoplastic agent, anti-tumor agent or chemotherapeutic agent.
  • Subjects
  • In some embodiments the subject is a human. In an embodiment the subject is 18 years or older. In another embodiment the subject is less than 18 years old.
  • All combinations of the various elements disclosed herein are within the scope of the invention.
  • This invention will be better understood by reference to the Experimental Details which follow, but those skilled in the art will readily appreciate that the specific examples detailed are only illustrative of the invention as described more fully in the claims which follow thereafter.
  • SymmetroAdhesins
  • This patent specification describes genetic devices which are devices comprising functional stretches of consecutive amino acids joined in a novel manner. Until now, proteins have been genetically engineered to create new functions by virtue of their adopting a novel fixed structure or conformation. In contrast to such previously genetically engineered proteins, the genetic devices disclosed herein comprise two or more distinguishable protein domains that are connected by novel chemical bonds in a manner permitting relative motion to occur between the domains. The relative motion between protein domains constitutes the moving parts of the genetic devices, and the useful work which they are able to thereby carry out. Input energy for this work is provided by the kinetic and rotational energies intrinsic to the protein domains themselves, as well as the energy of mechanical interactions between the protein domains and solvent molecules, and the like.
  • This disclosure describes “symmetroadhesins”, a specific class of genetic devices. Symmetroadhesins comprise two or more chemically-bonded adhesins (independently folding polypeptide binding domains or stretches of consecutive amino acids). These chemically-bonded adhesins are capable of relative motion with respect to one another, resulting in the formation of two or more symmetrically-oriented binding domains useful in binding dimeric ligands, trimeric ligands, tetrameric ligands, and the like, with greatly increased affinity. Symmetroadhesin-Fc hybrid proteins are a particularly useful embodiment of the genetic devices.
  • The importance of symmetry in the effectiveness of therapeutic proteins is due to the fact that most protein disease targets themselves display such a higher-order symmetric structure. For example, if the disease target consists of two proteins it is said to be a dimer, if it consists of three proteins it is said to be a trimer, and so forth. If a protein therapeutic binds to the protein disease target only on a one-at-a-time basis, then the strength of the binding is typically on the order of the nano-molar range. At this ordinary level of binding, which is typical of present-day therapeutic proteins, it becomes necessary to flood the body with an enormous and wasteful excess of the therapeutic protein relative to the protein disease target (one million-to-one basis).
  • Each symmetroadhesin is engineered using a simple set of rules that makes proteins into more useful therapeutics by making them more symmetric. For a symmetroadhesin designed to bind to the protein disease target on a two-at-a-time basis, the strength of binding will be on the order of the nano H nano-molar range. Cooperative binding permits such an extraordinary level of binding. At this extraordinary level of binding, it is only necessary to administer much less of the therapeutic protein relative to the protein disease target (one to one basis).
  • Peptide Bond Chemistry
  • All proteins consist of one or more polypeptide chains, stretches of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond. Due to resonance between the single bond form (—C—N—) and double bond form (—C═N—) which occur in amides, the peptide bond has a significant degree of double bond character (—C═N—Cα—C═N—). As a consequence, peptide bonds in proteins are approximately planar. Although the adjoining N—Cα and Cα—C bonds are relatively free to rotate, the rigidly of the peptide bond reduces the degrees of freedom of the folded polypeptide chain to the point where it behaves like a single, static object.
  • Consider a first stretch of N consecutive amino acids and a second stretch of P consecutive amino acids, AA1-[ ]-AAn and AA1-[ ]-AAp, with the peptide bonding shown in 1:

  • Cα(1)—C═N—[ ]—C═N—Cα(N) & Cα(1)—C═N—[ ]—C═N—C α(P)  1
  • Joining of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids at its N-terminus by a new peptide bond to the C-terminus of the second stretch of consecutive amino acids will form a chimeric polypeptide, AA1-[ ]-AAn-AAn+1-[ ]-AAn+p, with the peptide bonding shown in 2:

  • Cα(1)—C═N—[ ]-C═N—Cα(N)—C═N—Cα(N+1)—C═N—[ ]—C═N—C α(N+P)  2
  • The chimeric polypeptide, like either of its progenitors, is a single stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is also joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond. The folded chimeric polypeptide chain will thus also generally behave like a single, static object.
  • This invention provides for novel protein-like molecules, herein termed genetic devices, which like mechanical devices are dynamic objects with two or more moving parts that are interconnected in a manner to permit relative movement. Each part, or domain, in a genetic device is a stretch of consecutive amino acids, and each interconnection is made by a non-peptide bond joining a predefined end of each stretch of consecutive amino acids. Preferably, the domains in a genetic device are binding domains. Three distinct types of genetic devices are distinguished by the topology of their interconnections as shown in 3, 4, and 5:

  • Cα(1)—C═N—[ ]—C═N—Cα(N)—Xc—Xn—Cα(N+1)—C═N—[ ]—C═N—C α(N+P)  3

  • Cα(1)—C═N—[ ]—C═N—Cα(N)—Xc—Xc—Cα(P)—N═C—[ ]—N═C—C α(1)  4

  • Cα(N)—N═C—[ ]N═C—Cα(1)—Xn—Xn—Cα(1)—C═N—[ ]—C═N—C α(P)  5
  • Genetic device with two identical binding domains that are connected at distinct termini (6) have an asymmetric configuration,

  • Cα(1)—C═N—[ ]—C═N—Cα(N)—Xc—Xn—Cα(N+1)—C═N—[ ]—C═N—C α(2N)  6
  • Genetic device with two identical binding domains that are connected at identical termini (7 and 8) have a configuration with point symmetry,

  • Cα(1)—C═N—[ ]—C═N—Cα(N)—Xc—Xc—Cα(N)—N═C—[ ]—N═C—C α(1)  7

  • Cα(N)—N═C—[ ]—N═C—Cα(1)—Xn—Xn—Cα(1)—C═N—[ ]—C═N—C α(N)  8
  • The genetic devices shown in 7 and 8 are herein termed hemi-symmetroadhesins. Although hemi-symmetroadhesins are have structures with point symmetry they are not capable of rotating both their binding domains independently, and thus, they are generally not able to bind symmetrically to more than one binding site in a symmetric target.
  • This invention also provides protein-like molecules capable of binding symmetrically to two or more binding sites in a symmetric target (i.e., cooperatively). Genetic devices that are capable of binding symmetric targets symmetrically are termed herein symmetroadhesins. Like a human body grasping a oversized, yet symmetric object (e.g., a medicine ball) with two hands instead of one, the ability of symmetroadhesins to bind symmetric targets is generally much greater than proteins.
  • Symmetroadhesin Subtypes
  • Tables 2-11 set forth various non-limiting embodiments of different symmetroadhesins. For example, Table 2, describing CD4-symmetroadhesins, shows in the top line the configuration of a CD4 hemi-symmetroadhesin, i.e. a CD4 domain with a C-terminal X-terminus, e.g. a stretch of consecutive amino acids which is a CD4 domain with a C-terminal cysteine or selenosyteine residue bonded through a non-peptide link (for example a cysteine-cysteine disulfide bond or a selenocysteine-selenocysteine diselenide bond) to a second stretch of consecutive amino acids which is a CD4 domain with a C-terminal cysteine or selenosyteine residue bonded through a non-peptide link, generically described as [CD4-Xc-Xc-CD4]. A dimer of the CD4 hemi-symmetroadhesin and a Fc hemisymmetroadhesin to form an immuno-symmetroadhesin is set forth in the second row of Table 2, for example, described as [CD4-Xc-Sn-Fc]2. In each of the tables Xc represents a C-terminal X-terminus; Xn a N-terminal X-terminus, Sn a N-terminal cysteine residue
  • TABLE 2
    CD4 Symmetroadhesins
    Stretches of
    Consecutive Amino Acids Class Symmetroadhesin Configuration
    CD4-Xc hemi- [CD4-Xc-Xc-CD4]
    CD4-Xc + Sn-Fc immuno [CD4-Xc-Sn-Fc]2
    CD4-Xc + Xn-Fc immuno [CD4-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    CD4-Xc + Fc-Xc immuno [Fc-Xc-Xc-CD4]2
    CD4-Xc + Sn-Fc-Xc bi- [CD4-Xc-Sn-Fc-Xc-Xc-CD4]2
    CD4-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc bi- [CD4-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-CD4]2
  • TABLE 3
    TNR Hemi-Symmetroadhesins
    Stretches
    of Consecutive Amino Acids # Symmetroadhesin Configurations
    TNR1-Xc 1 [TNR1-Xc-Xc-TNR1]
    TNR2-Xc 1 [TNR2-Xc-Xc-TNR2]
    TNRFab-Xc 1 [TNRFab-Xc-Xc-TNRFab]
    TNR1-Xc + TNR2-Xc 3 [(TNR1/2)-Xc-Xc-(TNR1/2)]
    TNR1-Xc + TNRFab-Xc 3 [(TNR1/Fab)-Xc-Xc-(TNR1/Fab)]
    TNR2-Xc + TNRFab-Xc 3 [(TNR2/Fab)-Xc-Xc-(TNR2/Fab)]
    TNR1-Xc + TNR2-Xc + 6 [(TNR1/2/Fab)-Xc-Xc-(TNR1/2/Fab)]
    TNRFab-Xc
  • TABLE 4
    TNR ImmunoSymmetroadhesins
    Stretches
    of Consecutive Amino Acids # Symmetroadhesin Configurations
    TNR1-Xc + Sn-Fc 1 [TNR1-Xc-Sn-Fc]2
    TNR1-Xc + Xn-Fc 1 [TNR1-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    TNR1-Xc + Fc-Xc 1 [Fc-Xc-Xc-TNR1]2
    TNR2-Xc + Sn-Fc 1 [TNR2-Xc-Sn-Fc]2
    TNR2-Xc + Xn-Fc 1 [TNR2-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    TNR2-Xc + Fc-Xc 1 [Fc-Xc-Xc-TNR2]2
    TNRFab-Xc + Sn-Fc 1 [TNRFab-Xc-Sn-Fc]2
    TNRFab-Xc + Xn-Fc 1 [TNRFab-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    TNRFab-Xc + Fc-Xc 1 [Fc-Xc-Xc-TNRFab]2
    TNR1-Xc + TNR2-Xc + Sn-Fc 3 [(TNR1/2)-Xc-Sn-Fc]2
    TNR1-Xc + TNR2-Xc + Xn-Fc 3 [(TNR1/2)-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    TNR1-Xc + TNR2-Xc + Fc-Xc 3 [Fc-Xc-Xc-(TNR1/2)]2
    TNR1-Xc + TNRFab-Xc + Sn-Fc 3 [(TNR1/Fab)-Xc-Sn-Fc]2
    TNR1-Xc + TNRFab-Xc + Xn-Fc 3 [(TNR1/Fab)-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    TNR1-Xc + TNRFab-Xc + Fc-Xc 3 [Fc-Xc-Xc-(TNR1/Fab)]2
    TNR2-Xc + TNRFab-Xc + Sn-Fc 3 [(TNR2/Fab)-Xc-Sn-Fc]2
    TNR2-Xc + TNRFab-Xc + Xn-Fc 3 [(TNR2/Fab)-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    TNR2-Xc + TNRFab-Xc + Fc-Xc 3 [Fc-Xc-Xc-(TNR2/Fab)]2
    TNR1-Xc + TNR2-Xc + 6 [(TNR1/2/Fab)-Xc-Sn-Fc]2
    TNRFab-Xc + Sn-Fc
    TNR1-Xc + TNR2-Xc + 6 [(TNR1/2/Fab)-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    TNRFab-Xc + Xn-Fc
    TNR1-Xc + TNR2-Xc + 6 [Fc-Xc-Xc-(TNR1/2/Fab)]2
    TNRFab-Xc + Fc-Xc
  • TABLE 5
    TNR Bi-Symmetroadhesins
    Stretches of Consecutive Amino Acids # Symmetroadhesin Configurations
    TNR1-Xc + Sn-Fc-Xc 1 [TNR1-Xc-Sn-Fc-Xc-Xc-TNR1]2
    TNR1-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 1 [TNR1-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-TNR1]2
    TNR2-Xc + Sn-Fc-Xc 1 [TNR2-Xc-Sn-Fc-Xc-Xc-TNR2]2
    TNR2-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 1 [TNR2-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-TNR2]2
    TNRFab-Xc + Sn-Fc-Xc 1 [TNRFab-Xc-Sn-Fc-Xc-Xc-TNRFab]2
    TNRFab-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 1 [TNRFab-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-TNRFab]2
    TNR1-Xc + TNR2-Xc + Sn-Fc-Xc 12 [(TNR1/2)-Xc-Sn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(TNR1/2)]2
    TNR1-Xc + TNR2-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 12 [(TNR1/2)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(TNR1/2)]2
    TNR1-Xc + TNRFab-Xc + Sn-Fc-Xc 12 [(TNR1/Fab)-Xc-Sn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(TNR1/Fab)]2
    TNR1-Xc + TNRFab-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 12 [(TNR1/Fab)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(TNR1/Fab)]2
    TNR2-Xc + TNRFab-Xc + Sn-Fc-Xc 12 [(TNR2/Fab)-Xc-Sn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(TNR2/Fab)]2
    TNR2-Xc + TNRFab-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 12 [(TNR2/Fab)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(TNR2/Fab)]2
    TNR1-Xc + TNR2-Xc + TNRFab-Xc + Sn-Fc-Xc 63 [(TNR1/2/Fab)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(TNR1/2/Fab)]2
    TNR1-Xc + TNR2-Xc + TNRFab-Xc + Sn-Fc-Xc 63 [(TNR1/2/Fab)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(TNR1/2/Fab)]2
  • TABLE 6
    VGFR Hemi-Symmetroadhesins
    Stretches
    of Consecutive Amino Acids # Symmetroadhesin Configurations
    VGFR1-Xc 1 [VGFR1-Xc-Xc-VGFR1]
    VGFR2-Xc 1 [VGFR2-Xc-Xc-VGFR2]
    VGFR3-Xc 1 [VGFR3-Xc-Xc-VGFR3]
    VGFR1-Xc + VGFR2-Xc 3 [(VGFR1/2)-Xc-Xc-(VGFR1/2)]
    VGFR1-Xc + VGFR3-Xc 3 [(VGFR1/3)-Xc-Xc-(VGFR1/3)]
    VGFR2-Xc + VGFR3-Xc 3 [(VGFR2/3)-Xc-Xc-(VGFR2/3)]
    VGFR1-Xc + VGFR2-Xc + 6 [(VGFR1/2/3)-Xc-Xc-(VGFR1/2/3)]
    VGFR3-Xc
  • TABLE 7
    VGFR ImmunoSymmetroadhesins
    Stretches of Consecutive Amino Acids # Symmetroadhesin Configurations
    VGFR1-Xc + Sn-Fc 1 [VGFR1-Xc-Sn-Fc]2
    VGFR1-Xc + Xn-Fc 1 [VGFR1-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    VGFR1-Xc + Fc-Xc 1 [Fc-Xc-Xc-VGFR1]2
    VGFR2-Xc + Sn-Fc 1 [VGFR2-Xc-Sn-Fc]2
    VGFR2-Xc + Xn-Fc 1 [VGFR2-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    VGFR2-Xc + Fc-Xc 1 [Fc-Xc-Xc-VGFR2]2
    VGFR3-Xc + Sn-Fc 1 [VGFR3-Xc-Sn-Fc]2
    VGFR3-Xc + Xn-Fc 1 [VGFR3-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    VGFR3-Xc + Fc-Xc 1 [Fc-Xc-Xc-VGFR3]2
    VGFR1-Xc + VGFR2-Xc + Sn-Fc 3 [(VGFR1/2)-Xc-Sn-Fc]2
    VGFR1-Xc + VGFR2-Xc + Xn-Fc 3 [(VGFR1/2)-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    VGFR1-Xc + VGFR2-Xc + Fc-Xc 3 [Fc-Xc-Xc-(VGFR1/2)]2
    VGFR1-Xc + VGFR3-Xc + Sn-Fc 3 [(VGFR1/3)-Xc-Sn-Fc]2
    VGFR1-Xc + VGFR3-Xc + Xn-Fc 3 [(VGFR1/3)-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    VGFR1-Xc + VGFR3-Xc + Fc-Xc 3 [Fc-Xc-Xc-(VGFR1/3)]2
    VGFR2-Xc + VGFR3-Xc + Sn-Fc 3 [(VGFR2/3)-Xc-Sn-Fc]2
    VGFR2-Xc + VGFR3-Xc + Xn-Fc 3 [(VGFR2/3)-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    VGFR2-Xc + VGFR3-Xc + Fc-Xc 3 [Fc-Xc-Xc-(VGFR2/3)]2
    VGFR1-Xc + VGFR2-Xc + VGFR3-Xc + Sn-Fc 6 [(VGFR1/2/3)-Xc-Sn-Fc]2
    VGFR1-Xc + VGFR2-Xc + VGFR3-Xc + Xn-Fc 6 [(VGFR1/2/3)-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    VGFR1-Xc + VGFR2-Xc + VGFR3-Xc + Fc-Xc 6 [Fc-Xc-Xc-(VGFR1/2/3)]2
  • TABLE 8
    VGFR Bi-Symmetroadhesins
    Stretches of Consecutive Amino Acids # Symmetroadhesin Configurations
    VGFR1-Xc + Sn-Fc-Xc 1 [VGFR1-Xc-Sn-Fc-Xc-Xc-VGFR1]2
    VGFR1-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 1 [VGFR1-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-VGFR1]2
    VGFR2-Xc + Sn-Fc-Xc 1 [VGFR2-Xc-Sn-Fc-Xc-Xc-VGFR2]2
    VGFR2-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 1 [VGFR2-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-VGFR2]2
    VGFR3-Xc + Sn-Fc-Xc 1 [VGFR3-Xc-Sn-Fc-Xc-Xc-VGFR3]2
    VGFR3-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 1 [VGFR3-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-VGFR3]2
    VGFR1-Xc + VGFR2-Xc + Sn-Fc-Xc 12 [(VGFR1/2)-Xc-Sn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(VGFR1/2)]2
    VGFR1-Xc + VGFR2-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 12 [(VGFR1/2)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(VGFR1/2)]2
    VGFR1-Xc + VGFR3-Xc + Sn-Fc-Xc 12 [(VGFR1/3)-Xc-Sn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(VGFR1/3)]2
    VGFR1-Xc + VGFR3-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 12 [(VGFR1/3)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(VGFR1/3)]2
    VGFR2-Xc + VGFR3-Xc + Sn-Fc-Xc 12 [(VGFR2/3)-Xc-Sn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(VGFR2/3)]2
    VGFR2-Xc + VGFR3-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 12 [(VGFR2/3)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(VGFR2/3)]2
    VGFR1-Xc + VGFR2-Xc + VGFR3-Xc + Sn-Fc-Xc 63 [(VGFR1/2/3)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(VGFR1/2/3)]2
    VGFR1-Xc + VGFR2-Xc + VGFR3-Xc + Sn-Fc-Xc 63 [(VGFR1/2/3)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(VGFR1/2/3)]2
  • TABLE 9
    ErbB Hemi-Symmetroadhesins
    Stretches of Consecutive Amino Acids # Symmetroadhesin Configurations
    ErbB1-Xc 1 [ErbB1-Xc-Xc-ErbB1]
    ErbB2-Xc 1 [ErbB2-Xc-Xc-ErbB2]
    ErbB3-Xc 1 [ErbB3-Xc-Xc-ErbB3]
    ErbB4-Xc 1 [ErbB4-Xc-Xc-ErbB4]
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB2-Xc 3 [(ErbB1/2)-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/2)]
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB3-Xc 3 [(ErbB1/3)-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/3)]
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB4-Xc 3 [(ErbB1/4)-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/4)]
    ErbB2-Xc + ErbB3-Xc 3 [(ErbB2/3)-Xc-Xc-(ErbB2/3)]
    ErbB2-Xc + ErbB4-Xc 3 [(ErbB2/4)-Xc-Xc-(ErbB2/4)]
    ErbB3-Xc + ErbB4-Xc 3 [(ErbB3/4)-Xc-Xc-(ErbB3/4)]
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB2-Xc + ErbB3-Xc 6 [(ErbB1/2/3)-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/2/3)]
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB2-Xc + ErbB4-Xc 6 [(ErbB1/2/4)-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/2/4)]
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + ErbB4-Xc 6 [(ErbB1/3/4)-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/3/4)]
    ErbB2-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + ErbB4-Xc 6 [(ErbB2/3/4)-Xc-Xc-(ErbB2/3/4)]
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB2-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + ErbB4-Xc 10 [(ErbB1/2/3/4)-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/2/3/4)]
  • TABLE 10
    ErbB ImmunoSymmetroadhesins
    Stretches of Consecutive Amino Acids # Symmetroadhesin Configurations
    ErbB1-Xc + Xn-Fc 1 [ErbB1-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    ErbB1-Xc + Fc-Xc 1 [Fc-Xc-Xc-ErbB1]2
    ErbB2-Xc + Xn-Fc 1 [ErbB2-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    ErbB2-Xc + Fc-Xc 1 [Fc-Xc-Xc-ErbB2]2
    ErbB3-Xc + Xn-Fc 1 [ErbB3-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    ErbB3-Xc + Fc-Xc 1 [Fc-Xc-Xc-ErbB3]2
    ErbB4-Xc + Xn-Fc 1 [ErbB4-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    ErbB4-Xc + Fc-Xc 1 [Fc-Xc-Xc-ErbB4]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB2-Xc + Xn-Fc 3 [(ErbB1/2)-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB2-Xc + Fc-Xc 3 [Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/2)]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + Xn-Fc 3 [(ErbB1/3)-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + Fc-Xc 3 [Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/3)]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Xn-Fc 3 [(ErbB1/4)-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Fc-Xc 3 [Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/4)]2
    ErbB2-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + Xn-Fc 3 [(ErbB2/3)-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    ErbB2-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + Fc-Xc 3 [Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB2/3)]2
    ErbB2-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Xn-Fc 3 [(ErbB2/4)-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    ErbB2-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Fc-Xc 3 [Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB2/4)]2
    ErbB3-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Xn-Fc 3 [(ErbB3/4)-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    ErbB3-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Fc-Xc 3 [Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB3/4)]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB2-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + Xn-Fc 6 [(ErbB1/2/3)-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB2-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + Fc-Xc 6 [Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/2/3)]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB2-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Xn-Fc 6 [(ErbB1/2/4)-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB2-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Fc-Xc 6 [Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/2/4)]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Xn-Fc 6 [(ErbB1/3/4)-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Fc-Xc 6 [Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/3/4)]2
    ErbB2-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Xn-Fc 6 [(ErbB2/3/4)-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    ErbB2-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Fc-Xc 6 [Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB2/3/4)]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB2-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Xn-Fc 10 [(ErbB1/2/3/4)-Xc-Xn-Fc]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB2-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Fc-Xc 10 [Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/2/3/4)]2
  • TABLE 11
    ErbB Bi-Symmetroadhesins
    Stretches of Consecutive Amino Acids # Symmetroadhesin Configurations
    ErbB1-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 1 [ErbB1-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-ErbB1]2
    ErbB2-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 1 [ErbB2-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-ErbB2]2
    ErbB3-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 1 [ErbB3-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-ErbB3]2
    ErbB4-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 1 [ErbB4-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-ErbB4]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB2-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 12 [(ErbB1/2)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/2)]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 12 [(ErbB1/3)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/3)]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 12 [(ErbB1/4)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/4)]2
    ErbB2-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 12 [(ErbB2/3)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB2/3)]2
    ErbB2-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 12 [(ErbB2/4)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB2/4)]2
    ErbB3-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 12 [(ErbB3/4)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB3/4)]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB2-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 63 [(ErbB1/2/3)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/2/3)]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB2-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 63 [(ErbB1/2/4)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/2/4)]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 63 [(ErbB1/3/4)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/3/4)]2
    ErbB2-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc 63 [(ErbB2/3/4)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB2/3/4)]2
    ErbB1-Xc + ErbB2-Xc + ErbB3-Xc + ErbB4-Xc + Xn-Fc-Xc [(ErbB1/2/3/4)-Xc-Xn-Fc-Xc-Xc-(ErbB1/2/3/4)]2
  • Stretches of Consecutive Amino Acids
  • Examples of stretches of consecutive amino acids as referred to herein include, but are not limited to, consecutive amino acids including binding domains such as secreted or transmembrane proteins, intracellular binding domains and antibodies (whole or portions thereof) and modified versions thereof. The following are some non-limiting examples:
  • 1) Immunoglobulins
  • Immunoglobulins are molecules containing polypeptide chains held together by intra-chain disulfide bonds, wherein at least one of the bonded amino acids is not a terminus residue, typically having two light chains and two heavy chains. In each chain, one domain (V) has a variable amino acid sequence depending on the antibody specificity of the molecule. The other domains (C) have a rather constant sequence common among molecules of the same class. The domains are numbered in sequence from the amino-terminal end.
  • The immunoglobulin gene superfamily consists of molecules with immunoglobulin-like domains. Members of this family include class I and class II major histocompatibility antigens, immunoglobulins, T-cell receptor alpha, beta, gamma and delta chains, CD1, CD2, CD4, CD8, CD28, the gamma, delta and epsilon chains of CD3, OX-2, Thy-1, the intercellular or neural cell adhesion molecules (1-CAM or N-CAM), lymphocyte function associated antigen-3 (LFA-3), neurocytoplasmic protein (NCP-3), poly-Ig receptor, myelin-associated glycoprotein (MAG), high affinity IgE receptor, the major glycoprotein of peripheral myelin (Po), platelet derived growth factor receptor, colony stimulating factor-1 receptor, macrophage Fc receptor, Fc gamma receptors and carcinoembryonic antigen.
  • It is known that one can substitute variable domains (including hypervariable regions) of one immunoglobulin for another, and from one species to another. See, for example, EP 0 173 494; EP 0 125 023; Munro, Nature 312 (13 Dec. 1984); Neuberger et al., Nature 312: (13 Dec. 1984); Sharon et al., Nature 309 (May 24, 1984); Morrison et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 81:6851-6855 (1984); Morrison et al. Science 229:1202-1207 (1985); and Boulianne et al., Nature 312:643-646 (Dec. 13, 1984).
  • Morrison et al., Science 229:1202-1207 (1985) teaches the preparation of an immunoglobulin chimera having a variable region from one species fused to an immunoglobulin constant region from another species.
  • It has also been shown that it is possible to substitute immunoglobulin variable-like domains from two members of the immunoglobulin gene superfamily-CD4 and the T cell receptor—for a variable domain in an immunoglobulin; see e.g. Capon et al., Nature 337:525-531, 1989, Traunecker et al., Nature 339:68-70, 1989, Gascoigne et al., Proc. Nat. Acad. Sci. 84:2936-2940, 1987, and published European application EPO 0 325 224 A2.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 5,116,964 (Capon et al., May 26, 1992) hereby incorporated by reference, describes hybrid immunoglobulins commonly referred to as immunoadhesins, which combine, for example, the adhesive and targeting properties of a ligand binding partner with immunoglobulin effector functions. U.S. Pat. No. 5,336,603 (Capon et al., Aug. 9, 1994), hereby incorporated by reference, describes a heterofunctional immunoadhesin comprising a fusion protein in which a polypeptide comprising a human CD4 antigen variable (V) region is fused at its C-terminus to the N-terminus of a polypeptide comprising a constant region of an immunoglobulin chain disulfide bonded to a companion immunoglobulin heavy chain-light chain pair bearing a antibody combining site capable of binding a predetermined antigen.
  • “Components” of immunoglobulins include antibody fragments comprise a portion of an intact antibody, preferably the antigen binding or variable region of the intact antibody. Examples of antibody fragments include Fab, Fab′, F(ab′)2, and Fv fragments; diabodies; linear antibodies (Zapata et al., Protein Eng. 8(10): 1057-1062 (1995)); single-chain antibody molecules; and multispecific antibodies formed from antibody fragments.
  • Papain digestion of antibodies produces two identical antigen-binding fragments, called “Fab” fragments, each with a single antigen-binding site, and a residual “Fc” fragment, a designation reflecting the ability to crystallize readily. Pepsin treatment yields an F(ab′)2 fragment that has two antigen-combining sites and is still capable of cross-linking antigen.
  • “Fv” is the minimum antibody fragment which contains a complete antigen-recognition and -binding site. This region consists of a dimer of one heavy- and one light-chain variable domain in tight, non-covalent association. It is in this configuration that the three CDRs of each variable domain interact to define an antigen-binding site on the surface of the VH-VL dimer. Collectively, the six CDRs confer antigen-binding specificity to the antibody. However, even a single variable domain (or half of an Fv comprising only three CDRs specific for an antigen) has the ability to recognize and bind antigen, although at a lower affinity than the entire binding site.
  • The Fab fragment also contains the constant domain of the light chain and the first constant domain (CH1) of the heavy chain. Fab fragments differ from Fab′ fragments by the addition of a few residues at the carboxy terminus of the heavy chain CH1 domain including one or more cysteines from the antibody hinge region. Fab′-SH is the designation herein for Fab′ in which the cysteine residue(s) of the constant domains bear a free thiol group. F(ab′)2 antibody fragments originally were produced as pairs of Fab′ fragments which have hinge cysteines between them. Other chemical couplings of antibody fragments are also known.
  • The “light chains” of antibodies (immunoglobulins) from any vertebrate species can be assigned to one of two clearly distinct types, called kappa and lambda, based on the amino acid sequences of their constant domains.
  • Depending on the amino acid sequence of the constant domain of their heavy chains, immunoglobulins can be assigned to different classes. There are five major classes of immunoglobulins: IgA, IgD, IgE, IgG, and IgM, and several of these may be further divided into subclasses (isotypes), e.g., IgG1, IgG2, IgG3, IgG4, IgA, and IgA2.
  • “Single-chain Fv” or “sFv” antibody fragments comprise the VH and VL domains of antibody, wherein these domains are present in a single polypeptide chain. Preferably, the Fv polypeptide further comprises a polypeptide linker between the VH and VL domains which enables the sFv to form the desired structure for antigen binding. For a review of sFv, see Pluckthun in The Pharmacology of Monoclonal Antibodies, vol. 113, Rosenburg and Moore eds., Springer-Verlag, New York, pp. 269-315 (1994).
  • Thus, linking of the various components of immunoglobulins and other biologically active molecules has allowed production of hybrid molecules which retain the functionalities of the individual components.
  • In an embodiment, the invention described herein provides novel hybrid molecules which include one or more immunoglobulin components.
  • 2) Extracellular Proteins
  • Extracellular proteins play important roles in, among other things, the formation, differentiation and maintenance of multicellular organisms. A discussion of various intracellular proteins of interest is set forth in U.S. Pat. No. 6,723,535, Ashkenazi et al., issued Apr. 20, 2004, hereby incorporated by reference.
  • The fate of many individual cells, e.g., proliferation, migration, differentiation, or interaction with other cells, is typically governed by information received from other cells and/or the immediate environment. This information is often transmitted by secreted polypeptides (for instance, mitogenic factors, survival factors, cytotoxic factors, differentiation factors, neuropeptides, and hormones) which are, in turn, received and interpreted by diverse cell receptors or membrane-bound proteins. These secreted polypeptides or signaling molecules normally pass through the cellular secretory pathway to reach their site of action in the extracellular environment.
  • Secreted proteins have various industrial applications, including as pharmaceuticals, diagnostics, biosensors and bioreactors. Most protein drugs available at present, such as thrombolytic agents, interferons, interleukins, erythropoietines, colony stimulating factors, and various other cytokines, are secretory proteins. Their receptors, which are membrane proteins, also have potential as therapeutic or diagnostic agents. Efforts are being undertaken by both industry and academia to identify new, native secreted proteins. Many efforts are focused on the screening of mammalian recombinant DNA libraries to identify the coding sequences for novel secreted proteins. Examples of screening methods and techniques are described in the literature (see, for example, Klein et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 93:7108-7113 (1996); U.S. Pat. No. 5,536,637)).
  • Membrane-bound proteins and receptors can play important roles in, among other things, the formation, differentiation and maintenance of multicellular organisms. The fate of many individual cells, e.g., proliferation, migration, differentiation, or interaction with other cells, is typically governed by information received from other cells and/or the immediate environment. This information is often transmitted by secreted polypeptides (for instance, mitogenic factors, survival factors, cytotoxic factors, differentiation factors, neuropeptides, and hormones) which are, in turn, received and interpreted by diverse cell receptors or membrane-bound proteins. Such membrane-bound proteins and cell receptors include, but are not limited to, cytokine receptors, receptor kinases, receptor phosphatases, receptors involved in cell-cell interactions, and cellular adhesin molecules like selectins and integrins. For instance, transduction of signals that regulate cell growth and differentiation is regulated in part by phosphorylation of various cellular proteins. Protein tyrosine kinases, enzymes that catalyze that process, can also act as growth factor receptors. Examples include fibroblast growth factor receptor and nerve growth factor receptor.
  • Membrane-bound proteins and receptor molecules have various industrial applications, including as pharmaceutical and diagnostic agents. Receptor immunoadhesins, for instance, can be employed as therapeutic agents to block receptor-ligand interactions. The membrane-bound proteins can also be employed for screening of potential peptide or small molecule inhibitors of the relevant receptor/ligand interaction.
  • Examples of such proteins include EGF and growth factors.
  • Epidermal growth factor (EGF) is a conventional mitogenic factor that stimulates the proliferation of various types of cells including epithelial cells and fibroblasts. EGF binds to and activates the EGF receptor (EGFR), which initiates intracellular signaling and subsequent effects. The EGFR is expressed in neurons of the cerebral cortex, cerebellum, and hippocampus in addition to other regions of the central nervous system (CNS). In addition, EGF is also expressed in various regions of the CNS. Therefore, EGF acts not only on mitotic cells, but also on postmitotic neurons. In fact, many studies have indicated that EGF has neurotrophic or neuromodulatory effects on various types of neurons in the CNS. For example, EGF acts directly on cultured cerebral cortical and cerebellar neurons, enhancing neurite outgrowth and survival. On the other hand, EGF also acts on other cell types, including septal cholinergic and mesencephalic dopaminergic neurons, indirectly through glial cells. Evidence of the effects of EGF on neurons in the CNS is accumulating, but the mechanisms of action remain essentially unknown. EGF-induced signaling in mitotic cells is better understood than in postmitotic neurons. Studies of cloned pheochromocytoma PC12 cells and cultured cerebral cortical neurons have suggested that the EGF-induced neurotrophic actions are mediated by sustained activation of the EGFR and mitogen-activated protein kinase (MAPK) in response to EGF. The sustained intracellular signaling correlates with the decreased rate of EGFR down-regulation, which might determine the response of neuronal cells to EGF. It is likely that EGF is a multi-potent growth factor that acts upon various types of cells including mitotic cells and postmitotic neurons.
  • EGF is produced by the salivary and Brunner's glands of the gastrointestinal system, kidney, pancreas, thyroid gland, pituitary gland, and the nervous system, and is found in body fluids such as saliva, blood, cerebrospinal fluid (CSF), urine, amniotic fluid, prostatic fluid, pancreatic juice, and breast milk, Plata-Salaman, Peptides 12:653-663 (1991).
  • EGF is mediated by its membrane specific receptor, which contains an intrinsic tyrosine kinase. Stoscheck et al., J. Cell Biochem. 31:135-152 (1986). EGF is believed to function by binding to the extracellular portion of its receptor which induces a transmembrane signal that activates the intrinsic tyrosine kinase.
  • Purification and sequence analysis of the EGF-like domain has revealed the presence of six conserved cysteine residues which cross-bind to create three peptide loops, Savage et al., J. Biol. Chem. 248:7669-7672 (1979). It is now generally known that several other peptides can react with the EGF receptor which share the same generalized motif Xn CX7 CX4/5 CX10 CXCX5 GX2 CXn, where X represents any non-cysteine amino acid, and n is a variable repeat number. Non isolated peptides having this motif include TGF-alpha, amphiregulin, schwannoma-derived growth factor (SDGF), heparin-binding EGF-like growth factors and certain virally encoded peptides (e.g., Vaccinia virus, Reisner, Nature 313:801-803 (1985), Shope fibroma virus, Chang et al., Mol Cell Biol. 7:535-540 (1987), Molluscum contagiosum, Porter and Archard, J. Gen. Virol. 68:673-682 (1987), and Myxoma virus, Upton et al., J. Virol. 61:1271-1275 (1987), Prigent and Lemoine, Prog. Growth Factor Res. 4:1-24 (1992).
  • EGF-like domains are not confined to growth factors but have been observed in a variety of cell-surface and extracellular proteins which have interesting properties in cell adhesion, protein-protein interaction and development, Laurence and Gusterson, Tumor Biol. 11:229-261 (1990). These proteins include blood coagulation factors (factors VI, IX, X, XII, protein C, protein S, protein Z, tissue plasminogen activator, urokinase), extracellular matrix components (laminin, cytotactin, entactin), cell surface receptors (LDL receptor, thrombomodulin receptor) and immunity-related proteins (complement C1r, uromodulin).
  • Even more interesting, the general structure pattern of EGF-like precursors is preserved through lower organisms as well as in mammalian cells. A number of genes with developmental significance have been identified in invertebrates with EGF-like repeats. For example, the notch gene of Drosophila encodes 36 tandemly arranged 40 amino acid repeats which show homology to EGF, Wharton et al., Cell 43:557-581 (1985). Hydropathy plots indicate a putative membrane spanning domain, with the EGF-related sequences being located on the extracellular side of the membrane. Other homeotic genes with EGF-like repeats include Delta, 95F and 5ZD which were identified using probes based on Notch, and the nematode gene Lin-12 which encodes a putative receptor for a developmental signal transmitted between two specified cells.
  • Specifically, EGF has been shown to have potential in the preservation and maintenance of gastrointestinal mucosa and the repair of acute and chronic mucosal lesions, Konturek et al., Eur. J. Gastroenterol Hepatol. 7 (10), 933-37 (1995), including the treatment of necrotizing enterocolitis, Zollinger-Ellison syndrome, gastrointestinal ulceration gastrointestinal ulcerations and congenital microvillus atrophy, Guglietta and Sullivan, Eur. J. Gastroenterol Hepatol, 7(10), 945-50 (1995). Additionally, EGF has been implicated in hair follicle differentiation; du Cros, J. Invest. Dermatol. 101 (1 Suppl.), 106S-113S (1993), Hillier, Clin. Endocrinol. 33(4), 427-28 (1990); kidney function, Hamm et al., Semin. Nephrol. 13(1): 109-15 (1993), Harris, Am. J. Kidney Dis. 17(6): 627-30 (1991); tear fluid, van Setten et al., Int. Opthalmol 15(6); 359-62 (1991); vitamin K mediated blood coagulation, Stenflo et al., Blood 78(7): 1637-51 (1991). EGF is also implicated various skin disease characterized by abnormal keratinocyte differentiation, e.g., psoriasis, epithelial cancers such as squamous cell carcinomas of the lung, epidermoid carcinoma of the vulva and gliomas. King et al., Am. J. Med. Sci. 296:154-158 (1988).
  • Of great interest is mounting evidence that genetic alterations in growth factors signaling pathways are closely linked to developmental abnormalities and to chronic diseases including cancer. Aaronson, Science 254: 1146-1153 (1991). For example, c-erb-2 (also known as HER-2), a proto-oncogene with close structural similarity to EGF receptor protein, is overexpressed in human breast cancer. King et al., Science 229:974-976 (1985); Gullick, Hormones and their actions, Cooke et al., eds, Amsterdam, Elsevier, pp 349-360 (1986).
  • Growth factors are molecular signals or mediators that enhance cell growth or proliferation, alone or in concert, by binding to specific cell surface receptors. However, there are other cellular reactions than only growth upon expression to growth factors. As a result, growth factors are better characterized as multifunctional and potent cellular regulators. Their biological effects include proliferation, chemotaxis and stimulation of extracellular matrix production. Growth factors can have both stimulatory and inhibitory effects. For example, transforming growth factor (TGF-beta) is highly pleiotropic and can stimulate proliferation in some cells, especially connective tissue, while being a potent inhibitor of proliferation in others, such as lymphocytes and epithelial cells.
  • The physiological effect of growth stimulation or inhibition by growth factors depends upon the state of development and differentiation of the target tissue. The mechanism of local cellular regulation by classical endocrine molecules involves comprehends autocrine (same cell), juxtacrine (neighbor cell), and paracrine (adjacent cells) pathways. Peptide growth factors are elements of a complex biological language, providing the basis for intercellular communication. They permit cells to convey information between each other, mediate interaction between cells and change gene expression. The effect of these multifunctional and pluripotent factors is dependent on the presence or absence of other peptides.
  • FGF-8 is a member of the fibroblast growth factors (FGFs) which are a family of heparin-binding, potent mitogens for both normal diploid fibroblasts and established cell lines, Gospodarowicz et al. (1984), Proc. Nat. Acad. Sci. USA 81:6963. The FGF family comprises acidic FGF (FGF-1), basic FGF (FGF-2), INT-2 (FGF-3), K-FGF/HST (FGF-4), FGF-5, FGF-6, KGF (FGF-7), AIGF (FGF-8) among others. All FGFs have two conserved cysteine residues and share 30-50% sequence homology at the amino acid level. These factors are mitogenic for a wide variety of normal diploid mesoderm-derived and neural crest-derived cells, including granulosa cells, adrenal cortical cells, chondrocytes, myoblasts, corneal and vascular endothelial cells (bovine or human), vascular smooth muscle cells, lens, retina and prostatic epithelial cells, oligodendrocytes, astrocytes, chrondocytes, myoblasts and osteoblasts.
  • Fibroblast growth factors can also stimulate a large number of cell types in a non-mitogenic manner. These activities include promotion of cell migration into wound area (chemotaxis), initiation of new blood vessel formulation (angiogenesis), modulation of nerve regeneration and survival (neurotrophism), modulation of endocrine functions, and stimulation or suppression of specific cellular protein expression, extracellular matrix production and cell survival. Baird & Bohlen, Handbook of Exp. Pharmacol. 95(1): 369418, Springer, (1990). These properties provide a basis for using fibroblast growth factors in therapeutic approaches to accelerate wound healing, nerve repair, collateral blood vessel formation, and the like. For example, fibroblast growth factors have been suggested to minimize myocardium damage in heart disease and surgery (U.S. Pat. No. 4,378,347).
  • FGF-8, also known as androgen-induced growth factor (AIGF), is a 215 amino acid protein which shares 30-40% sequence homology with the other members of the FGF family. FGF-8 has been proposed to be under androgenic regulation and induction in the mouse mammary carcinoma cell line SC3. Tanaka et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 89:8928-8932 (1992); Sato et al., J. Steroid Biochem. Molec. Biol. 47:91-98 (1993). As a result, FGF-8 may have a local role in the prostate, which is known to be an androgen-responsive organ. FGF-8 can also be oncogenic, as it displays transforming activity when transfected into NIH-3T3 fibroblasts. Kouhara et al., Oncogene 9 455-462 (1994). While FGF-8 has been detected in heart, brain, lung, kidney, testis, prostate and ovary, expression was also detected in the absence of exogenous androgens. Schmitt et al., J. Steroid Biochem. Mol. Biol. 57 (34): 173-78 (1996).
  • FGF-8 shares the property with several other FGFs of being expressed at a variety of stages of murine embryogenesis, which supports the theory that the various FGFs have multiple and perhaps coordinated roles in differentiation and embryogenesis. Moreover, FGF-8 has also been identified as a protooncogene that cooperates with Wnt-1 in the process of mammary tumorigenesis (Shackleford et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 90, 740-744 (1993); Heikinheimo et al., Mech. Dev. 48:129-138 (1994)).
  • In contrast to the other FGFs, FGF-8 exists as three protein isoforms, as a result of alternative splicing of the primary transcript. Tanaka et al., supra. Normal adult expression of FGF-8 is weak and confined to gonadal tissue, however northern blot analysis has indicated that FGF-8 mRNA is present from day 10 through day 12 or murine gestation, which suggests that FGF-8 is important to normal development. Heikinheimo et al., Mech Dev. 48(2): 129-38 (1994). Further in situ hybridization assays between day 8 and 16 of gestation indicated initial expression in the surface ectoderm of the first bronchial arches, the frontonasal process, the forebrain and the midbrain-hindbrain junction. At days 10-12, FGF-8 was expressed in the surface ectoderm of the forelimb and hindlimb buds, the nasal its and nasopharynx, the infundibulum and in the telencephalon, diencephalon and metencephalon. Expression continues in the developing hindlimbs through day 13 of gestation, but is undetectable thereafter. The results suggest that FGF-8 has a unique temporal and spatial pattern in embryogenesis and suggests a role for this growth factor in multiple regions of ectodermal differentiation in the post-gastrulation embryo.
  • The TGF-beta supergene family, or simply TGF-beta superfamily, a group of secreted proteins, includes a large number of related growth and differentiation factors expressed in virtually all phyla. Superfamily members bind to specific cell surface receptors that activate signal transduction mechanisms to elicit their multifunctional cytokine effects. Kolodziejczyk and Hall, Biochem. Cell. Biol., 74:299-314 (1996); Attisano and Wrana, Cytokine Growth Factor Rev., 7:327-339 (1996); and Hill, Cellular Signaling, 8:533-544 (1996).
  • Members of this family include five distinct forms of TGF-beta (Sporn and Roberts, in Peptide Growth Factors and Their Receptors, Sporn and Roberts, eds. (Springer-Verlag: Berlin, 1990) pp. 419-472), as well as the differentiation factors vg1 (Weeks and Melton, Cell, 51:861-867 (1987)) and DPP-C polypeptide (Padgett et al., Nature, 325:81-84 (1987)), the hormones activin and inhibin (Mason et al., Nature 318-659-663 (1985); Mason et al., Growth Factors, 1:77-88 (1987)), the Mullerian-inhibiting substance (MIS) (Cate et al., Cell, 45: 685-698 (1986)), the bone morphogenetic proteins (BMPs) (Wozney et al., Science, 242:1528-1534 (1988); PCT WO 88/00205 published Jan. 14, 1988; U.S. Pat. No. 4,877,864 issued Oct. 31, 1989), the developmentally regulated proteins Vgr-1 (Lyons et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA. 86:45544558 (1989)) and Vgr-2 (Jones et al., Molec. Endocrinol., 6:1961-1968 (1992)), the mouse growth differentiation factor (GDF), such as GDF-3 and GDF-9 (Kingsley, Genes Dev., 8:133-146 (1994); McPherron and Lee, J. Biol. Chem., 268:3444-3449 (1993)), the mouse lefty/Stral (Meno et al., Nature, 381:151-155 (1996); Bouillet et al., Dev. Biol., 170: 420-433 (1995)), glial cell line-derived neurotrophic factor (GDNF) (Lin et al., Science, 260:1130-1132 (1993), neurturin (Kotzbauer et al., Nature, 384:467-470 (1996)), and endometrial bleeding-associated factor (EBAF) (Kothapalli et al., J. Clin. Invest., 99:2342-2350 (1997)). The subset BMP-2A and BMP-2B is approximately 75% homologous in sequence to DPP-C and may represent the mammalian equivalent of that protein.
  • The proteins of the TGF-beta superfamily are disulfide-linked homo- or heterodimers encoded by larger precursor polypeptide chains containing a hydrophobic signal sequence, a long and relatively poorly conserved N-terminal pro region of several hundred amino acids, a cleavage site (usually polybasic), and a shorter and more highly conserved C-terminal region. This C-terminal region corresponds to the processed mature protein and contains approximately 100 amino acids with a characteristic cysteine motif, i.e. the conservation of seven of the nine cysteine residues of TGF-beta among all known family members. Although the position of the cleavage site between the mature and pro regions varies among the family members, the C-terminus of all of the proteins is in the identical position, ending in the sequence Cys-X-Cys-X, but differing in every case from the TGF-beta consensus C-terminus of Cys-Lys-Cys-Ser. Sporn and Roberts, 1990, supra.
  • There are at least five forms of TGF-beta currently identified, TGF-beta1, TGF-beta2, TGF-beta3, TGF-beta4, and TGF-beta5. The activated form of TGF-beta1 is a homodimer formed by dimerization of the carboxy-terminal 112 amino acids of a 390 amino acid precursor. Recombinant TGF-beta1 has been cloned (Derynck et al., Nature, 316:701-705 (1985)) and expressed in Chinese hamster ovary cells (Gentry et al., Mol. Cell. Biol. 7:3418-3427 (1987)). Additionally, recombinant human TGF-beta2 (deMartin et al., EMBO J., 6:3673 (1987)), as well as human and porcine TGF-beta3 (Derynck et al., EMBO J., 7:3737-3743 (1988); ten Dijke et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 85:4715 (1988)) have been cloned. TGF-beta2 has a precursor form of 414 amino acids and is also processed to a homodimer from the carboxy-terminal 112 amino acids that shares approximately 70% homology with the active form of TGF-beta1 (Marquardt et al., J. Biol. Chem., 262:12127 (1987)). See also EP 200,341; 169,016; 268,561; and 267,463; U.S. Pat. No. 4,774,322; Cheifetz et al., Cell, 48:409-415 (1987); Jakowlew et al., Molecular Endocrin., 2:747-755 (1988); Derynck et al., J. Biol. Chem., 261:4377-4379 (1986); Sharples et al., DNA, 6:239-244 (1987); Derynck et al., Nucl. Acids. Res., 15:3188-3189 (1987); Derynck et al., Nucl. Acids. Res. 15:3187 (1987); Seyedin et al., J. Biol. Chem., 261:5693-5695 (1986); Madisen et al., DNA 7:1-8 (1988); and Hanks et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. (U.S.A.), 85:79-82 (1988).
  • TGF-beta4 and TGF-beta5 were cloned from a chicken chondrocyte cDNA library (Jakowlew et al., Molec. Endocrinol., 2:1186-1195 (1988)) and from a frog oocyte cDNA library, respectively.
  • The pro region of TGF-beta associates non-covalently with the mature TGF-beta dimer (Wakefield et al., J. Biol. Chem., 263:7646-7654 (1988); Wakefield et al., Growth Factors, 1:203-218 (1989)), and the pro regions are found to be necessary for proper folding and secretion of the active mature dimers of both TGF-beta and activin (Gray and Mason, Science, 247:1328-1330 (1990)). The association between the mature and pro regions of TGF-beta masks the biological activity of the mature dimer, resulting in formation of an inactive latent form. Latency is not a constant of the TGF-beta superfamily, since the presence of the pro region has no effect on activin or inhibin biological activity.
  • A unifying feature of the biology of the proteins from the TGF-beta superfamily is their ability to regulate developmental processes. TGF-beta has been shown to have numerous regulatory actions on a wide variety of both normal and neoplastic cells. TGF-beta is multifunctional, as it can either stimulate or inhibit cell proliferation, differentiation, and other critical processes in cell function (Sporn and Roberts, supra).
  • One member of the TGF-beta superfamily, EBAF, is expressed in endometrium only in the late secretory phase and during abnormal endometrial bleeding. Kothapalli et al., J. Clin. Invest., 99:2342-2350 (1997). Human endometrium is unique in that it is the only tissue in the body that bleeds at regular intervals. In addition, abnormal endometrial bleeding is one of the most common manifestations of gynecological diseases, and is a prime indication for hysterectomy. In situ hybridization showed that the mRNA of EBAF was expressed in the stroma without any significant mRNA expression in the endometrial glands or endothelial cells.
  • The predicted protein sequence of EBAF showed a strong homology to the protein encoded by mouse lefty/stra3 of the TGF-beta superfamily. A motif search revealed that the predicted EBAF protein contains most of the cysteine residues which are conserved among the TGF-beta-related proteins and which are necessary for the formation of the cysteine knot structure. The EBAF sequence contains an additional cysteine residue, 12 amino acids upstream from the first conserved cysteine residue. The only other family members known to contain an additional cysteine residue are TGF-betas, inhibins, and GDF-3. EBAF, similar to LEFTY, GDF-3/Vgr2, and GDF-9, lacks the cysteine residue that is known to form the intermolecular disulfide bond. Therefore, EBAF appears to be an additional member of the TGF-beta superfamily with an unpaired cysteine residue that may not exist as a dimer. However, hydrophobic contacts between the two monomer subunits may promote dimer formation. Fluorescence in situ hybridization showed that the ebaf gene is located on human chromosome 1 at band q42.1.
  • Further examples of such extracellular proteins are well known in the art, for example see U.S. Pat. No. 6,723,535.
  • Conjugates
  • The invention also pertains to conjugates of symmtroadhesins/immunosymmetroadhesins. Thus the instant compositions can be conjugated to a cytotoxic agent such as a chemotherapeutic agent, toxin (e.g., an enzymatically active toxin of bacterial, fungal, plant, or animal origin, or fragments thereof), or a radioactive isotope (i.e., a radioconjugate).
  • Chemotherapeutic agents useful in the generation of such immunoconjugates are well known in the art. Enzymatically active toxins and fragments thereof that can be used include diphtheria A chain, nonbinding active fragments of diphtheria toxin, exotoxin A chain (from Pseudomonas aeruginosa), ricin A chain, abrin A chain, modeccin A chain, alpha-sarcin, Aleurites fordii proteins, dianthin proteins, Phytolaca americana proteins (PAPI, PAPH, and PAP-S), momordica charantia inhibitor, curcin, crotin, sapaonaria officinalis inhibitor, gelonin, mitogellin, restrictocin, phenomycin, enomycin, and the tricothecenes. A variety of radionuclides are available for the production of radioconjugated antibodies. Examples include 212Bi, 131I, 113In, 90Y, and 186Re.
  • Conjugates of the compositions of the invention including cytotoxic agent are made using a variety of bifunctional protein-coupling agents such as N-succinimidyl-3-(2-pyridyldithiol) propionate (SPDP), iminothiolane (IT), bifunctional derivatives of imidoesters (such as dimethyl adipimidate HCL), active esters (such as disuccinimidyl suberate), aldehydes (such as glutareldehyde), bis-azido compounds (such as bis(p-azidobenzoyl)hexanediamine), bis-diazonium derivatives (such as bis-(p-diazoniumbenzoyl)-ethylenediamine), diisocyanates (such as tolyene 2,6-diisocyanate), and bis-active fluorine compounds (such as 1,5-difluoro-2,4-dinitrobenzene). For example, a ricin immunotoxin can be prepared as described in Vitetta et al., Science, 238:1098 (1987). Carbon-14-labeled 1-isothiocyanatobenzyl-3-methyldiethylene triaminepentaacetic acid (MX-DTPA) is an exemplary chelating agent for conjugation of radionucleotide to the antibody. See WO94111026.
  • Synthesis of Genetic Devices
  • The genetic devices disclosed herein may be synthesized by various routes. One particular route is to synthesize components in vivo by recombinant DNA technology and then to chemically modify the secreted or procured products under conditions so as to form the compounds. Alternative routes include solid-state synthesis.
  • General Techniques
  • The description below relates primarily to production of stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest by culturing cells transformed or transfected with a vector containing an encoding nucleic acid. It is, of course, contemplated that alternative methods, which are well known in the art, may be employed. For instance, the amino acid sequence, or portions thereof, may be produced by direct peptide synthesis using solid-phase techniques (see, e.g., Stewart et al., Solid-Phase Peptide Synthesis, W.H. Freeman Co., San Francisco, Calif. (1969); Merrifield, J. Am. Chem. Soc., 85:2149-2154 (1963)). In vitro protein synthesis may be performed using manual techniques or by automation. Automated synthesis may be accomplished, for instance, using an Applied Biosystems Peptide Synthesizer (Foster City, Calif.) using manufacturer's instructions. Various portions of the stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest may be chemically synthesized separately and combined using chemical or enzymatic methods to produce the full-length stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest.
  • 1. Isolation of DNA Encoding Stretches of Consecutive Amino Acids or Polypeptides of Interest
  • Encoding DNA may be obtained from a cDNA library prepared from tissue believed to possess the mRNA of interest and to express it at a detectable level. Accordingly, human DNA can be conveniently obtained from a cDNA library prepared from human tissue, and so forth. An encoding gene may also be obtained from a genomic library or by known synthetic procedures (e.g., automated nucleic acid synthesis).
  • Libraries can be screened with probes (such as antibodies to the stretch of consecutive amino acids or oligonucleotides of at least about 20-80 bases) designed to identify the gene of interest or the protein encoded by it. Screening the cDNA or genomic library with the selected probe may be conducted using standard procedures, such as described in Sambrook et al., Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual (New York: Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, 1989). An alternative means to isolate the encoding gene is to use PCR methodology (Sambrook et al., supra; Dieffenbach et al., PCR Primer: A Laboratory Manual (Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, 1995)).
  • The oligonucleotide sequences selected as probes should be of sufficient length and sufficiently unambiguous that false positives are minimized. The oligonucleotide is preferably labeled such that it can be detected upon hybridization to DNA in the library being screened. Methods of labeling are well known in the art, and include the use of radiolabels like 32P-labeled ATP, biotinylation or enzyme labeling. Hybridization conditions, including moderate stringency and high stringency, are provided in Sambrook et al., supra.
  • Sequences identified in such library screening methods can be compared and aligned to other known sequences deposited and available in public databases such as GenBank or other private sequence databases. Sequence identity (at either the amino acid or nucleotide level) within defined regions of the molecule or across the full-length sequence can be determined using methods known in the art and as described herein.
  • Nucleic acid having protein coding sequence may be obtained by screening selected cDNA or genomic libraries using the deduced amino acid sequence disclosed herein for the first time, and, if necessary, using conventional primer extension procedures as described in Sambrook et al., supra, to detect precursors and processing intermediates of mRNA that may not have been reverse-transcribed into cDNA.
  • 2. Selection and Transformation of Host Cells
  • Host cells are transfected or transformed with expression or cloning vectors described herein for production and cultured in conventional nutrient media modified as appropriate for inducing promoters, selecting transformants, or amplifying the genes encoding the desired sequences. The culture conditions, such as media, temperature, pH and the like, can be selected by the skilled artisan without undue experimentation. In general, principles, protocols, and practical techniques for maximizing the productivity of cell cultures can be found in Mammalian Cell Biotechnology: a Practical Approach, M. Butler, ed. (IRL Press, 1991) and Sambrook et al., supra.
  • Methods of eukaryotic cell transfection and prokaryotic cell transformation are known to the ordinarily skilled artisan, for example, CaCl2, CaPO4, liposome-mediated and electroporation. Depending on the host cell used, transformation is performed using standard techniques appropriate to such cells. The calcium treatment employing calcium chloride, as described in Sambrook et al., supra, or electroporation is generally used for prokaryotes. Infection with Agrobacterium tumefaciens is used for transformation of certain plant cells, as described by Shaw et al., Gene, 23:315 (1983) and WO 89/05859 published Jun. 29, 1989. For mammalian cells without such cell walls, the calcium phosphate precipitation method of Graham and van der Eb, Virology, 52:456-457 (1978) can be employed. General aspects of mammalian cell host system transfections have been described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,399,216. Transformations into yeast are typically carried out according to the method of Van Solingen et al., J. Bact., 130:946 (1977) and Hsiao et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. (USA), 76:3829 (1979). However, other methods for introducing DNA into cells, such as by nuclear microinjection, electroporation, bacterial protoplast fusion with intact cells, or polycations, e.g., polybrene, polyornithine, may also be used. For various techniques for transforming mammalian cells, see Keown et al., Methods in Enzymology, 185:527-537 (1990) and Mansour et al., Nature, 336:348-352 (1988).
  • Suitable host cells for cloning or expressing the DNA in the vectors herein include prokaryote, yeast, or higher eukaryote cells. Suitable prokaryotes include but are not limited to eubacteria, such as Gram-negative or Gram-positive organisms, for example, Enterobacteriaceae such as E. coli. Various E. coli strains are publicly available, such as E. coli K12 strain MM294 (ATCC 31,446); E. coli X1776 (ATCC 31,537); E. coli strain W3110 (ATCC 27,325) and K5772 (ATCC 53,635). Other suitable prokaryotic host cells include Enterobacteriaceae such as Escherichia, e.g., E. coli, Enterobacter, Erwinia, Klebsiella, Proteus, Salmonella, e.g., Salmonella typhimurium, Serratia, e.g., Serratia marcescans, and Shigella, as well as Bacilli such as B. subtilis and B. licheniformis (e.g., B. licheniformis 41P disclosed in DD 266,710 published Apr. 12, 1989), Pseudomonas such as P. aeruginosa, and Streptomyces. These examples are illustrative rather than limiting. Strain W3110 is one particularly preferred host or parent host because it is a common host strain for recombinant DNA product fermentations. Preferably, the host cell secretes minimal amounts of proteolytic enzymes. For example, strain W3110 may be modified to effect a genetic mutation in the genes encoding proteins endogenous to the host, with examples of such hosts including E. coli W3110 strain 1A2, which has the complete genotype tonA; E. coli W3110 strain 9E4, which has the complete genotype tonA ptr3; E. coli W3110 strain 27C7 (ATCC 55,244), which has the complete genotype tonAptr3phoA E15 (argF-lac)169 degP ompT kan.sup.r; E. coli W3110 strain 37D6, which has the complete genotype tonA ptr3 phoA E15 (argF-lac)169 degP ompT rbs7 ilvG kan.sup.r, E. coli W3110 strain 40B4, which is strain 37D6 with a non-kanamycin resistant degP deletion mutation; and an E. coli strain having mutant periplasmic protease disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 4,946,783 issued Aug. 7, 1990. Alternatively, in vitro methods of cloning, e.g., PCR or other nucleic acid polymerase reactions, are suitable.
  • In addition to prokaryotes, eukaryotic microbes such as filamentous fungi or yeast are suitable cloning or expression hosts for encoding vectors. Saccharomyces cerevisiae is a commonly used lower eukaryotic host microorganism. Others include Schizosaccharomyces pombe (Beach and Nurse, Nature, 290:140 (1981); EP 139,383 published May 2, 1985); Kluyveromyces hosts (U.S. Pat. No. 4,943,529; Fleer et al., Bio/Technology, 9:968-975 (1991)) such as, e.g., K. lactis (MW98-8C, CBS683, CBS4574; Louvencourt et al., J. Bacteriol., 737 (1983)), K. fragilis (ATCC 12,424), K. bulgaricus (ATCC 16,045), K. wickeramii (ATCC 24,178), K. waltii (ATCC 56,500), K. drosophilarum (ATCC 36,906; Van den Berg et al., Bio/Technology, 8:135 (1990)), K. thermotolerans, and K. marxianus; yarrowia (EP 402,226); Pichia pastoris (EP 183,070; Sreekrishna et al., J. Basic Microbiol., 28:265-278 (1988)); Candida; Trichoderma reesia (EP 244,234); Neurospora crassa (Case et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 76:5259-5263 (1979)); Schwanniomyces such as Schwanniomyces occidentalis (EP 394,538 published Oct. 31, 1990); and filamentous fungi such as, e.g., Neurospora, Penicillium, Tolypocladium (WO 91/00357 published Jan. 10, 1991), and Aspergillus hosts such as A. nidulans (Ballance et al., Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun., 112:284-289 (1983); Tilburn et al., Gene, 26:205-221 (1983); Yelton et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 81:1470-1474 (1984)) and A. niger (Kelly and Hynes, EMBO J., 4:475479 (1985)). Methylotropic yeasts are suitable herein and include, but are not limited to, yeast capable of growth on methanol selected from the genera consisting of Hansenula, Candida, Kloeckera, Pichia, Saccharomyces, Torulopsis, and Rhodotorula. A list of specific species that are exemplary of this class of yeasts may be found in C. Anthony, The Biochemistry of Methylotrophs, 269 (1982).
  • Suitable host cells for the expression of glycosylated stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest are derived from multicellular organisms. Examples of invertebrate cells include insect cells such as Drosophila S2 and Spodoptera Sf9, as well as plant cells. Examples of useful mammalian host cell lines include Chinese hamster ovary (CHO) and COS cells. More specific examples include monkey kidney CV1 line transformed by SV40 (COS-7, ATCC CRL 1651); human embryonic kidney line (293 or 293 cells subcloned for growth in suspension culture, Graham et al., J. Gen Virol., 36:59 (1977)); Chinese hamster ovary cells/−DHFR (CHO, Urlaub and Chasin, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 77:4216 (1980)); mouse sertoli cells (TM4, Mather, Biol. Reprod., 23:243-251 (1980)); human lung cells (W138, ATCC CCL 75); human liver cells (Hep G2, HB 8065); and mouse mammary tumor (MMT 060562, ATCC CCL51). The selection of the appropriate host cell is deemed to be within the skill in the art.
  • 3. Selection and Use of a Replicable Vector
  • The nucleic acid (e.g., cDNA or genomic DNA) encoding the stretch of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest may be inserted into a replicable vector for cloning (amplification of the DNA) or for expression. Various vectors are publicly available. The vector may, for example, be in the form of a plasmid, cosmid, viral particle, or phage. The appropriate nucleic acid sequence may be inserted into the vector by a variety of procedures. In general, DNA is inserted into an appropriate restriction endonuclease site(s) using techniques known in the art. Vector components generally include, but are not limited to, one or more of a signal sequence, an origin of replication, one or more marker genes, an enhancer element, a promoter, and a transcription termination sequence. Construction of suitable vectors containing one or more of these components employs standard ligation techniques which are known to the skilled artisan.
  • The stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest may be produced recombinantly not only directly, but also as a fusion polypeptide with a heterologous polypeptide, which may be a signal sequence or other polypeptide having a specific cleavage site at the N-terminus of the mature protein or polypeptide. In general, the signal sequence may be a component of the vector, or it may be a part of the encoding DNA that is inserted into the vector. The signal sequence may be a prokaryotic signal sequence selected, for example, from the group of the alkaline phosphatase, penicillinase, lpp, or heat-stable enterotoxin II leaders. For yeast secretion the signal sequence may be, e.g., the yeast invertase leader, alpha factor leader (including Saccharomyces and Kluyveromyces alpha-factor leaders, the latter described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,010,182), or acid phosphatase leader, the C. albicans glucoamylase leader (EP 362,179 published Apr. 4, 1990), or the signal described in WO 90/13646 published Nov. 15, 1990. In mammalian cell expression, mammalian signal sequences may be used to direct secretion of the protein, such as signal sequences from secreted polypeptides of the same or related species, as well as viral secretory leaders.
  • Both expression and cloning vectors contain a nucleic acid sequence that enables the vector to replicate in one or more selected host cells. Such sequences are well known for a variety of bacteria, yeast, and viruses. The origin of replication from the plasmid pBR322 is suitable for most Gram-negative bacteria, the 2mu plasmid origin is suitable for yeast, and various viral origins (SV40, polyoma, adenovirus, VSV or BPV) are useful for cloning vectors in mammalian cells.
  • Expression and cloning vectors will typically contain a selection gene, also termed a selectable marker. Typical selection genes encode proteins that (a) confer resistance to antibiotics or other toxins, e.g., ampicillin, neomycin, methotrexate, or tetracycline, (b) complement auxotrophic deficiencies, or (c) supply critical nutrients not available from complex media, e.g., the gene encoding D-alanine racemase for Bacilli.
  • An example of suitable selectable markers for mammalian cells are those that enable the identification of cells competent to take up the encoding nucleic acid, such as DHFR or thymidine kinase. An appropriate host cell when wild-type DHFR is employed is the CHO cell line deficient in DHFR activity, prepared and propagated as described by Urlaub et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 77:4216 (1980). A suitable selection gene for use in yeast is the trp1 gene present in the yeast plasmid YRp7 (Stinchcomb et al., Nature, 282:39 (1979); Kingsman et al., Gene, 7:141 (1979); Tschemper et al., Gene, 10:157 (1980)). The trp1 gene provides a selection marker for a mutant strain of yeast lacking the ability to grow in tryptophan, for example, ATCC No. 44076 or PEP4-1 (Jones, Genetics, 85:12 (1977)).
  • Expression and cloning vectors usually contain a promoter operably linked to the encoding nucleic acid sequence to direct mRNA synthesis. Promoters recognized by a variety of potential host cells are well known. Promoters suitable for use with prokaryotic hosts include the beta-lactamase and lactose promoter systems (Chang et al., Nature, 275:615 (1978); Goeddel et al., Nature, 281:544 (1979)), alkaline phosphatase, a tryptophan (trp) promoter system (Goeddel, Nucleic Acids Res., 8:4057 (1980); EP 36,776), and hybrid promoters such as the tac promoter (deBoer et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 80:21-25 (1983)). Promoters for use in bacterial systems also will contain a Shine-Dalgarno (S.D.) sequence operably linked to the encoding DNA.
  • Examples of suitable promoting sequences for use with yeast hosts include the promoters for 3-phosphoglycerate kinase (Hitzeman et al., J. Biol. Chem., 255:2073 (1980)) or other glycolytic enzymes (Hess et al., J. Adv. Enzyme Re.g., 7:149 (1968); Holland, Biochemistry, 17:4900 (1978)), such as enolase, glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase, hexokinase, pyruvate decarboxylase, phosphofructokinase, glucose-6-phosphate isomerase, 3-phosphoglycerate mutase, pyruvate kinase, triosephosphate isomerase, phosphoglucose isomerase, and glucokinase.
  • Other yeast promoters, which are inducible promoters having the additional advantage of transcription controlled by growth conditions, are the promoter regions for alcohol dehydrogenase 2, isocytochrome C, acid phosphatase, degradative enzymes associated with nitrogen metabolism, metallothionein, glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase, and enzymes responsible for maltose and galactose utilization. Suitable vectors and promoters for use in yeast expression are further described in EP 73,657.
  • Transcription from vectors in mammalian host cells is controlled, for example, by promoters obtained from the genomes of viruses such as polyoma virus, fowlpox virus (UK 2,211,504 published Jul. 5, 1989), adenovirus (such as Adenovirus 2), bovine papilloma virus, avian sarcoma virus, cytomegalovirus, a retrovirus, hepatitis-B virus and Simian Virus 40 (SV40), from heterologous mammalian promoters, e.g., the actin promoter or an immunoglobulin promoter, and from heat-shock promoters, provided such promoters are compatible with the host cell systems.
  • Transcription of a DNA encoding the stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest by higher eukaryotes may be increased by inserting an enhancer sequence into the vector. Enhancers are cis-acting elements of DNA, usually about from 10 to 300 bp, that act on a promoter to increase its transcription. Many enhancer sequences are now known from mammalian genes (globin, elastase, albumin, alpha-fetoprotein, and, insulin). Typically, however, one will use an enhancer from a eukaryotic cell virus. Examples include the SV40 enhancer on the late side of the replication origin (bp 100-270), the cytomegalovirus early promoter enhancer, the polyoma enhancer on the late side of the replication origin, and adenovirus enhancers. The enhancer may be spliced into the vector at a position 5′ or 3′ to the coding sequence, but is preferably located at a site 5′ from the promoter.
  • Expression vectors used in eukaryotic host cells (yeast, fungi, insect, plant, animal, human, or nucleated cells from other multicellular organisms) will also contain sequences necessary for the termination of transcription and for stabilizing the mRNA. Such sequences are commonly available from the 5′ and, occasionally 3′, untranslated regions of eukaryotic or viral DNAs or cDNAs. These regions contain nucleotide segments transcribed as polyadenylated fragments in the untranslated portion of the mRNA encoding stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest.
  • Still other methods, vectors, and host cells suitable for adaptation to the synthesis of stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides in recombinant vertebrate cell culture are described in Gething et al., Nature 293:620-625 (1981); Mantei et al., Nature, 281:4046 (1979); EP 117,060; and EP 117,058.
  • 4. Detecting Gene Amplification/Expression
  • Gene amplification and/or expression may be measured in a sample directly, for example, by conventional Southern blotting, Northern blotting to quantitate the transcription of mRNA (Thomas, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 77:5201-5205 (1980)), dot blotting (DNA analysis), or in situ hybridization, using an appropriately labeled probe, based on the sequences provided herein. Alternatively, antibodies may be employed that can recognize specific duplexes, including DNA duplexes, RNA duplexes, and DNA-RNA hybrid duplexes or DNA-protein duplexes. The antibodies in turn may be labeled and the assay may be carried out where the duplex is bound to a surface, so that upon the formation of duplex on the surface, the presence of antibody bound to the duplex can be detected.
  • Gene expression, alternatively, may be measured by immunological methods, such as immunohistochemical staining of cells or tissue sections and assay of cell culture or body fluids, to quantitate directly the expression of gene product. Antibodies useful for immunohistochemical staining and/or assay of sample fluids may be either monoclonal or polyclonal, and may be prepared in any mammal. Conveniently, the antibodies may be prepared against a native sequence stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest or against a synthetic peptide based on the DNA sequences provided herein or against exogenous sequence fused to DNA encoding a stretch of consecutive amino acids or polypeptide of interest and encoding a specific antibody epitope.
  • 5. Purification of Polypeptide
  • Forms of the stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest may be recovered from culture medium or from host cell lysates. If membrane-bound, it can be released from the membrane using a suitable detergent solution (e.g. Triton-X 100) or by enzymatic cleavage. Cells employed in expression of the stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest can be disrupted by various physical or chemical means, such as freeze-thaw cycling, sonication, mechanical disruption, or cell lysing agents.
  • It may be desired to purify the stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest from recombinant cell proteins or polypeptides. The following procedures are exemplary of suitable purification procedures: by fractionation on an ion-exchange column; ethanol precipitation; reverse phase HPLC; chromatography on silica or on a cation-exchange resin such as DEAE; chromatofocusing; SDS-PAGE; ammonium sulfate precipitation; gel filtration using, for example, Sephadex G-75; protein A Sepharose columns to remove contaminants such as IgG; and metal chelating columns to bind epitope-tagged forms. Various methods of protein purification may be employed and such methods are known in the art and described for example in Deutscher, Methods in Enzymology, 182 (1990); Scopes, Protein Purification: Principles and Practice, Springer-Verlag, New York (1982). The purification step(s) selected will depend, for example, on the nature of the production process used and the particular stretches of consecutive amino acids or polypeptides of interest produced.
  • Example of Expression of Stretch of Consecutive Amino Acids or Polypeptide Component of Interest in E. coli
  • The DNA sequence encoding the desired amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide is initially amplified using selected PCR primers. The primers should contain restriction enzyme sites which correspond to the restriction enzyme sites on the selected expression vector. A variety of expression vectors may be employed. An example of a suitable vector is pBR322 (derived from E. coli; see Bolivar et al., Gene, 2:95 (1977)) which contains genes for ampicillin and tetracycline resistance. The vector is digested with restriction enzyme and dephosphorylated. The PCR amplified sequences are then ligated into the vector. The vector will preferably include sequences which encode for an antibiotic resistance gene, a trp promoter, a polyhis leader (including the first six STII codons, polyhis sequence, and enterokinase cleavage site), the specific amino acid sequence of interest/polypeptide coding region, lambda transcriptional terminator, and an argU gene.
  • The ligation mixture is then used to transform a selected E. coli strain using the methods described in Sambrook et al., supra. Transformants are identified by their ability to grow on LB plates and antibiotic resistant colonies are then selected. Plasmid DNA can be isolated and confirmed by restriction analysis and DNA sequencing.
  • Selected clones can be grown overnight in liquid culture medium such as LB broth supplemented with antibiotics. The overnight culture may subsequently be used to inoculate a larger scale culture. The cells are then grown to a desired optical density, during which the expression promoter is turned on.
  • After culturing the cells for several more hours, the cells can be harvested by centrifugation. The cell pellet obtained by the centrifugation can be solubilized using various agents known in the art, and the solubilized amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide can then be purified using a metal chelating column under conditions that allow tight binding of the protein.
  • The primers can contain restriction enzyme sites which correspond to the restriction enzyme sites on the selected expression vector, and other useful sequences providing for efficient and reliable translation initiation, rapid purification on a metal chelation column, and proteolytic removal with enterokinase. The PCR-amplified, poly-His tagged sequences can be ligated into an expression vector used to transform an E. coli host based on, for example, strain 52 (W3110 fuhA(tonA) Ion galE rpoHts(htpRts) clpP(lacIq). Transformants can first be grown in LB containing 50 mg/ml carbenicillin at 30° C. with shaking until an O.D.600 of 3-5 is reached. Cultures are then diluted 50-100 fold into C RAP media (prepared by mixing 3.57 g (NH4)2 SO4, 0.71 g sodium citrate-2H2O, 1.07 g KCl, 5.36 g Difco yeast extract, 5.36 g Sheffield hycase SF in 500 mL water, as well as 110 mM MPOS, pH 7.3, 0.55% (w/v) glucose and 7 mM MgSO4) and grown for approximately 20-30 hours at 30° C. with shaking. Samples were removed to verify expression by SDS-PAGE analysis, and the bulk culture is centrifuged to pellet the cells. Cell pellets were frozen until purification and refolding.
  • E. coli paste from 0.5 to 1 L fermentations (6-10 g pellets) was resuspended in 10 volumes (w/v) in 7 M guanidine, 20 mM Tris, pH 8 buffer. Solid sodium sulfite and sodium tetrathionate is added to make final concentrations of 0.1M and 0.02 M, respectively, and the solution was stirred overnight at 4° C. This step results in a denatured protein with all cysteine residues blocked by sulfitolization. The solution was centrifuged at 40,000 rpm in a Beckman Ultracentifuge for 30 min. The supernatant was diluted with 3-5 volumes of metal chelate column buffer (6 M guanidine, 20 mM Tris, pH 7.4) and filtered through 0.22 micron filters to clarify. Depending the clarified extract was loaded onto a 5 mil Qiagen Ni-NTA metal chelate column equilibrated in the metal chelate column buffer. The column was washed with additional buffer containing 50 mM imidazole (Calbiochem, Utrol grade), pH 7.4. The protein was eluted with buffer containing 250 mM imidazole. Fractions containing the desired protein were pooled and stored at 4.degree. C. Protein concentration was estimated by its absorbance at 280 nm using the calculated extinction coefficient based on its amino acid sequence.
  • Expression of Consecutive Stretches of Amino Acids in Mammalian Cells
  • This general example illustrates a preparation of a glycosylated form of a desired amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component by recombinant expression in mammalian cells.
  • The vector pRK5 (see EP 307,247, published Mar. 15, 1989) can be employed as the expression vector. Optionally, the encoding DNA is ligated into pRK5 with selected restriction enzymes to allow insertion of the DNA using ligation methods such as described in Sambrook et al., supra.
  • In one embodiment, the selected host cells may be 293 cells. Human 293 cells (ATCC CCL 1573) are grown to confluence in tissue culture plates in medium such as DMEM supplemented with fetal calf serum and optionally, nutrient components and/or antibiotics. About 10 μg of the ligated vector DNA is mixed with about 1 μg DNA encoding the VA RNA gene [Thimmappaya et al., Cell 31:543 (1982)] and dissolved in 500 μl of 1 mM Tris-HCl, 0.1 mM EDTA, 0.227 M CaCl2 To this mixture is added, dropwise, 500 μl of 50 mM HEPES (pH 7.35), 280 mM NaCl, 1.5 mM NaPO4, and a precipitate is allowed to form for 10 minutes at 25° C. The precipitate is suspended and added to the 293 cells and allowed to settle for about four hours at 37° C. The culture medium is aspirated off and 2 ml of 20% glycerol in PBS is added for 30 seconds. The 293 cells are then washed with serum free medium, fresh medium is added and the cells are incubated for about 5 days.
  • Approximately 24 hours after the transfections, the culture medium is removed and replaced with culture medium (alone) or culture medium containing 200 μCi/ml 35S-cysteine and 200 μCi/ml 35S-methionine. After a 12 hour incubation, the conditioned medium is collected, concentrated on a spin filter, and loaded onto a 15% SDS gel. The processed gel may be dried and exposed to film for a selected period of time to reveal the presence of amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component. The cultures containing transfected cells may undergo further incubation (in serum free medium) and the medium is tested in selected bioassays.
  • In an alternative technique, the nucleic acid amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component may be introduced into 293 cells transiently using the dextran sulfate method described by Somparyrac et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci., 12:7575 (1981). 293 cells are grown to maximal density in a spinner flask and 700 μg of the ligated vector is added. The cells are first concentrated from the spinner flask by centrifugation and washed with PBS. The DNA-dextran precipitate is incubated on the cell pellet for four hours. The cells are treated with 20% glycerol for 90 seconds, washed with tissue culture medium, and re-introduced into the spinner flask containing tissue culture medium, 5 μg/ml bovine insulin and 0.1 μg/ml bovine transferrin. After about four days, the conditioned media is centrifuged and filtered to remove cells and debris. The sample containing expressed amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component can then be concentrated and purified by any selected method, such as dialysis and/or column chromatography.
  • In another embodiment, the amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component can be expressed in CHO cells. The amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component can be transfected into CHO cells using known reagents such as CaPO4 or DEAE-dextran. As described above, the cell cultures can be incubated, and the medium replaced with culture medium (alone) or medium containing a radiolabel such as 35S-methionine. After determining the presence of amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component, the culture medium may be replaced with serum free medium. Preferably, the cultures are incubated for about 6 days, and then the conditioned medium is harvested. The medium containing the expressed amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component can then be concentrated and purified by any selected method.
  • Epitope-tagged amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component may also be expressed in host CHO cells. The amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component may be subcloned out of a pRK5 vector. The subclone insert can undergo PCR to fuse in frame with a selected epitope tag such as a poly-his tag into a Baculovirus expression vector. The poly-his tagged amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component insert can then be subcloned into a SV40 driven vector containing a selection marker such as DHFR for selection of stable clones. Finally, the CHO cells can be transfected (as described above) with the SV40 driven vector. Labeling may be performed, as described above, to verify expression. The culture medium containing the expressed poly-His tagged amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component can then be concentrated and purified by any selected method, such as by Ni2+-chelate affinity chromatography.
  • In an embodiment the amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component are expressed as an IgG construct (immunoadhesin), in which the coding sequences for the soluble forms (e.g. extracellular domains) of the respective proteins are fused to an IgG1 constant region sequence containing the hinge, CH2 and CH2 domains and/or is a poly-His tagged form.
  • Following PCR amplification, the respective DNAs are subcloned in a CHO expression vector using standard techniques as described in Ausubel et al., Current Protocols of Molecular Biology, Unit 3.16, John Wiley and Sons (1997). CHO expression vectors are constructed to have compatible restriction sites 5′ and 3′ of the DNA of interest to allow the convenient shuttling of cDNA's. The vector used in expression in CHO cells is as described in Lucas et al., Nucl. Acids Res. 24:9 (1774-1779 (1996), and uses the SV40 early promoter/enhancer to drive expression of the cDNA of interest and dihydrofolate reductase (DHFR). DHFR expression permits selection for stable maintenance of the plasmid following transfection.
  • Expression of Stretch of Consecutive Amino Acids in Yeast
  • The following method describes recombinant expression of a desired amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component in yeast.
  • First, yeast expression vectors are constructed for intracellular production or secretion of a stretch of consecutive amino acids from the ADH2/GAPDH promoter. DNA encoding a desired amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component, a selected signal peptide and the promoter is inserted into suitable restriction enzyme sites in the selected plasmid to direct intracellular expression of the amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component. For secretion, DNA encoding the stretch of consecutive amino acids can be cloned into the selected plasmid, together with DNA encoding the ADH2/GAPDH promoter, the yeast alpha-factor secretory signal/leader sequence, and linker sequences (if needed) for expression of the stretch of consecutive amino acids.
  • Yeast cells, such as yeast strain AB110, can then be transformed with the expression plasmids described above and cultured in selected fermentation media. The transformed yeast supernatants can be analyzed by precipitation with 10% trichloroacetic acid and separation by SDS-PAGE, followed by staining of the gels with Coomassie Blue stain.
  • Recombinant amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component can subsequently be isolated and purified by removing the yeast cells from the fermentation medium by centrifugation and then concentrating the medium using selected cartridge filters. The concentrate containing the amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component may further be purified using selected column chromatography resins.
  • Expression of Stretches of Consecutive Amino Acids in Baculovirus-Infected Insect Cells
  • The following method describes recombinant expression of stretches of consecutive amino acids in Baculovirus-infected insect cells.
  • The desired nucleic acid encoding the stretch of consecutive amino acids is fused upstream of an epitope tag contained with a baculovirus expression vector. Such epitope tags include poly-his tags and immunoglobulin tags (like Fc regions of IgG). A variety of plasmids may be employed, including plasmids derived from commercially available plasmids such as pVL1393 (Novagen). Briefly, the amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component or the desired portion of the amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component (such as the sequence encoding the extracellular domain of a transmembrane protein) is amplified by PCR with primers complementary to the 5′ and 3′ regions. The 5′ primer may incorporate flanking (selected) restriction enzyme sites. The product is then digested with those selected restriction enzymes and subcloned into the expression vector.
  • Recombinant baculovirus is generated by co-transfecting the above plasmid and BaculoGold™ virus DNA (Pharmingen) into Spodoptera frugiperda (“Sf9”) cells (ATCC CRL 1711) using lipofectin (commercially available from GIBCO-BRL). After 4-5 days of incubation at 28° C., the released viruses are harvested and used for further amplifications. Viral infection and protein expression is performed as described by O'Reilley et al., Baculovirus expression vectors: A laboratory Manual, Oxford: Oxford University Press (1994).
  • Expressed poly-his tagged amino acid sequence of interest or polypeptide component can then be purified, for example, by Ni2+-chelate affinity chromatography as follows. Extracts are prepared from recombinant virus-infected Sf9 cells as described by Rupert et al., Nature, 362:175-179 (1993). Briefly, Sf9 cells are washed, resuspended in sonication buffer (25 mL Hepes, pH 7.9; 12.5 mM MgCl2; 0.1 mM EDTA; 10% Glycerol; 0.1% NP40; 0.4 M KCl), and sonicated twice for 20 seconds on ice. The sonicates are cleared by centrifugation, and the supernatant is diluted 50-fold in loading buffer (50 mM phosphate, 300 mM NaCl, 10% Glycerol, pH 7.8) and filtered through a 0.45 μm filter. A Ni2+-NTA agarose column (commercially available from Qiagen) is prepared with a bed volume of 5 mL, washed with 25 mL of water and equilibrated with 25 mL of loading buffer. The filtered cell extract is loaded onto the column at 0.5 mL per minute. The column is washed to baseline A280 with loading buffer, at which point fraction collection is started. Next, the column is washed with a secondary wash buffer (50 mM phosphate; 300 mM NaCl, 10% Glycerol, pH 6.0), which elutes nonspecifically bound protein. After reaching A280 baseline again, the column is developed with a 0 to 500 mM Imidazole gradient in the secondary wash buffer. One mL fractions are collected and analyzed by SDS-PAGE and silver staining or western blot with Ni2+-NTA-conjugated to alkaline phosphatase (Qiagen). Fractions containing the eluted His10-tagged sequence are pooled and dialyzed against loading buffer.
  • Alternatively, purification of the IgG tagged (or Fc tagged) amino acid sequence can be performed using known chromatography techniques, including for instance, Protein A or Protein G column chromatography.
  • Immunoadhesin (Fc containing) constructs of proteins can be purified from conditioned media as follows. The conditioned media is pumped onto a 5 ml Protein A column (Pharmacia) which is equilibrated in 20 mM Na phosphate buffer, pH 6.8. After loading, the column is washed extensively with equilibration buffer before elution with 100 mM citric acid, pH 3.5. The eluted protein is immediately neutralized by collecting 1 ml fractions into tubes containing 275 mL of 1 M Tris buffer, pH 9. The highly purified protein is subsequently desalted into storage buffer as described above for the poly-His tagged proteins. The homogeneity of the proteins is verified by SDS polyacrylamide gel (PEG) electrophoresis and N-terminal amino acid sequencing by Edman degradation.
  • Intein-Based C-Terminal Syntheses
  • As described, for example, in U.S. Pat. No. 6,849,428, issued Feb. 1, 2005, inteins are the protein equivalent of the self-splicing RNA introns (see Perler et al., Nucleic Acids Res. 22:1125-1127 (1994)), which catalyze their own excision from a precursor protein with the concomitant fusion of the flanking protein sequences, known as exteins (reviewed in Perler et al., Curr. Opin. Chem. Biol. 1:292-299 (1997); Perler, F. B. Cell 92(1):1-4 (1998); Xu et al., EMBO J. 15(19):5146-5153 (1996)).
  • Studies into the mechanism of intein splicing led to the development of a protein purification system that utilized thiol-induced cleavage of the peptide bond at the N-terminus of the Sce VMA intein (Chong et al., Gene 192(2):271-281 (1997)). Purification with this intein-mediated system generates a bacterially-expressed protein with a C-terminal thioester (Chong et al., (1997)). In one application, where it is described to isolate a cytotoxic protein, the bacterially expressed protein with the C-terminal thioester is then fused to a chemically-synthesized peptide with an N-terminal cysteine using the chemistry described for “native chemical ligation” (Evans et al., Protein Sci. 7:2256-2264 (1998); Muir et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 95:6705-6710 (1998)).
  • This technique, referred to as “intein-mediated protein ligation” (IPL), represents an important advance in protein semi-synthetic techniques. However, because chemically-synthesized peptides of larger than about 100 residues are difficult to obtain, the general application of IPL was limited by the requirement of a chemically-synthesized peptide as a ligation partner.
  • IPL technology was significantly expanded when an expressed protein with a predetermined N-terminus, such as cysteine, was generated, as described for example in U.S. Pat. No. 6,849,428. This allows the fusion of one or more expressed proteins from a host cell, such as bacterial, yeast or mammalian cells. In one non-limiting example the intein a modified RIR1 Methanobacterium thermoautotrophicum is that cleaves at either the C-terminus or N-terminus is used which allows for the release of a bacterially expressed protein during a one-column purification, thus eliminating the need proteases entirely.
  • Intein technology is one example of one route to obtain components. In one embodiment, the subunits of the compounds of the invention are obtained by transfecting suitable cells, capable of expressing and secreting mature chimeric polypeptides, wherein such polypeptides comprise, for example, an adhesin domain contiguous with an isolatable c-terminal intein domain (see U.S. Pat. No. 6,849,428, Evans et al., issued Feb. 1, 2005, hereby incorporated by reference). The cells, such as mammalian cells or bacterial cells, are transfected using known recombinant DNA techniques. The secreted chimeric polypeptide can then be isolated, e.g. using a chitin-derivatized resin in the case of an intein-chitin binding domain (see U.S. Pat. No. 6,897,285, Xu et al., issued May 24, 2005, hereby incorporated by reference), and is then treated under conditions permitting thiol-mediated cleavage and release of the now C-terminal thioester-terminated adhesion subunit. The thioester-terminated adhesion subunit is readily converted to a C-terminal cysteine terminated subunit.
  • These subunits can be treated under oxidizing conditions to permit formation of, for example, a disulfide bond between the two terminal cysteine residues, thus forming a symmetroadhesin. In addition, this technique can be used to make the symmetroadhesin-Fc hybrid subunits by treating the individual adhesion-Fc heterodimers under conditions permitting formation of bonds between the Fc portions of the heterodimers.
  • EXAMPLE 1 Preparation of Immunoglobulin Fc with N-Terminal-S-Termini (S-Fc)
  • Digestion of immunoglobulin (IgG) with papain yields two Fab fragments and one Fc fragment (Porter (1959) Biochem. 73, 119-126). The site of proteolysis in human IgG is the heavy chain hinge region between the cys-5 and cys-11 residues, EPKSCDKTHTCPPCP, (Fleischman et al., Biochem J. (1963) 88, 220-227; Edelman et al. (1969) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 63, 78-85). The cys-5 residue normally forms a disulfide bond with the human IgG light chain, which is easily cleaved under mild reducing conditions, making it an ideal candidate for Fc-like molecules with N-terminal-S-termini (S-Fc).
  • Accordingly, host cells were transfected with expression vectors encoding IgG1 pre-Fc chimeric polypeptides consisting of a signal peptide joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of an Fc domain beginning at the cys-5 residue, CDKTHTCPPCP (FIG. 35A). The heterologous signal peptides used are selected from proteins with N-terminal cysteines (part i). Thus, cleavage by the cellular signal peptidase will provide a mature S-Fc protein having cys-5 at the N-terminus (part ii).
  • The sequences of the IgG1 precursor polypeptides of FIG. 35A are shown in SEQ ID NO: 32, SEQ ID NO:33, and SEQ ID NO:34. The sequence of the mature IgG1 polypeptide of FIG. 35A is shown in SEQ ID NO: 35. Other mature IgG1 polypeptides made by methods described in EXAMPLES 1 to 5 are shown in SEQ ID NO: 36 through SEQ ID NO: 46.
  • Host cells are transfected with expression vectors encoding IgG2 pre-Fc chimeric polypeptides consisting of a signal peptide joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of an Fc domain beginning at the cys-4 residue, CCVECPPCP (FIG. 35B). The heterologous signal peptides used are selected from proteins with N-terminal cysteines (part i). Thus, cleavage by the cellular signal peptidase will provide a mature S-Fc protein having cys-4 at the N-terminus (part ii).
  • The sequences of the IgG2 precursor polypeptides of FIG. 35B are shown in SEQ ID NO:50, SEQ ID NO:51, and SEQ ID NO:52. The sequence of the mature IgG2 polypeptide of FIG. 35B is shown in SEQ ID NO:53. Other mature IgG2 polypeptides made by methods described in EXAMPLES 1 to 5 are shown in SEQ ID NO:54 through SEQ ID NO:67.
  • Host cells are transfected with expression vectors encoding IgG3 pre-Fc chimeric polypeptides consisting of a signal peptide joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of an Fc domain beginning at the cys-13 residue, CPRCP (FIG. 35C). The heterologous signal peptides used are selected from proteins with N-terminal cysteines (part i). Thus, cleavage by the cellular signal peptidase will provide a mature S-Fc protein having cys-13 at the N-terminus (part ii).
  • The sequences of the IgG3 precursor polypeptides of FIG. 35C are shown in SEQ ID NO:71, SEQ ID NO:72, and SEQ ID NO:73. The sequence of the mature IgG3 polypeptide of FIG. 35C is shown in SEQ ID NO:74. Other mature IgG2 polypeptides made by methods described in EXAMPLES 1 to 5 are shown in SEQ ID NO:75 through SEQ ID NO:82.
  • Host cells are transfected with expression vectors encoding IgG4 pre-Fc chimeric polypeptides consisting of a signal peptide joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of an Fc domain beginning at the cys-8 residue, CPSCP (FIG. 35D). The heterologous signal peptides used are selected from proteins with N-terminal cysteines (part i). Thus, cleavage by the cellular signal peptidase will provide a mature S-Fc protein having cys-8 at the N-terminus (part ii).
  • The sequences of the IgG4 precursor polypeptides of FIG. 35D are shown in SEQ ID NO:86, SEQ ID NO:87, and SEQ ID NO:88. The sequence of the mature IgG4 polypeptide of FIG. 35D is shown in SEQ ID NO:89. Other mature IgG4 polypeptides made by methods described in EXAMPLES 1 to 5 are shown in SEQ ID NO:90 through SEQ ID NO:97.
  • Suitable host cells include 293 human embryonic cells (ATCC CRL-1573) and CHO-K1 hamster ovary cells (ATCC CCL-61) obtained from the American Type Culture Collection (Rockville, Md.). Cells are grown at 37° C. in an atmosphere of air, 95%; carbon dioxide, 5%. 293 cells are maintained in Minimal essential medium (Eagle) with 2 mM L-glutamine and Earle's BSS adjusted to contain 1.5 g/L sodium bicarbonate, 0.1 mM non-essential amino acids, and 1.0 mM sodium pyruvate, 90%; fetal bovine serum, 10%. CHO-K1 cells are maintained in Ham's F12K medium with 2 mM L-glutamine adjusted to contain 1.5 g/L sodium bicarbonate, 90%; fetal bovine serum, 10%. Other suitable host cells include CV1 monkey kidney cells (ATCC CCL-70), COS-7 monkey kidney cells (ATCC CRL-1651), VERO-76 monkey kidney cells (ATCC CRL-1587), HELA human cervical cells (ATCC CCL-2), W138 human lung cells (ATCC CCL-75), MDCK canine kidney cells (ATCC CCL-34), BRL3A rat liver cells (ATCC CRL-1442), BHK hamster kidney cells (ATCC CCL-10), MMT060562 mouse mammary cells (ATCC CCL-51), and human CD8+ T lymphocytes (described in U.S. Ser. No. 08/258,152 incorporated herein in its entirety by reference).
  • An example of a suitable expression vector is plasmid pSA (SEQ ID NO:1). Plasmid pSA contains the following DNA sequence elements: 1) pBluescriptIIKS(+) (nucleotides 912 to 2941/1 to 619, GenBank Accession No. X52327), 2) a human cytomegalovirus promoter, enhancer, and first exon splice donor (nucleotides 63 to 912, GenBank Accession No. K03104), 3) a human alpha1-globin second exon splice acceptor (nucleotides 6808 to 6919, GenBank Accession No. J00153), 4) an SV40 T antigen polyadenylation site (nucleotides 2770 to 2533, Reddy et al. (1978) Science 200, 494-502), and 5) an SV40 origin of replication (nucleotides 5725 to 5578, Reddy et al., ibid). For expression of the polypeptide of interest, an EcoRI-BglII DNA fragment encoding the polypeptide is inserted into plasmid pSA between the EcoRI and BglII restriction sites located at positions 1,608 and 1,632, respectively. Other suitable expression vectors include plasmids pSVeCD4DHFR and pRKCD4 (U.S. Pat. No. 5,336,603), plasmid pIK.1.1 (U.S. Pat. No. 5,359,046), plasmid pVL-2 (U.S. Pat. No. 5,838,464), plasmid pRT43.2F3 (described in U.S. Ser. No. 08/258,152 incorporated herein in its entirety by reference), and plasmid pCDNA3.1(+) (Invitrogen, Inc.).
  • Suitable selectable markers include the Tn5 transposon neomycin phosphotransferase (NEO) gene (Southern and Berg (1982) J. Mol. Appl. Gen. 1, 327-341), and the dihydrofolate reductase (DHFR) cDNA (Lucas et al. (1996) Nucl. Acids Res. 24, 1774-1779). One example of a suitable expression vector that incorporates a NEO gene is plasmid pSA-NEO, which is constructed by ligating a first DNA fragment, prepared by digesting SEQ ID NO:2 with EcoRI and BglII, with a second DNA fragment, prepared by digesting SEQ ID NO:1 with EcoRI and BglII. SEQ ID NO:2 incorporates a NEO gene (nucleotides 1551 to 2345, Genbank Accession No. U00004) preceded by a sequence for translational initiation (Kozak (1991) J. Biol. Chem, 266, 19867-19870). Another example of a suitable expression vector that incorporates a NEO gene and a DHFR cDNA is plasmid pSVe-NEO-DHFR, which is constructed by ligating a first DNA fragment, prepared by digesting SEQ ID NO:2 with EcoRI and BglII, with a second DNA fragment, prepared by digesting pSVeCD4DHFR with EcoRI and BglII. Plasmid pSVe-NEO-DHFR uses SV40 early promoter/enhancers to drive expression of the NEO gene and the DHFR cDNA. Other suitable selectable markers include the XPGT gene (Mulligan and Berg (1980) Science 209, 1422-1427) and the hygromycin resistance gene (Sugden et al. (1985) Mol. Cell. Biol. 5, 410-413).
  • Human IgG1 DNA sequences are described in Ellison et al. (1982) Nuc. Acids Res. 10, 4071-4079) (Genbank Acc. No. Z17370)
  • Suitable examples of signal peptides are sonic hedgehog (SHH) (GenBank Acc. No. NM000193), interferona-2 (IFN) (GenBank Acc. No. NP000596), and cholesterol ester transferase (CETP) (GenBank Accession No. NM000078). Other suitable examples include Indian hedgehog (Genbank Acc. No. NM002181), desert hedgehog (Genbank Acc. No. NM021044), IFNα-1 (Genbank Acc. No. NP076918), IFNα-4 (Genbank Acc. No. NM021068), IFNα-5 (Genbank Acc. No. NM002169), IFNα-6 (Genbank Acc. No. NM021002), IFNα-7 (Genbank Acc. No. NM021057), IFNα-8 (Genbank Acc. No. NM002170), IFNα-10 (Genbank Acc. No. NM002171), IFNα-13 (Genbank Acc. No. NM006900), IFNα-14 (Genbank Acc. No. NM002172), IFNα-16 (Genbank Acc. No. NM002173), IFNα-17 (Genbank Acc. No. NM021268) and IFNα-21 (Genbank Acc. No. NM002175).
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert and vector fragment prepared by digestion with EcoRI and BglII. For unamplified expression, plasmid pSHH-Fc5 (SHH signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:3 and SEQ ID NO:1, plasmid pIFN-Fc5 (IFN signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:4 and SEQ ID NO:1 and plasmid pCETP-Fc5 (CETP signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:3 and SEQ ID NO:1. For amplified expression, plasmid PSHH-Fc5-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:3 and pSVeCD4DHFR (U.S. Pat. No. 5,336,603), pIFN-Fc5-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:4 and pSVeCD4DHFR, and pCETP-Fc5-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:5 and pSVeCD4DHFR.
  • Suitable expression vectors for human IgG1 Fc polypeptides were constructed by ligation of an insert fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and EagI and a vector fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and PspOM1. Plasmid pCDNA3-SHH-IgG1-Fc (SHH signal) was constructed using SEQ ID NO:29 and pCDNA3.1(+), plasmid pCDNA3-IFN-IgG1-Fc (IFN signal) was constructed using SEQ ID NO:30 and pCDNA3.1(+), and plasmid pCDNA3-IgG1-Fc (CETP signal) was constructed using SEQ ID NO:31 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • Suitable expression vectors for human IgG2 Fc polypeptides are constructed by ligation of an insert fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and EagI and a vector fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and PspOM1. Plasmid pCDNA3-SHH-IgG2-Fc (SHH signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:47 and pCDNA3.1(+), plasmid pCDNA3-IFN-IgG2-Fc (IFN signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:48 and pCDNA3.1(+), and plasmid pCDNA3-IgG2-Fc (CETP signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:49 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • Suitable expression vectors for human IgG3 Fc polypeptides are constructed by ligation of an insert fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and EagI and a vector fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and PspOM1. Plasmid pCDNA3-SHH-IgG3-Fc (SHH signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:68 and pCDNA3.1(+), plasmid pCDNA3-IFN-IgG3-Fc (IFN signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:69 and pCDNA3.1(+), and plasmid pCDNA3-IgG3-Fc (CETP signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:70 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • Suitable expression vectors for human IgG4 Fc polypeptides are constructed by ligation of an insert fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and EagI and a vector fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and PspOM1. Plasmid pCDNA3-SHH-IgG4-Fc (SHH signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:83 and pCDNA3.1(+), plasmid pCDNA3-IFN-IgG4-Fc (IFN signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:84 and pCDNA3.1(+), and plasmid pCDNA3-IgG4-Fc (CETP signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:85 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • In one embodiment, cells are transfected by the calcium phosphate method of Graham et al. (1977) J. Gen. Virol. 36, 59-74. A DNA mixture (10 micrograms) is dissolved in 0.5 ml of 1 mM Tris-HCl, 0.1 mM EDTA, and 227 mM CaCl2. The DNA mixture contains (in a ratio of 10:1:1) the expression vector DNA, the selectable marker DNA, and a DNA encoding the VA RNA gene (Thimmappaya et al. (1982) Cell 31, 543-551). To this mixture is added, dropwise, 0.5 mL of 50 mM Hepes (pH 7.35), 280 mM NaCl, and 1.5 mM NaPO4. The DNA precipitate is allowed to form for 10 minutes at 25° C., then suspended and added to cells grown to confluence on 100 mm plastic tissue culture dishes. After 4 hours at 37° C., the culture medium is aspirated and 2 ml of 20% glycerol in PBS is added for 0.5 minutes. The cells are then washed with serum-free medium, fresh culture medium is added, and the cells are incubated for 5 days.
  • In another embodiment, cells are transiently transfected by the dextran sulfate method of Somparyrac et al. (1981) Proc. Nat. Acad. Sci. 12, 7575-7579. Cells are grown to maximal density in spinner flasks, concentrated by centrifugation, and washed with PBS. The DNA-dextran precipitate is incubated on the cell pellet. After 4 hours at 37° C., the DEAE-dextran is aspirated and 20% glycerol in PBS is added for 1.5 minutes. The cells are then washed with serum-free medium, and re-introduced into spinner flasks containing fresh culture medium with 5 micrograms/ml bovine insulin and 0.1 micrograms/ml bovine transferring, and the cells are incubated for 4 days. Following transfection by either method, the conditioned media is centrifuged and filtered to remove the host cells and debris. The sample contained the S-Fc domain is then concentrated and purified by any selected method, such as dialysis and/or column chromatography (see below).
  • To identify the S-Fc in the cell culture supernatant, the culture medium is removed 24 hours after transfection and replaced with culture medium containing 200 microCi/ml each of 35S-methionine and 35S-cysteine. After a 12 hour incubation, the conditioned medium is collected by centrifugation to remove the host cells and debris, concentrated on a spin dialysis filter. The labeled supernatants is analyzed by immunoprecipitation with protein A sepharose beads in the absence of added antibodies. The precipitated proteins are analyzed on 7.5% polyacrylamide-SDS gels either with or without reduction with β-mercaptoethanol. The processed gel is dried and exposed to x-ray film to reveal the presence of the S-Fc domain.
  • For unamplified expression, plasmids pSHH-Fc-5, pIFN-Fc-5 and pCETP-Fc-5 are transfected into human 293 cells (Graham et al., J. Gen. Virol. 36:59 74 (1977)), using a high efficiency procedure (Gorman et al., DNA Prot. Eng. Tech. 2:3 10 (1990)). Media is changed to serum-free and harvested daily for up to five days. The S-Fc proteins are purified from the cell culture supernatant using protein A-Sepharose CL-4B (Pharmacia). The eluted S-Fc protein is buffer-exchanged into PBS using a Centricon-30 (Amicon), concentrated to 0.5 ml, sterile filtered using a Millex-GV (Millipore) and stored at 4° C.
  • For unamplified expression, plasmids pCDNA3-SHH-IgG1-Fc, pCDA3-IFN-IgG1-Fc and pCDA-3-CETP-IgG1-Fc were transfected into human 293 cells (Graham et al., J. Gen. Virol. 36:59 74 (1977)), using a high efficiency procedure (Gorman et al., DNA Prot. Eng. Tech. 2:3 10 (1990)). Media was changed to serum-free and harvested daily for up to five days. The S-Fc proteins were purified from the cell culture supernatant using protein A-Sepharose CL-4B (Pharmacia). The eluted S-Fc protein was buffer-exchanged into PBS using a Centricon-30 (Amicon), concentrated to 0.5 ml, sterile filtered using a Millex-GV (Millipore) and stored at 4° C.
  • FIG. 52 shows expression in 293 kidney cells of human IgG1 Fc symmetroadhesin subunits with N-terminal-S-termini. Lanes 1-6 and lanes 7-12 show the IgG1 Fc polypeptides of FIG. 35A (ii) and FIG. 36A (ii), respectively. Cell supernatants: lanes 1, 3, 5, 7, 9 and 11; cell lysates: lanes 2, 4, 6, 8, 10 and 12. Signal sequences used: SHH ( lanes 1, 2, 7 and 8); IFNα ( lanes 3, 4, 9, 10); CETP ( lanes 5, 6, 11 and 12).
  • FIG. 53 shows expression in 293 kidney cells of human IgG1 Fc symmetroadhesin subunits. Lanes 1-2, 3-4 and 5-6 show the IgG1 Fc polypeptides of FIG. 35A (ii), FIG. 36A (ii) and FIG. 37B (ii), respectively. Cell supernatants: (lanes 1-6). Signal sequences used: SHH (lanes 1-6).
  • FIG. 54 shows Protein A purification of human IgG1 Fc symmetroadhesin subunits expressed in 293 kidney cells. Lane 2 and 8 show the IgG1 Fc polypeptides of FIG. 36A and FIG. 35A, respectively. Lanes 1-7: proteinA-sepharose column fractions for the IgG1 Fc polypeptide of FIG. 36A.
  • FIG. 55 shows Thiol-sepharose binding of proteinA-purified human IgG1 Fc symmetroadhesin subunits shown in FIG. 54. Lanes 1-3 and lanes 4-6 show the human IgG1 Fc polypeptides of FIG. 35A and FIG. 36A, respectively. Lanes 1 and 4: starting material; lanes 2 and 5: thiol-sepharose flow-thru fraction; lanes 3 and 6: thiol-sepharose bound fraction.
  • Analysis of the two IgG1 Fc polypeptides of FIG. 35A and FIG. 36A by mass spectrometry (MALDI) reveals average molecular masses of 54,552.85 and 53,173.43 daltons, respectively. Assuming each molecular mass represents the corresponding Fc dimers, the apparent difference in molecular mass between the two polypeptides (1,379.4 daltons) is in good agreement (0.6% deviation) with the predicted difference in molecular mass (1,371.5).
  • For amplified expression, Chinese hamster ovary (CHO) cells are transfected with dicistronic vectors pSHH-Fc5-DHFR, pIFN-Fc-5-DHFR and pCETP-Fc-5-DHFR which co-express a DHFR cDNA. Plasmids are introduced into CHO-K1 DUX B11 cells developed by L. Chasin (Columbia University) via lipofection and selected for growth in GHT-free medium (Chisholm (1996) High efficiency gene transfer in mammalian cells. In: Glover, D M, Hames, B D. DNA Cloning vol 4. Mammalian systems. Oxford Univ. Press, pp 1-41). Approximately 20 unamplified clones are randomly chosen and reseeded into 96 well plates. Relative specific productivity of each colony is monitored using an ELISA to quantitate the S-Fc protein accumulated in each well after 3 days and a fluorescent dye, Calcien AM, as a surrogate marker of viable cell number per well. Based on these data, several unamplified clones are chosen for further amplification in the presence of increasing concentrations of methotrexate. Individual clones surviving at 10, 50, and 100 nM methotrexate are chosen and transferred to 96 well plates for productivity screening. Suitable clones, which reproducibly exhibit high specific productivity, are expanded in T-flasks and used to inoculate spinner cultures. After several passages, the suspension-adapted cells are used to inoculate production cultures in GHT-containing, serum-free media supplemented with various hormones and protein hydrolysates. Harvested cell culture fluid containing the S-Fc protein is purified using protein A-Sepharose CL-4B.
  • EXAMPLE 2 Preparation of Immunoglobulin Fc with N-Terminal-X-Termini (X-Fc)
  • Selenocysteine (sec) is the 21st amino acid incorporated during ribosome-mediated protein synthesis (Zinoni et al. (1986) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 83, 4650-4654; Chambers et al. (1986) EMBO J. 5, 1221-1227). The process is complex and distinct from cysteine incorporation, requiring an mRNA selenocysteine insertion element in order to decode a UGA stop codon. Protein semi-synthesis offers an alternative means for preparing Fc-like molecules having N-terminal-X-termini (X-Fc) that begin at cysteine (cys) and/or selenocysteine (sec).
  • Accordingly, host cells are transfected with constructs that encode pre-Fc chimeric polypeptides consisting of a signal peptide joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of an Fc domain beginning at cys-11, CDKTHTCPPCP (FIG. 36A) and cys-14 CDKTHTCPPCP (FIG. 36B). The heterologous signal peptides used are selected from proteins with N-terminal cysteines (part i). Thus, cleavage by the cellular signal peptidase will provide a mature S-Fc protein having cys-11 at the N-terminus (part ii). Native chemical ligation is then employed to prepare mature X-Fc proteins having cys-5 or sec-5 at the N-terminus, XDKTHTCPPCP (part iii).
  • The sequences of the IgG1 precursor polypeptides of FIG. 36A are shown in SEQ ID NO: 101, SEQ ID NO:102, and SEQ ID NO:103. The sequence of the mature IgG1 polypeptide of FIG. 35A is shown in SEQ ID NO: 104. The sequences of the IgG1 precursor polypeptides of FIG. 36B are shown in SEQ ID NO: 109, SEQ ID NO:110, and SEQ ID NO:111. The sequence of the mature IgG1 polypeptide of FIG. 35B is shown in SEQ ID NO: 112.
  • Accordingly, host cells are transfected with constructs that encode pre-Fc chimeric polypeptides consisting of a signal peptide joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of an Fc domain beginning at cys-14, CDKTHTCPPCP (FIG. 36B). The heterologous signal peptides used are selected from proteins with N-terminal cysteines (part i). Thus, cleavage by the cellular signal peptidase will provide a mature S-Fc protein having cys-11 at the N-terminus (part ii). Native chemical ligation is then employed to prepare mature X-Fc proteins having cys-11 or sec-11 at the N-terminus, XPPCP (part iii).
  • The S-Fc proteins with cys-11 and cys-14 at the N-terminus is first prepared using the procedures described in EXAMPLE 1. Native chemical ligation is carried out with S-Fc protein and peptide Fc-A (5-11: cys-asp-lys-thr-his-thr), or S-Fc protein and peptide Fc-B (5-11: sec-asp-lys-thr-his-thr). Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert and vector fragment prepared by digestion with EcoRI and BglII. For unamplified expression, plasmid pSHH-Fc11 (SHH signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:6 and SEQ ID NO:1, plasmid pIFN-Fc11 (IFN signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO 7 and SEQ ID NO:1 and plasmid pCETP-Fc11 (CETP signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:8 and SEQ ID NO:1. For amplified expression, plasmid pSHH-Fc11-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:6 and pSVeCD4DHFR, plasmid pIFN-Fc11-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:7 and pSVeCD4DHFR, and plasmid pCETP-Fc11-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:8 and pSVeCD4DHFR.
  • Suitable expression vectors for human IgG1 Fc are constructed by ligation of an insert fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and EagI and a vector fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and PspOM1. Plasmid pCDNA3-SHH-IgG1-Fc11 (SHH signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:98 and pCDNA3.1(+), plasmid pCDNA3-IFN-IgG1-Fc11 (IFN signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:99 and pCDNA3.1(+), and plasmid pCDNA3-IgG1-Fc11 (CETP signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:100 and pCDNA3.1(+). Plasmid pCDNA3-SHH-IgG1-Fc14 (SHH signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:106 and pCDNA3.1(+), plasmid pCDNA3-IFN-IgG1-Fc14 (IFN signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:107 and pCDNA3.1(+), and plasmid pCDNA3-IgG1-Fc14 (CETP signal) is constructed using SEQ ID NO:108 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • General principles of native chemical ligation are described in U.S. Pat. No. 6,184,344, the whole of which is incorporated herein by reference. Peptides Fc-A and Fc-B are synthesized using a TAMPAL resin from which any desired thioester can be readily obtained. After de-protection of side chain protecting groups, the resulting C-terminal activated peptides are used in native chemical ligation without further modification. To prevent the cyclization or polymerization of bifunctional peptides, the sulfhydryl moiety (peptide Fc-A) and the selenohydryl moiety (peptide Fc-B) are reversibly blocked with Msc.
  • Peptide synthesis is carried out by manual a solid-phase procedure using an in situ neutralization/HBTU activation procedure for Boc chemistry (Schnolzer et al. (1992) Int. J. Pept. Protein Res. 40, 180-193). After each coupling step, yields are determined by measuring residual free amine with the quantitative ninhydrin assay (Sarin et al. (1981) Anal. Biochem. 117, 147-157). Side chain protected amino acids are Boc-Asp(O-cyclohexyl)-OH, Boc-Cys(4-methylbenzyl)-OH, Boc-Lys(2-Cl-Z)-OH, and Boc-Thr(benzyl)-OH. After chain assembly is completed, peptides are deprotected and cleaved from the resin by treatment with anhydrous HF for 1 hour at 0° C. with 4% anisole as scavenger.
  • Peptides Fc-A and Fc-B are synthesized on trityl-associated mercaptopropionic acid leucine (TAMPAL) resin to yield C-terminal MPAL-activated thioesters (Hackeng et al. (1999) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 96, 10068-10073). The N-terminal cys/sec residues of the thioester peptides are protected with 2-(methylsulfonyl)ethyl carbonate (Msc) groups in a 2 hour reaction (10-fold excess) of activated Msc nitrophenol ester dissolved in a minimal volume of dimethylformamide/5% diisopropylethylamine. The thioester-activated peptides are deprotected and cleaved from the TAMPAL resin, HPLC-purified, lyophilized, and stored until use at −20° C. Preparative reversed-phase HPLC is performed using a Vydac C-18 column (10 micrometer, 1.0 cm×25 cm). The bound peptides are eluted using a linear gradient of acetonitrile in H 20/10% trifluoroacetic acid.
  • Starting with the purified C-terminal S-Fc protein, native chemical ligation is carried out with the Msc-NH-cys5-thr10-α-thioester peptide (Fc-A) or the Msc-NH-sec5-thr10-α-thioester peptide (Fc-B) under non-denaturing conditions as previously described (Evans et al. (1999) J. Biol. Chem. 274, 3923-3926). The thioester-activated peptides are mixed in molar excess with freshly prepared S-Fc protein (starting concentration, 1-200 micromolar). The solution is concentrated with a Centriprep 3/30 apparatus (Millipore, Mass.), then with a Centricon 3/10 apparatus to a final concentration of 0.15 to 1.2 mM for the S-Fc protein. Ligations are incubated overnight at 4° C. and visualized using SDS-page electrophoresis. After native chemical ligation, the N-terminal Msc protecting group is removed by a brief incubation (<5 minute) at pH 13. The X-Fc product is purified to remove unreacted peptides by affinity chromatography with protein A sepharose using the procedure in EXAMPLE 1.
  • The sequence of the native ligation product of FIG. 36A is shown in SEQ ID NO: 105. The sequence of the native ligation product of FIG. 36B is shown in SEQ ID NO: 113.
  • EXAMPLE 3 Preparation of Immuoglobulin Fc with C-Terminal-X-Termini (Fc-X)
  • IgG is expressed in two abundant forms, the soluble antibody molecule and the cell-bound B-cell receptor. Both forms arise from a single messenger RNA by alternative splicing with the result that two additional exons are added to the IgG heavy chain coding region (Tyler et al. (1982) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 79, 2008-2012; Yamawaki-Kataoka et al. (1982) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 79, 2623-2627). The first exon added (M1 exon) encodes a stretch of 18 amino acids, ELQLEESCAEAQDGELDG, which flexibly tethers IgG to the cell surface, making it a good choice for novel Fc-like molecules with a C-terminal-X-terminus (Fc-X). The C-terminal gly-18 residue of the M1 domain is also well-suited for preparing Fc-intein fusion proteins used in generating a C-terminal activated thioester. Following an intein autocleavage reaction, a thioester intermediate is generated that permits the facile addition of cysteine or selenocysteine to the C-terminus by native chemical ligation.
  • Accordingly, host cells are transfected with expression vectors that encode pre-Fc-intein chimeric polypeptides containing the M1 domain joined at its C-terminus, ELQLEESCAEAQDGELDG, by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site (FIG. 37A), or the Fc protein containing a portion of the M1 domain, ELQLEESC (FIG. 37B). To ensure that the Fc-X protein does not have an N-terminal-X-terminus, heterologous signal peptides are used that are cleaved by the cellular signal peptidase before lysine residues (part i). Thus, cleavage by the cellular signal peptidase will provide a Fc-intein fusion protein with lys-7, EPKSCDKTHTCPPCP, at the N-terminus (part ii). Excision of the intein domain by protein splicing provides an Fc-thioester intermediate (part iii). Finally, native chemical ligation of the Fc-thioester with free cysteine and/or selenocysteine is employed to prepare Fc-X proteins having the C-terminal-X-terminus, ELQLEESCAEAQDGELDGX (part iv).
  • The sequences of the IgG1 precursor polypeptides of FIG. 37A are shown in SEQ ID NO:116, and SEQ ID NO:117. The sequence of the mature and modified IgG1 polypeptides of FIG. 37A is shown in SEQ ID NO:118 to SEQ ID NO:120. The sequences of the IgG1 precursor polypeptides of FIG. 37B are shown in SEQ ID NO:123, and SEQ ID NO:124. The sequence of the mature IgG1 polypeptide of FIG. 37B is shown in SEQ ID NO:125.
  • The Fc-intein fusion protein with lys-7 at the N-terminus is prepared using the procedures described in EXAMPLE 1. The initial purification step is carried out using affinity chromatography with a chitin resin instead of protein A sepharose. After cleavage from the resin, the activated Fc-thioester intermediate is used directly for native ligation with cysteine and/or selenocysteine.
  • A suitable DNA sequence for the M1 membrane domain of human IgG1 is described in Strausberg et. al. (2002) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 99, 16899-16903 (GenBank Acc. No. BC019046).
  • Suitable examples of signal peptides are the CD2 T-cell surface glycoprotein (CD2) (GenBank Acc. No. NM001767), and the CD4 T-cell surface glycoprotein (CD4) (GenBank Acc. No. NP000616).
  • A suitable example of a self-splicing intein is found in the Methanobacterium thermoautotrophicum ribonucleotide reductase large subunit (MthRIR1) (Genbank Acc. No. AE000845). To limit the intein autocleave reaction to the Fc-intein fusion junction, an MthRR1 intein variant with only N-terminal cleavage activity is prepared by changing the pro at position −1 to gly and the C-terminal asn at position 134 to ala (Evans et al. (1999) J. Biol. Chem. 274, 3923-3926). In addition, an Mth RRI intein sequence fused to a Bacillus circulans chitin binding domain is used to facilitate the purification of the Fc-intein chimeric polypeptide by affinity chromatography. A suitable sequence for the modified MthRIR1 intein is found in plasmid pTWIN-2 (New England BioLabs, MA).
  • Other suitable examples are found in the Mycobacterium xenopi gyrase subunit A (Mxe GyrA) (Genbank Acc. No. MXU67876), and the Saccharomyces cerevisiae vacuolar ATPase (Sce VMA1) (GenBank Acc. No. NC001136). Many other suitable examples of self-splicing inteins are described in Inbase: the Intein Database (Perler (2002) Nucl. Acids Res. 30, 383-384).
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert and vector fragment prepared by digestion with EcoRI and BglII. For unamplified expression, plasmid pCD2-Fc7-Mth (CD2 signal) is constructed with SEQ ID NO:9 and SEQ ID NO:1, and plasmid pCD4-Fc7-Mth (CD4 signal) is constructed with SEQ ID NO:10 and SEQ ID NO:1. For amplified expression, plasmid pCD2-Fc7-Mth-DHFR is constructed with SEQ ID NO:9 and pSVeCD4DHFR, and plasmid pCD4-Fc7-Mth-DHFR is constructed with SEQ ID NO:10 and pSVeCD4DHFR.
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and EagI and a vector fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and PspOM1. Plasmid pCDNA3-CD2-Fc7-Mth (CD2 signal) is constructed with SEQ ID NO:114 and pCDNA3.1(+), and plasmid pCDNA3-CD4-Fc7-Mth (CD4 signal) is constructed with SEQ ID NO:115 and pCDNA3.1(+). Plasmid pCDNA3-CD2-Fc7-ELQLEESC (CD2 signal) is constructed with SEQ ID NO:121 and pCDNA3.1(+), and plasmid pCDNA3-CD4-Fc7-ELQLEESC (CD4 signal) is constructed with SEQ ID NO:122 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • General principles of chitin affinity purification and the self-splicing intein autocleavage reaction are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,834,247, the whole of which is incorporated herein by reference.
  • Following host cell transfection, cell culture supernatant is applied to a column packed with chitin resin (New England BioLabs, MA) that is equilibrated in buffer A (20 mM Tris-HCl, pH 7.5 containing 500 mM NaCl). Unbound protein is washed from the column with 10 column volumes of buffer A. Thiol reagent-induced cleavage is initiated by rapidly equilibrating the chitin resin in buffer B (20 mM Tris-HCl, pH 8 containing 0.5 M NaCl and 0.1 M 2-mercaptoethane-sulfonic acid (MESNA)). The cleavage, which simultaneously generates a C-terminal thioester on the target protein, is carried out overnight at 4° C. after which the protein was eluted from the column.
  • Starting with the purified Fc-thioester intermediate, native chemical ligation is carried out with cysteine or selenocysteine using the procedure in EXAMPLE 2. The final Fc-X product is purified to remove unreacted cysteine and selenocysteine by affinity chromatography with protein A sepharose.
  • EXAMPLE 4 Preparation of Immunoglobulin Fc with N-Terminal-S-Termini and C-Terminal-X-Termini (S-Fc-X)
  • The S-Fc and Fc-X proteins are useful in preparing immunosymmetroadhesins having two binding domains joined to a single Fc domain (see below). Binding domains are added to the N-terminal-S-termini (S-Fc) or C-terminal-X-termini (Fc-X). S-Fc-X domains that are useful in preparing bi-symmetroadhesins with four binding domains joined to a single Fc domain are prepared using the procedures described in EXAMPLE 1 and EXAMPLE 3.
  • Accordingly, host cells are transfected with expression vectors that encode pre-Fc-intein chimeric polypeptides containing the M1 domain joined at its C-terminus, ELQLEESCAEAQDGELDG, by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site (FIG. 38). Heterologous signal peptides are selected from proteins with N-terminal cysteines (part i). Thus, cleavage by the cellular signal peptidase will provide a mature S-Fc-intein fusion protein having cys-5 at the N-terminus, CDKTHTCPPCP (part ii). Excision of the intein by protein splicing provides an Fc-thioester intermediate (part iii). Finally, native ligation of the Fc-thioester with free cysteine and/or selenocysteine is employed to prepare S-Fc-X proteins having the C-terminal-X-terminus, ELQLEESCAEAQDGELDGX (part iv).
  • The sequences of the IgG1 precursor polypeptides of FIGS. 38A-38B are shown in SEQ ID NO:126, SEQ ID NO:127, and SEQ ID NO:128. The sequence of the mature and modified IgG1 polypeptides of FIGS. 38A-38B is shown in SEQ ID NO:129 to SEQ ID NO:131.
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert and vector fragment prepared by digestion with EcoRI and BglII. For unamplified expression, PSHH-Fc5-Mth is constructed with SEQ ID NO:11 and SEQ ID NO:1, pIFN-Fc5-Mth is constructed with SEQ ID NO:12 and SEQ ID NO:1, and pCETP-Fc5-Mth is constructed with SEQ ID NO:13 and SEQ ID NO:1. For amplified expression, pSHH-Fc5-Mth-DHFR is constructed with SEQ ID NO:11 and pSVeCD4DHFR, pIFN-Fc5-Mth-DHFR is constructed with SEQ ID NO:12 and pSVeCD4DHFR, and pCETP-Fc5-Mth-DHFR is constructed with SEQ ID NO:13 and pSVeCD4DHFR.
  • The S-Fc-intein fusion protein is first purified from the culture supernatant of transfected host cells using chitin affinity chromatography. After cleavage from the chitin resin, the Fc-thioester intermediate is directly applied to a protein A Sepharose column in order to prevent cyclization or polymerization side-reactions. The column bound activated S-Fc-thioester is used directly for native ligation with cysteine and/or selenocysteine. The column is then washed to remove excess amino acids, and the S-Fc-X is eluted from the protein A sepharose.
  • EXAMPLE 5 Preparation of Immunoglobulin Fc with N-Terminal-X-Termini and C-Terminal-X-Termini (X-Fc-X)
  • The X-Fc and Fc-X proteins are useful in preparing immunosymmetroadhesins having two binding domains joined to a single Fc domain (see below). Binding domains are added to the N-terminal-X-termini (X-Fc) or C-terminal-X-termini (Fc-X). X-Fc-X domains that are useful in preparing bi-symmetroadhesins with four binding domains joined to a single Fc domain are prepared using the procedures described in EXAMPLE 2 and EXAMPLE 3.
  • Accordingly, host cells are transfected with expression vectors that encode pre-Fc-intein chimeric polypeptides containing the M1 domain joined at its C-terminus, ELQLEESCAEAQDGELDG, by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site (FIG. 39). Heterologous signal peptides are selected from proteins with N-terminal cysteines (part i). Thus, cleavage by the cellular signal peptidase will provide a mature S-Fc-intein fusion protein having cys-11 at the N-terminus (part ii). Native chemical ligation is then employed to prepare X-Fc-intein fusion proteins having cys-5 or sec-5 at the N-terminus, XDKTHTCPPCP (part iii). Excision of the intein by protein splicing provides an Fc-thioester intermediate (part iv). Finally, in a second native chemical ligation reaction, the Fc-thioester with is carried out with free cysteine and/or selenocysteine to prepare X-Fc-X proteins having a C-terminal-X-terminus ELQLEESCAEAQDGELDGX (part v). Alternately, part iii is carried following parts iv and v.
  • The sequences of the IgG1 precursor polypeptides of FIGS. 39A-39B are shown in SEQ ID NO:132, SEQ ID NO:133, and SEQ ID NO:134. The sequence of the mature and modified IgG1 polypeptides of FIGS. 38A-38B is shown in SEQ ID NO:135 to SEQ ID NO:138.
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert and vector fragment prepared by digestion with EcoRI and BglII. For unamplified expression, plasmid pSHH-Fc11-Mth is constructed with SEQ ID NO:14 and SEQ ID NO:1, pIFN-Fc11-Mth is constructed with SEQ ID NO:15 and SEQ ID NO:1, and pCETP-Fc11-Mth is constructed with SEQ ID NO:16 and SEQ ID NO:1. For amplified expression, pSHH-Fc11-Mth-DHFR is constructed with SEQ ID NO:14 and pSVeCD4DHFR, pIFN-Fc11-Mth-DHFR is constructed with SEQ ID NO:15 and pSVeCD4DHFR, and pCETP-Fc11-Mth-DHFR is constructed with SEQ ID NO:16 and pSVeCD4DHFR.
  • The S-Fc-intein fusion protein is first purified from the culture supernatant of transfected host cells using chitin affinity chromatography. Native chemical ligation is carried out on the chitin column with the Msc-NH-cys5-thr10-α-thioester peptide (Fc-A) or the Msc-NH-sec5-thr10-α-thioester peptide (Fc-B) as described (EXAMPLE 2). The chitin column is then washed thoroughly to remove unreacted peptide. The intein autocleavage reaction is then carried out. After cleavage, the X-Fc-thioester intermediate is directly applied to protein A Sepharose. The bound activated X-Fc-thioester is used directly for native ligation with cysteine and/or selenocysteine. The column is then washed to remove excess amino acids. The Msc-blocked X-Fc-X is eluted from the column, treated to remove the Msc protecting group, and repurified using protein A Sepharose to yield the final X-Fc-X product.
  • EXAMPLE 6 CD4 Symmetroadhesins
  • A therapeutic strategy for treating HIV-1 infection is based upon human CD4, a component of the HIV-1 receptor. CD4 immunoadhesins (Capon et al. (1989) Nature 337, 525-531) effectively block HIV-1 infectivity by binding to the gp120 envelope protein. The blocking activity resides in the CD4 extracellular domain (residues 1 to 371).
  • Accordingly, various CD4 symmetroadhesins are prepared using CD4-X protein, and analysed for their ability to bind gp120 and block HIV-1 infectively. The activity of CD4 symmetroadhesins is compared with CD4 immunoadhesin prepared as described (Capon et al., ibid).
  • CD4-X protein is prepared by the procedures of EXAMPLE 3. Host cells are transfected with expression vectors that encode the pre-CD4 chimeric polypeptide containing the CD4 extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site (FIGS. 40A-40B).
  • Cleavage of the CD4 signal sequence (part i) by the cellular signal peptidase provides mature CD4-intein fusion protein (part ii). Excision of the intein domain provides a CD4-thioester intermediate (part iii). Finally, native chemical ligation of the CD4-thioester with free cysteine and/or selenocysteine is employed to prepare CD4 domains with C-terminal-X-termini (part iv).
  • The sequences of these polypeptides are shown in SEQ ID NO: 140, SEQ ID NO:141, SEQ ID NO:142, and SEQ ID NO:143.
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert and vector fragment prepared by digestion with EcoRI and BglII. For unamplified expression, plasmid pCD4-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:17 and SEQ ID NO:1. For amplified expression, plasmid pCD4-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:17 and pSVeCD4DHFR.
  • Suitable expression vectors were constructed by ligation of an insert fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and EagI and a vector fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and PspOM1. Plasmid pCDNA3-CD4-Mth was constructed using SEQ ID NO:139 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • FIG. 56 shows expression in human 293 kidney cells of human CD4-intein fusion proteins. Lanes 1-4 show the CD4-intein fusion polypeptide of FIG. 40A (ii). Cell supernatants: lanes 1 and 3; cell lysates: lanes 2 and 4.
  • CD4-X is used to prepare various CD4 symmetroadhesins (Table 2). Hemi-symmetroadhesins are prepared using the CD4-X protein alone, immunosymmetroadhesins are prepared using the CD4-X protein with S-Fc, X-Fc, or Fc-X, and bi-symmetroadhesins are prepared using the CD4-X protein with S-Fc-X or X-Fc-X.
  • CD4 hemi-symmetroadhesin is prepared using CD4-X protein exposed to mildly reducing conditions that activate the X-termini, but do not denature the protein (Fleischman et al. (1962) Arch. Biochem. Biophys. 1 (Suppl.), 174-180; Edelman et al. (1963) Proc. Nat. Acad. Sci. (1963) 50, 753-761). CD4-X protein (0.5 to 2.0 mgs/ml) is dissolved in reducing buffer (0.05 M Tris-HCl buffer pH 8.0, made 0.1 M in 2-mercaptoethanol) and incubated for 1 hour at room temperature. The protein is then exchanged into oxidation buffer (0.1 M K2HPO4) by Sephadex G-100 chromatography, gently agitated in a round bottom glass test tube stoppered with a loosely packed cotton plug, and allowed to proceed at room temperature for 20 hours (Haber and Anfinsen (1961) J. Biol. Chem. 236, 422-424). CD4 immunosymmetroadhesins and CD4 bi-symmetroadhesins are prepared on protein A Sepharose beads using the S-Fc, X-Fc, Fc-X, S-Fc-X, or X-Fc-X proteins as indicated (Table 2). The bound proteins are gently agitated in reducing buffer for 1 hour at room temperature, then washed with oxidation buffer. CD4-X is treated with reducing buffer, added to the beads, and the reaction allowed to proceed at room temperature for 20 hours.
  • CD4-gp120 saturation binding analysis is carried out as described (Smith et al. (1987) Science 238, 1704-1707) using radio-iodinated gp120 prepared as described (Lasky et al. (1987) Cell 50, 975-985). Reactions (0.2) contain 0.25% NP-40, 0.1% sodium deoxycholate, 0.06 M NaCl, 0.01 M Tris-HCl, pH 8.0 (1× buffer A) with 125I-gp120 (3 ng to 670 ng at 2.9 nCi/ng). Binding is carried out for 1 hour at 0° C. in the presence or absence of 50 micrograms of unlabeled purified gp120. The bound 125I-gp120 is then determined by immunoprecipitation. Binding reactions are preabsorbed with 5 microliters of normal rabbit serum for 1 hour at 0° C., cleared with 40 microliters of 10% w/v Pansorbin (Calbiochem) for 30 minutes at 0° C., and incubated overnight at 0° C. with 2 microliters of normal serum or 5 microliters (0.25 microgram) of OKT4 monoclonal antibody (Ortho Biotech). Immunoprecipitates are collected with 10 microliters of Pansorbin, washed twice in 2× buffer and once in water, then eluted at 100° C. for 2 minutes in 0.12 M Tris-HCl pH 6.8, 4% SDS, 0.7 M mercaptoethanol. The fraction of bound 125I-gp120 is determined in a gamma counter and Scatchard analysis is used to determine the apparent dissociation contant.
  • HIV-1 blocking studies are carried out as described (Robert-Guroff et al. (1985) Nature 316, 72-74). Equal volumes of inhibitor and HIV-1 (60 microliters) are incubated at 4° C. for 1 hour, then the same volume of H9 cells (Gallo et al. (1984) Science 224, 500-503) at 5×106/ml is added and incubation continued for 1 hour at 37° C. Following absorption of virus, 2.5×105 cells in 150 microliters are transferred to 2 ml of incubation media. After 4 days at 37° C., the cultures are split 1:2 with fresh media and incubated for an additional 3 days. Cultures are harvested, reverse transcriptase activity is measured (Groopman et al., AIDS Res. Hum. Retroviruses (1987) 3, 71-85), and immunofluorescence with HIV-1 positive serum is determined as described (Poiesz et al. (1980) Proc. Acad. Nat. Sci. 77, 7415-7419). Challenge dose of virus is 100 TCID50 of HIV-1 strain HTLV-IIIB grown in H9 cells assayed in the same system. Incubation media is RPMI 1640 media containing 2 mM L-glutamine, 100 units/ml penicillin, 100 micrograms/ml streptomycin, 2 micrograms/ml polybrene and 20% fetal calf serum.
  • EXAMPLE 7 Tumor Necrosis Factor Receptor Symmetroadhesins
  • A therapeutic strategy for treating autoimmune disease is based upon tumor necrosis factor α (TNF-α), and its binding interaction with TNF-α antibodies and receptors (TNR). Both are an important therapeutic option in adult rheumatoid arthritis, juvenile rheumatoid arthritis, ankylosing spondylitis, psoriatic arthritis, Crohn's disease, and ulcerative colitis.
  • Accordingly, various TNR symmetroadhesins are prepared using TNR-X proteins, and analyzed for their ability to bind TNF-α and to block TNF-α biological activity. The activity of TNR symmetroadhesins is compared to that of TNR immunoadhesins (Ashkenazi et al. (1991) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 88, 10535-10539).
  • Human TNR include TNR1A (Genbank Acc. No. NM001065); and TNR1B (GenBank Acc. No. NM001066). TNF-α antibody Di62 includes Di62 heavy chain (Genbank Acc. No. AJ002433); and Di62 light chain (Genbank Acc. No. AJ002434) (hereafter, TNR1A=TNR1; TNR1B=TNR2; and Di62-VH-CH+Di62-VkCk=TNRFab).
  • Di62-Vk is prepared according to the method of EXAMPLE 1. Di62-VH-X, TNR1A-X, and TNR1B-X, are prepared according to the method of EXAMPLE 3.
  • Host cells are co-transfected with two expression vectors that encode the Di62-VH-CH-intein chimeric polypeptide and Di62-VkCk protein result in co-expression of the Di62-VH-CH-intein:Di62-Vk-Ck protein that is used to prepare the TNFFab-X protein:
  • 1) a pre-Di62-VH-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the Di62-VH-CH1 domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site (FIGS. 41A-41B); and
    2) a pre-Di62-Vk polypeptide containing the Di62-Vk-Ck domain (FIG. 42).
  • Cleavage of the homologous Di62-VH-CH signal sequence (part i) by the cellular signal peptidase provides mature Di62-VH-CH-intein fusion protein (part ii). Excision of the intein by protein splicing provides the Di62-VH-CH-thioester intermediate (part iii). Finally, native chemical ligation of the Di62-VH-CH-thioester with free cysteine and/or selenocysteine is employed to prepare Di62-VH-CH-X protein with C-terminal-X-termini (part iv) (refer to FIGS. 41A-41B).
  • Cleavage of the homologous Di62-Vk-Ck signal sequence (part i) by the cellular signal peptidase provides the mature Di62-Vk-Ck protein (part ii) (refer to FIG. 42).
  • Host cells are transfected with expression vectors that encode the TNR1A-intein chimeric polypeptide and TNR1B-intein chimeric polypeptide to prepare the TNF1-X and TNF2-X proteins, respectively:
  • 1) a pre-TNR1A-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the TNR1A extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site (FIG. 43); and
    2) a pre-TNR1B-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the TNR1B extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site (FIG. 44A).
  • Cleavage of the homologous TNR signal sequences (part i) by the cellular signal peptidase provides mature TNR-intein fusion proteins (part ii). Excision of the intein by protein splicing provides TNR-thioester intermediates (part iii). Finally, native chemical ligation of the TNR-thioesters with free cysteine and/or selenocysteine is employed to prepare TNR-X proteins with C-terminal-X-termini (part iv) (refer to FIG. 43, 44A).
  • The sequences of these polypeptides are shown in SEQ ID NO: 145, SEQ ID NO:146, SEQ ID NO:147, and SEQ ID NO:148 (Di62-VHCH); in SEQ ID NO: 150, and SEQ ID NO:151 (Di62-VkCk); in SEQ ID NO: 153, SEQ ID NO:154, SEQ ID NO:155, and SEQ ID NO:156 (TNR1A); in SEQ ID NO: 158, SEQ ID NO:159, SEQ ID NO:160, and SEQ ID NO:161 (TNR1B); and in SEQ ID NO: 163, and SEQ ID NO:164 (TNR1B immunoadhesin).
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert and vector fragment prepared by digestion with EcoRI and BglII. For unamplified expression, plasmid pDi62-VHCH-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:18 and SEQ ID NO:1, plasmid pDi62-VkCk is constructed using SEQ ID NO:19 and SEQ ID NO:1, plasmid pTNR1A-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:20 and SEQ ID NO:1, and plasmid pTNR1A-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:22 and SEQ ID NO:1. For amplified expression, plasmid pDi62-VHCH-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:18 and pSVeCD4DHFR, plasmid pDi62-VkCk-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:19 and pSVeCD4DHFR, plasmid pTNR1A-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:20 and pSVeCD4DHFR, and plasmid pTNR1A-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:22 and pSVeCD4DHFR.
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and EagI and a vector fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and PspOM1. Plasmid pCDA3-Di62-VHCH-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:144 and pCDNA3.1(+). Plasmid pCDA3-Di62-VkCk is constructed using SEQ ID NO:149 and pCDNA3.1(+). Plasmid pCDNA-3-TNR1A-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:152 and pCDNA3.1(+). Plasmid pCDNA-3-TNR1B-Mth-DHFR was constructed using SEQ ID NO:157 and pCDNA3.1(+). Plasmid pCDNA-3-TNR1B-immunoadhesin was constructed using SEQ ID NO:162 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • FIG. 57 shows the expression in human 293 kidney cells of human TNR1B fusion proteins. Lanes 2 and 5 show the TNR1B-intein fusion protein of FIG. 44A (ii). Lanes 1 and 3 show the TNR1B-immunoadhesin fusion protein of FIG. 44B (ii). Lanes 3 and 6 show proteins from mock-transfected cells. Cell supernatants: lanes 1-3; cell lysates: lanes 4-7. Lane 7: control TNR1B-immunoadhesin (R&D Systems).
  • FIG. 58 shows TNR1B symmetroadhesin subunits with C-terminal-S-termini. Lanes 1-2 show the TNR1B polypeptide of FIG. 44A (iii) following purification by chitin affinity chromatography and cleavage/elution with MESNA. Lanes 3 shows the native ligation product between the TNR1B polypeptide of FIG. 44A (iii) with a fluorescent-labeled peptide (New England Biolabs). Panel (i): direct fluorescence; panel (ii): western blot with anti-TNR1B antibody (R&D Systems); panel (iii): SYPRO Ruby staining (Sigma-Aldrich).
  • FIG. 59 shows TNR1B symmetroadhesin subunits with C-terminal-S-termini. Lane 5 shows the TNR1B polypeptide of FIG. 44A (iv) following purification by chitin affinity chromatography and cleavage/elution with cysteine. Lanes 1-4 show TNR1B-immunoadhesin.
  • FIG. 60 shows TNR1B symmetroadhesin. Lanes 1-4 show the TNR1B symmetroadhesin of FIG. 44A (iv) before oxidation (lanes 1 and 4) and after oxidation in the presence of 10 mM CuSO4. Lanes 3 and 6 show a TNR1B-immunoadhesin control. Lanes 1-3: reducing conditions; lanes 4-6: non-reducing conditions. The TNR1B symmetroadhesin monomer (42 kd) and dimer (84 kd) are apparent in lanes 2 and 5, and lane 5, respectively.
  • FIGS. 61A-61C show TNF-alpha saturation binding analysis with various TNR1B polypeptides on the Biacore T-100. (A) The TNR1B symmetroadhesin of FIG. 44A (iv) was covalently coupled to a Biacore CM-5 chip using standard Biacore amine chemistry. (B) TNR1B immunoadhesin (R&D Systems) was covalently coupled to a Biacore CM-5 chip using standard Biacore amine chemistry. (C) The TNR1B symmetroadhesin of FIG. 44A (iv) was covalently coupled to a Biacore CM-5 chip using standard Biacore thiol chemistry. Following coupling, saturation binding analysis was carried out using TNF-alpha (R&D Systems) at the indicated concentations.
  • FIGS. 62A-62C shows Scatchard analysis of the TNF-alpha saturation binding analysis shown in FIG. 61A-61C. (A) TNR1B symmetroadhesin of FIG. 44A (iv) covalently coupled using amine chemistry; Kd=Kd=4.697×10−9 M. (B) TNR1B-immunoadhesin (R&D Systems) covalently coupled using amine chemistry; Kd=4.089×10−9 M. (C) TNR1B symmetroadhesin of FIG. 44A (iv) covalently coupled using thiol chemistry; Kd=0.8476×10−9 M.
  • The TNR1-X, TNR2-X, and TNRFab-X proteins, individually and in various combinations, are used to prepare various VGFR symmetroadhesins (Tables 3, 4, and 5). The number of distinct configurations obtained for each combination, as well as the general structure for each, is also shown.
  • Hemi-symmetroadhesins are prepared using the TNR-X proteins alone, immunosymmetroadhesins are prepared using the TNR-X proteins with S-Fc, X-Fc, or Fc-X, and bi-symmetroadhesins are prepared using the TNR-X proteins with S-Fc-X or X-Fc-X.
  • Each TNR-X protein or TNR symmetroadhesin is determined by a quantitative immunoassay using subtype-specific, affinity-purified polyclonal antibodies to TNR1A, TNR1B, and Di62 (goat-anti-mouse), and immunoadhesins (TNR1A-Ig and TNR2A-Ig) as reference standards. TNR antibodies, TNR-Ig immunoadhesins, and TNF-α protein are obtained from R&D Systems (MN).
  • Binding of TNGR symmetroadhesins to TNF-α is studied as described (Ashkenazi et al. (1991) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 88, 10535-10539). Individual samples (1 microgram/ml) are immobilized onto microtiter wells coated with goat-anti-human Ig Fc antibody. Reactions with recombinant human 125I-TNF-α (radiodinated by using lactoperoxidase to a specific activity of 19.1 microCi/microgram, 1 microCi=37 kBq) are done in phosphate-buffered saline (PBS) containing 1% bovine serum albumin for 1 hour at 24° C. Non-specific binding is determined by omitting the sample. In competition binding analyses, 125I-TNF-α is incubated with immobilized samples in the presence of increasing concentrations of unlabeled TNF-α. The Kd is determined from competition IC50 values according to the following equation: Kd=IC50/(1+[T]/KdT), where [T] is the concentration of the tracer (0.1 nm) and KdT is the Kd of the tracer determined by saturation binding (80 μM). TNF cytotoxity is studied as described (Kawade and Watanabe (1984) J. Interferon Res. 4, 571-584). Mouse L-M cells are plated in microtiter dishes (4×104 cells per well) and treated with actinomycin D (3 micrograms/ml) and TNF-α or TNF-β (1 nanogram/ml) in the presence or absence of the sample or other inhibitors. After 20 hours of incubation at 39° C., the cell survival is determined by a crystal violet dye exclusion test.
  • A mouse model for septic shock is studied by endotoxin injection of 6- to 8-week-old BALB/c mice. Animals are injected intravenously (i.v.) with an LD100 dose of Salmonella abortus-derived endotoxin (175 micrograms per mouse) in phosphate-buffered saline (PBS), and survival is followed for at least 78 hour. TNR1-immunoadhesin and CD4-immunoadhesin are used as the positive and negative controls, respectively. Each is diluted in PBS and injected i.v. prior to, or after, the administration of endotoxin.
  • EXAMPLE 8 Vascular Endothelial Growth Factor Receptor Symmetroadhesins
  • A therapeutic strategy for treating angiogenic disease is based upon vascular endothelial growth factors (VEGF) and their binding interaction with VEGF receptors (VGFR). VEGF-antibodies and VGFR-immunoadhesins are promising candidates for treatment in a number of metastatic carcinomas including colon, rectum, lung, and breast, and in age-related macular degeneration.
  • Accordingly, various VGFR symmetroadhesins are prepared using VGFR-X proteins, and analyzed for their ability to bind VEGF and to block VEGF biological activity. The activity of VGFR symmetroadhesins is compared to that of VGRF immunoadhesins (Park et al. (1994) J. Biol. Chem. 269, 25646-25654).
  • Human VGFR include VGFR1 (Genbank Acc. No. NM002019); VGFR2 (GenBank Acc. No. NM002253); and VGFR3 (GenBank Acc. No. NM002020). VGFR1-X, VGFR2-X, and VGFR3-X are prepared according to the method of EXAMPLE 3. Host cells are transfected with expression vectors that encode:
  • 1) a pre-VGFR1-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the VGFR1 extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site (FIGS. 45A-45C);
    2) a pre-VGFR2-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the VGFR1 extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site (FIGS. 46A-46C); and
    3) a pre-VGFR1-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the VGFR1 extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site (FIGS. 47A-47C).
  • Cleavage of the VGFR signal sequence (part i) by the cellular signal peptidase provides mature VGFR-intein fusion proteins (part ii). Excision of the intein domain provides a VGFR-thioester intermediate (part iii). Finally, native chemical ligation of the VGFR-thioester with free cysteine and/or selenocysteine is employed to prepare VGFR domains with C-terminal-X-termini (part iv).
  • The sequences of these polypeptides are shown in SEQ ID NO: 166, SEQ ID NO:167, SEQ ID NO:168, and SEQ ID NO:169 (VGFR1); in SEQ ID NO: 171, SEQ ID NO:172, SEQ ID NO:173, and SEQ ID NO:174 (VGFR2); and in SEQ ID NO: 176, SEQ ID NO:177, SEQ ID NO:178, and SEQ ID NO:179 (VGFR3).
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert and vector fragment prepared by digestion with EcoRI and BglII. For unamplified expression, plasmid pVGFR1-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:22 and SEQ ID NO:1, plasmid pVGR1-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:23 and SEQ ID NO:1, and plasmid pVGR1-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:24 and SEQ ID NO:1. For unamplified expression, plasmid pVGFR1-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:22 and pSVeCD4DHFR, plasmid pVGR1-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:23 and pSVeCD4DHFR, and plasmid pVGR1-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:24 and pSVeCD4DHFR.
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and EagI and a vector fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and PspOM1. Plasmid pCDNA3-VGFR1-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:165 and pCDNA3.1(+). Plasmid pCDNA3-VGFR2-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:170 and pCDNA3.1(+). Plasmid pCDNA3-VGFR3-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:175 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • The VGFR1-X, VGFR2-X, and VEGFR3-X proteins, individually and in various combinations, are used to prepare various VGFR symmetroadhesins (Tables 6, 7, and 8). The number of distinct configurations obtained for each combination, as well as the general structure for each, is also shown.
  • Hemi-symmetroadhesins are prepared using the VGFR-X proteins alone, immunosymmetroadhesins are prepared using the VGFR-X proteins with S-Fc, X-Fc, or Fc-X, and bi-symmetroadhesins are prepared using the VGFR-X proteins with S-Fc-X or X-Fc-X.
  • Each VGFR-X protein or VGFR symmetroadhesin is determined by a quantitative immunoassay using subtype-specific, affinity-purified polyclonal antibodies to VGFR1, VGFR2, and VGFR3, and immunoadhesins (VGFR1-Ig, VGFR2-Ig, and VGFR3-Ig) as reference standards. VGFR antibodies, VGFR-Ig immunoadhesins, and VEGF165 protein are obtained from R&D Systems (MN).
  • Binding of VEGR symmetroadhesins to VEGF is studied using a VEGF saturation binding assay. Reactions (0.1 ml) contain 10% fetal bovine serum in PBS (buffer A) with 125I-VEGF165 (<9000 cpm/well, 5.69×107 cpm/microgram). Chloramine T is used to iodinated VEGF165 as described (Keyt et al. (1996) J. Biol Chem. 271, 5638-5646). Binding is carried out overnight at 4° C. in the presence or absence of 50 nanograms of unlabeled purified VEGF165. The bound 125I-VEGF165 is then determined by capture in 96-well breakaway immunoabsorbent assay plates (Nunc). Plates are coated overnight at 4° C. with 2 micrograms/ml affinity-purified goat anti-human Fc IgG (Organon-Teknika) in 50 mM Na2CO3, pH 9.6, and preblocked for 1 hr in buffer A. Binding reactions are then incubated in the coated wells for 4 hrs at room temperature, followed by 4 washes with buffer A. The fraction of bound 125I-VEGF165 is determined in a gamma counter. Data is analyzed using a 4-parameter non-linear curve fitting program (Kalidagraph, Abelbeck Software, Pa.).
  • Binding of VEGF to VEGR symmetroadhesins is also studied using a competition binding assay. ELISA plates are coated with 2 micrograms/ml rabbit F(ab′)2 to human IgG Fc (Jackson ImmunoResearch, Pa.) and blocked with buffer A. KDR-IgG (3 nanograms/ml) in buffer A is added to the plate and incubated for 1 hr. Serially-diluted samples are incubated with 2 nM biotinylated VEGF for 1 h in tubes. The reactions are then transferred to the ELISA plates and incubated for 1 h. After washing, the fraction of biotinylated VEGF bound to KDR-Ig is detected using horseradish peroxidase-labeled streptavidin (Sigma, Mo.) followed by 3,3′,5,5′-tetramethylbenzidine substrate. Data is analyzed using 4-parameter non-linear regression curve fitting analysis.
  • Endothelial cell growth inhibition studies are carried out as described (Leung et al. (1989) Science 246, 1306-1309). Bovine adrenal cortex capillary endothelial cells are cultured in the presence of low glucose Dulbecco's modified Eagle's medium (GIBCO) supplemented with 10% calf serum, and 2 mM glutamine (growth medium). Cells are seeded at a density of 6×103 cells/well in 6-well plates. Serially diluted samples are added to the cells at concentrations between 1 to 5000 nanograms/ml and incubated for 2 to 3 hr. Purified VEGF165 is added to a final concentration of 3 nanograms/ml. Cells are then incubated for 5 to 6 days, removed from plates with trypsin, and cell number determined in a Coulter counter (Coulter Electronics, FL). Data is analyzed using 4-parameter non-linear regression curve fitting analysis.
  • In vivo tumor studies are carried out as described (Kim et al. (1993) Nature 362, 841-844; Borgstrom et al. (1996) Cancer Res. 56, 4032-4039). Human A673 rhabdomyosarcoma cells (ATCC CRL-1598) are cultured in DMEM/F12 supplemented with 10% fetal bovine serum, and 2 mM glutamine. Female BALB/c nude mice, 6 to 10 weeks old, are injected subcutaneously with 2×106 tumor cells in the dorsal area in a volume of 200 microliters. Following tumor cell inoculation (24 hr.), animals (10 per group) are treated with serially diluted samples at dose of 0.05 mg/kg, 0.5 mg/kg, and 5 mg/kg, administered twice weekly intraperitoneally in a volume of 0.1 ml. Tumor size is determined at weekly intervals. Four weeks after tumor cell inoculation, animals are euthanized and the tumors removed and weighed. Statistical analysis is carried out by ANOVA.
  • EXAMPLE 9 ErbB Syetroadhesins
  • A therapeutic strategy for treating malignant disease is based upon epidermal growth factor-like receptors (ErbB) and their ligands, including the neuregulins/heregulins (NRG/HRG), and the family of EGF-related protein ligands. ErbB-antibodies and ErbB-immunoadhesins are under clinical investigation, and are well-proven in treating metastatic breast cancers overexpressing ErbB2.
  • Accordingly, various ErbB symmetroadhesins are prepared using ErbB-X proteins, and analyzed for their ability to bind heregulins and block heregulin biological activity. The activity of ErbB symmetroadhesins is compared to that of ErbB immunoadhesins (Sliwkowski et al. (1994) J. Biol. Chem. 269, 14661-14665).
  • Human ErbB include ErbB1 (Genbank Acc. No. NM005228); ErbB2 (GenBank Acc. No. NM004448); ErbB3 (GenBank Acc. No. NM001982); and ErbB4 (GenBank Acc. No. NM005235). ErbB1-X, ErbB2-X, ErbB3-X, and ErbB4-X are prepared according to the method of EXAMPLE 3. Host cells are transfected with expression vectors that encode:
  • 1) a pre-ErbB1-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the ErbB1 extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site (FIGS. 48A-48B);
    2) a pre-ErbB2-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the ErbB2 extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site (FIGS. 49A-49B);
    3) a pre-ErbB3-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the ErbB3 extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site (FIGS. 50A-50B); and
    4) a pre-ErbB4-intein chimeric polypeptide containing the ErbB4 extracellular domain joined at its C-terminus by a peptide bond to the N-terminus of a self-splicing intein at the autocleavage site (FIGS. 51A-50B).
  • Cleavage of the homologous ErbB signal sequence (part i) by the cellular signal peptidase provides mature ErbB-intein fusion proteins (part ii). Excision of the intein domain by protein splicing provides a ErbB-thioester intermediate (part iii). Finally, native chemical ligation of the ErbB-thioester with free cysteine and/or selenocysteine is employed to prepare VEGR domains with C-terminal-X-termini (part iv).
  • The sequences of these polypeptides are shown in SEQ ID NO: 181, SEQ ID NO:182, SEQ ID NO:183, and SEQ ID NO:184 (ERBB1); in SEQ ID NO: 186, SEQ ID NO:187, SEQ ID NO:188, and SEQ ID NO:189 (ERBB2); in SEQ ID NO: 191, SEQ ID NO:192, SEQ ID NO:193, and SEQ ID NO:194 (ERBB3); and in SEQ ID NO: 196, SEQ ID NO:197, SEQ ID NO:198, and SEQ ID NO:199 (ERBB4).
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert and vector fragment prepared by digestion with EcoRI and BglII. For unamplified expression, plasmid pErbB1-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:25 and SEQ ID NO:1, plasmid pErbB2-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:26 and SEQ ID NO:1, plasmid pErbB3-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:27 and SEQ ID NO:1, and plamid pErbB4-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:28 and SEQ ID NO:1. For amplified expression, plasmid pErbB1-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:25 and pSVeCD4DHFR, plasmid pErbB2-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:26 and pSVeCD4DHFR, plasmid pErbB3-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:27 and pSVeCD4DHFR, and plamid pErbB4-Mth-DHFR is constructed using SEQ ID NO:28 and pSVeCD4DHFR.
  • Suitable expression vectors are constructed by ligation of an insert fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and EagI and a vector fragment prepared by digestion with Hind III and PspOM1. Plasmid pCDNA3-ERBB1-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:180 and pCDNA3.1(+). Plasmid pCDNA3-ERBB2-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:185 and pCDNA3.1(+). Plasmid pCDNA3-ERBB3-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:190 and pCDNA3.1(+). Plasmid pCDNA3-ERBB4-Mth is constructed using SEQ ID NO:195 and pCDNA3.1(+).
  • The ErbB1-X, ErbB2-X, ErbB3-X and ErbB4-X proteins, individually and in various combinations, are used to prepare various VGFR symmetroadhesins (Tables 9, 10, 11). The number of distinct configurations obtained for each combination, as well as the general structure for each, is also shown.
  • Hemi-symmetroadhesins are prepared using the ErbB-X proteins alone, immunosymmetroadhesins are prepared using the ErbB-X proteins with S-Fc, X-Fc, or Fc-X, and bi-symmetroadhesins are prepared using the ErbB-X proteins with S-Fc-X or X-Fc-X.
  • Each ErbB-X protein or ErbB symmetroadhesin is determined by a quantitative immunoassay using subtype-specific, affinity-purified polyclonal antibodies to ErbB1, ErbB2, ErbB3, and ErbB4, and immunoadhesins (ErbB1-Ig, ErbB2-Ig, ErbB3-Ig, and ErbB4-Ig) as reference standards. ErbB antibodies, ErbB-Ig immunoadhesins, NRG1-α177-241 protein, NRG1-β176-246 protein, NRG1-β1-246 protein, and NRG1-SMDF1-296 protein are obtained from R&D Systems (MN).
  • Binding of ErbB symmetroadhesins to neuregulins is studied using a HRG saturation binding assay (Sliwkowski et al. (1994) J. Biol. Chem. 269, 14661-14665). Reactions are performed in Nunc breakapart immuno-module plates. Plate wells are coated at 4° C. overnight with 100 microliters of 5 micrograms/ml goat-anti-human antibody (Boehringer Mannheim) in 50 mM carbonate buffer (pH 9.6). Plates are rinsed twice with 200 microliters wash buffer (PBS/0.05% Tween-20™) followed by a brief incubation with 100 microliters 1% BSA/PBS for 30 min at room temperature. Buffer is removed and each well is incubated with 100 microliters of the sample in 1% BSA/PBS under vigorous side-to-side rotation for 1 hour. Plates are rinsed three times with wash buffer and competitive binding is carried out by adding various amounts of cold competitor gamma-HRG and 125I-HRGβ1 and incubating at room temperature for 2 to 3 hours with vigorous side-to-side rotation. Wells are quickly rinsed three times with wash buffer, drained and individual wells are counted in a gamma-counter. Scatchard analysis is performed using a modified Ligand program (Munson, P. and Robard, D. (1980) Analytical Biochemistry 107:220-239).
  • The ability of ErbB symmetroadhesins to inhibit HRG-dependent proliferation is studied in the MCF7 breast carcinoma cell line (Lewis et al. (1996) Cancer Res. 56, 1457-1465). 3H-thymidine incorporation is are carried out in 96-well format. Serum-starved MCF7-7 cells are plated at 10,000 cells/well in 50:50 F12/DMEM (high glucose). Varying concentrations of sample are incubated with 1 nM HRG and added to the cells. After a 15 hour incubation, cells are labeled with 3H-thymidine to measure DNA synthesis (20 mL of 1/20 diluted tritiated thymidine stock: Amersham TRA 120 B363, 1 mCi/ml). Cells are then harvested onto GF/C unifilters (96 well format) using a Packard Filtermate 196 harvester. Filters are counted using a Packard Topcount apparatus.
  • Screening
  • This invention is particularly useful for screening compounds by using consecutive amino acid sequences/or compounds comprising such in any of a variety of drug screening techniques. The compound employed in such a test may either be free in solution, affixed to a solid support, borne on a cell surface, or located intracellularly. One method of drug screening utilizes eukaryotic or prokaryotic host cells which are stably transformed with recombinant nucleic acids expressing the compound. Drugs are screened against such transformed cells in competitive binding assays. Such cells, either in viable or fixed form, can be used for standard binding assays. One may measure, for example, the formation of complexes between compound or a fragment and the agent being tested. Alternatively, one can examine the diminution in complex formation between the compound and its target cell or target receptors caused by the agent being tested.
  • Thus, the present invention provides methods of screening for drugs or any other agents which can affect a disease or disorder associated with a stretch of consecutive amino acids of the compound. These methods comprise contacting such an agent with the compound or fragment thereof and assaying (I) for the presence of a complex between the agent and the compound or fragment thereof, or (ii) for the presence of a complex between the compound or fragment thereof and the cell, by methods well known in the art. In such competitive binding assays, the compound or fragment thereof is typically labeled. After suitable incubation, free compound or fragment thereof is separated from that present in bound form, and the amount of free or uncomplexed label is a measure of the ability of the particular agent to bind to the compound or fragment thereof or to interfere with the compound/cell complex.
  • Another technique for drug screening provides high throughput screening for compounds having suitable binding affinity to a polypeptide and is described in detail in WO 84/03564, published on Sep. 13, 1984. Briefly stated, large numbers of different small peptide test compounds are synthesized on a solid substrate, such as plastic pins or some other surface. As applied to the instant compound or fragment thereof, the peptide test compounds are reacted with compound or fragment thereof and washed. Bound compound or fragment thereof is detected by methods well known in the art. Purified compound or fragment thereof can also be coated directly onto plates for use in the aforementioned drug screening techniques. In addition, non-neutralizing antibodies can be used to capture the peptide and immobilize it on the solid support.
  • This invention also contemplates the use of competitive drug screening assays in which neutralizing antibodies capable of binding compound or fragment thereof specifically compete with a test compound for binding to compound or fragment thereof. In this manner, the antibodies can be used to detect the presence of any peptide which shares one or more antigenic determinants with the stretch(es) of consecutive amino acids of the compound.
  • Rational Drug Design
  • The goal of rational drug design is to produce structural analogs of biologically active polypeptide of interest (i.e., a compound of the invention, or an amino acid sequence of a compound of the invention) or of small molecules with which they interact, e.g., agonists, antagonists, or inhibitors. Any of these examples can be used to fashion drugs which are more active or stable forms of the a compound of the invention, or an amino acid sequence of a compound of the invention or which enhance or interfere with the function of the a compound of the invention, or an amino acid sequence of a compound of the invention in vivo (cf., Hodgson, Bio/Technology, 9:19-21 (1991)).
  • In one approach, the three-dimensional structure of a compound of the invention, or an amino acid sequence of a compound of the invention, or of a compound-inhibitor complex, is determined by x-ray crystallography, by computer modeling or, most typically, by a combination of the two approaches. Both the shape and charges of a compound of the invention, or an amino acid sequence of a compound of the invention, must be ascertained to elucidate the structure and to determine active site(s). Relevant structural information is used to then design analogous molecules or to identify efficient inhibitors. Useful examples of rational drug design may include molecules which have improved activity or stability as shown by Braxton and Wells, Biochemistry, 31:7796-7801 (1992) or which act as inhibitors, agonists, or antagonists of native peptides as shown by Athauda et al., J. Biochem., 113:742-746 (1993).
  • It is also possible to isolate a target-specific antibody, selected by functional assay, as described above, and then to solve its crystal structure. This approach, in principle, yields a pharmacore upon which subsequent drug design can be based. It is possible to bypass protein crystallography altogether by generating anti-idiotypic antibodies (anti-ids) to a functional, pharmacologically active antibody. As a mirror image of a mirror image, the binding site of the anti-ids would be expected to be an analog of the original receptor. The anti-id could then be used to identify and isolate peptides from banks of chemically or biologically produced peptides. The isolated peptides would then act as the pharmacore.
  • By virtue of the present invention, sufficient amounts of the compounds of the invention, or an amino acid sequence of a compound of the invention may be made available to perform such analytical studies as X-ray crystallography.
  • Assays of Biological Activity
  • The compounds disclosed herein, including components thereof such as a stretch of consecutive amino acids of a compound, are readily assayed using one or more standard assays of biological activity known to those in the art. The following are non-limiting examples of such assays:
  • Ability of the Compounds to Inhibit Vascular Endothelial Growth Factor (VEGF) Stimulated Proliferation of Endothelial Cell Growth
  • The ability of the various compounds of this invention to inhibit VEGF stimulated proliferation of endothelial cells was tested. Positive testing in this assay indicates the compound is useful for inhibiting endothelial cell growth in mammals where such an effect would be beneficial, e.g., for inhibiting tumor growth.
  • In a specific example of the assay, bovine adrenal cortical capillary endothelial cells (ACE) (from primary culture, maximum of 12-14 passages) are plated in 96-well plates at 500 cells/well per 100 microliter. Assay media includes low glucose DMEM, 10% calf serum, 2 mM glutamine, and 1× penicillin/streptomycin/fungizone. Control wells include the following: (1) no ACE cells added; (2) ACE cells alone; (3) ACE cells plus 5 ng/ml FGF; (4) ACE cells plus 3 ng/ml VEGF; (5) ACE cells plus 3 ng/ml VEGF plus 1 ng/ml TGF-beta; and (6) ACE cells plus 3 ng/ml VEGF plus 5 ng/ml LIF. The test samples, poly-his tagged compounds (in 100 microliter volumes), are then added to the wells (at dilutions of 1%, 0.1% and 0.01%, respectively). The cell cultures are incubated for 6-7 days at 37° C./5% CO2 After the incubation, the media in the wells is aspirated, the cells are washed 1× with PBS. An acid phosphatase reaction mixture (100 microliter; 0.1M sodium acetate, pH 5.5, 0.1% Triton X-100, 10 mM p-nitrophenyl phosphate) is then added to each well. After a 2 hour incubation at 37° C., the reaction is stopped by addition of 10 microliters 1M NaOH. Optical density (OD) is measured on a microplate reader at 405 nm.
  • The activity of the assayed compound is calculated as the percent inhibition of VEGF (3 ng/ml) stimulated proliferation (as determined by measuring acid phosphatase activity at OD 405 nm) relative to the cells without stimulation. TGF-beta can be employed as an activity reference at 1 ng/ml, since TGF-beta blocks 70-90% of VEGF-stimulated ACE cell proliferation. The results are indicative of the utility of the assayed compound in cancer therapy and specifically in inhibiting tumor angiogenesis. Numerical values (relative inhibition) are determined by calculating the percent inhibition of VEGF stimulated proliferation by the assayed compound relative to cells without stimulation and then dividing that percentage into the percent inhibition obtained by TGF-beta at 1 ng/ml which is known to block 70-90% of VEGF stimulated cell proliferation. The results are considered positive if the assayed compound exhibits 30% or greater inhibition of VEGF stimulation of endothelial cell growth (relative inhibition 30% or greater).
  • Retinal Neuron Survival
  • This assay can demonstrate if the compound tested has efficacy in enhancing the survival of retinal neuron cells and, therefore, is useful for the therapeutic treatment of retinal disorders or injuries including, for example, treating sight loss in mammals due to retinitis pigmentosum, AMD, etc.
  • Sprague Dawley rat pups at postnatal day 7 (mixed population: glia and retinal neuronal types) are killed by decapitation following CO2 anesthesia and the eyes are removed under sterile conditions. The neural retina is dissected away from the pigment epithelium and other ocular tissue and then dissociated into a single cell suspension using 0.25% trypsin in Ca2+, Mg2+-free PBS. The retinas are incubated at 37° C. for 7-10 minutes after which the trypsin is inactivated by adding 1 ml soybean trypsin inhibitor. The cells are plated at 100,000 cells per well in 96 well plates in DMEM/F12 supplemented with N2 and with or without the specific test compound. Cells for all experiments are grown at 37° C. in a water saturated atmosphere of 5% CO2. After 2-3 days in culture, cells are stained with calcein AM then fixed using 4% paraformaldehyde and stained with DAPI for determination of total cell count. The total cells (fluorescent) are quantified at 20× objective magnification using CCD camera and NIH image software for MacIntosh. Fields in the well are chosen at random.
  • The effect of various concentration of the tested compound are reported herein where percent survival is calculated by dividing the total number of calcein AM positive cells at 2-3 days in culture by the total number of DAPI-labeled cells at 2-3 days in culture. Anything above 30% survival is considered positive.
  • Rod Photoreceptor Cell Survival
  • This assay is used to show whether certain compounds of the invention act to enhance the survival/proliferation of rod photoreceptor cells and, therefore, are useful for the therapeutic treatment of retinal disorders or injuries including, for example, treating sight loss in mammals due to retinitis pigmentosum, AMD, etc. Sprague Dawley rat pups at 7 day postnatal (mixed population: glia and retinal neuronal cell types) are killed by decapitation following CO2 anesthesis and the eyes are removed under sterile conditions. The neural retina is dissected away form the pigment epithelium and other ocular tissue and then dissociated into a single cell suspension using 0.25% trypsin in Ca2+, Mg2+-free PBS. The retinas are incubated at 37° C. for 7-10 minutes after which the trypsin is inactivated by adding 1 ml soybean trypsin inhibitor. The cells are plated at 100,000 cells per well in 96 well plates in DMEM/F12 supplemented with N2. Cells for all experiments are grown at 37° C. in a water saturated atmosphere of 5% CO2. After 2-3 days in culture, cells are fixed using 4% paraformaldehyde, and then stained using CellTracker Green CMFDA. Rho 4D2 (ascites or IgG 1:100), a monoclonal antibody directed towards the visual pigment rhodopsin is used to detect rod photoreceptor cells by indirect immunofluorescence. The results are calculated as % survival: total number of calcein-rhodopsin positive cells at 2-3 days in culture, divided by the total number of rhodopsin positive cells at time 2-3 days in culture. The total cells (fluorescent) are quantified at 20× objective magnification using a CCD camera and NIH image software for MacIntosh. Fields in the well are chosen at random.
  • Induction of Endothelial Cell Apoptosis
  • The ability of the compounds disclosed herein to induce apoptosis in endothelial cells can be tested in human venous umbilical vein endothelial cells (HUVEC, Cell Systems). A positive test in the assay is indicative of the usefulness of the compound in therapeutically treating tumors as well as vascular disorders where inducing apoptosis of endothelial cells would be beneficial.
  • The cells are plated on 96-well microtiter plates (Amersham Life Science, cytostar-T scintillating microplate, RPNQ160, sterile, tissue-culture treated, individually wrapped), in 10% serum (CSG-medium, Cell Systems), at a density of 2×104 cells per well in a total volume of 100 μl. On day 2, test samples containing the tested compound are added in triplicate at dilutions of 1%, 0.33% and 0.11%. Wells without cells were used as a blank and wells with cells only are used as a negative control. As a positive control 1:3 serial dilutions of 50 μl of a 3× stock of staurosporine were used. The ability of the compound to induce apoptosis is determined by processing of the 96 well plates for detection of Annexin V, a member of the calcium and phospholipid binding proteins, to detect apoptosis.
  • 0.2 ml Annexin V-Biotin stock solution (100 μg/ml) was diluted in 4.6 ml 2× Ca2+ binding buffer and 2.5% BSA (1:25 dilution). 50 μl of the diluted Annexin V-Biotin solution was added to each well (except controls) to a final concentration of 1.0 μg/ml. The samples were incubated for 10-15 minutes with Annexin-Biotin prior to direct addition of 35S-Streptavidin. 35S-Streptavidin was diluted in 2× Ca2+ Binding buffer, 2.5% BSA and was added to all wells at a final concentration of 3×104 cpm/well. The plates were then sealed, centrifuged at 1000 rpm for 15 minutes and placed on orbital shaker for 2 hours. The analysis was performed on a 1450 Microbeta Trilux (Wallac). Percent above background represents the percentage amount of counts per minute above the negative controls. Percents greater than or equal to 30% above background are considered positive.
  • PDB12 Cell Inhibition
  • This assay will demonstrates if the compounds disclosed herein have efficacy in inhibiting protein production by PDB12 pancreatic ductal cells and are, therefore, useful in the therapeutic treatment of disorders which involve protein secretion by the pancreas, including diabetes, and the like.
  • PDB12 pancreatic ductal cells are plated on fibronectin coated 96 well plates at 1.5×103 cells per well in 100 μL/180 μL of growth media. 100 μL of growth media with the compound test sample or negative control lacking the compound is then added to well, for a final volume of 200 μL. Controls contain growth medium containing a protein shown to be inactive in this assay. Cells are incubated for 4 days at 37° C. 20 μL of Alamar Blue Dye (AB) is then added to each well and the flourescent reading is measured at 4 hours post addition of AB, on a microtiter plate reader at 530 nm excitation and 590 nm emission. The standard employed is cells without Bovine Pituitary Extract (BPE) and with various concentrations of BPE. Buffer or CM controls from unknowns are run 2 times on each 96 well plate.
  • These assays allow one to calculate a percent decrease in protein production by comparing the Alamar Blue Dye calculated protein concentration produced by the compound-treated cells with the Alamar Blue Dye calculated protein concentration produced by the negative control cells. A percent decrease in protein production of greater than or equal to 25% as compared to the negative control cells is considered positive.
  • Stimulation of Adult Heart Hypertrophy
  • This assay is designed to measure the ability of the various compounds disclosed herein to stimulate hypertrophy of adult heart. A positive test in this assay indicates that the compound would be expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of various cardiac insufficiency disorders.
  • Ventricular myocytes freshly isolated from adult (250 g) Sprague Dawley rats are plated at 2000 cell/well in 180 μl volume. Cells are isolated and plated on day 1, the compound-containing test samples or growth medium only (negative control) (20 μl volume) is added on day 2 and the cells are then fixed and stained on day 5. After staining, cell size is visualized wherein cells showing no growth enhancement as compared to control cells are given a value of 0.0, cells showing small to moderate growth enhancement as compared to control cells are given a value of 1.0 and cells showing large growth enhancement as compared to control cells are given a value of 2.0. Any degree of growth enhancement as compared to the negative control cells is considered positive for the assay.
  • PDB12 Cell Proliferation
  • This assay demonstrates whether the various compounds disclosed herein have efficacy in inducing proliferation of PDB12 pancreatic ductal cells and are, therefore, useful in the therapeutic treatment of disorders which involve protein secretion by the pancreas, including diabetes, and the like.
  • PDB12 pancreatic ductal cells are plated on fibronectin coated 96 well plates at 1.5×103 cells per well in 100 μL/180 μL of growth media. 100 μL of growth media with the compound test sample or negative control lacking the compound tested is then added to well, for a final volume of 200 μL. Controls contain growth medium containing a protein shown to be inactive in this assay. Cells are incubated for 4 days at 37° C. 20 μL of Alamar Blue Dye (AB) is then added to each well and the flourescent reading is measured at 4 hours post addition of AB, on a microtiter plate reader at 530 nm excitation and 590 nm emission. The standard employed is cells without Bovine Pituitary Extract (BPE) and with various concentrations of BPE. Buffer or growth medium only controls from unknowns are run 2 times on each 96 well plate.
  • Percent increase in protein production is calculated by comparing the Alamar Blue Dye calculated protein concentration produced by the test compound-treated cells with the Alamar Blue Dye calculated protein concentration produced by the negative control cells. A percent increase in protein production of greater than or equal to 25% as compared to the negative control cells is considered positive.
  • Enhancement of Heart Neonatal Hypertrophy
  • This assay is designed to measure the ability of the compounds disclosed herein to stimulate hypertrophy of neonatal heart. Testing positive in this assay indicates the compounds to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of various cardiac insufficiency disorders.
  • Cardiac myocytes from 1-day old Harlan Sprague Dawley rats are obtained. Cells (180 μl at 7.5×104/ml, serum <0.1%, freshly isolated) are added on day 1 to 96-well plates previously coated with DMEM/F12+4% FCS. Test samples containing the test compound or growth medium only (negative control) (201/well) are added directly to the wells on day 1. PGF (20 μl/well) is then added on day 2 at final concentration of 10−6 M. The cells are then stained on day 4 and visually scored on day 5, wherein cells showing no increase in size as compared to negative controls are scored 0.0, cells showing a small to moderate increase in size as compared to negative controls are scored 1.0 and cells showing a large increase in size as compared to negative controls are scored 2.0. A positive result in the assay is a score of 1.0 or greater.
  • Stimulatory Activity in Mixed Lymphocyte Reaction (MLR) Assay
  • This assay is used to determine if the compounds disclosed herein are active as a stimulator of the proliferation of stimulated T-lymphocytes. Compounds which stimulate proliferation of lymphocytes are useful therapeutically where enhancement of an immune response is beneficial. A therapeutic agent may take the form of antagonists of the compounds of the invention, for example, murine-human chimeric, humanized or human antibodies against the compound.
  • The basic protocol for this assay is described in Current Protocols in Immunology, unit 3.12; edited by J E Coligan, A M Kruisbeek, D H Marglies, E M Shevach, W Strober, National Insitutes of Health, Published by John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
  • More specifically, in one assay variant, peripheral blood mononuclear cells (PBMC) are isolated from mammalian individuals, for example a human volunteer, by leukopheresis (one donor will supply stimulator PBMCs, the other donor will supply responder PBMCs). If desired, the cells are frozen in fetal bovine serum and DMSO after isolation. Frozen cells may be thawed overnight in assay media (37° C., 5% CO2) and then washed and resuspended to 3×106 cells/ml of assay media (RPMI; 10% fetal bovine serum, 1% penicillin/streptomycin, 1% glutamine, 1% HEPES, 1% non-essential amino acids, 1% pyruvate). The stimulator PBMCs are prepared by irradiating the cells (about 3000 Rads).
  • The assay is prepared by plating in triplicate wells a mixture of:
  • 100:1 of test sample diluted to 1% or to 0.1%, 50:1 of irradiated stimulator cells, and 50:1 of responder PBMC cells.
  • 100 microliters of cell culture media or 100 microliter of CD4-IgG is used as the control. The wells are then incubated at 37° C., 5% CO2 for 4 days. On day 5, each well is pulsed with tritiated thymidine (1.0 mC/well; Amersham). After 6 hours the cells are washed 3 times and then the uptake of the label is evaluated.
  • In another variant of this assay, PBMCs are isolated from the spleens of Balb/c mice and C57B6 mice. The cells are teased from freshly harvested spleens in assay media (RPMI; 10% fetal bovine serum, 1% penicillin/streptomycin, 1% glutamine, 1% HEPES, 1% non-essential amino acids, 1% pyruvate) and the PBMCs are isolated by overlaying these cells over Lympholyte M (Organon Teknika), centrifuging at 2000 rpm for 20 minutes, collecting and washing the mononuclear cell layer in assay media and resuspending the cells to 1×107 cells/ml of assay media. The assay is then conducted as described above.
  • Positive increases over control are considered positive with increases of greater than or equal to 180% being preferred. However, any value greater than control indicates a stimulatory effect for the test protein.
  • Pericyte c-Fos Induction
  • This assay shows the ability of the compounds disclosed herein of the invention act to induce the expression of c-fos in pericyte cells and, therefore, their use not only as diagnostic markers for particular types of pericyte-associated tumors but also for giving rise to antagonists which would be expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of pericyte-associated tumors. Specifically, on day 1, pericytes are received from VEC Technologies and all but 5 ml of media is removed from flask. On day 2, the pericytes are trypsinized, washed, spun and then plated onto 96 well plates. On day 7, the media is removed and the pericytes are treated with 100 μl of test compound samples and controls (positive control=DME+5% serum +/−PDGF at 500 ng/ml; negative control=protein 32). Replicates are averaged and SD/CV are determined. Fold increase over Protein 32 (buffer control) value indicated by chemiluminescence units (RLU) luminometer reading verses frequency is plotted on a histogram. Two-fold above Protein 32 value is considered positive for the assay. ASY Matrix: Growth media=low glucose DMEM=20% FBS+1× pen/strep+1× fungizone. Assay Media=low glucose DMEM+5% FBS.
  • Ability of the Compounds of the Invention to Stimulate the Release of Proteoglycans from Cartilage
  • The ability of the compounds disclosed herein to stimulate the release of proteoglycans from cartilage tissue can be tested as follows.
  • The metacarphophalangeal joint of 4-6 month old pigs is aseptically dissected, and articular cartilage was removed by free hand slicing being careful to avoid the underlying bone. The cartilage was minced and cultured in bulk for 24 hours in a humidified atmosphere of 95% air, 5% CO2 in serum free (SF) media (DME/F12 1:1) with 0.1% BSA and 100 U/ml penicillin and 100 μg/ml streptomycin. After washing three times, approximately 100 mg of articular cartilage is aliquoted into micronics tubes and incubated for an additional 24 hours in the above SF media. The compound is then added at 1% either alone or in combination with 18 ng/ml interleukin-1 alpha, a known stimulator of proteoglycan release from cartilage tissue. The supernatant is then harvested and assayed for the amount of proteoglycans using the 1,9-dimethyl-methylene blue (DMB) calorimetric assay (Farndale and Buttle, Biochem. Biophys. Acta 883:173-177 (1985)). A positive result in this assay indicates that the test compound will find use, for example, in the treatment of sports-related joint problems, articular cartilage defects, osteoarthritis or rheumatoid arthritis.
  • Skin Vascular Permeability Assay
  • This assay is used to test whether compounds of the invention stimulate an immune response and induce inflammation by inducing mononuclear cell, eosinophil and PMN infiltration at the site of injection of the animal. Compounds which stimulate an immune response are useful therapeutically where stimulation of an immune response is beneficial. This skin vascular permeability assay is conducted as follows. Hairless guinea pigs weighing 350 grams or more are anesthetized with ketamine (75-80 mg/Kg) and 5 mg/Kg xylazine intramuscularly (IM). A sample of purified compound of the invention or a conditioned media test sample is injected intradermally onto the backs of the test animals with 100 μl per injection site. It is possible to have about 10-30, preferably about 16-24, injection sites per animal. One μl of Evans blue dye (1% in physiologic buffered saline) is injected intracardially. Blemishes at the injection sites are then measured (mm diameter) at 1 hr and 6 hr post injection. Animals were sacrificed at 6 hrs after injection. Each skin injection site is biopsied and fixed in formalin. The skins are then prepared for histopathologic evaluation. Each site is evaluated for inflammatory cell infiltration into the skin. Sites with visible inflammatory cell inflammation are scored as positive. Inflammatory cells may be neutrophilic, eosinophilic, monocytic or lymphocytic. At least a minimal perivascular infiltrate at the injection site is scored as positive, no infiltrate at the site of injection is scored as negative.
  • Enhancement of Heart Neonatal Hypertrophy Induced by F2a
  • This assay is designed to measure the ability of compounds disclosed herein to stimulate hypertrophy of neonatal heart, a positive test indicating usefulness for the therapeutic treatment of various cardiac insufficiency disorders.
  • Cardiac myocytes from 1-day old Harlan Sprague Dawley rats were obtained. Cells (180 μl at 7.5×104/ml, serum <0.1%, freshly isolated) are added on day 1 to 96-well plates previously coated with DMEM/F12+4% FCS. Test samples containing the test compound (20 μl/well) are added directly to the wells on day 1. PGF (20 μl/well) is then added on day 2 at a final concentration of 10−6 M. The cells are then stain on day 4 and visually scored on day ˜5. Visual scores are based on cell size, wherein cells showing no increase in size as compared to negative controls are scored 0.0, cells showing a small to moderate increase in size as compared to negative controls are scored 1.0 and cells showing a large increase in size as compared to negative controls are scored 2.0. A score of 1.0 or greater is considered positive.
  • No PBS is included, since calcium concentration is critical for assay response. Plates are coated with DMEM/F12 plus 4% FCS (200 μl/well). Assay media included: DMEM/F12 (with 2.44 gm bicarbonate), μg/ml transferrin, 1 μg/ml insulin, 1 μg/ml aprotinin, 2 mmol/L glutamine, 100 U/ml penicillin G, 100 μg/ml streptomycin. Protein buffer containing mannitol (4%) gave a positive signal (score 3.5) at 1/10 (0.4%) and 1/100 (0.04%), but not at 1/1000 (0.004%). Therefore the test sample buffer containing mannitol is not run.
  • Inhibitory Activity in Mixed Lymphocyte Reaction (MLR) Assay
  • This example shows that one or more of the compound of the invention are active as inhibitors of the proliferation of stimulated T-lymphocytes. Compounds which inhibit proliferation of lymphocytes are useful therapeutically where suppression of an immune response is beneficial.
  • The basic protocol for this assay is described in Current Protocols in Immunology, unit 3.12; edited by J E Coligan, A M Kruisbeek, D H Marglies, E M Shevach, W Strober, National Insitutes of Health, Published by John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
  • More specifically, in one assay variant, peripheral blood mononuclear cells (PBMC) are isolated from mammalian individuals, for example a human volunteer, by leukopheresis (one donor will supply stimulator PBMCs, the other donor will supply responder PBMCs). If desired, the cells are frozen in fetal bovine serum and DMSO after isolation. Frozen cells may be thawed overnight in assay media (37° C., 5% CO2) and then washed and resuspended to 3×106 cells/ml of assay media (RPMI; 10% fetal bovine serum, 1% penicillin/streptomycin, 1% glutamine, 1% HEPES, 1% non-essential amino acids, 1% pyruvate). The stimulator PBMCs are prepared by irradiating the cells (about 3000 Rads).
  • The assay is prepared by plating in triplicate wells a mixture of:
  • 100:1 of test sample diluted to 1% or to 0.1%, 50:1 of irradiated stimulator cells, and
    50:1 of responder PBMC cells.
  • 100 microliters of cell culture media or 100 microliter of CD4-IgG is used as the control. The wells are then incubated at 37° C., 5% CO2 for 4 days. On day 5, each well is pulsed with tritiated thymidine (1.0 mC/well; Amersham). After 6 hours the cells are washed 3 times and then the uptake of the label is evaluated.
  • In another variant of this assay, PBMCs are isolated from the spleens of Balb/c mice and C57B6 mice. The cells are teased from freshly harvested spleens in assay media (RPMI; 10% fetal bovine serum, 1% penicillin/streptomycin, 1% glutamine, 1% HEPES, 1% non-essential amino acids, 1% pyruvate) and the PBMCs are isolated by overlaying these cells over Lympholyte M (Organon Teknika), centrifuging at 2000 rpm for 20 minutes, collecting and washing the mononuclear cell layer in assay media and resuspending the cells to 1×107 cells/ml of assay media. The assay is then conducted as described above.
  • Any decreases below control is considered to be a positive result for an inhibitory compound, with decreases of less than or equal to 80% being preferred. However, any value less than control indicates an inhibitory effect for the test protein.
  • Induction of Endothelial Cell Apoptosis (ELISA)
  • The ability of the compounds disclosed herein to induce apoptosis in endothelial cells can be tested in human venous umbilical vein endothelial cells (HUVEC, Cell Systems) using a 96-well format, in 0% serum media supplemented with 100 ng/ml VEGF, 0.1% BSA, 1× pen/strep.
  • A positive result in this assay indicates the usefulness of the compound for therapeutically treating any of a variety of conditions associated with undesired endothelial cell growth including, for example, the inhibition of tumor growth. Coating of 96 well plates can be prepared by allowing gelatinization to occur for >30 minutes with 100 μl of 0.2% gelatin in PBS solution. The gelatin mix is aspirated thoroughly before plating HUVEC cells at a final concentration of 2×104 cells/ml in 10% serum containing medium—100 μl volume per well. The cells were grown for 24 hours before adding test samples containing the compound of interest.
  • To all wells, 100 μl of 0% serum media (Cell Systems) complemented with 100 ng/ml VEGF, 0.1% BSA, 1× pen/strep is added. Test samples containing the test compound were added in triplicate at dilutions of 1%, 0.33% and 0.11%. Wells without cells were used as a blank and wells with cells only are used as a negative control. As a positive control, 1:3 serial dilutions of 50 μl of a 3× stock of staurosporine are used. The cells were incubated for 24 to 35 hours prior to ELISA.
  • ELISA is used to determine levels of apoptosis preparing solutions according to the Boehringer Manual [Boehringer, Cell Death Detection ELISA plus, Cat No. 1 920 685]. Sample preparations: 96 well plates are spun down at 1 krpm for 10 minutes (200 g); the supernatant is removed by fast inversion, placing the plate upside down on a paper towel to remove residual liquid. To each well, 200 μl of 1× Lysis buffer is added and incubation allowed at room temperature for 30 minutes without shaking. The plates were spun down for 10 minutes at 1 krpm, and 20 μl of the lysate (cytoplasmic fraction) is transferred into streptavidin coated MTP. 80 μl of immunoreagent mix was added to the 20 μl lystate in each well. The MTP was covered with adhesive foil and incubated at room temperature for 2 hours by placing it on an orbital shaker (200 rpm). After two hours, the supernatant was removed by suction and the wells rinsed three times with 250 μl of 1× incubation buffer per well (removed by suction). Substrate solution was added (100 μl) into each well and incubated on an orbital shaker at room temperature at 250 rpm until color development was sufficient for a photometric analysis (approx. after 10-20 minutes). A 96 well reader was used to read the plates at 405 nm, reference wavelength, 492 nm. The levels obtained for PIN 32 (control buffer) was set to 100%. Samples with levels >130% were considered positive for induction of apoptosis.
  • Human Venous Endothelial Cell Calcium Flux Assay
  • This assay is designed to determine whether compounds of the present invention show the ability to stimulate calcium flux in human umbilical vein endothelial cells (HUVEC, Cell Systems). Calcium influx is a well documented response upon binding of certain ligands to their receptors. A test compound that results in a positive response in the present calcium influx assay can be said to bind to a specific receptor and activate a biological signaling pathway in human endothelial cells. This could ultimately lead, for example, to endothelial cell division, inhibition of endothelial cell proliferation, endothelial tube formation, cell migration, apoptosis, etc.
  • Human venous umbilical vein endothelial cells (HUVEC, Cell Systems) in growth media (50:50 without glycine, 1% glutamine, 10 mM Hepes, 10% FBS, 10 ng/ml bFGF), are plated on 96-well microtiter ViewPlates-96 (Packard Instrument Company Part #6005182) microtiter plates at a cell density of 2×104 cells/well. The day after plating, the cells are washed three times with buffer (HBSS plus 10 mM Hepes), leaving 100 μl/well. Then 100 μl/well of 8 μM Fluo-3 (2× is added. The cells are incubated for 1.5 hours at 37° C./5% CO2. After incubation, the cells are then washed 3× with buffer (described above) leaving 100 μl/well. Test samples of the compound are prepared on different 96-well plates at 5× concentration in buffer. The positive control corresponded to 50 μM ionomycin (5×); the negative control corresponded to Protein 32. Cell plate and sample plates are run on a FLIPR (Molecular Devices) machine. The FLIPR machine added 25 μl of test sample to the cells, and readings are taken every second for one minute, then every 3 seconds for the next three minutes.
  • The fluorescence change from baseline to the maximum rise of the curve (Δ change) is calculated, and replicates averaged. The rate of fluorescence increase is monitored, and only those samples which had a Δ change greater than 1000 and a rise within 60 seconds, are considered positive.
  • Fibroblast (BHK-21) Proliferation
  • This assay will show if the compounds of the invention act to induce proliferation of mammalian fibroblast cells in culture and, therefore, function is useful growth factors in mammalian systems.
  • The assay is performed is follows. BHK-21 fibroblast cells plated in standard growth medium at 2500 cells/well in a total volume of 100 μl. The compound, beta-FGF (positive control) or nothing (negative control) are then added to the wells in the presence of 1 μg/ml of heparin for a total final volume of 200 μl. The cells are then incubated at 37° C. for 6 to 7 days. After incubation, the media is removed, the cells are washed with PBS and then an acid phosphatase substrate reaction mixture (100 μl/well) is added. The cells are then incubated at 37° C. for 2 hours. 10 μL per well of 1N NaOH is then added to stop the acid phosphatase reaction. The plates are then read at OD 405 nm. A positive in the assay is acid phosphatase activity which is at least 50% above the negative control.
  • Inhibition of Heart Adult Hypertrophy
  • This assay is designed to measure the inhibition of heart adult hypertrophy. Compounds testing positive in this assay may find use in the therapeutic treatment of cardiac disorders associated with cardiac hypertrophy.
  • Ventricular myocytes are freshly isolated from adult (250 g) Harlan Sprague Dawley rats and the cells are plated at 2000/well in 180 μl volume. On day two, test samples (20 μL) containing the test compound are added. On day five, the cells are fixed and then stained. An increase in ANP message can also be measured by PCR from cells after a few hours. Results are based on a visual score of cell size: 0=no inhibition, −1=small inhibition, −2=large inhibition. A score of less than 0 is considered positive. Activity reference corresponds to phenylephrine (PE) at 0.1 mM, is a positive control. Assay media included: M199 (modified)-glutamine free, NaHCO3, phenol red, supplemented with 100 nM insulin, 0.2% BSA, 5 mM cretine, 2 mM L-carnitine, 5 mM taurine, 100 U/ml penicillin G, 100 μg/ml streptomycin (CCT medium). Only inner 60 wells are used in 96 well plates. Of these, 6 wells are reserved for negative and positive (PE) controls.
  • Induction of c-Fos in Endothelial Cells
  • This assay is designed to determine whether compounds of the invention show the ability to induce c-fos in endothelial cells. Compounds testing positive in this assay would be expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of conditions or disorders where angiogenesis would be beneficial including, for example, wound healing, and the like (is would agonists of these compounds). Antagonists of the compounds testing positive in this assay would be expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of cancerous tumors.
  • Human venous umbilical vein endothelial cells (HUVEC, Cell Systems) in growth media (50% Ham's F12 w/o GHT: low glucose, and 50% DMEM without glycine: with NaHCO3, 1% glutamine, 10 mM HEPES, 10% FBS, 10 ng/ml bFGF) are plated on 96-well microtiter plates at a cell density of 1×104 cells/well. The day after plating, the cells are starved by removing the growth media and treating the cells with 100 μl/well test samples and controls (positive control=growth media; negative control=Protein 32 buffer=10 mM HEPES, 140 mM NaCl, 4% (w/v) mannitol, pH 6.8). The cells are incubated for 30 minutes at 37° C., in 5% CO2. The samples are removed, and the first part of the bDNA kit protocol (Chiron Diagnostics, cat. #6005-037) is followed, where each capitalized reagent/buffer listed below is available from the kit.
  • Briefly, the amounts of the TM Lysis Buffer and Probes needed for the tests are calculated based on information provided by the manufacturer. The appropriate amounts of thawed Probes are added to the TM Lysis Buffer. The Capture Hybridization Buffer is warmed to room temperature. The bDNA strips are set up in the metal strip holders, and 100 μl of Capture Hybridization Buffer is added to each b-DNA well needed, followed by incubation for at least 30 minutes. The test plates with the cells are removed from the incubator, and the media is gently removed using the vacuum manifold. 100 μl of Lysis Hybridization Buffer with Probes are quickly pipetted into each well of the microtiter plates. The plates are then incubated at 55° C. for 15 minutes. Upon removal from the incubator, the plates are placed on the vortex mixer with the microtiter adapter head and vortexed on the #2 setting for one minute. 80 μl of the lysate is removed and added to the bDNA wells containing the Capture Hybridization Buffer, and pipetted up and down to mix. The plates are incubated at 53° C. for at least 16 hours.
  • On the next day, the second part of the bDNA kit protocol is followed. Specifically, the plates are removed from the incubator and placed on the bench to cool for 10 minutes. The volumes of additions needed are calculated based upon information provided by the manufacturer. An Amplifier Working Solution is prepared by making a 1:100 dilution of the Amplifier Concentrate (20 fm/μl) in AL Hybridization Buffer. The hybridization mixture is removed from the plates and washed twice with Wash A. 50 μl of Amplifier Working Solution is added to each well and the wells are incubated at 53° C. for 30 minutes. The plates are then removed from the incubator and allowed to cool for 10 minutes. The Label Probe Working Solution is prepared by making a 1:100 dilution of Label Concentrate (40 pmoles/μl) in AL Hybridization Buffer. After the 10-minute cool-down period, the amplifier hybridization mixture is removed and the plates are washed twice with Wash A. 50 μl of Label Probe Working Solution is added to each well and the wells are incubated at 53° C. for 15 minutes. After cooling for 10 minutes, the Substrate is warmed to room temperature. Upon addition of 3 μl of Substrate Enhancer to each ml of Substrate needed for the assay, the plates are allowed to cool for 10 minutes, the label hybridization mixture is removed, and the plates are washed twice with Wash A and three times with Wash D. 50 μl of the Substrate Solution with Enhancer is added to each well. The plates are incubated for 30 minutes at 37° C. and RLU is read in an appropriate luminometer.
  • The replicates are averaged and the coefficient of variation is determined. The measure of activity of the fold increase over the negative control (Protein 32/HEPES buffer described above) value is indicated by chemiluminescence units (RLU). The results are considered positive if the compound exhibits at least a two-fold value over the negative buffer control. Negative control=1.00 RLU at 1.00% dilution. Positive control=8.39 RLU at 1.00% dilution.
  • Guinea Pig Vascular Leak
  • This assay is designed to determine whether the compounds of the present invention show the ability to induce vascular permeability. Compounds testing positive in this assay are expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of conditions which would benefit from enhanced vascular permeability including, for example, conditions which may benefit from enhanced local immune system cell infiltration.
  • Hairless guinea pigs weighing 350 grams or more are anesthetized with Ketamine (75-80 mg/kg) and 5 mg/kg Xylazine intramuscularly. Test samples containing the tested compound or a physiological buffer without the test compound are injected into skin on the back of the test animals with 100 μl per injection site intradermally. There are approximately 16-24 injection sites per animal. One ml of Evans blue dye (1% in PBS) is then injected intracardially. Skin vascular permeability responses to the compounds (i.e., blemishes at the injection sites of injection) are visually scored by measuring the diameter (in mm) of blue-colored leaks from the site of injection at 1 and 6 hours post administration of the test materials. The mm diameter of blueness at the site of injection is observed and recorded is well is the severity of the vascular leakage. Blemishes of at least 5 mm in diameter are considered positive for the assay when testing purified proteins, being indicative of the ability to induce vascular leakage or permeability. A response greater than 7 mm diameter is considered positive for conditioned media samples. Human VEGF at 0.1 μg/100 μl is used is a positive control, inducing a response of 15-23 mm diameter.
  • Detection of Endothelial Cell Apoptosis (FACS)
  • The ability of the compounds disclosed herein to induce apoptosis in endothelial cells is tested in human venous umbilical vein endothelial cells (HUVEC, Cell Systems) in gelatinized T175 flasks using HUVEC cells below passage 10. Compounds testing positive in this assay are expected to be useful for therapeutically treating conditions where apoptosis of endothelial cells would be beneficial including, for example, the therapeutic treatment of tumors.
  • On day one, the cells are split [420,000 cells per gelatinized 6 cm dishes (11×103 cells/cm2 Falcon, Primaria)] and grown in media containing serum (CS-C, Cell System) overnight or for 16 hours to 24 hours.
  • On day 2, the cells are washed 1× with 5 ml PBS; 3 ml of 0% serum medium is added with VEGF (100 ng/ml); and 30 μl of the PRO test compound (final dilution 1%) or 0% serum medium (negative control) is added. The mixtures are incubated for 48 hours before harvesting.
  • The cells are then harvested for FACS analysis. The medium is aspirated and the cells washed once with PBS. 5 ml of 1× trypsin is added to the cells in a T-175 flask, and the cells are allowed to stand until they are released from the plate (about 5-10 minutes). Trypsinization is stopped by adding 5 ml of growth media. The cells are spun at 1000 rpm for 5 minutes at 4° C. The media is aspirated and the cells are resuspended in 10 ml of 10% serum complemented medium (Cell Systems), 5 μl of Annexin-FITC (BioVison) added and chilled tubes are submitted for FACS. A positive result is determined to be enhanced apoptosis in the compound treated samples is compared to the negative control.
  • Induction of c-Fos in Cortical Neurons
  • This assay is designed to determine whether the compounds tested show the ability to induce c-fos in cortical neurons. Compounds testing positive in this assay would be expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of nervous system disorders and injuries where neuronal proliferation would be beneficial.
  • Cortical neurons are dissociated and plated in growth medium at 10,000 cells per well in 96 well plates. After approximately 2 cellular divisions, the cells are treated for 30 minutes with the compound or nothing (negative control). The cells are then fixed for 5 minutes with cold methanol and stained with an antibody directed against phosphorylated CREB. mRNA levels are then calculated using chemiluminescence. A positive in the assay is any factor that results in at least a 2-fold increase in c-fos message is compared to the negative controls.
  • Stimulation of Endothelial Tube Formation
  • This assay is designed to determine whether the compounds of the invention show the ability to promote endothelial vacuole and lumen formation in the absence of exogenous growth factors. Compounds testing positive in this assay would be expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of disorders where endothelial vacuole and/or lumen formation would be beneficial including, for example, where the stimulation of pinocytosis, ion pumping, vascular permeability and/or junctional formation would be beneficial.
  • HUVEC cells (passage <8 from primary) are mixed with type I rat tail collagen (final concentration 2.6 mg/ml) at a density of 6×105 cells per ml and plated at 50 μl per well of M199 culture media supplement with 1% FBS and 1 μM 6-FAM-FITC dye to stain the vacuoles while they are forming and in the presence of the test compound. The cells are then incubated at 37° C./5% CO2 for 48 hours, fixed with 3.7% formalin room temperature for 10 minutes, washed 5 times with M199 medium and then stained with Rh-Phalloidin at 4° C. overnight followed by nuclear staining with 4 μM DAPI. A positive result in the assay is when vacuoles are present in greater than 50% of the cells.
  • Detection of Compounds of the Invention that Affect Glucose and/or FFA Uptake in Skeletal Muscle
  • This assay is designed to determine whether compounds of the invention show the ability to affect glucose or FFA uptake by skeletal muscle cells. Compounds testing positive in this assay would be expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of disorders where either the stimulation or inhibition of glucose uptake by skeletal muscle would be beneficial including, for example, diabetes or hyper- or hypo-insulinemia.
  • In a 96 well format, a compound to be assayed is added to primary rat differentiated skeletal muscle, and allowed to incubate overnight. Then fresh media with the compound and +/− insulin are added to the wells. The sample media is then monitored to determine glucose and FFA uptake by the skeletal muscle cells. The insulin will stimulate glucose and FFA uptake by the skeletal muscle, and insulin in media without the compound is used is a positive control, and a limit for scoring. As the compound being tested may either stimulate or inhibit glucose and FFA uptake, results are scored is positive in the assay if greater than 1.5 times or less than 0.5 times the insulin control.
  • Rod Photoreceptor Cell Survival Assay
  • This assay tests the ability of the compounds of this invention act to enhance the survival/proliferation of rod photoreceptor cells and, therefore, are useful for the therapeutic treatment of retinal disorders or injuries including, for example, treating sight loss in mammals due to retinitis pigmentosum, AMD, etc.
  • Sprague Dawley rat pups (postnatal day 7, mixed population: glia and netinal neural cell types) are killed by decapitation following CO2 anesthesia and the eyes removed under sterile conditions. The neural retina is dissected away from the pigment epithelium and other ocular tissue and then dissociated into a single cell suspension using 0.25% trypsin in Ca2+, Mg2+-free PBS. The retinas are incubated at 37° C. in this solution for 7-10 minutes after which the trypsin is inactivated by adding 1 ml soybean trypsin inhibitor. The cells are plated at a density of approximately 10,000 cells/ml into 96 well plates in DMEM/F12 supplemented with N2. Cells for all experiments are grown at 37° C. in a water saturated atmosphere of 5% CO2. After 7-10 days in culture, the cells are stained using calcein AM or CellTracker Green CMFDA and then fixed using 4% paraformaldehyde. Rho 4D2 (ascities or IgG 1:100) monoclonal antibody directed towards the visual pigment rhodopsin is used to detect rod photoreceptor cells by indirect immunofluorescence. The results are calculated is % survival: total number of calcein—rhodopsin positive cells at 7-10 days in culture, divided by the total number of rhodopsin positive cells at time 7-10 days in culture. The total cells (fluorescent) are quantified at 20× objective magnification using a CCD camera and NIH image software for MacIntosh. Fields in the well are chosen at random.
  • In Vitro Antitumor Assay
  • The antiproliferative activity of the compounds disclosed herein can be determined in the investigational, disease-oriented in vitro anti-cancer drug discovery assay of the National Cancer Institute (NCl), using a sulforhodamine B (SRB) dye binding assay essentially is described by Skehan et al., J. Natl. Cancer Inst. 82:1107-1112 (1990). The 60 tumor cell lines employed in this study (“the NCl panel”), as well as conditions for their maintenance and culture in vitro, have been described by Monks et al., J. Natl. Cancer Inst. 83:757-766 (1991). The purpose of this screen is to initially evaluate the cytotoxic and/or cytostatic activity of the test compounds against different types of tumors (Monks et al., supra; Boyd, Cancer: Princ. Pract. Oncol. Update 3(10):1-12 [1989]).
  • Cells from approximately 60 human tumor cell lines are harvested with trypsin/EDTA (Gibco), washed once, resuspended in IMEM and their viability is determined. The cell suspensions are added by pipet (100 μL volume) into separate 96-well microtiter plates. The cell density for the 6-day incubation is less than for the 2-day incubation to prevent overgrowth. Inoculates are allowed a preincubation period of 24 hours at 37° C. for stabilization. Dilutions at twice the intended test concentration are added at time zero in 100 μL aliquots to the microtiter plate wells (1:2 dilution). Test compounds are evaluated at five half-log dilutions (1000 to 100.000-fold). Incubations took place for two days and six days in a 5% CO2 atmosphere and 100% humidity.
  • After incubation, the medium is removed and the cells are fixed in 0.1 ml of 10% trichloroacetic acid at 40° C. The plates are rinsed five times with deionized water, dried, stained for 30 minutes with 0.1 ml of 0.4% sulforhodamine B dye (Sigma) dissolved in 1% acetic acid, rinsed four times with 1% acetic acid to remove unbound dye, dried, and the stain is extracted for five minutes with 0.1 ml of 10 mM Tris base [tris(hydroxymethyl)aminomethane], pH 10.5. The absorbance (OD) of sulforhodamine B at 492 nm is measured using a computer-interfaced, 96-well microtiter plate reader.
  • A test sample is considered positive if it shows at least 50% growth inhibitory effect at one or more concentrations.
  • Determination of Compounds of this Invention that Affect Glucose or FFA Uptake by Primary Rat Adipocytes
  • This assay is designed to determine whether the compounds of this invention show the ability to affect glucose or FFA uptake by adipocyte cells. Compounds testing positive in this assay would be expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of disorders where either the stimulation or inhibition of glucose uptake by adipocytes would be beneficial including, for example, obesity, diabetes or hyper- or hypo-insulinemia.
  • In a 96 well format, compounds to be assayed are added to primary rat adipocytes, and allowed to incubate overnight. Samples are taken at 4 and 16 hours and assayed for glycerol, glucose and FFA uptake. After the 16 hour incubation, insulin is added to the media and allowed to incubate for 4 hours. At this time, a sample is taken and glycerol, glucose and FFA uptake is measured. Media containing insulin without the compound is used as a positive reference control. As the compound being tested may either stimulate or inhibit glucose and FFA uptake, results are scored as positive in the assay if greater than 1.5 times or less than 0.5 times the insulin control.
  • Chondrocyte Re-Differentiation Assay
  • This assay shows whether the compounds of the invention act to induce redifferentiation of chondrocytes, and therefore are expected to be useful for the treatment of various bone and/or cartilage disorders such as, for example, sports injuries and arthritis. The assay is performed as follows. Porcine chondrocytes are isolated by overnight collagenase digestion of articulary cartilage of metacarpophalangeal joints of 4-6 month old female pigs. The isolated cells are then seeded at 25,000 cells/cm2 in Ham F-12 containing 10% FBS and 4 μg/ml gentamycin. The culture media is changed every third day and the cells are then seeded in 96 well plates at 5,000 cells/well in 100 μl of the same media without serum and 100 μl of the test compound, 5 nM staurosporin (positive control) or medium alone (negative control) is added to give a final volume of 200 μl/well. After 5 days of incubation at 37° C., a picture of each well is taken and the differentiation state of the chondrocytes is determined. A positive result in the assay occurs when the redifferentiation of the chondrocytes is determined to be more similar to the positive control than the negative control.
  • Fetal Hemoglobin Induction in an Erythroblastic Cell Line
  • This assay is useful for screening compounds for the ability to induce the switch from adult hemoglobin to fetal hemoglobin in an erythroblastic cell line. Compounds testing positive in this assay are expected to be useful for therapeutically treating various mammalian hemoglobin-associated disorders such as the various thalassemias. The assay is performed as follows. Erythroblastic cells are plated in standard growth medium at 1000 cells/well in a 96 well format. The tested compound is added to the growth medium at a concentration of 0.2% or 2% and the cells are incubated for 5 days at 37° C. As a positive control, cells are treated with 100 μM hemin and as a negative control, the cells are untreated. After 5 days, cell lysates are prepared and analyzed for the expression of gamma globin (a fetal marker). A positive in the assay is a gamma globin level at least 2-fold above the negative control.
  • Mouse Kidney Mesangial Cell Proliferation Assay
  • This assay shows whether compounds of the invention act to induce proliferation of mammalian kidney mesangial cells and therefore are useful for treating kidney disorders associated with decreased mesangial cell function such as Berger disease or other nephropathies associated with Schonlein-Henoch purpura, celiac disease, dermatitis herpetiformis or Crohn disease. The assay is performed as follows. On day one, mouse kidney mesangial cells are plated on a 96 well plate in growth media (3:1 mixture of Dulbecco's modified Eagle's medium and Ham's F12 medium, 95% fetal bovine serum, 5% supplemented with 14 mM HEPES) and grown overnight. On day 2, the test compound is diluted at 2 concentrations (1% and 0.1%) in serum-free medium and added to the cells. Control samples are serum-free medium alone. On day 4, 20 μl of the Cell Titer 96 Aqueous one solution reagent (Progema) was added to each well and the colormetric reaction was allowed to proceed for 2 hours. The absorbance (OD) is then measured at 490 nm. A positive in the assay is an absorbance reading which is at least 15% above the control reading.
  • Proliferation of Rat Utricular Supporting Cells
  • This assay is used to determine of compounds of the invention act as potent mitogens for inner ear supporting cells which are auditory hair cell progenitors and, therefore, are useful for inducing the regeneration of auditory hair cells and treating hearing loss in mammals. The assay is performed as follows. Rat UEC-4 utricular epithelial cells are aliquoted into 96 well plates with a density of 3000 cells/well in 200 μl of serum-containing medium at 33° C. The cells are cultured overnight and are then switched to serum-free medium at 37° C. Various dilutions of the compounds (or nothing for a control) are then added to the cultures and the cells are incubated for 24 hours. After the 24 hour incubation, 3H-thymidine (1 μCi/well) is added and the cells are then cultured for an additional 24 hours. The cultures are then washed to remove unincorporated radiolabel, the cells harvested and Cpm per well determined. Cpm of at least 30% or greater in the test compound treated cultures as compared to the control cultures is considered a positive in the assay.
  • Chondrocyte Proliferation Assay
  • This assay is designed to determine whether compounds of the present invention show the ability to induce the proliferation and/or redifferentiation of chondrocytes in culture. Compounds testing positive in this assay would be expected to be useful for the therapeutic treatment of various bone and/or cartilage disorders such as, for example, sports injuries and arthritis.
  • Porcine chondrocytes are isolated by overnight collagenase digestion of articular cartilage of the metacarpophalangeal joint of 4-6 month old female pigs. The isolated cells are then seeded at 25,000 cells/cm2 in Ham F-12 containing 10% FBS and 4 μg/ml gentamycin. The culture media is changed every third day and the cells are reseeded to 25,000 cells/cm2 every five days. On day 12, the cells are seeded in 96 well plates at 5,000 cells/well in 100 μl of the same media without serum and 100 μl of either serum-free medium (negative control), staurosporin (final concentration of 5 nM; positive control) or the test compound are added to give a final volume of 200 μl/well. After 5 days at 37° C., 20 μl of Alamar blue is added to each well and the plates are incubated for an additional 3 hours at 37° C. The fluorescence is then measured in each well (Ex: 530 nm; Em: 590 nm). The fluorescence of a plate containing 200 μl of the serum-free medium is measured to obtain the background. A positive result in the assay is obtained when the fluorescence of the compound treated sample is more like that of the positive control than the negative control.
  • Inhibition of Heart Neonatal Hypertrophy Induced by LIF+ET-1
  • This assay is designed to determine whether the compounds of the present invention show the ability to inhibit neonatal heart hypertrophy induced by LIF and endothelin-1 (ET-1). A test compound that provides a positive response in the present assay would be useful for the therapeutic treatment of cardiac insufficiency diseases or disorders characterized or associated with an undesired hypertrophy of the cardiac muscle.
  • Cardiac myocytes from 1-day old Harlan Sprague Dawley rats (180 μl at 7.5×104/ml, serum <0.1, freshly isolated) are introduced on day 1 to 96-well plates previously coated with DMEM/F12+4% FCS. Test compound samples or growth medium alone (negative control) are then added directly to the wells on day 2 in 20 μl volume. LIF+ET-1 are then added to the wells on day 3. The cells are stained after an additional 2 days in culture and are then scored visually the next day. A positive in the assay occurs when the compound treated myocytes are visually smaller on the average or less numerous than the untreated myocytes.

Claims (32)

1. A compound comprising a first stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which comprises a binding site for a target; and
a second stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which is identical to the sequence of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and which comprises an identical binding site for the target;
wherein each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids has at a predefined end thereof a cysteine residue or a selenocysteine residue and such cysteine residues or such selenocysteine residues are joined by a bond having the structure:
Figure US20080254512A1-20081016-C00012
wherein each X is the same and represents a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and each C represents a beta-carbon of one of such cysteine or selenocysteine residues.
2-7. (canceled)
8. A compound comprising a first stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which comprises a binding site for a target; and
a second stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which is different from the sequence of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and which comprises a binding site for a different moiety;
wherein each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids has at a predefined end thereof a cysteine residue or a selenocysteine residue and such residues are joined by a bond having the structure:
Figure US20080254512A1-20081016-C00013
wherein each X may be the same or different and represents a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and each C represents a beta-carbon of one of such cysteine or selenocysteine residues.
9-17. (canceled)
18. A multimer comprising two or more identical compounds according to any one of claims 1 or 8 joined together by at least one bond.
19-50. (canceled)
51. A method of affecting the activity of a target comprising contacting the target with a composition comprising the compound of claim 1 under conditions such that the compound binds to and affects the activity of the target.
52-62. (canceled)
63. A process of making the compound of claim 1, comprising:
(a) transfecting a cell with a recombinant nucleic acid which comprises (i) a first portion, the sequence of which is a N-terminal signal sequence, contiguous with (ii) a second portion, the sequence of which encodes a stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous with (iii) a third portion, the sequence of which encodes a C-terminal intein-containing binding domain, under conditions permitting synthesis of a chimeric polypeptide comprising the stretch of consecutive amino acids contiguous with the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain;
(b) isolating the chimeric polypeptide produced in step (a);
(c) treating the chimeric polypeptide so as to cause thio-mediated cleavage of the C-terminal intein-containing binding domain from the stretch of consecutive amino acids and its replacement with a C-terminal thioester;
(d) treating the product of step (c) to permit the attachment of a cysteine residue to the product so as to form product with a C-terminal cysteine; and
(e) oxidizing the product of step (e) in the presence of another product of step (e) under conditions permitting formation of the compound.
64-69. (canceled)
70. A compound comprising an independently folding protein domain fused to a second independently folding protein domain by non-peptide bond.
71-74. (canceled)
75. A method of making a stretch of consecutive amino acids comprising an N-terminal cysteine comprising:
(a) transfecting a cell with a recombinant nucleic acid which comprises (i) a first portion, the sequence of which encodes a N-terminal signal sequence contiguous with (ii) a second portion, the sequence of which encodes a stretch of consecutive amino acids comprising a N-terminal cysteine residue, under conditions permitting (i) synthesis of a chimeric polypeptide which comprises the N-terminal signal sequence joined by a peptide bond at its C-terminus to the N-terminal cysteine of the stretch of consecutive amino acids and (ii) cleavage of the N-terminal signal sequence from the chimeric polypeptide within the cell so as to produce a stretch of consecutive amino acids comprising an N-terminal cysteine;
(b) recovering the stretch of consecutive amino acids produced in step (a).
76-154. (canceled)
155. A process for making a compound comprising contacting a stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which comprises a binding site for a target with a second stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which is identical to the sequence of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and which comprises an identical binding site for the target, wherein each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids has at a predefined end thereof a cysteine residue or a selenocysteine residue, under reducing conditions so as to make the compound.
156. A process for making a compound comprising contacting a stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which comprises a binding site for a target with a second stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which is different to the sequence of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and which comprises an identical binding site for the target, wherein each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids has at a predefined end thereof a cysteine residue or a selenocysteine residue, under reducing conditions so as to make the compound.
157-164. (canceled)
165. A compound comprising a first stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which comprises a binding site for a target; and
a second stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which is identical to the sequence of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and which comprises an identical binding site for the target;
wherein each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids has at a predefined end thereof, independently, a natural amino acid or non-natural amino having a linear aliphatic side-chain acid comprising a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and wherein such sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) are joined by a bond having the structure:
Figure US20080254512A1-20081016-C00014
wherein each X is a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and each (C) represents a carbon of the linear aliphatic side-chain of one of such natural or non-natural amino acid and wherein n and m are, independently, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10.
166-170. (canceled)
171. A compound comprising a first stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which comprises a binding site for a target; and
a second stretch of consecutive amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and the sequence of which is different from the sequence of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and which comprises a binding site for a different moiety;
wherein each of the first stretch of amino acids and the second stretch of amino acids has at a predefined end thereof, independently, a natural amino acid or non-natural amino having a linear aliphatic side-chain acid comprising a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and wherein such sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) are joined by a bond having the structure:
Figure US20080254512A1-20081016-C00015
wherein each X may be the same or different and represents a sulfur (S) or a selenium (Se) and each (C) represents a carbon of the linear aliphatic side-chain of one of such natural or non-natural amino acid and wherein n and m are, independently, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10.
172-176. (canceled)
177. A method of producing a protein which comprises a first polypeptide contiguous with an intein, which intein is contiguous with a second polypeptide comprising a binding domain, the method comprising transfecting an animal cell with a nucleic acid, which nucleic acid comprises (i) a first portion which encodes the polypeptide contiguous with (ii) a second portion which encodes the intein, contiguous with a and the third portion of which encodes the binding domain, under conditions such that the animal cell expresses and secretes the protein.
178-181. (canceled)
182. A compound comprising:
a first stretch of consecutive amino acids each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond and which first stretch of consecutive amino acids comprises an amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain; and
a second stretch of consecutive amino acids, comprising at least 100 amino acids, each of which is joined to the preceding amino acid by a peptide bond, wherein at least 90 consecutive amino acids thereof of the second stretch of consecutive amino acids have a sequence identical to portion of a human immunoglobulin constant region polypeptide, and wherein the second stretch of consecutive amino acids comprises an amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain at a predefined terminus thereof,
wherein said amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and said amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain of the second stretch of consecutive amino acids are joined by a bond having the structure:
Figure US20080254512A1-20081016-C00016
wherein each X represents, independently, a chalcogen, and wherein C1 represents a side chain carbon of the amino acid residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain of the first stretch of consecutive amino acids and C2 represents a side chain carbon of the second stretch of consecutive amino acids.
183-194. (canceled)
195. The compound of claim 182, wherein the human immunoglobulin constant region polypeptide is a human IgG1, human IgG2, human IgG3, or human IgG4.
196. The compound of claim 195, wherein the side chain of at least one of amino acid residues having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain comprises a C1-C10 alkylene.
197. A composition comprising two of the compounds of claim 182 bonded together via at least one disulfide bond between the second stretch of consecutive amino acids of each of the compounds.
198. A polypeptide consisting of consecutive amino acids having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:35 through 46, or having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:53 through 67, or having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:74 through 82, or having the sequence set forth in one of SEQ ID NOS:89 through 97.
199-201. (canceled)
202. A polypeptide consisting of consecutive amino acids having a sequence identical to a portion of the sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO:44, SEQ ID NO:64, SEQ ID NO:81 or SEQ ID NO:96, wherein at least one of the terminal residues of the polypeptide has a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain.
203. The polypeptide of claim 202, wherein the terminal residue having a chalcogen functional group-containing side chain is a cysteine or analog thereof
US11/982,085 2006-11-02 2007-10-31 Hybrid immunoglobulins with moving parts Abandoned US20080254512A1 (en)

Priority Applications (3)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US11/982,085 US20080254512A1 (en) 2006-11-02 2007-10-31 Hybrid immunoglobulins with moving parts
US15/198,475 US10428332B2 (en) 2006-11-02 2016-06-30 Hybrid immunoglobulins with moving parts
US16/590,143 US20200032272A1 (en) 2006-11-02 2019-10-01 Hybrid immunoglobulins with moving parts

Applications Claiming Priority (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US85686406P 2006-11-02 2006-11-02
US11/982,085 US20080254512A1 (en) 2006-11-02 2007-10-31 Hybrid immunoglobulins with moving parts

Related Child Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US15/198,475 Continuation US10428332B2 (en) 2006-11-02 2016-06-30 Hybrid immunoglobulins with moving parts

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20080254512A1 true US20080254512A1 (en) 2008-10-16

Family

ID=39854063

Family Applications (3)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US11/982,085 Abandoned US20080254512A1 (en) 2006-11-02 2007-10-31 Hybrid immunoglobulins with moving parts
US15/198,475 Active US10428332B2 (en) 2006-11-02 2016-06-30 Hybrid immunoglobulins with moving parts
US16/590,143 Pending US20200032272A1 (en) 2006-11-02 2019-10-01 Hybrid immunoglobulins with moving parts

Family Applications After (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US15/198,475 Active US10428332B2 (en) 2006-11-02 2016-06-30 Hybrid immunoglobulins with moving parts
US16/590,143 Pending US20200032272A1 (en) 2006-11-02 2019-10-01 Hybrid immunoglobulins with moving parts

Country Status (16)

Country Link
US (3) US20080254512A1 (en)
EP (2) EP2078040B1 (en)
JP (3) JP5519287B2 (en)
KR (1) KR20090105913A (en)
CN (1) CN101965363A (en)
AU (1) AU2007353396C1 (en)
BR (1) BRPI0716680A2 (en)
CA (1) CA2668208C (en)
DK (1) DK3284825T3 (en)
ES (1) ES2870017T3 (en)
HK (1) HK1251609A1 (en)
IL (1) IL198424A (en)
MX (1) MX2009004664A (en)
NZ (1) NZ576445A (en)
SG (1) SG176476A1 (en)
WO (1) WO2008140477A2 (en)

Cited By (102)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20100104510A1 (en) * 2007-04-02 2010-04-29 The United States Of America, As Represented By The Secretary, Department Of Health And Human Selenocysteine mediated hybrid antibody molecules
WO2011094617A3 (en) * 2010-01-29 2011-09-22 Archer-Daniels-Midland Company Peptide domains that bind small molecules of industrial significance
EP2784080A4 (en) * 2011-10-31 2015-07-01 Shimadzu Corp Peptide-hinge-free flexible antibody-like molecule
WO2015138920A1 (en) 2014-03-14 2015-09-17 Novartis Ag Antibody molecules to lag-3 and uses thereof
WO2015142675A2 (en) 2014-03-15 2015-09-24 Novartis Ag Treatment of cancer using chimeric antigen receptor
WO2016014530A1 (en) 2014-07-21 2016-01-28 Novartis Ag Combinations of low, immune enhancing. doses of mtor inhibitors and cars
WO2016014565A2 (en) 2014-07-21 2016-01-28 Novartis Ag Treatment of cancer using humanized anti-bcma chimeric antigen receptor
WO2016014553A1 (en) 2014-07-21 2016-01-28 Novartis Ag Sortase synthesized chimeric antigen receptors
WO2016025880A1 (en) 2014-08-14 2016-02-18 Novartis Ag Treatment of cancer using gfr alpha-4 chimeric antigen receptor
US20160060318A1 (en) * 2013-04-03 2016-03-03 Wan Keung Raymond Wong Means and method for expression of authentic human epidermal growth factor and/or basic fibrolast growth factor in cytoplasm and/or culture medium of escherichia coli
WO2016044605A1 (en) 2014-09-17 2016-03-24 Beatty, Gregory Targeting cytotoxic cells with chimeric receptors for adoptive immunotherapy
WO2016061142A1 (en) 2014-10-14 2016-04-21 Novartis Ag Antibody molecules to pd-l1 and uses thereof
WO2016090034A2 (en) 2014-12-03 2016-06-09 Novartis Ag Methods for b cell preconditioning in car therapy
WO2016164731A2 (en) 2015-04-08 2016-10-13 Novartis Ag Cd20 therapies, cd22 therapies, and combination therapies with a cd19 chimeric antigen receptor (car) - expressing cell
WO2016172583A1 (en) 2015-04-23 2016-10-27 Novartis Ag Treatment of cancer using chimeric antigen receptor and protein kinase a blocker
WO2017019894A1 (en) 2015-07-29 2017-02-02 Novartis Ag Combination therapies comprising antibody molecules to lag-3
WO2017019897A1 (en) 2015-07-29 2017-02-02 Novartis Ag Combination therapies comprising antibody molecules to tim-3
CN106456809A (en) * 2013-12-03 2017-02-22 韦尔特生物分子医药有限责任公司 Antibodies targeting b-cell receptor complex membrane bound igm and uses thereof
WO2017106810A2 (en) 2015-12-17 2017-06-22 Novartis Ag Combination of c-met inhibitor with antibody molecule to pd-1 and uses thereof
WO2017106656A1 (en) 2015-12-17 2017-06-22 Novartis Ag Antibody molecules to pd-1 and uses thereof
WO2017125897A1 (en) 2016-01-21 2017-07-27 Novartis Ag Multispecific molecules targeting cll-1
WO2017146767A1 (en) * 2015-02-27 2017-08-31 Icell Gene Therapeutics, Llc Chimeric antigen receptors (cars) targeting hematologic malignancies, compositions and methods of use thereof
WO2017143840A1 (en) * 2016-02-23 2017-08-31 上海交通大学 Method for expressing and preparing polyvalent multi-specific antibody and immune hybrid protein
WO2017149515A1 (en) 2016-03-04 2017-09-08 Novartis Ag Cells expressing multiple chimeric antigen receptor (car) molecules and uses therefore
WO2017165683A1 (en) 2016-03-23 2017-09-28 Novartis Ag Cell secreted minibodies and uses thereof
WO2017181119A2 (en) 2016-04-15 2017-10-19 Novartis Ag Compositions and methods for selective protein expression
WO2017210617A2 (en) 2016-06-02 2017-12-07 Porter, David, L. Therapeutic regimens for chimeric antigen receptor (car)- expressing cells
WO2018013918A2 (en) 2016-07-15 2018-01-18 Novartis Ag Treatment and prevention of cytokine release syndrome using a chimeric antigen receptor in combination with a kinase inhibitor
WO2018023025A1 (en) 2016-07-28 2018-02-01 Novartis Ag Combination therapies of chimeric antigen receptors adn pd-1 inhibitors
WO2018026819A2 (en) 2016-08-01 2018-02-08 Novartis Ag Treatment of cancer using a chimeric antigen receptor in combination with an inhibitor of a pro-m2 macrophage molecule
WO2018067992A1 (en) 2016-10-07 2018-04-12 Novartis Ag Chimeric antigen receptors for the treatment of cancer
WO2018140725A1 (en) 2017-01-26 2018-08-02 Novartis Ag Cd28 compositions and methods for chimeric antigen receptor therapy
WO2018160731A1 (en) 2017-02-28 2018-09-07 Novartis Ag Shp inhibitor compositions and uses for chimeric antigen receptor therapy
WO2018201051A1 (en) 2017-04-28 2018-11-01 Novartis Ag Bcma-targeting agent, and combination therapy with a gamma secretase inhibitor
WO2018201056A1 (en) 2017-04-28 2018-11-01 Novartis Ag Cells expressing a bcma-targeting chimeric antigen receptor, and combination therapy with a gamma secretase inhibitor
WO2018237157A1 (en) 2017-06-22 2018-12-27 Novartis Ag Antibody molecules to cd73 and uses thereof
WO2019006007A1 (en) 2017-06-27 2019-01-03 Novartis Ag Dosage regimens for anti-tim-3 antibodies and uses thereof
WO2019018730A1 (en) 2017-07-20 2019-01-24 Novartis Ag Dosage regimens of anti-lag-3 antibodies and uses thereof
US10273520B2 (en) 2013-04-03 2019-04-30 Wan Keung Raymond Wong Means and methods for hyper-production of authentic human basic fibroblast growth factor in Escherichia coli
WO2019089798A1 (en) 2017-10-31 2019-05-09 Novartis Ag Anti-car compositions and methods
WO2019099838A1 (en) 2017-11-16 2019-05-23 Novartis Ag Combination therapies
EP3514179A1 (en) 2014-01-24 2019-07-24 Dana-Farber Cancer Institute, Inc. Antibody molecules to pd-1 and uses thereof
WO2019152660A1 (en) 2018-01-31 2019-08-08 Novartis Ag Combination therapy using a chimeric antigen receptor
WO2019168947A1 (en) * 2018-02-28 2019-09-06 Ap Biosciences, Inc. Bifunctional proteins combining checkpoint blockade for targeted therapy
US10428332B2 (en) 2006-11-02 2019-10-01 Daniel Capon Hybrid immunoglobulins with moving parts
WO2019200229A1 (en) 2018-04-13 2019-10-17 Novartis Ag Dosage regimens for anti-pd-l1 antibodies and uses thereof
WO2019210153A1 (en) 2018-04-27 2019-10-31 Novartis Ag Car t cell therapies with enhanced efficacy
WO2019226617A1 (en) 2018-05-21 2019-11-28 Compass Therapeutics Llc Compositions and methods for enhancing the killing of target cells by nk cells
WO2019226658A1 (en) 2018-05-21 2019-11-28 Compass Therapeutics Llc Multispecific antigen-binding compositions and methods of use
WO2019227003A1 (en) 2018-05-25 2019-11-28 Novartis Ag Combination therapy with chimeric antigen receptor (car) therapies
WO2019232244A2 (en) 2018-05-31 2019-12-05 Novartis Ag Antibody molecules to cd73 and uses thereof
WO2019241426A1 (en) 2018-06-13 2019-12-19 Novartis Ag Bcma chimeric antigen receptors and uses thereof
WO2019246293A2 (en) 2018-06-19 2019-12-26 Atarga, Llc Antibody molecules to complement component 5 and uses thereof
WO2020012337A1 (en) 2018-07-10 2020-01-16 Novartis Ag 3-(5-amino-1-oxoisoindolin-2-yl)piperidine-2,6-dione derivatives and their use in the treatment of i karos family zinc finger 2 (ikzf2)-dependent diseases
WO2020021465A1 (en) 2018-07-25 2020-01-30 Advanced Accelerator Applications (Italy) S.R.L. Method of treatment of neuroendocrine tumors
EP3611180A1 (en) 2013-03-15 2020-02-19 Daniel J. Capon Hybrid immunoglobulin containing non-peptidyl linkage
EP3660042A1 (en) 2014-07-31 2020-06-03 Novartis AG Subset-optimized chimeric antigen receptor-containing t-cells
WO2020128972A1 (en) 2018-12-20 2020-06-25 Novartis Ag Dosing regimen and pharmaceutical combination comprising 3-(1-oxoisoindolin-2-yl)piperidine-2,6-dione derivatives
WO2020128898A1 (en) 2018-12-20 2020-06-25 Novartis Ag Pharmaceutical combinations
WO2020165833A1 (en) 2019-02-15 2020-08-20 Novartis Ag 3-(1-oxo-5-(piperidin-4-yl)isoindolin-2-yl)piperidine-2,6-dione derivatives and uses thereof
WO2020165868A1 (en) 2019-02-15 2020-08-20 Perkinelmer Cellular Technologies Germany Gmbh Low-power microscope-objective pre-scan and high-power microscope-objective scan in x,y and z-direction for imaging objects such as cells using a microscope
WO2020165834A1 (en) 2019-02-15 2020-08-20 Novartis Ag Substituted 3-(1-oxoisoindolin-2-yl)piperidine-2,6-dione derivatives and uses thereof
WO2020172553A1 (en) 2019-02-22 2020-08-27 Novartis Ag Combination therapies of egfrviii chimeric antigen receptors and pd-1 inhibitors
EP3701971A1 (en) 2014-03-14 2020-09-02 Daniel J. Capon Compounds useful in preparing hybrid immunoglobulin containing non-peptidyl linkage
EP3712171A1 (en) 2014-08-19 2020-09-23 Novartis AG Treatment of cancer using a cd123 chimeric antigen receptor
WO2020205523A1 (en) 2019-03-29 2020-10-08 Atarga, Llc Anti fgf23 antibody
EP3722316A1 (en) 2014-07-21 2020-10-14 Novartis AG Treatment of cancer using a cd33 chimeric antigen receptor
WO2020243755A1 (en) * 2019-05-31 2020-12-03 Spectrum Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Methods of treatment using g-csf protein complex
US10968263B2 (en) 2012-07-17 2021-04-06 Biomolecular Holdings Llc Affinity support and method for trapping substance using the same
WO2021079188A1 (en) 2019-10-21 2021-04-29 Novartis Ag Combination therapies with venetoclax and tim-3 inhibitors
WO2021079195A1 (en) 2019-10-21 2021-04-29 Novartis Ag Tim-3 inhibitors and uses thereof
WO2021108661A2 (en) 2019-11-26 2021-06-03 Novartis Ag Chimeric antigen receptors and uses thereof
WO2021123902A1 (en) 2019-12-20 2021-06-24 Novartis Ag Combination of anti tim-3 antibody mbg453 and anti tgf-beta antibody nis793, with or without decitabine or the anti pd-1 antibody spartalizumab, for treating myelofibrosis and myelodysplastic syndrome
US11046769B2 (en) 2018-11-13 2021-06-29 Compass Therapeutics Llc Multispecific binding constructs against checkpoint molecules and uses thereof
WO2021146636A1 (en) 2020-01-17 2021-07-22 Becton, Dickinson And Company Methods and compositions for single cell secretomics
WO2021144657A1 (en) 2020-01-17 2021-07-22 Novartis Ag Combination comprising a tim-3 inhibitor and a hypomethylating agent for use in treating myelodysplastic syndrome or chronic myelomonocytic leukemia
WO2021173995A2 (en) 2020-02-27 2021-09-02 Novartis Ag Methods of making chimeric antigen receptor-expressing cells
US11155804B2 (en) 2016-07-11 2021-10-26 Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Recombinant polypeptides comprising selenocysteine and method for producing the same
US11173179B2 (en) 2015-06-25 2021-11-16 Icell Gene Therapeutics Llc Chimeric antigen receptor (CAR) targeting multiple antigens, compositions and methods of use thereof
WO2021260528A1 (en) 2020-06-23 2021-12-30 Novartis Ag Dosing regimen comprising 3-(1-oxoisoindolin-2-yl)piperidine-2,6-dione derivatives
WO2022013787A1 (en) 2020-07-16 2022-01-20 Novartis Ag Anti-betacellulin antibodies, fragments thereof, and multi-specific binding molecules
WO2022026592A2 (en) 2020-07-28 2022-02-03 Celltas Bio, Inc. Antibody molecules to coronavirus and uses thereof
WO2022029573A1 (en) 2020-08-03 2022-02-10 Novartis Ag Heteroaryl substituted 3-(1-oxoisoindolin-2-yl)piperidine-2,6-dione derivatives and uses thereof
WO2022043557A1 (en) 2020-08-31 2022-03-03 Advanced Accelerator Applications International Sa Method of treating psma-expressing cancers
WO2022043558A1 (en) 2020-08-31 2022-03-03 Advanced Accelerator Applications International Sa Method of treating psma-expressing cancers
WO2022097065A2 (en) 2020-11-06 2022-05-12 Novartis Ag ANTIBODY Fc VARIANTS
WO2022104061A1 (en) 2020-11-13 2022-05-19 Novartis Ag Combination therapies with chimeric antigen receptor (car)-expressing cells
WO2022162569A1 (en) 2021-01-29 2022-08-04 Novartis Ag Dosage regimes for anti-cd73 and anti-entpd2 antibodies and uses thereof
WO2022215011A1 (en) 2021-04-07 2022-10-13 Novartis Ag USES OF ANTI-TGFβ ANTIBODIES AND OTHER THERAPEUTIC AGENTS FOR THE TREATMENT OF PROLIFERATIVE DISEASES
WO2022243846A1 (en) 2021-05-18 2022-11-24 Novartis Ag Combination therapies
WO2023044483A2 (en) 2021-09-20 2023-03-23 Voyager Therapeutics, Inc. Compositions and methods for the treatment of her2 positive cancer
US11655452B2 (en) 2015-06-25 2023-05-23 Icell Gene Therapeutics Inc. Chimeric antigen receptors (CARs), compositions and methods of use thereof
WO2023092004A1 (en) 2021-11-17 2023-05-25 Voyager Therapeutics, Inc. Compositions and methods for the treatment of tau-related disorders
US11684655B2 (en) 2019-05-31 2023-06-27 Spectrum Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Methods of treating neutorpenia using G-CSF protein complex
US11718679B2 (en) 2017-10-31 2023-08-08 Compass Therapeutics Llc CD137 antibodies and PD-1 antagonists and uses thereof
WO2023150778A1 (en) 2022-02-07 2023-08-10 Visterra, Inc. Anti-idiotype antibody molecules and uses thereof
US11752207B2 (en) 2017-07-11 2023-09-12 Compass Therapeutics Llc Agonist antibodies that bind human CD137 and uses thereof
WO2023220695A2 (en) 2022-05-13 2023-11-16 Voyager Therapeutics, Inc. Compositions and methods for the treatment of her2 positive cancer
US11820819B2 (en) 2016-06-24 2023-11-21 Icell Gene Therapeutics Inc. Chimeric antigen receptors (CARs), compositions and methods thereof
US11851497B2 (en) 2017-11-20 2023-12-26 Compass Therapeutics Llc CD137 antibodies and tumor antigen-targeting antibodies and uses thereof
WO2024030976A2 (en) 2022-08-03 2024-02-08 Voyager Therapeutics, Inc. Compositions and methods for crossing the blood brain barrier
EP4324518A2 (en) 2014-01-31 2024-02-21 Novartis AG Antibody molecules to tim-3 and uses thereof

Families Citing this family (10)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
EP2095829A1 (en) * 2008-02-27 2009-09-02 LEK Pharmaceuticals D.D. Selenium containing modifying agents and conjugates
WO2011064758A2 (en) * 2009-11-30 2011-06-03 Pfizer Limited Fusion protein
ES2887299T3 (en) 2014-04-03 2021-12-22 Igm Biosciences Inc Modified J string
IL284430B1 (en) 2015-01-20 2023-12-01 Igm Biosciences Inc Tumor necrosis factor (tnf) superfamily receptor binding molecules and uses thereof
JP7058213B2 (en) 2015-09-30 2022-04-21 アイジーエム バイオサイエンシズ インコーポレイテッド Bonded molecule with modified J chain
WO2017059380A1 (en) 2015-09-30 2017-04-06 Igm Biosciences, Inc. Binding molecules with modified j-chain
CN111499724A (en) * 2020-04-15 2020-08-07 上海领潮生物新材料有限公司 Preparation method of S-adenosyl homocysteine-chicken ovalbumin conjugate
CN116600829A (en) 2020-05-22 2023-08-15 波士顿大学董事会 Methods and compositions for treating fibrotic diseases
WO2021247475A1 (en) * 2020-06-02 2021-12-09 Trustees Of Boston University Production of soluble relaxin and relaxin analogs
WO2023064841A1 (en) * 2021-10-13 2023-04-20 The Wistar Institute Of Anatomy And Biology Antibodies for use against sars-cov-2

Citations (34)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4179337A (en) * 1973-07-20 1979-12-18 Davis Frank F Non-immunogenic polypeptides
US4301144A (en) * 1979-07-11 1981-11-17 Ajinomoto Company, Incorporated Blood substitute containing modified hemoglobin
US4378347A (en) * 1980-06-30 1983-03-29 Franco Wayne P Composition for treating the heart for myocardial infarction
US4399216A (en) * 1980-02-25 1983-08-16 The Trustees Of Columbia University Processes for inserting DNA into eucaryotic cells and for producing proteinaceous materials
US4496689A (en) * 1983-12-27 1985-01-29 Miles Laboratories, Inc. Covalently attached complex of alpha-1-proteinase inhibitor with a water soluble polymer
US4640835A (en) * 1981-10-30 1987-02-03 Nippon Chemiphar Company, Ltd. Plasminogen activator derivatives
US4670417A (en) * 1985-06-19 1987-06-02 Ajinomoto Co., Inc. Hemoglobin combined with a poly(alkylene oxide)
US4774322A (en) * 1984-07-16 1988-09-27 Collagen Corporation Polypeptide cartilage-inducing factors found in bone
US4791192A (en) * 1986-06-26 1988-12-13 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Chemically modified protein with polyethyleneglycol
US4877864A (en) * 1987-03-26 1989-10-31 Genetics Institute, Inc. Osteoinductive factors
US4943529A (en) * 1982-05-19 1990-07-24 Gist-Brocades Nv Kluyveromyces as a host strain
US4946783A (en) * 1987-01-30 1990-08-07 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Periplasmic protease mutants of Escherichia coli
US5010182A (en) * 1987-07-28 1991-04-23 Chiron Corporation DNA constructs containing a Kluyveromyces alpha factor leader sequence for directing secretion of heterologous polypeptides
US5116964A (en) * 1989-02-23 1992-05-26 Genentech, Inc. Hybrid immunoglobulins
US5336603A (en) * 1987-10-02 1994-08-09 Genentech, Inc. CD4 adheson variants
US5359046A (en) * 1990-12-14 1994-10-25 Cell Genesys, Inc. Chimeric chains for receptor-associated signal transduction pathways
US5364934A (en) * 1991-02-01 1994-11-15 Genentech, Inc. Plasma carboxypeptidase
US5519115A (en) * 1991-02-01 1996-05-21 Enichem S.P.A. Reverse antimicrobial peptides
US5536637A (en) * 1993-04-07 1996-07-16 Genetics Institute, Inc. Method of screening for cDNA encoding novel secreted mammalian proteins in yeast
US5686279A (en) * 1993-06-11 1997-11-11 Cell Genesys, Inc. Method for production of high titer virus and high efficiency retroviral mediated transduction of mammalian cells
US5834247A (en) * 1992-12-09 1998-11-10 New England Biolabs, Inc. Modified proteins comprising controllable intervening protein sequences or their elements methods of producing same and methods for purification of a target protein comprised by a modified protein
US5838464A (en) * 1995-11-02 1998-11-17 Eastman Kodak Company System and method for scanning images contained on a strip of photosensitive film
US6184344B1 (en) * 1995-05-04 2001-02-06 The Scripps Research Institute Synthesis of proteins by native chemical ligation
US20040009498A1 (en) * 2002-01-14 2004-01-15 Diversa Corporation Chimeric antigen binding molecules and methods for making and using them
US6723535B2 (en) * 1997-09-17 2004-04-20 Genentech, Inc. Secreted and transmembrane polypeptides and nucleic acids encoding the same
US6849428B1 (en) * 1997-03-05 2005-02-01 New England Biolabs, Inc. Intein-mediated protein ligation of expressed proteins
US20050027109A1 (en) * 2003-05-06 2005-02-03 Mezo Adam R. Methods for chemically synthesizing immunoglobulin chimeric proteins
US20050100987A1 (en) * 1998-09-30 2005-05-12 Evans Thomas C. Intein-mediated protein ligation of expressed proteins
US6897285B2 (en) * 2002-02-28 2005-05-24 New England Biolabs, Inc. Modified chitin binding domain and uses thereof
US20050125860A1 (en) * 2002-01-08 2005-06-09 Raab R. M. Transgenic plants expressing CIVPS or intein modified proteins and related method
US20050260194A1 (en) * 2003-05-06 2005-11-24 Peters Robert T Immunoglobulin chimeric monomer-dimer hybrids
US20060199180A1 (en) * 2002-08-06 2006-09-07 Macina Roberto A Compositions and methods relating to ovarian specific genes and proteins
US7259015B2 (en) * 2000-10-06 2007-08-21 Oxford Biomedia (Uk) Limited Vector system
US7312195B2 (en) * 1998-09-14 2007-12-25 The University Of Queensland Cyclised conotoxin peptides

Family Cites Families (35)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
DE266710C (en)
US4352804A (en) 1978-07-25 1982-10-05 Acf Chemiefarma Nv Oxime ethers, their preparation and pharmaceutical compositions containing them
ZA811368B (en) 1980-03-24 1982-04-28 Genentech Inc Bacterial polypedtide expression employing tryptophan promoter-operator
NZ201705A (en) 1981-08-31 1986-03-14 Genentech Inc Recombinant dna method for production of hepatitis b surface antigen in yeast
AU2353384A (en) 1983-01-19 1984-07-26 Genentech Inc. Amplification in eukaryotic host cells
US4713339A (en) 1983-01-19 1987-12-15 Genentech, Inc. Polycistronic expression vector construction
NZ207394A (en) 1983-03-08 1987-03-06 Commw Serum Lab Commission Detecting or determining sequence of amino acids
US4816567A (en) 1983-04-08 1989-03-28 Genentech, Inc. Recombinant immunoglobin preparations
DD266710A3 (en) 1983-06-06 1989-04-12 Ve Forschungszentrum Biotechnologie Process for the biotechnical production of alkaline phosphatase
AU3145184A (en) 1983-08-16 1985-02-21 Zymogenetics Inc. High expression of foreign genes in schizosaccharomyces pombe
EP0173494A3 (en) 1984-08-27 1987-11-25 The Board Of Trustees Of The Leland Stanford Junior University Chimeric receptors by dna splicing and expression
US4879231A (en) 1984-10-30 1989-11-07 Phillips Petroleum Company Transformation of yeasts of the genus pichia
IL78197A (en) 1985-03-22 1991-07-18 Genentech Inc Nucleic acid encoding tgf-beta and its uses
WO1987005330A1 (en) 1986-03-07 1987-09-11 Michel Louis Eugene Bergh Method for enhancing glycoprotein stability
GB8610600D0 (en) 1986-04-30 1986-06-04 Novo Industri As Transformation of trichoderma
IL83003A (en) 1986-07-01 1995-07-31 Genetics Inst Osteoinductive factors
NZ222168A (en) 1986-10-20 1991-05-28 Oncogene Science Inc Tumour growth inhibiting protein related to tgf-#b#1 and tgf-#b#2, preparation by genetic engineering methods, antibodies and pharmaceutical compositions
AU612617B2 (en) 1986-11-17 1991-07-18 Sandoz Ag Production and use of a novel t-cell suppressor factor
IL87737A (en) 1987-09-11 1993-08-18 Genentech Inc Method for culturing polypeptide factor dependent vertebrate recombinant cells
GB8724885D0 (en) 1987-10-23 1987-11-25 Binns M M Fowlpox virus promotors
DE3889546T2 (en) 1987-12-21 1994-09-08 Univ Toledo TRANSFORMATION OF Germinating PLANT SEEDS WITH THE HELP OF AGROBACTERIUM.
EP1762623A1 (en) 1988-01-22 2007-03-14 ZymoGenetics, Inc. Methods for producing biologically active peptide dimers
AU4005289A (en) 1988-08-25 1990-03-01 Smithkline Beecham Corporation Recombinant saccharomyces
ATE144281T1 (en) 1989-04-28 1996-11-15 Rhein Biotech Proz & Prod Gmbh YEAST CELLS OF THE GENUS SCHWANNIOMYCES
FR2646437B1 (en) 1989-04-28 1991-08-30 Transgene Sa NOVEL DNA SEQUENCES, THEIR APPLICATION AS A SEQUENCE ENCODING A SIGNAL PEPTIDE FOR THE SECRETION OF MATURE PROTEINS BY RECOMBINANT YEASTS, EXPRESSION CASSETTES, PROCESSED YEASTS AND PROCESS FOR PREPARING THE SAME
EP0402226A1 (en) 1989-06-06 1990-12-12 Institut National De La Recherche Agronomique Transformation vectors for yeast yarrowia
FR2649120B1 (en) 1989-06-30 1994-01-28 Cayla NOVEL STRAIN AND ITS MUTANTS OF FILAMENTOUS MUSHROOMS, PROCESS FOR PRODUCING RECOMBINANT PROTEINS USING SAID STRAIN, AND STRAINS AND PROTEINS OBTAINED BY SAID METHOD
PL174721B1 (en) 1992-11-13 1998-09-30 Idec Pharma Corp Monoclonal antibody anty-cd2
CA2184282A1 (en) * 1994-03-07 1995-09-14 Olavi Siiman Covalent immobilized antibodies on polymeric beads
WO2000000625A1 (en) * 1998-06-26 2000-01-06 Ppl Therapeutics (Scotland) Limited Methods for production of recombinant polypeptides
WO2001057183A2 (en) * 2000-02-04 2001-08-09 New England Biolabs, Inc. Method for producing circular or multimeric protein species in vivo or in vitro and related methods
AU2001242732B2 (en) * 2001-02-26 2006-08-24 Council Of Scientific And Industrial Research Carrier systems comprising vitamin B12-biodegradable micro particulate conju gates for peroral delivery of drugs, peptides/proteins and vaccines
US20040265921A1 (en) * 2003-06-30 2004-12-30 National University Of Singapore Intein-mediated attachment of ligands to proteins for immobilization onto a support
JP2005154345A (en) * 2003-11-26 2005-06-16 Peptide Door Co Ltd Peptide or protein having affinity to il-2, and il-2 absorbent, il-2 testing reagent and il-2 neutralizing agent, using the peptide or protein
AU2007353396C1 (en) * 2006-11-02 2013-06-27 Biomolecular Holdings Llc Hybrid immunoglobulins with moving parts

Patent Citations (35)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4179337A (en) * 1973-07-20 1979-12-18 Davis Frank F Non-immunogenic polypeptides
US4301144A (en) * 1979-07-11 1981-11-17 Ajinomoto Company, Incorporated Blood substitute containing modified hemoglobin
US4399216A (en) * 1980-02-25 1983-08-16 The Trustees Of Columbia University Processes for inserting DNA into eucaryotic cells and for producing proteinaceous materials
US4378347A (en) * 1980-06-30 1983-03-29 Franco Wayne P Composition for treating the heart for myocardial infarction
US4640835A (en) * 1981-10-30 1987-02-03 Nippon Chemiphar Company, Ltd. Plasminogen activator derivatives
US4943529A (en) * 1982-05-19 1990-07-24 Gist-Brocades Nv Kluyveromyces as a host strain
US4496689A (en) * 1983-12-27 1985-01-29 Miles Laboratories, Inc. Covalently attached complex of alpha-1-proteinase inhibitor with a water soluble polymer
US4774322A (en) * 1984-07-16 1988-09-27 Collagen Corporation Polypeptide cartilage-inducing factors found in bone
US4670417A (en) * 1985-06-19 1987-06-02 Ajinomoto Co., Inc. Hemoglobin combined with a poly(alkylene oxide)
US4791192A (en) * 1986-06-26 1988-12-13 Takeda Chemical Industries, Ltd. Chemically modified protein with polyethyleneglycol
US4946783A (en) * 1987-01-30 1990-08-07 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Periplasmic protease mutants of Escherichia coli
US4877864A (en) * 1987-03-26 1989-10-31 Genetics Institute, Inc. Osteoinductive factors
US5010182A (en) * 1987-07-28 1991-04-23 Chiron Corporation DNA constructs containing a Kluyveromyces alpha factor leader sequence for directing secretion of heterologous polypeptides
US5336603A (en) * 1987-10-02 1994-08-09 Genentech, Inc. CD4 adheson variants
US5116964A (en) * 1989-02-23 1992-05-26 Genentech, Inc. Hybrid immunoglobulins
US5359046A (en) * 1990-12-14 1994-10-25 Cell Genesys, Inc. Chimeric chains for receptor-associated signal transduction pathways
US5364934A (en) * 1991-02-01 1994-11-15 Genentech, Inc. Plasma carboxypeptidase
US5519115A (en) * 1991-02-01 1996-05-21 Enichem S.P.A. Reverse antimicrobial peptides
US5834247A (en) * 1992-12-09 1998-11-10 New England Biolabs, Inc. Modified proteins comprising controllable intervening protein sequences or their elements methods of producing same and methods for purification of a target protein comprised by a modified protein
US5536637A (en) * 1993-04-07 1996-07-16 Genetics Institute, Inc. Method of screening for cDNA encoding novel secreted mammalian proteins in yeast
US5686279A (en) * 1993-06-11 1997-11-11 Cell Genesys, Inc. Method for production of high titer virus and high efficiency retroviral mediated transduction of mammalian cells
US6184344B1 (en) * 1995-05-04 2001-02-06 The Scripps Research Institute Synthesis of proteins by native chemical ligation
US5838464A (en) * 1995-11-02 1998-11-17 Eastman Kodak Company System and method for scanning images contained on a strip of photosensitive film
US6849428B1 (en) * 1997-03-05 2005-02-01 New England Biolabs, Inc. Intein-mediated protein ligation of expressed proteins
US6723535B2 (en) * 1997-09-17 2004-04-20 Genentech, Inc. Secreted and transmembrane polypeptides and nucleic acids encoding the same
US7312195B2 (en) * 1998-09-14 2007-12-25 The University Of Queensland Cyclised conotoxin peptides
US20050100987A1 (en) * 1998-09-30 2005-05-12 Evans Thomas C. Intein-mediated protein ligation of expressed proteins
US7259015B2 (en) * 2000-10-06 2007-08-21 Oxford Biomedia (Uk) Limited Vector system
US20050125860A1 (en) * 2002-01-08 2005-06-09 Raab R. M. Transgenic plants expressing CIVPS or intein modified proteins and related method
US20040009498A1 (en) * 2002-01-14 2004-01-15 Diversa Corporation Chimeric antigen binding molecules and methods for making and using them
US6897285B2 (en) * 2002-02-28 2005-05-24 New England Biolabs, Inc. Modified chitin binding domain and uses thereof
US20060199180A1 (en) * 2002-08-06 2006-09-07 Macina Roberto A Compositions and methods relating to ovarian specific genes and proteins
US20050027109A1 (en) * 2003-05-06 2005-02-03 Mezo Adam R. Methods for chemically synthesizing immunoglobulin chimeric proteins
US20050032174A1 (en) * 2003-05-06 2005-02-10 Peters Robert T. Immunoglobulin chimeric monomer-dimer hybrids
US20050260194A1 (en) * 2003-05-06 2005-11-24 Peters Robert T Immunoglobulin chimeric monomer-dimer hybrids

Non-Patent Citations (5)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
Dakappagari et al (Journal of Biological Chemistry, 2005, 280:54-63) *
Hitzeman et al (Use of Heterologous and Homologous Signal Sequences for Secretion of Heterologous Protein from Yeast, 1990, Meth Enzymolo, vol 185, pg 421-440) *
Hitzeman et al (Use of Heterologous and Homologous Signal Sequences for Secretion of Heterologous Protein from Yeast, Meth Enzymolo, 1990, vol 185, pg 421-440). *
Hondal et al (Semisynthesis of Proteins Containing Selenocysteine, Methods in Enzymology, 2002 vol 347, pg 70-83) *
Wright et al (Effect of Glycosylation on Antibody Function: Implications for Genetic Engineering, Trends in Biotech, 1997, vol 15, pg 26-32) *

Cited By (131)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US10428332B2 (en) 2006-11-02 2019-10-01 Daniel Capon Hybrid immunoglobulins with moving parts
US20100104510A1 (en) * 2007-04-02 2010-04-29 The United States Of America, As Represented By The Secretary, Department Of Health And Human Selenocysteine mediated hybrid antibody molecules
US8916159B2 (en) 2007-04-02 2014-12-23 The United States Of America, As Represented By The Secretary, Department Of Health And Human Services Selenocysteine mediated hybrid antibody molecules
CN107936092A (en) * 2010-01-29 2018-04-20 阿切尔丹尼尔斯密德兰公司 It is combined with the peptide domain of the small molecule of industrial significance
US9447150B2 (en) 2010-01-29 2016-09-20 Iowa State University Research Foundation, Inc. Peptide domains that bind small molecules of industrial significance
WO2011094617A3 (en) * 2010-01-29 2011-09-22 Archer-Daniels-Midland Company Peptide domains that bind small molecules of industrial significance
US9695217B2 (en) 2010-01-29 2017-07-04 Iowa State University Research Foundation, Inc. Peptide domains that bind small molecules
US9617312B2 (en) 2010-01-29 2017-04-11 Iowa State University Research Foundation, Inc. Peptide domains that bind small molecules of industrial significance
US11345745B2 (en) * 2011-10-31 2022-05-31 Biomolecular Holdings Llc Peptide-hinge-free flexible antibody-like molecule
EP2784080A4 (en) * 2011-10-31 2015-07-01 Shimadzu Corp Peptide-hinge-free flexible antibody-like molecule
US10968263B2 (en) 2012-07-17 2021-04-06 Biomolecular Holdings Llc Affinity support and method for trapping substance using the same
EP4039281A1 (en) 2013-03-15 2022-08-10 Biomolecular Holdings LLC Hybrid immunoglobulin containing non-peptidyl linkage
US11220556B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2022-01-11 Biomolecular Holdings Llc Hybrid immunoglobulin containing non-peptidyl linkage
EP3611180A1 (en) 2013-03-15 2020-02-19 Daniel J. Capon Hybrid immunoglobulin containing non-peptidyl linkage
US9580484B2 (en) * 2013-04-03 2017-02-28 Wan Keung Raymond Wong Means and method for expression of authentic human epidermal growth factor and/or basic fibrolast growth factor in cytoplasm and/or culture medium of Escherichia coli
US10273520B2 (en) 2013-04-03 2019-04-30 Wan Keung Raymond Wong Means and methods for hyper-production of authentic human basic fibroblast growth factor in Escherichia coli
US20160060318A1 (en) * 2013-04-03 2016-03-03 Wan Keung Raymond Wong Means and method for expression of authentic human epidermal growth factor and/or basic fibrolast growth factor in cytoplasm and/or culture medium of escherichia coli
CN106456809A (en) * 2013-12-03 2017-02-22 韦尔特生物分子医药有限责任公司 Antibodies targeting b-cell receptor complex membrane bound igm and uses thereof
EP3514179A1 (en) 2014-01-24 2019-07-24 Dana-Farber Cancer Institute, Inc. Antibody molecules to pd-1 and uses thereof
EP4324518A2 (en) 2014-01-31 2024-02-21 Novartis AG Antibody molecules to tim-3 and uses thereof
EP4169944A1 (en) 2014-03-14 2023-04-26 Biomolecular Holdings LLC Process for preparing hybrid immunoglobulin containing non-peptidyl linkage
EP3701971A1 (en) 2014-03-14 2020-09-02 Daniel J. Capon Compounds useful in preparing hybrid immunoglobulin containing non-peptidyl linkage
WO2015138920A1 (en) 2014-03-14 2015-09-17 Novartis Ag Antibody molecules to lag-3 and uses thereof
US11066459B2 (en) 2014-03-14 2021-07-20 Biomolecular Holdings Llc Hybrid immunoglobulin containing non-peptidyl linkage
EP3660050A1 (en) 2014-03-14 2020-06-03 Novartis AG Antibody molecules to lag-3 and uses thereof
WO2015142675A2 (en) 2014-03-15 2015-09-24 Novartis Ag Treatment of cancer using chimeric antigen receptor
WO2016014553A1 (en) 2014-07-21 2016-01-28 Novartis Ag Sortase synthesized chimeric antigen receptors
EP3722316A1 (en) 2014-07-21 2020-10-14 Novartis AG Treatment of cancer using a cd33 chimeric antigen receptor
WO2016014530A1 (en) 2014-07-21 2016-01-28 Novartis Ag Combinations of low, immune enhancing. doses of mtor inhibitors and cars
WO2016014565A2 (en) 2014-07-21 2016-01-28 Novartis Ag Treatment of cancer using humanized anti-bcma chimeric antigen receptor
EP4205749A1 (en) 2014-07-31 2023-07-05 Novartis AG Subset-optimized chimeric antigen receptor-containing cells
EP3660042A1 (en) 2014-07-31 2020-06-03 Novartis AG Subset-optimized chimeric antigen receptor-containing t-cells
WO2016025880A1 (en) 2014-08-14 2016-02-18 Novartis Ag Treatment of cancer using gfr alpha-4 chimeric antigen receptor
EP3712171A1 (en) 2014-08-19 2020-09-23 Novartis AG Treatment of cancer using a cd123 chimeric antigen receptor
WO2016044605A1 (en) 2014-09-17 2016-03-24 Beatty, Gregory Targeting cytotoxic cells with chimeric receptors for adoptive immunotherapy
EP3967709A1 (en) 2014-09-17 2022-03-16 Novartis AG Targeting cytotoxic cells with chimeric receptors for adoptive immunotherapy
EP4245376A2 (en) 2014-10-14 2023-09-20 Novartis AG Antibody molecules to pd-l1 and uses thereof
WO2016061142A1 (en) 2014-10-14 2016-04-21 Novartis Ag Antibody molecules to pd-l1 and uses thereof
WO2016090034A2 (en) 2014-12-03 2016-06-09 Novartis Ag Methods for b cell preconditioning in car therapy
CN107249602A (en) * 2015-02-27 2017-10-13 美商生物细胞基因治疗有限公司 Target the Chimeric antigen receptor of hematologic malignancies(CAR), its composition and application method
WO2017146767A1 (en) * 2015-02-27 2017-08-31 Icell Gene Therapeutics, Llc Chimeric antigen receptors (cars) targeting hematologic malignancies, compositions and methods of use thereof
US10273280B2 (en) 2015-02-27 2019-04-30 Icell Gene Therapeutics Llc Chimeric antigen receptors (CARs), targeting hematologic malignancies, compositions and methods of use thereof
CN109414428A (en) * 2015-02-27 2019-03-01 美商生物细胞基因治疗有限公司 Target the Chimeric antigen receptor (CAR) of hematologic malignancies, its composition and application method
WO2016164731A2 (en) 2015-04-08 2016-10-13 Novartis Ag Cd20 therapies, cd22 therapies, and combination therapies with a cd19 chimeric antigen receptor (car) - expressing cell
EP4056588A1 (en) 2015-04-08 2022-09-14 Novartis AG Cd20 therapies, cd22 therapies, and combination therapies with a cd19 chimeric antigen receptor (car)- expressing cell
WO2016172583A1 (en) 2015-04-23 2016-10-27 Novartis Ag Treatment of cancer using chimeric antigen receptor and protein kinase a blocker
US11655452B2 (en) 2015-06-25 2023-05-23 Icell Gene Therapeutics Inc. Chimeric antigen receptors (CARs), compositions and methods of use thereof
US11173179B2 (en) 2015-06-25 2021-11-16 Icell Gene Therapeutics Llc Chimeric antigen receptor (CAR) targeting multiple antigens, compositions and methods of use thereof
WO2017019894A1 (en) 2015-07-29 2017-02-02 Novartis Ag Combination therapies comprising antibody molecules to lag-3
WO2017019897A1 (en) 2015-07-29 2017-02-02 Novartis Ag Combination therapies comprising antibody molecules to tim-3
EP3878465A1 (en) 2015-07-29 2021-09-15 Novartis AG Combination therapies comprising antibody molecules to tim-3
EP3964528A1 (en) 2015-07-29 2022-03-09 Novartis AG Combination therapies comprising antibody molecules to lag-3
WO2017106656A1 (en) 2015-12-17 2017-06-22 Novartis Ag Antibody molecules to pd-1 and uses thereof
WO2017106810A2 (en) 2015-12-17 2017-06-22 Novartis Ag Combination of c-met inhibitor with antibody molecule to pd-1 and uses thereof
EP3851457A1 (en) 2016-01-21 2021-07-21 Novartis AG Multispecific molecules targeting cll-1
WO2017125897A1 (en) 2016-01-21 2017-07-27 Novartis Ag Multispecific molecules targeting cll-1
WO2017143840A1 (en) * 2016-02-23 2017-08-31 上海交通大学 Method for expressing and preparing polyvalent multi-specific antibody and immune hybrid protein
WO2017149515A1 (en) 2016-03-04 2017-09-08 Novartis Ag Cells expressing multiple chimeric antigen receptor (car) molecules and uses therefore
WO2017165683A1 (en) 2016-03-23 2017-09-28 Novartis Ag Cell secreted minibodies and uses thereof
WO2017181119A2 (en) 2016-04-15 2017-10-19 Novartis Ag Compositions and methods for selective protein expression
EP4219721A2 (en) 2016-04-15 2023-08-02 Novartis AG Compositions and methods for selective protein expression
WO2017210617A2 (en) 2016-06-02 2017-12-07 Porter, David, L. Therapeutic regimens for chimeric antigen receptor (car)- expressing cells
US11820819B2 (en) 2016-06-24 2023-11-21 Icell Gene Therapeutics Inc. Chimeric antigen receptors (CARs), compositions and methods thereof
US11155804B2 (en) 2016-07-11 2021-10-26 Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Recombinant polypeptides comprising selenocysteine and method for producing the same
WO2018013918A2 (en) 2016-07-15 2018-01-18 Novartis Ag Treatment and prevention of cytokine release syndrome using a chimeric antigen receptor in combination with a kinase inhibitor
WO2018023025A1 (en) 2016-07-28 2018-02-01 Novartis Ag Combination therapies of chimeric antigen receptors adn pd-1 inhibitors
WO2018026819A2 (en) 2016-08-01 2018-02-08 Novartis Ag Treatment of cancer using a chimeric antigen receptor in combination with an inhibitor of a pro-m2 macrophage molecule
WO2018067992A1 (en) 2016-10-07 2018-04-12 Novartis Ag Chimeric antigen receptors for the treatment of cancer
WO2018140725A1 (en) 2017-01-26 2018-08-02 Novartis Ag Cd28 compositions and methods for chimeric antigen receptor therapy
EP4043485A1 (en) 2017-01-26 2022-08-17 Novartis AG Cd28 compositions and methods for chimeric antigen receptor therapy
WO2018160731A1 (en) 2017-02-28 2018-09-07 Novartis Ag Shp inhibitor compositions and uses for chimeric antigen receptor therapy
WO2018201051A1 (en) 2017-04-28 2018-11-01 Novartis Ag Bcma-targeting agent, and combination therapy with a gamma secretase inhibitor
WO2018201056A1 (en) 2017-04-28 2018-11-01 Novartis Ag Cells expressing a bcma-targeting chimeric antigen receptor, and combination therapy with a gamma secretase inhibitor
WO2018237157A1 (en) 2017-06-22 2018-12-27 Novartis Ag Antibody molecules to cd73 and uses thereof
WO2019006007A1 (en) 2017-06-27 2019-01-03 Novartis Ag Dosage regimens for anti-tim-3 antibodies and uses thereof
US11752207B2 (en) 2017-07-11 2023-09-12 Compass Therapeutics Llc Agonist antibodies that bind human CD137 and uses thereof
WO2019018730A1 (en) 2017-07-20 2019-01-24 Novartis Ag Dosage regimens of anti-lag-3 antibodies and uses thereof
WO2019089798A1 (en) 2017-10-31 2019-05-09 Novartis Ag Anti-car compositions and methods
US11718679B2 (en) 2017-10-31 2023-08-08 Compass Therapeutics Llc CD137 antibodies and PD-1 antagonists and uses thereof
WO2019099838A1 (en) 2017-11-16 2019-05-23 Novartis Ag Combination therapies
US11851497B2 (en) 2017-11-20 2023-12-26 Compass Therapeutics Llc CD137 antibodies and tumor antigen-targeting antibodies and uses thereof
WO2019152660A1 (en) 2018-01-31 2019-08-08 Novartis Ag Combination therapy using a chimeric antigen receptor
CN111565738A (en) * 2018-02-28 2020-08-21 圆祥生命科技股份有限公司 Bifunctional proteins binding checkpoint blockers as targeted therapies
US11780922B2 (en) 2018-02-28 2023-10-10 Ap Biosciences, Inc. Bifunctional proteins combining checkpoint blockade for targeted therapy
WO2019168947A1 (en) * 2018-02-28 2019-09-06 Ap Biosciences, Inc. Bifunctional proteins combining checkpoint blockade for targeted therapy
RU2756899C1 (en) * 2018-02-28 2021-10-06 ЭйПи БАЙОСАЙЕНСИЗ, ИНК. Bifunctional proteins combining checkpoint blockade for targeted therapy
WO2019200229A1 (en) 2018-04-13 2019-10-17 Novartis Ag Dosage regimens for anti-pd-l1 antibodies and uses thereof
WO2019210153A1 (en) 2018-04-27 2019-10-31 Novartis Ag Car t cell therapies with enhanced efficacy
WO2019226617A1 (en) 2018-05-21 2019-11-28 Compass Therapeutics Llc Compositions and methods for enhancing the killing of target cells by nk cells
WO2019226658A1 (en) 2018-05-21 2019-11-28 Compass Therapeutics Llc Multispecific antigen-binding compositions and methods of use
WO2019227003A1 (en) 2018-05-25 2019-11-28 Novartis Ag Combination therapy with chimeric antigen receptor (car) therapies
WO2019232244A2 (en) 2018-05-31 2019-12-05 Novartis Ag Antibody molecules to cd73 and uses thereof
WO2019241426A1 (en) 2018-06-13 2019-12-19 Novartis Ag Bcma chimeric antigen receptors and uses thereof
WO2019246293A2 (en) 2018-06-19 2019-12-26 Atarga, Llc Antibody molecules to complement component 5 and uses thereof
WO2020012337A1 (en) 2018-07-10 2020-01-16 Novartis Ag 3-(5-amino-1-oxoisoindolin-2-yl)piperidine-2,6-dione derivatives and their use in the treatment of i karos family zinc finger 2 (ikzf2)-dependent diseases
WO2020021465A1 (en) 2018-07-25 2020-01-30 Advanced Accelerator Applications (Italy) S.R.L. Method of treatment of neuroendocrine tumors
US11046769B2 (en) 2018-11-13 2021-06-29 Compass Therapeutics Llc Multispecific binding constructs against checkpoint molecules and uses thereof
WO2020128972A1 (en) 2018-12-20 2020-06-25 Novartis Ag Dosing regimen and pharmaceutical combination comprising 3-(1-oxoisoindolin-2-yl)piperidine-2,6-dione derivatives
WO2020128898A1 (en) 2018-12-20 2020-06-25 Novartis Ag Pharmaceutical combinations
WO2020165833A1 (en) 2019-02-15 2020-08-20 Novartis Ag 3-(1-oxo-5-(piperidin-4-yl)isoindolin-2-yl)piperidine-2,6-dione derivatives and uses thereof
WO2020165868A1 (en) 2019-02-15 2020-08-20 Perkinelmer Cellular Technologies Germany Gmbh Low-power microscope-objective pre-scan and high-power microscope-objective scan in x,y and z-direction for imaging objects such as cells using a microscope
WO2020165834A1 (en) 2019-02-15 2020-08-20 Novartis Ag Substituted 3-(1-oxoisoindolin-2-yl)piperidine-2,6-dione derivatives and uses thereof
WO2020172553A1 (en) 2019-02-22 2020-08-27 Novartis Ag Combination therapies of egfrviii chimeric antigen receptors and pd-1 inhibitors
WO2020205523A1 (en) 2019-03-29 2020-10-08 Atarga, Llc Anti fgf23 antibody
US11267858B2 (en) 2019-05-31 2022-03-08 Spectrum Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Methods of treatment using G-CSF protein complex
WO2020243755A1 (en) * 2019-05-31 2020-12-03 Spectrum Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Methods of treatment using g-csf protein complex
US11684655B2 (en) 2019-05-31 2023-06-27 Spectrum Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Methods of treating neutorpenia using G-CSF protein complex
WO2021079188A1 (en) 2019-10-21 2021-04-29 Novartis Ag Combination therapies with venetoclax and tim-3 inhibitors
WO2021079195A1 (en) 2019-10-21 2021-04-29 Novartis Ag Tim-3 inhibitors and uses thereof
WO2021108661A2 (en) 2019-11-26 2021-06-03 Novartis Ag Chimeric antigen receptors and uses thereof
WO2021123902A1 (en) 2019-12-20 2021-06-24 Novartis Ag Combination of anti tim-3 antibody mbg453 and anti tgf-beta antibody nis793, with or without decitabine or the anti pd-1 antibody spartalizumab, for treating myelofibrosis and myelodysplastic syndrome
WO2021123996A1 (en) 2019-12-20 2021-06-24 Novartis Ag Uses of anti-tgf-beta antibodies and checkpoint inhibitors for the treatment of proliferative diseases
WO2021146636A1 (en) 2020-01-17 2021-07-22 Becton, Dickinson And Company Methods and compositions for single cell secretomics
WO2021144657A1 (en) 2020-01-17 2021-07-22 Novartis Ag Combination comprising a tim-3 inhibitor and a hypomethylating agent for use in treating myelodysplastic syndrome or chronic myelomonocytic leukemia
WO2021173995A2 (en) 2020-02-27 2021-09-02 Novartis Ag Methods of making chimeric antigen receptor-expressing cells
WO2021260528A1 (en) 2020-06-23 2021-12-30 Novartis Ag Dosing regimen comprising 3-(1-oxoisoindolin-2-yl)piperidine-2,6-dione derivatives
WO2022013787A1 (en) 2020-07-16 2022-01-20 Novartis Ag Anti-betacellulin antibodies, fragments thereof, and multi-specific binding molecules
WO2022026592A2 (en) 2020-07-28 2022-02-03 Celltas Bio, Inc. Antibody molecules to coronavirus and uses thereof
WO2022029573A1 (en) 2020-08-03 2022-02-10 Novartis Ag Heteroaryl substituted 3-(1-oxoisoindolin-2-yl)piperidine-2,6-dione derivatives and uses thereof
WO2022043558A1 (en) 2020-08-31 2022-03-03 Advanced Accelerator Applications International Sa Method of treating psma-expressing cancers
WO2022043557A1 (en) 2020-08-31 2022-03-03 Advanced Accelerator Applications International Sa Method of treating psma-expressing cancers
WO2022097065A2 (en) 2020-11-06 2022-05-12 Novartis Ag ANTIBODY Fc VARIANTS
WO2022104061A1 (en) 2020-11-13 2022-05-19 Novartis Ag Combination therapies with chimeric antigen receptor (car)-expressing cells
WO2022162569A1 (en) 2021-01-29 2022-08-04 Novartis Ag Dosage regimes for anti-cd73 and anti-entpd2 antibodies and uses thereof
WO2022215011A1 (en) 2021-04-07 2022-10-13 Novartis Ag USES OF ANTI-TGFβ ANTIBODIES AND OTHER THERAPEUTIC AGENTS FOR THE TREATMENT OF PROLIFERATIVE DISEASES
WO2022243846A1 (en) 2021-05-18 2022-11-24 Novartis Ag Combination therapies
WO2023044483A2 (en) 2021-09-20 2023-03-23 Voyager Therapeutics, Inc. Compositions and methods for the treatment of her2 positive cancer
WO2023092004A1 (en) 2021-11-17 2023-05-25 Voyager Therapeutics, Inc. Compositions and methods for the treatment of tau-related disorders
WO2023150778A1 (en) 2022-02-07 2023-08-10 Visterra, Inc. Anti-idiotype antibody molecules and uses thereof
WO2023220695A2 (en) 2022-05-13 2023-11-16 Voyager Therapeutics, Inc. Compositions and methods for the treatment of her2 positive cancer
WO2024030976A2 (en) 2022-08-03 2024-02-08 Voyager Therapeutics, Inc. Compositions and methods for crossing the blood brain barrier

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
HK1251609A1 (en) 2019-02-01
MX2009004664A (en) 2009-10-12
US20160376601A1 (en) 2016-12-29
US10428332B2 (en) 2019-10-01
JP2010509222A (en) 2010-03-25
JP2017019778A (en) 2017-01-26
EP2078040A4 (en) 2010-08-11
EP2078040B1 (en) 2017-06-28
EP3284825B1 (en) 2021-04-07
NZ576445A (en) 2012-03-30
JP5519287B2 (en) 2014-06-11
US20200032272A1 (en) 2020-01-30
WO2008140477A3 (en) 2009-08-27
IL198424A0 (en) 2011-08-01
BRPI0716680A2 (en) 2013-09-24
WO2008140477A9 (en) 2009-10-15
WO2008140477A2 (en) 2008-11-20
AU2007353396C1 (en) 2013-06-27
JP6012580B2 (en) 2016-10-25
JP6357194B2 (en) 2018-07-11
CA2668208C (en) 2017-09-12
DK3284825T3 (en) 2021-05-25
JP2014062105A (en) 2014-04-10
ES2870017T3 (en) 2021-10-26
IL198424A (en) 2015-05-31
EP2078040A2 (en) 2009-07-15
SG176476A1 (en) 2011-12-29
AU2007353396A1 (en) 2008-11-20
CN101965363A (en) 2011-02-02
KR20090105913A (en) 2009-10-07
AU2007353396B2 (en) 2012-12-13
AU2007353396B9 (en) 2013-01-17
CA2668208A1 (en) 2008-11-20
EP3284825A1 (en) 2018-02-21
WO2008140477A8 (en) 2009-04-23

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US10428332B2 (en) Hybrid immunoglobulins with moving parts
ES2767259T3 (en) Syntac polypeptides and uses thereof
EP3116486B1 (en) Hybrid immunoglobulin containing non-peptidyl linkage
JP6486686B2 (en) Single chain antibodies and other heteromultimers
CA2095836C (en) Cytokine immunoconjugates
AU2017222700B2 (en) Multi-specific molecules
CN112534052A (en) Novel IL-21 prodrugs and methods of use
EP2968495B1 (en) Hybrid immunoglobulin containing non-peptidyl linkage
JP2023535677A (en) tetrahedral antibody
CA3166420A1 (en) Il2 orthologs and methods of use
KR20130033273A (en) A fusion monoclonal antibody comprising igf-r1 antibody and il-2, and pharmaceutical composition comprising the same
WO2023137373A1 (en) Tetrahedral antibodies
WO2023137387A2 (en) Tetrahedral antibodies

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION

AS Assignment

Owner name: BIOMOLECULAR HOLDINGS LLC, CALIFORNIA

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:CAPON, DANIEL J.;REEL/FRAME:051756/0001

Effective date: 20191223